* opts.c (decode_options): Properly move optimization_default_node
[official-gcc.git] / gcc / dwarf2out.c
blobe5648090f9c12184f05fc747ebe125e2df6da8ec
1 /* Output Dwarf2 format symbol table information from GCC.
2 Copyright (C) 1992, 1993, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002,
3 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 Contributed by Gary Funck (gary@intrepid.com).
5 Derived from DWARF 1 implementation of Ron Guilmette (rfg@monkeys.com).
6 Extensively modified by Jason Merrill (jason@cygnus.com).
8 This file is part of GCC.
10 GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
11 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
12 Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option) any later
13 version.
15 GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
16 WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
17 FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
18 for more details.
20 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
21 along with GCC; see the file COPYING3. If not see
22 <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
24 /* TODO: Emit .debug_line header even when there are no functions, since
25 the file numbers are used by .debug_info. Alternately, leave
26 out locations for types and decls.
27 Avoid talking about ctors and op= for PODs.
28 Factor out common prologue sequences into multiple CIEs. */
30 /* The first part of this file deals with the DWARF 2 frame unwind
31 information, which is also used by the GCC efficient exception handling
32 mechanism. The second part, controlled only by an #ifdef
33 DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO, deals with the other DWARF 2 debugging
34 information. */
36 /* DWARF2 Abbreviation Glossary:
38 CFA = Canonical Frame Address
39 a fixed address on the stack which identifies a call frame.
40 We define it to be the value of SP just before the call insn.
41 The CFA register and offset, which may change during the course
42 of the function, are used to calculate its value at runtime.
44 CFI = Call Frame Instruction
45 an instruction for the DWARF2 abstract machine
47 CIE = Common Information Entry
48 information describing information common to one or more FDEs
50 DIE = Debugging Information Entry
52 FDE = Frame Description Entry
53 information describing the stack call frame, in particular,
54 how to restore registers
56 DW_CFA_... = DWARF2 CFA call frame instruction
57 DW_TAG_... = DWARF2 DIE tag */
59 #include "config.h"
60 #include "system.h"
61 #include "coretypes.h"
62 #include "tm.h"
63 #include "tree.h"
64 #include "version.h"
65 #include "flags.h"
66 #include "real.h"
67 #include "rtl.h"
68 #include "hard-reg-set.h"
69 #include "regs.h"
70 #include "insn-config.h"
71 #include "reload.h"
72 #include "function.h"
73 #include "output.h"
74 #include "expr.h"
75 #include "libfuncs.h"
76 #include "except.h"
77 #include "dwarf2.h"
78 #include "dwarf2out.h"
79 #include "dwarf2asm.h"
80 #include "toplev.h"
81 #include "varray.h"
82 #include "ggc.h"
83 #include "md5.h"
84 #include "tm_p.h"
85 #include "diagnostic.h"
86 #include "debug.h"
87 #include "target.h"
88 #include "langhooks.h"
89 #include "hashtab.h"
90 #include "cgraph.h"
91 #include "input.h"
92 #include "gimple.h"
93 #include "tree-pass.h"
95 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
96 static void dwarf2out_source_line (unsigned int, const char *, int, bool);
98 static rtx last_var_location_insn;
99 #endif
101 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
102 int vms_file_stats_name (const char *, long long *, long *, char *, int *);
104 /* Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the directory specifications
105 which are output in the debug info should end with a separator. */
106 #define DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR 1
107 /* Define this macro to evaluate to a nonzero value if GCC should refrain
108 from generating indirect strings in DWARF2 debug information, for instance
109 if your target is stuck with an old version of GDB that is unable to
110 process them properly or uses VMS Debug. */
111 #define DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET 1
112 #else
113 #define DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR 0
114 #define DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET 0
115 #endif
117 #ifndef DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
118 # ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
119 # define DWARF2_FRAME_INFO \
120 (write_symbols == DWARF2_DEBUG || write_symbols == VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG)
121 # else
122 # define DWARF2_FRAME_INFO 0
123 # endif
124 #endif
126 /* Map register numbers held in the call frame info that gcc has
127 collected using DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM to those that should be output in
128 .debug_frame and .eh_frame. */
129 #ifndef DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT
130 #define DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT(REGNO, FOR_EH) (REGNO)
131 #endif
133 /* Save the result of dwarf2out_do_frame across PCH. */
134 static GTY(()) bool saved_do_cfi_asm = 0;
136 /* Decide whether we want to emit frame unwind information for the current
137 translation unit. */
140 dwarf2out_do_frame (void)
142 /* We want to emit correct CFA location expressions or lists, so we
143 have to return true if we're going to output debug info, even if
144 we're not going to output frame or unwind info. */
145 return (write_symbols == DWARF2_DEBUG
146 || write_symbols == VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG
147 || DWARF2_FRAME_INFO || saved_do_cfi_asm
148 #ifdef DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
149 || (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
150 && (flag_unwind_tables
151 || (flag_exceptions && ! USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS)))
152 #endif
156 /* Decide whether to emit frame unwind via assembler directives. */
159 dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm (void)
161 int enc;
163 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
164 return false;
165 #endif
166 if (!flag_dwarf2_cfi_asm || !dwarf2out_do_frame ())
167 return false;
168 if (saved_do_cfi_asm)
169 return true;
170 if (!HAVE_GAS_CFI_PERSONALITY_DIRECTIVE)
171 return false;
173 /* Make sure the personality encoding is one the assembler can support.
174 In particular, aligned addresses can't be handled. */
175 enc = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2,/*global=*/1);
176 if ((enc & 0x70) != 0 && (enc & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_pcrel)
177 return false;
178 enc = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0,/*global=*/0);
179 if ((enc & 0x70) != 0 && (enc & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_pcrel)
180 return false;
182 if (!HAVE_GAS_CFI_SECTIONS_DIRECTIVE)
184 #ifdef TARGET_UNWIND_INFO
185 return false;
186 #else
187 if (USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS || (!flag_unwind_tables && !flag_exceptions))
188 return false;
189 #endif
192 saved_do_cfi_asm = true;
193 return true;
196 /* The size of the target's pointer type. */
197 #ifndef PTR_SIZE
198 #define PTR_SIZE (POINTER_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT)
199 #endif
201 /* Array of RTXes referenced by the debugging information, which therefore
202 must be kept around forever. */
203 static GTY(()) VEC(rtx,gc) *used_rtx_array;
205 /* A pointer to the base of a list of incomplete types which might be
206 completed at some later time. incomplete_types_list needs to be a
207 VEC(tree,gc) because we want to tell the garbage collector about
208 it. */
209 static GTY(()) VEC(tree,gc) *incomplete_types;
211 /* A pointer to the base of a table of references to declaration
212 scopes. This table is a display which tracks the nesting
213 of declaration scopes at the current scope and containing
214 scopes. This table is used to find the proper place to
215 define type declaration DIE's. */
216 static GTY(()) VEC(tree,gc) *decl_scope_table;
218 /* Pointers to various DWARF2 sections. */
219 static GTY(()) section *debug_info_section;
220 static GTY(()) section *debug_abbrev_section;
221 static GTY(()) section *debug_aranges_section;
222 static GTY(()) section *debug_macinfo_section;
223 static GTY(()) section *debug_line_section;
224 static GTY(()) section *debug_loc_section;
225 static GTY(()) section *debug_pubnames_section;
226 static GTY(()) section *debug_pubtypes_section;
227 static GTY(()) section *debug_dcall_section;
228 static GTY(()) section *debug_vcall_section;
229 static GTY(()) section *debug_str_section;
230 static GTY(()) section *debug_ranges_section;
231 static GTY(()) section *debug_frame_section;
233 /* Personality decl of current unit. Used only when assembler does not support
234 personality CFI. */
235 static GTY(()) rtx current_unit_personality;
237 /* How to start an assembler comment. */
238 #ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
239 #define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
240 #endif
242 typedef struct dw_cfi_struct *dw_cfi_ref;
243 typedef struct dw_fde_struct *dw_fde_ref;
244 typedef union dw_cfi_oprnd_struct *dw_cfi_oprnd_ref;
246 /* Call frames are described using a sequence of Call Frame
247 Information instructions. The register number, offset
248 and address fields are provided as possible operands;
249 their use is selected by the opcode field. */
251 enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type {
252 dw_cfi_oprnd_unused,
253 dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num,
254 dw_cfi_oprnd_offset,
255 dw_cfi_oprnd_addr,
256 dw_cfi_oprnd_loc
259 typedef union GTY(()) dw_cfi_oprnd_struct {
260 unsigned int GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num"))) dw_cfi_reg_num;
261 HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_offset"))) dw_cfi_offset;
262 const char * GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_addr"))) dw_cfi_addr;
263 struct dw_loc_descr_struct * GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_loc"))) dw_cfi_loc;
265 dw_cfi_oprnd;
267 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_cfi_struct {
268 dw_cfi_ref dw_cfi_next;
269 enum dwarf_call_frame_info dw_cfi_opc;
270 dw_cfi_oprnd GTY ((desc ("dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc (%1.dw_cfi_opc)")))
271 dw_cfi_oprnd1;
272 dw_cfi_oprnd GTY ((desc ("dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc (%1.dw_cfi_opc)")))
273 dw_cfi_oprnd2;
275 dw_cfi_node;
277 /* This is how we define the location of the CFA. We use to handle it
278 as REG + OFFSET all the time, but now it can be more complex.
279 It can now be either REG + CFA_OFFSET or *(REG + BASE_OFFSET) + CFA_OFFSET.
280 Instead of passing around REG and OFFSET, we pass a copy
281 of this structure. */
282 typedef struct GTY(()) cfa_loc {
283 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
284 HOST_WIDE_INT base_offset;
285 unsigned int reg;
286 BOOL_BITFIELD indirect : 1; /* 1 if CFA is accessed via a dereference. */
287 BOOL_BITFIELD in_use : 1; /* 1 if a saved cfa is stored here. */
288 } dw_cfa_location;
290 /* All call frame descriptions (FDE's) in the GCC generated DWARF
291 refer to a single Common Information Entry (CIE), defined at
292 the beginning of the .debug_frame section. This use of a single
293 CIE obviates the need to keep track of multiple CIE's
294 in the DWARF generation routines below. */
296 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_fde_struct {
297 tree decl;
298 const char *dw_fde_begin;
299 const char *dw_fde_current_label;
300 const char *dw_fde_end;
301 const char *dw_fde_hot_section_label;
302 const char *dw_fde_hot_section_end_label;
303 const char *dw_fde_unlikely_section_label;
304 const char *dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label;
305 dw_cfi_ref dw_fde_cfi;
306 dw_cfi_ref dw_fde_switch_cfi; /* Last CFI before switching sections. */
307 unsigned funcdef_number;
308 HOST_WIDE_INT stack_realignment;
309 /* Dynamic realign argument pointer register. */
310 unsigned int drap_reg;
311 /* Virtual dynamic realign argument pointer register. */
312 unsigned int vdrap_reg;
313 unsigned all_throwers_are_sibcalls : 1;
314 unsigned nothrow : 1;
315 unsigned uses_eh_lsda : 1;
316 /* Whether we did stack realign in this call frame. */
317 unsigned stack_realign : 1;
318 /* Whether dynamic realign argument pointer register has been saved. */
319 unsigned drap_reg_saved: 1;
320 /* True iff dw_fde_begin label is in text_section or cold_text_section. */
321 unsigned in_std_section : 1;
322 /* True iff dw_fde_unlikely_section_label is in text_section or
323 cold_text_section. */
324 unsigned cold_in_std_section : 1;
325 /* True iff switched sections. */
326 unsigned dw_fde_switched_sections : 1;
327 /* True iff switching from cold to hot section. */
328 unsigned dw_fde_switched_cold_to_hot : 1;
330 dw_fde_node;
332 /* Maximum size (in bytes) of an artificially generated label. */
333 #define MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES 30
335 /* The size of addresses as they appear in the Dwarf 2 data.
336 Some architectures use word addresses to refer to code locations,
337 but Dwarf 2 info always uses byte addresses. On such machines,
338 Dwarf 2 addresses need to be larger than the architecture's
339 pointers. */
340 #ifndef DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
341 #define DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE (POINTER_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT)
342 #endif
344 /* The size in bytes of a DWARF field indicating an offset or length
345 relative to a debug info section, specified to be 4 bytes in the
346 DWARF-2 specification. The SGI/MIPS ABI defines it to be the same
347 as PTR_SIZE. */
349 #ifndef DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
350 #define DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE 4
351 #endif
353 /* The size in bytes of a DWARF 4 type signature. */
355 #ifndef DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE
356 #define DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE 8
357 #endif
359 /* According to the (draft) DWARF 3 specification, the initial length
360 should either be 4 or 12 bytes. When it's 12 bytes, the first 4
361 bytes are 0xffffffff, followed by the length stored in the next 8
362 bytes.
364 However, the SGI/MIPS ABI uses an initial length which is equal to
365 DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE. It is defined (elsewhere) accordingly. */
367 #ifndef DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE
368 #define DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? 4 : 12)
369 #endif
371 /* Round SIZE up to the nearest BOUNDARY. */
372 #define DWARF_ROUND(SIZE,BOUNDARY) \
373 ((((SIZE) + (BOUNDARY) - 1) / (BOUNDARY)) * (BOUNDARY))
375 /* Offsets recorded in opcodes are a multiple of this alignment factor. */
376 #ifndef DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
377 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
378 #define DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT (-((int) UNITS_PER_WORD))
379 #else
380 #define DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT ((int) UNITS_PER_WORD)
381 #endif
382 #endif
384 /* CIE identifier. */
385 #if HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64
386 #define DWARF_CIE_ID \
387 (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? DW_CIE_ID : DW64_CIE_ID)
388 #else
389 #define DWARF_CIE_ID DW_CIE_ID
390 #endif
392 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains frame description
393 information for each routine. */
394 static GTY((length ("fde_table_allocated"))) dw_fde_ref fde_table;
396 /* Number of elements currently allocated for fde_table. */
397 static GTY(()) unsigned fde_table_allocated;
399 /* Number of elements in fde_table currently in use. */
400 static GTY(()) unsigned fde_table_in_use;
402 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
403 fde_table. */
404 #define FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT 256
406 /* Get the current fde_table entry we should use. */
408 static inline dw_fde_ref
409 current_fde (void)
411 return fde_table_in_use ? &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1] : NULL;
414 /* A list of call frame insns for the CIE. */
415 static GTY(()) dw_cfi_ref cie_cfi_head;
417 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
418 /* Some DWARF extensions (e.g., MIPS/SGI) implement a subprogram
419 attribute that accelerates the lookup of the FDE associated
420 with the subprogram. This variable holds the table index of the FDE
421 associated with the current function (body) definition. */
422 static unsigned current_funcdef_fde;
423 #endif
425 struct GTY(()) indirect_string_node {
426 const char *str;
427 unsigned int refcount;
428 enum dwarf_form form;
429 char *label;
432 static GTY ((param_is (struct indirect_string_node))) htab_t debug_str_hash;
434 /* True if the compilation unit has location entries that reference
435 debug strings. */
436 static GTY(()) bool debug_str_hash_forced = false;
438 static GTY(()) int dw2_string_counter;
439 static GTY(()) unsigned long dwarf2out_cfi_label_num;
441 /* True if the compilation unit places functions in more than one section. */
442 static GTY(()) bool have_multiple_function_sections = false;
444 /* Whether the default text and cold text sections have been used at all. */
446 static GTY(()) bool text_section_used = false;
447 static GTY(()) bool cold_text_section_used = false;
449 /* The default cold text section. */
450 static GTY(()) section *cold_text_section;
452 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
454 /* Forward declarations for functions defined in this file. */
456 static char *stripattributes (const char *);
457 static const char *dwarf_cfi_name (unsigned);
458 static dw_cfi_ref new_cfi (void);
459 static void add_cfi (dw_cfi_ref *, dw_cfi_ref);
460 static void add_fde_cfi (const char *, dw_cfi_ref);
461 static void lookup_cfa_1 (dw_cfi_ref, dw_cfa_location *, dw_cfa_location *);
462 static void lookup_cfa (dw_cfa_location *);
463 static void reg_save (const char *, unsigned, unsigned, HOST_WIDE_INT);
464 #ifdef DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
465 static void initial_return_save (rtx);
466 #endif
467 static HOST_WIDE_INT stack_adjust_offset (const_rtx, HOST_WIDE_INT,
468 HOST_WIDE_INT);
469 static void output_cfi (dw_cfi_ref, dw_fde_ref, int);
470 static void output_cfi_directive (dw_cfi_ref);
471 static void output_call_frame_info (int);
472 static void dwarf2out_note_section_used (void);
473 static void dwarf2out_stack_adjust (rtx, bool);
474 static void dwarf2out_args_size_adjust (HOST_WIDE_INT, const char *);
475 static void flush_queued_reg_saves (void);
476 static bool clobbers_queued_reg_save (const_rtx);
477 static void dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (rtx, const char *);
479 /* Support for complex CFA locations. */
480 static void output_cfa_loc (dw_cfi_ref);
481 static void output_cfa_loc_raw (dw_cfi_ref);
482 static void get_cfa_from_loc_descr (dw_cfa_location *,
483 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *);
484 static struct dw_loc_descr_struct *build_cfa_loc
485 (dw_cfa_location *, HOST_WIDE_INT);
486 static struct dw_loc_descr_struct *build_cfa_aligned_loc
487 (HOST_WIDE_INT, HOST_WIDE_INT);
488 static void def_cfa_1 (const char *, dw_cfa_location *);
490 /* How to start an assembler comment. */
491 #ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
492 #define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
493 #endif
495 /* Data and reference forms for relocatable data. */
496 #define DW_FORM_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8 ? DW_FORM_data8 : DW_FORM_data4)
497 #define DW_FORM_ref (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8 ? DW_FORM_ref8 : DW_FORM_ref4)
499 #ifndef DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION
500 #define DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION ".debug_frame"
501 #endif
503 #ifndef FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL
504 #define FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL "LFB"
505 #endif
507 #ifndef FUNC_END_LABEL
508 #define FUNC_END_LABEL "LFE"
509 #endif
511 #ifndef FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL
512 #define FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL "Lframe"
513 #endif
514 #define CIE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL "LSCIE"
515 #define CIE_END_LABEL "LECIE"
516 #define FDE_LABEL "LSFDE"
517 #define FDE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL "LASFDE"
518 #define FDE_END_LABEL "LEFDE"
519 #define LINE_NUMBER_BEGIN_LABEL "LSLT"
520 #define LINE_NUMBER_END_LABEL "LELT"
521 #define LN_PROLOG_AS_LABEL "LASLTP"
522 #define LN_PROLOG_END_LABEL "LELTP"
523 #define DIE_LABEL_PREFIX "DW"
525 /* The DWARF 2 CFA column which tracks the return address. Normally this
526 is the column for PC, or the first column after all of the hard
527 registers. */
528 #ifndef DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
529 #ifdef PC_REGNUM
530 #define DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (PC_REGNUM)
531 #else
532 #define DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
533 #endif
534 #endif
536 /* The mapping from gcc register number to DWARF 2 CFA column number. By
537 default, we just provide columns for all registers. */
538 #ifndef DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM
539 #define DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM(REG) DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (REG)
540 #endif
542 /* Hook used by __throw. */
545 expand_builtin_dwarf_sp_column (void)
547 unsigned int dwarf_regnum = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
548 return GEN_INT (DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (dwarf_regnum, 1));
551 /* Return a pointer to a copy of the section string name S with all
552 attributes stripped off, and an asterisk prepended (for assemble_name). */
554 static inline char *
555 stripattributes (const char *s)
557 char *stripped = XNEWVEC (char, strlen (s) + 2);
558 char *p = stripped;
560 *p++ = '*';
562 while (*s && *s != ',')
563 *p++ = *s++;
565 *p = '\0';
566 return stripped;
569 /* MEM is a memory reference for the register size table, each element of
570 which has mode MODE. Initialize column C as a return address column. */
572 static void
573 init_return_column_size (enum machine_mode mode, rtx mem, unsigned int c)
575 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = c * GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
576 HOST_WIDE_INT size = GET_MODE_SIZE (Pmode);
577 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (mem, mode, offset), GEN_INT (size));
580 /* Divide OFF by DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT, asserting no remainder. */
582 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
583 div_data_align (HOST_WIDE_INT off)
585 HOST_WIDE_INT r = off / DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
586 gcc_assert (r * DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT == off);
587 return r;
590 /* Return true if we need a signed version of a given opcode
591 (e.g. DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf vs DW_CFA_offset_extended). */
593 static inline bool
594 need_data_align_sf_opcode (HOST_WIDE_INT off)
596 return DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT < 0 ? off > 0 : off < 0;
599 /* Generate code to initialize the register size table. */
601 void
602 expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes (tree address)
604 unsigned int i;
605 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (char_type_node);
606 rtx addr = expand_normal (address);
607 rtx mem = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, addr);
608 bool wrote_return_column = false;
610 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
612 int rnum = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i), 1);
614 if (rnum < DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS)
616 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = rnum * GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
617 enum machine_mode save_mode = reg_raw_mode[i];
618 HOST_WIDE_INT size;
620 if (HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (i, save_mode))
621 save_mode = choose_hard_reg_mode (i, 1, true);
622 if (DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i) == DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN)
624 if (save_mode == VOIDmode)
625 continue;
626 wrote_return_column = true;
628 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (save_mode);
629 if (offset < 0)
630 continue;
632 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (mem, mode, offset),
633 gen_int_mode (size, mode));
637 if (!wrote_return_column)
638 init_return_column_size (mode, mem, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN);
640 #ifdef DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
641 init_return_column_size (mode, mem, DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN);
642 #endif
644 targetm.init_dwarf_reg_sizes_extra (address);
647 /* Convert a DWARF call frame info. operation to its string name */
649 static const char *
650 dwarf_cfi_name (unsigned int cfi_opc)
652 switch (cfi_opc)
654 case DW_CFA_advance_loc:
655 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc";
656 case DW_CFA_offset:
657 return "DW_CFA_offset";
658 case DW_CFA_restore:
659 return "DW_CFA_restore";
660 case DW_CFA_nop:
661 return "DW_CFA_nop";
662 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
663 return "DW_CFA_set_loc";
664 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
665 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc1";
666 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
667 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc2";
668 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
669 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc4";
670 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
671 return "DW_CFA_offset_extended";
672 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
673 return "DW_CFA_restore_extended";
674 case DW_CFA_undefined:
675 return "DW_CFA_undefined";
676 case DW_CFA_same_value:
677 return "DW_CFA_same_value";
678 case DW_CFA_register:
679 return "DW_CFA_register";
680 case DW_CFA_remember_state:
681 return "DW_CFA_remember_state";
682 case DW_CFA_restore_state:
683 return "DW_CFA_restore_state";
684 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
685 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa";
686 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
687 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_register";
688 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
689 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset";
691 /* DWARF 3 */
692 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
693 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression";
694 case DW_CFA_expression:
695 return "DW_CFA_expression";
696 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
697 return "DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf";
698 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
699 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf";
700 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
701 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf";
703 /* SGI/MIPS specific */
704 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
705 return "DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8";
707 /* GNU extensions */
708 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
709 return "DW_CFA_GNU_window_save";
710 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
711 return "DW_CFA_GNU_args_size";
712 case DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended:
713 return "DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended";
715 default:
716 return "DW_CFA_<unknown>";
720 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated Call Frame Instruction. */
722 static inline dw_cfi_ref
723 new_cfi (void)
725 dw_cfi_ref cfi = GGC_NEW (dw_cfi_node);
727 cfi->dw_cfi_next = NULL;
728 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = 0;
729 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num = 0;
731 return cfi;
734 /* Add a Call Frame Instruction to list of instructions. */
736 static inline void
737 add_cfi (dw_cfi_ref *list_head, dw_cfi_ref cfi)
739 dw_cfi_ref *p;
740 dw_fde_ref fde = current_fde ();
742 /* When DRAP is used, CFA is defined with an expression. Redefine
743 CFA may lead to a different CFA value. */
744 /* ??? Of course, this heuristic fails when we're annotating epilogues,
745 because of course we'll always want to redefine the CFA back to the
746 stack pointer on the way out. Where should we move this check? */
747 if (0 && fde && fde->drap_reg != INVALID_REGNUM)
748 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
750 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
751 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
752 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
753 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
754 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
755 gcc_unreachable ();
757 default:
758 break;
761 /* Find the end of the chain. */
762 for (p = list_head; (*p) != NULL; p = &(*p)->dw_cfi_next)
765 *p = cfi;
768 /* Generate a new label for the CFI info to refer to. FORCE is true
769 if a label needs to be output even when using .cfi_* directives. */
771 char *
772 dwarf2out_cfi_label (bool force)
774 static char label[20];
776 if (!force && dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
778 /* In this case, we will be emitting the asm directive instead of
779 the label, so just return a placeholder to keep the rest of the
780 interfaces happy. */
781 strcpy (label, "<do not output>");
783 else
785 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LCFI", dwarf2out_cfi_label_num++);
786 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, label);
789 return label;
792 /* True if remember_state should be emitted before following CFI directive. */
793 static bool emit_cfa_remember;
795 /* Add CFI to the current fde at the PC value indicated by LABEL if specified,
796 or to the CIE if LABEL is NULL. */
798 static void
799 add_fde_cfi (const char *label, dw_cfi_ref cfi)
801 dw_cfi_ref *list_head;
803 if (emit_cfa_remember)
805 dw_cfi_ref cfi_remember;
807 /* Emit the state save. */
808 emit_cfa_remember = false;
809 cfi_remember = new_cfi ();
810 cfi_remember->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_remember_state;
811 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi_remember);
814 list_head = &cie_cfi_head;
816 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
818 if (label)
820 dw_fde_ref fde = current_fde ();
822 gcc_assert (fde != NULL);
824 /* We still have to add the cfi to the list so that lookup_cfa
825 works later on. When -g2 and above we even need to force
826 emitting of CFI labels and add to list a DW_CFA_set_loc for
827 convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list purposes. If we're generating
828 DWARF3 output we use DW_OP_call_frame_cfa and so don't use
829 convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list. */
830 if (dwarf_version == 2
831 && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
832 && (write_symbols == DWARF2_DEBUG
833 || write_symbols == VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG))
835 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
837 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
838 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
839 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
840 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
841 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
842 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
843 case DW_CFA_restore_state:
844 if (*label == 0 || strcmp (label, "<do not output>") == 0)
845 label = dwarf2out_cfi_label (true);
847 if (fde->dw_fde_current_label == NULL
848 || strcmp (label, fde->dw_fde_current_label) != 0)
850 dw_cfi_ref xcfi;
852 label = xstrdup (label);
854 /* Set the location counter to the new label. */
855 xcfi = new_cfi ();
856 /* It doesn't metter whether DW_CFA_set_loc
857 or DW_CFA_advance_loc4 is added here, those aren't
858 emitted into assembly, only looked up by
859 convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list. */
860 xcfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_set_loc;
861 xcfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr = label;
862 add_cfi (&fde->dw_fde_cfi, xcfi);
863 fde->dw_fde_current_label = label;
865 break;
866 default:
867 break;
871 output_cfi_directive (cfi);
873 list_head = &fde->dw_fde_cfi;
875 /* ??? If this is a CFI for the CIE, we don't emit. This
876 assumes that the standard CIE contents that the assembler
877 uses matches the standard CIE contents that the compiler
878 uses. This is probably a bad assumption. I'm not quite
879 sure how to address this for now. */
881 else if (label)
883 dw_fde_ref fde = current_fde ();
885 gcc_assert (fde != NULL);
887 if (*label == 0)
888 label = dwarf2out_cfi_label (false);
890 if (fde->dw_fde_current_label == NULL
891 || strcmp (label, fde->dw_fde_current_label) != 0)
893 dw_cfi_ref xcfi;
895 label = xstrdup (label);
897 /* Set the location counter to the new label. */
898 xcfi = new_cfi ();
899 /* If we have a current label, advance from there, otherwise
900 set the location directly using set_loc. */
901 xcfi->dw_cfi_opc = fde->dw_fde_current_label
902 ? DW_CFA_advance_loc4
903 : DW_CFA_set_loc;
904 xcfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr = label;
905 add_cfi (&fde->dw_fde_cfi, xcfi);
907 fde->dw_fde_current_label = label;
910 list_head = &fde->dw_fde_cfi;
913 add_cfi (list_head, cfi);
916 /* Subroutine of lookup_cfa. */
918 static void
919 lookup_cfa_1 (dw_cfi_ref cfi, dw_cfa_location *loc, dw_cfa_location *remember)
921 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
923 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
924 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
925 loc->offset = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset;
926 break;
927 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
928 loc->reg = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num;
929 break;
930 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
931 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
932 loc->reg = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num;
933 loc->offset = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset;
934 break;
935 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
936 get_cfa_from_loc_descr (loc, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc);
937 break;
939 case DW_CFA_remember_state:
940 gcc_assert (!remember->in_use);
941 *remember = *loc;
942 remember->in_use = 1;
943 break;
944 case DW_CFA_restore_state:
945 gcc_assert (remember->in_use);
946 *loc = *remember;
947 remember->in_use = 0;
948 break;
950 default:
951 break;
955 /* Find the previous value for the CFA. */
957 static void
958 lookup_cfa (dw_cfa_location *loc)
960 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
961 dw_fde_ref fde;
962 dw_cfa_location remember;
964 memset (loc, 0, sizeof (*loc));
965 loc->reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
966 remember = *loc;
968 for (cfi = cie_cfi_head; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
969 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, loc, &remember);
971 fde = current_fde ();
972 if (fde)
973 for (cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
974 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, loc, &remember);
977 /* The current rule for calculating the DWARF2 canonical frame address. */
978 static dw_cfa_location cfa;
980 /* The register used for saving registers to the stack, and its offset
981 from the CFA. */
982 static dw_cfa_location cfa_store;
984 /* The current save location around an epilogue. */
985 static dw_cfa_location cfa_remember;
987 /* The running total of the size of arguments pushed onto the stack. */
988 static HOST_WIDE_INT args_size;
990 /* The last args_size we actually output. */
991 static HOST_WIDE_INT old_args_size;
993 /* Entry point to update the canonical frame address (CFA).
994 LABEL is passed to add_fde_cfi. The value of CFA is now to be
995 calculated from REG+OFFSET. */
997 void
998 dwarf2out_def_cfa (const char *label, unsigned int reg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
1000 dw_cfa_location loc;
1001 loc.indirect = 0;
1002 loc.base_offset = 0;
1003 loc.reg = reg;
1004 loc.offset = offset;
1005 def_cfa_1 (label, &loc);
1008 /* Determine if two dw_cfa_location structures define the same data. */
1010 static bool
1011 cfa_equal_p (const dw_cfa_location *loc1, const dw_cfa_location *loc2)
1013 return (loc1->reg == loc2->reg
1014 && loc1->offset == loc2->offset
1015 && loc1->indirect == loc2->indirect
1016 && (loc1->indirect == 0
1017 || loc1->base_offset == loc2->base_offset));
1020 /* This routine does the actual work. The CFA is now calculated from
1021 the dw_cfa_location structure. */
1023 static void
1024 def_cfa_1 (const char *label, dw_cfa_location *loc_p)
1026 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
1027 dw_cfa_location old_cfa, loc;
1029 cfa = *loc_p;
1030 loc = *loc_p;
1032 if (cfa_store.reg == loc.reg && loc.indirect == 0)
1033 cfa_store.offset = loc.offset;
1035 loc.reg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (loc.reg);
1036 lookup_cfa (&old_cfa);
1038 /* If nothing changed, no need to issue any call frame instructions. */
1039 if (cfa_equal_p (&loc, &old_cfa))
1040 return;
1042 cfi = new_cfi ();
1044 if (loc.reg == old_cfa.reg && !loc.indirect)
1046 /* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset <offset>" instruction, indicating
1047 the CFA register did not change but the offset did. The data
1048 factoring for DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf happens in output_cfi, or
1049 in the assembler via the .cfi_def_cfa_offset directive. */
1050 if (loc.offset < 0)
1051 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf;
1052 else
1053 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset;
1054 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset = loc.offset;
1057 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO /* SGI dbx thinks this means no offset. */
1058 else if (loc.offset == old_cfa.offset
1059 && old_cfa.reg != INVALID_REGNUM
1060 && !loc.indirect)
1062 /* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa_register <register>" instruction,
1063 indicating the CFA register has changed to <register> but the
1064 offset has not changed. */
1065 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_register;
1066 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = loc.reg;
1068 #endif
1070 else if (loc.indirect == 0)
1072 /* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa <register> <offset>" instruction,
1073 indicating the CFA register has changed to <register> with
1074 the specified offset. The data factoring for DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf
1075 happens in output_cfi, or in the assembler via the .cfi_def_cfa
1076 directive. */
1077 if (loc.offset < 0)
1078 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf;
1079 else
1080 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa;
1081 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = loc.reg;
1082 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset = loc.offset;
1084 else
1086 /* Construct a DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression instruction to
1087 calculate the CFA using a full location expression since no
1088 register-offset pair is available. */
1089 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *loc_list;
1091 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression;
1092 loc_list = build_cfa_loc (&loc, 0);
1093 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc = loc_list;
1096 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
1099 /* Add the CFI for saving a register. REG is the CFA column number.
1100 LABEL is passed to add_fde_cfi.
1101 If SREG is -1, the register is saved at OFFSET from the CFA;
1102 otherwise it is saved in SREG. */
1104 static void
1105 reg_save (const char *label, unsigned int reg, unsigned int sreg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
1107 dw_cfi_ref cfi = new_cfi ();
1108 dw_fde_ref fde = current_fde ();
1110 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = reg;
1112 /* When stack is aligned, store REG using DW_CFA_expression with
1113 FP. */
1114 if (fde
1115 && fde->stack_realign
1116 && sreg == INVALID_REGNUM)
1118 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_expression;
1119 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num = reg;
1120 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc
1121 = build_cfa_aligned_loc (offset, fde->stack_realignment);
1123 else if (sreg == INVALID_REGNUM)
1125 if (need_data_align_sf_opcode (offset))
1126 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf;
1127 else if (reg & ~0x3f)
1128 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_offset_extended;
1129 else
1130 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_offset;
1131 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset = offset;
1133 else if (sreg == reg)
1134 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_same_value;
1135 else
1137 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_register;
1138 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num = sreg;
1141 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
1144 /* Add the CFI for saving a register window. LABEL is passed to reg_save.
1145 This CFI tells the unwinder that it needs to restore the window registers
1146 from the previous frame's window save area.
1148 ??? Perhaps we should note in the CIE where windows are saved (instead of
1149 assuming 0(cfa)) and what registers are in the window. */
1151 void
1152 dwarf2out_window_save (const char *label)
1154 dw_cfi_ref cfi = new_cfi ();
1156 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_GNU_window_save;
1157 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
1160 /* Add a CFI to update the running total of the size of arguments
1161 pushed onto the stack. */
1163 void
1164 dwarf2out_args_size (const char *label, HOST_WIDE_INT size)
1166 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
1168 if (size == old_args_size)
1169 return;
1171 old_args_size = size;
1173 cfi = new_cfi ();
1174 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_GNU_args_size;
1175 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset = size;
1176 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
1179 /* Entry point for saving a register to the stack. REG is the GCC register
1180 number. LABEL and OFFSET are passed to reg_save. */
1182 void
1183 dwarf2out_reg_save (const char *label, unsigned int reg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
1185 reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (reg), INVALID_REGNUM, offset);
1188 /* Entry point for saving the return address in the stack.
1189 LABEL and OFFSET are passed to reg_save. */
1191 void
1192 dwarf2out_return_save (const char *label, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
1194 reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, INVALID_REGNUM, offset);
1197 /* Entry point for saving the return address in a register.
1198 LABEL and SREG are passed to reg_save. */
1200 void
1201 dwarf2out_return_reg (const char *label, unsigned int sreg)
1203 reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (sreg), 0);
1206 #ifdef DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
1207 /* Record the initial position of the return address. RTL is
1208 INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX. */
1210 static void
1211 initial_return_save (rtx rtl)
1213 unsigned int reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
1214 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
1216 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
1218 case REG:
1219 /* RA is in a register. */
1220 reg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (rtl));
1221 break;
1223 case MEM:
1224 /* RA is on the stack. */
1225 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
1226 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
1228 case REG:
1229 gcc_assert (REGNO (rtl) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
1230 offset = 0;
1231 break;
1233 case PLUS:
1234 gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
1235 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1));
1236 break;
1238 case MINUS:
1239 gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
1240 offset = -INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1));
1241 break;
1243 default:
1244 gcc_unreachable ();
1247 break;
1249 case PLUS:
1250 /* The return address is at some offset from any value we can
1251 actually load. For instance, on the SPARC it is in %i7+8. Just
1252 ignore the offset for now; it doesn't matter for unwinding frames. */
1253 gcc_assert (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)));
1254 initial_return_save (XEXP (rtl, 0));
1255 return;
1257 default:
1258 gcc_unreachable ();
1261 if (reg != DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN)
1262 reg_save (NULL, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, reg, offset - cfa.offset);
1264 #endif
1266 /* Given a SET, calculate the amount of stack adjustment it
1267 contains. */
1269 static HOST_WIDE_INT
1270 stack_adjust_offset (const_rtx pattern, HOST_WIDE_INT cur_args_size,
1271 HOST_WIDE_INT cur_offset)
1273 const_rtx src = SET_SRC (pattern);
1274 const_rtx dest = SET_DEST (pattern);
1275 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
1276 enum rtx_code code;
1278 if (dest == stack_pointer_rtx)
1280 code = GET_CODE (src);
1282 /* Assume (set (reg sp) (reg whatever)) sets args_size
1283 level to 0. */
1284 if (code == REG && src != stack_pointer_rtx)
1286 offset = -cur_args_size;
1287 #ifndef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
1288 offset = -offset;
1289 #endif
1290 return offset - cur_offset;
1293 if (! (code == PLUS || code == MINUS)
1294 || XEXP (src, 0) != stack_pointer_rtx
1295 || !CONST_INT_P (XEXP (src, 1)))
1296 return 0;
1298 /* (set (reg sp) (plus (reg sp) (const_int))) */
1299 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1300 if (code == PLUS)
1301 offset = -offset;
1302 return offset;
1305 if (MEM_P (src) && !MEM_P (dest))
1306 dest = src;
1307 if (MEM_P (dest))
1309 /* (set (mem (pre_dec (reg sp))) (foo)) */
1310 src = XEXP (dest, 0);
1311 code = GET_CODE (src);
1313 switch (code)
1315 case PRE_MODIFY:
1316 case POST_MODIFY:
1317 if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1319 rtx val = XEXP (XEXP (src, 1), 1);
1320 /* We handle only adjustments by constant amount. */
1321 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == PLUS
1322 && CONST_INT_P (val));
1323 offset = -INTVAL (val);
1324 break;
1326 return 0;
1328 case PRE_DEC:
1329 case POST_DEC:
1330 if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1332 offset = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
1333 break;
1335 return 0;
1337 case PRE_INC:
1338 case POST_INC:
1339 if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1341 offset = -GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
1342 break;
1344 return 0;
1346 default:
1347 return 0;
1350 else
1351 return 0;
1353 return offset;
1356 /* Precomputed args_size for CODE_LABELs and BARRIERs preceeding them,
1357 indexed by INSN_UID. */
1359 static HOST_WIDE_INT *barrier_args_size;
1361 /* Helper function for compute_barrier_args_size. Handle one insn. */
1363 static HOST_WIDE_INT
1364 compute_barrier_args_size_1 (rtx insn, HOST_WIDE_INT cur_args_size,
1365 VEC (rtx, heap) **next)
1367 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
1368 int i;
1370 if (! RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn))
1372 if (prologue_epilogue_contains (insn))
1373 /* Nothing */;
1374 else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SET)
1375 offset = stack_adjust_offset (PATTERN (insn), cur_args_size, 0);
1376 else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == PARALLEL
1377 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SEQUENCE)
1379 /* There may be stack adjustments inside compound insns. Search
1380 for them. */
1381 for (i = XVECLEN (PATTERN (insn), 0) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
1382 if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i)) == SET)
1383 offset += stack_adjust_offset (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i),
1384 cur_args_size, offset);
1387 else
1389 rtx expr = find_reg_note (insn, REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR, NULL_RTX);
1391 if (expr)
1393 expr = XEXP (expr, 0);
1394 if (GET_CODE (expr) == PARALLEL
1395 || GET_CODE (expr) == SEQUENCE)
1396 for (i = 1; i < XVECLEN (expr, 0); i++)
1398 rtx elem = XVECEXP (expr, 0, i);
1400 if (GET_CODE (elem) == SET && !RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (elem))
1401 offset += stack_adjust_offset (elem, cur_args_size, offset);
1406 #ifndef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
1407 offset = -offset;
1408 #endif
1410 cur_args_size += offset;
1411 if (cur_args_size < 0)
1412 cur_args_size = 0;
1414 if (JUMP_P (insn))
1416 rtx dest = JUMP_LABEL (insn);
1418 if (dest)
1420 if (barrier_args_size [INSN_UID (dest)] < 0)
1422 barrier_args_size [INSN_UID (dest)] = cur_args_size;
1423 VEC_safe_push (rtx, heap, *next, dest);
1428 return cur_args_size;
1431 /* Walk the whole function and compute args_size on BARRIERs. */
1433 static void
1434 compute_barrier_args_size (void)
1436 int max_uid = get_max_uid (), i;
1437 rtx insn;
1438 VEC (rtx, heap) *worklist, *next, *tmp;
1440 barrier_args_size = XNEWVEC (HOST_WIDE_INT, max_uid);
1441 for (i = 0; i < max_uid; i++)
1442 barrier_args_size[i] = -1;
1444 worklist = VEC_alloc (rtx, heap, 20);
1445 next = VEC_alloc (rtx, heap, 20);
1446 insn = get_insns ();
1447 barrier_args_size[INSN_UID (insn)] = 0;
1448 VEC_quick_push (rtx, worklist, insn);
1449 for (;;)
1451 while (!VEC_empty (rtx, worklist))
1453 rtx prev, body, first_insn;
1454 HOST_WIDE_INT cur_args_size;
1456 first_insn = insn = VEC_pop (rtx, worklist);
1457 cur_args_size = barrier_args_size[INSN_UID (insn)];
1458 prev = prev_nonnote_insn (insn);
1459 if (prev && BARRIER_P (prev))
1460 barrier_args_size[INSN_UID (prev)] = cur_args_size;
1462 for (; insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
1464 if (INSN_DELETED_P (insn) || NOTE_P (insn))
1465 continue;
1466 if (BARRIER_P (insn))
1467 break;
1469 if (LABEL_P (insn))
1471 if (insn == first_insn)
1472 continue;
1473 else if (barrier_args_size[INSN_UID (insn)] < 0)
1475 barrier_args_size[INSN_UID (insn)] = cur_args_size;
1476 continue;
1478 else
1480 /* The insns starting with this label have been
1481 already scanned or are in the worklist. */
1482 break;
1486 body = PATTERN (insn);
1487 if (GET_CODE (body) == SEQUENCE)
1489 HOST_WIDE_INT dest_args_size = cur_args_size;
1490 for (i = 1; i < XVECLEN (body, 0); i++)
1491 if (INSN_ANNULLED_BRANCH_P (XVECEXP (body, 0, 0))
1492 && INSN_FROM_TARGET_P (XVECEXP (body, 0, i)))
1493 dest_args_size
1494 = compute_barrier_args_size_1 (XVECEXP (body, 0, i),
1495 dest_args_size, &next);
1496 else
1497 cur_args_size
1498 = compute_barrier_args_size_1 (XVECEXP (body, 0, i),
1499 cur_args_size, &next);
1501 if (INSN_ANNULLED_BRANCH_P (XVECEXP (body, 0, 0)))
1502 compute_barrier_args_size_1 (XVECEXP (body, 0, 0),
1503 dest_args_size, &next);
1504 else
1505 cur_args_size
1506 = compute_barrier_args_size_1 (XVECEXP (body, 0, 0),
1507 cur_args_size, &next);
1509 else
1510 cur_args_size
1511 = compute_barrier_args_size_1 (insn, cur_args_size, &next);
1515 if (VEC_empty (rtx, next))
1516 break;
1518 /* Swap WORKLIST with NEXT and truncate NEXT for next iteration. */
1519 tmp = next;
1520 next = worklist;
1521 worklist = tmp;
1522 VEC_truncate (rtx, next, 0);
1525 VEC_free (rtx, heap, worklist);
1526 VEC_free (rtx, heap, next);
1530 /* Check INSN to see if it looks like a push or a stack adjustment, and
1531 make a note of it if it does. EH uses this information to find out how
1532 much extra space it needs to pop off the stack. */
1534 static void
1535 dwarf2out_stack_adjust (rtx insn, bool after_p)
1537 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
1538 const char *label;
1539 int i;
1541 /* Don't handle epilogues at all. Certainly it would be wrong to do so
1542 with this function. Proper support would require all frame-related
1543 insns to be marked, and to be able to handle saving state around
1544 epilogues textually in the middle of the function. */
1545 if (prologue_epilogue_contains (insn))
1546 return;
1548 /* If INSN is an instruction from target of an annulled branch, the
1549 effects are for the target only and so current argument size
1550 shouldn't change at all. */
1551 if (final_sequence
1552 && INSN_ANNULLED_BRANCH_P (XVECEXP (final_sequence, 0, 0))
1553 && INSN_FROM_TARGET_P (insn))
1554 return;
1556 /* If only calls can throw, and we have a frame pointer,
1557 save up adjustments until we see the CALL_INSN. */
1558 if (!flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables && cfa.reg != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1560 if (CALL_P (insn) && !after_p)
1562 /* Extract the size of the args from the CALL rtx itself. */
1563 insn = PATTERN (insn);
1564 if (GET_CODE (insn) == PARALLEL)
1565 insn = XVECEXP (insn, 0, 0);
1566 if (GET_CODE (insn) == SET)
1567 insn = SET_SRC (insn);
1568 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (insn) == CALL);
1569 dwarf2out_args_size ("", INTVAL (XEXP (insn, 1)));
1571 return;
1574 if (CALL_P (insn) && !after_p)
1576 if (!flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables)
1577 dwarf2out_args_size ("", args_size);
1578 return;
1580 else if (BARRIER_P (insn))
1582 /* Don't call compute_barrier_args_size () if the only
1583 BARRIER is at the end of function. */
1584 if (barrier_args_size == NULL && next_nonnote_insn (insn))
1585 compute_barrier_args_size ();
1586 if (barrier_args_size == NULL)
1587 offset = 0;
1588 else
1590 offset = barrier_args_size[INSN_UID (insn)];
1591 if (offset < 0)
1592 offset = 0;
1595 offset -= args_size;
1596 #ifndef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
1597 offset = -offset;
1598 #endif
1600 else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SET)
1601 offset = stack_adjust_offset (PATTERN (insn), args_size, 0);
1602 else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == PARALLEL
1603 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SEQUENCE)
1605 /* There may be stack adjustments inside compound insns. Search
1606 for them. */
1607 for (offset = 0, i = XVECLEN (PATTERN (insn), 0) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
1608 if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i)) == SET)
1609 offset += stack_adjust_offset (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i),
1610 args_size, offset);
1612 else
1613 return;
1615 if (offset == 0)
1616 return;
1618 label = dwarf2out_cfi_label (false);
1619 dwarf2out_args_size_adjust (offset, label);
1622 /* Adjust args_size based on stack adjustment OFFSET. */
1624 static void
1625 dwarf2out_args_size_adjust (HOST_WIDE_INT offset, const char *label)
1627 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1628 cfa.offset += offset;
1630 if (cfa_store.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1631 cfa_store.offset += offset;
1633 #ifndef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
1634 offset = -offset;
1635 #endif
1637 args_size += offset;
1638 if (args_size < 0)
1639 args_size = 0;
1641 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1642 if (flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables)
1643 dwarf2out_args_size (label, args_size);
1646 #endif
1648 /* We delay emitting a register save until either (a) we reach the end
1649 of the prologue or (b) the register is clobbered. This clusters
1650 register saves so that there are fewer pc advances. */
1652 struct GTY(()) queued_reg_save {
1653 struct queued_reg_save *next;
1654 rtx reg;
1655 HOST_WIDE_INT cfa_offset;
1656 rtx saved_reg;
1659 static GTY(()) struct queued_reg_save *queued_reg_saves;
1661 /* The caller's ORIG_REG is saved in SAVED_IN_REG. */
1662 struct GTY(()) reg_saved_in_data {
1663 rtx orig_reg;
1664 rtx saved_in_reg;
1667 /* A list of registers saved in other registers.
1668 The list intentionally has a small maximum capacity of 4; if your
1669 port needs more than that, you might consider implementing a
1670 more efficient data structure. */
1671 static GTY(()) struct reg_saved_in_data regs_saved_in_regs[4];
1672 static GTY(()) size_t num_regs_saved_in_regs;
1674 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
1675 static const char *last_reg_save_label;
1677 /* Add an entry to QUEUED_REG_SAVES saying that REG is now saved at
1678 SREG, or if SREG is NULL then it is saved at OFFSET to the CFA. */
1680 static void
1681 queue_reg_save (const char *label, rtx reg, rtx sreg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
1683 struct queued_reg_save *q;
1685 /* Duplicates waste space, but it's also necessary to remove them
1686 for correctness, since the queue gets output in reverse
1687 order. */
1688 for (q = queued_reg_saves; q != NULL; q = q->next)
1689 if (REGNO (q->reg) == REGNO (reg))
1690 break;
1692 if (q == NULL)
1694 q = GGC_NEW (struct queued_reg_save);
1695 q->next = queued_reg_saves;
1696 queued_reg_saves = q;
1699 q->reg = reg;
1700 q->cfa_offset = offset;
1701 q->saved_reg = sreg;
1703 last_reg_save_label = label;
1706 /* Output all the entries in QUEUED_REG_SAVES. */
1708 static void
1709 flush_queued_reg_saves (void)
1711 struct queued_reg_save *q;
1713 for (q = queued_reg_saves; q; q = q->next)
1715 size_t i;
1716 unsigned int reg, sreg;
1718 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1719 if (REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg) == REGNO (q->reg))
1720 break;
1721 if (q->saved_reg && i == num_regs_saved_in_regs)
1723 gcc_assert (i != ARRAY_SIZE (regs_saved_in_regs));
1724 num_regs_saved_in_regs++;
1726 if (i != num_regs_saved_in_regs)
1728 regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg = q->reg;
1729 regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg = q->saved_reg;
1732 reg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (q->reg));
1733 if (q->saved_reg)
1734 sreg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (q->saved_reg));
1735 else
1736 sreg = INVALID_REGNUM;
1737 reg_save (last_reg_save_label, reg, sreg, q->cfa_offset);
1740 queued_reg_saves = NULL;
1741 last_reg_save_label = NULL;
1744 /* Does INSN clobber any register which QUEUED_REG_SAVES lists a saved
1745 location for? Or, does it clobber a register which we've previously
1746 said that some other register is saved in, and for which we now
1747 have a new location for? */
1749 static bool
1750 clobbers_queued_reg_save (const_rtx insn)
1752 struct queued_reg_save *q;
1754 for (q = queued_reg_saves; q; q = q->next)
1756 size_t i;
1757 if (modified_in_p (q->reg, insn))
1758 return true;
1759 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1760 if (REGNO (q->reg) == REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg)
1761 && modified_in_p (regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg, insn))
1762 return true;
1765 return false;
1768 /* Entry point for saving the first register into the second. */
1770 void
1771 dwarf2out_reg_save_reg (const char *label, rtx reg, rtx sreg)
1773 size_t i;
1774 unsigned int regno, sregno;
1776 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1777 if (REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg) == REGNO (reg))
1778 break;
1779 if (i == num_regs_saved_in_regs)
1781 gcc_assert (i != ARRAY_SIZE (regs_saved_in_regs));
1782 num_regs_saved_in_regs++;
1784 regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg = reg;
1785 regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg = sreg;
1787 regno = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (reg));
1788 sregno = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (sreg));
1789 reg_save (label, regno, sregno, 0);
1792 /* What register, if any, is currently saved in REG? */
1794 static rtx
1795 reg_saved_in (rtx reg)
1797 unsigned int regn = REGNO (reg);
1798 size_t i;
1799 struct queued_reg_save *q;
1801 for (q = queued_reg_saves; q; q = q->next)
1802 if (q->saved_reg && regn == REGNO (q->saved_reg))
1803 return q->reg;
1805 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1806 if (regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg
1807 && regn == REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg))
1808 return regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg;
1810 return NULL_RTX;
1814 /* A temporary register holding an integral value used in adjusting SP
1815 or setting up the store_reg. The "offset" field holds the integer
1816 value, not an offset. */
1817 static dw_cfa_location cfa_temp;
1819 /* A subroutine of dwarf2out_frame_debug, process a REG_DEF_CFA note. */
1821 static void
1822 dwarf2out_frame_debug_def_cfa (rtx pat, const char *label)
1824 memset (&cfa, 0, sizeof (cfa));
1826 switch (GET_CODE (pat))
1828 case PLUS:
1829 cfa.reg = REGNO (XEXP (pat, 0));
1830 cfa.offset = INTVAL (XEXP (pat, 1));
1831 break;
1833 case REG:
1834 cfa.reg = REGNO (pat);
1835 break;
1837 default:
1838 /* Recurse and define an expression. */
1839 gcc_unreachable ();
1842 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1845 /* A subroutine of dwarf2out_frame_debug, process a REG_ADJUST_CFA note. */
1847 static void
1848 dwarf2out_frame_debug_adjust_cfa (rtx pat, const char *label)
1850 rtx src, dest;
1852 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (pat) == SET);
1853 dest = XEXP (pat, 0);
1854 src = XEXP (pat, 1);
1856 switch (GET_CODE (src))
1858 case PLUS:
1859 gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa.reg);
1860 cfa.offset -= INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1861 break;
1863 case REG:
1864 break;
1866 default:
1867 gcc_unreachable ();
1870 cfa.reg = REGNO (dest);
1871 gcc_assert (cfa.indirect == 0);
1873 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1876 /* A subroutine of dwarf2out_frame_debug, process a REG_CFA_OFFSET note. */
1878 static void
1879 dwarf2out_frame_debug_cfa_offset (rtx set, const char *label)
1881 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
1882 rtx src, addr, span;
1884 src = XEXP (set, 1);
1885 addr = XEXP (set, 0);
1886 gcc_assert (MEM_P (addr));
1887 addr = XEXP (addr, 0);
1889 /* As documented, only consider extremely simple addresses. */
1890 switch (GET_CODE (addr))
1892 case REG:
1893 gcc_assert (REGNO (addr) == cfa.reg);
1894 offset = -cfa.offset;
1895 break;
1896 case PLUS:
1897 gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (addr, 0)) == cfa.reg);
1898 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (addr, 1)) - cfa.offset;
1899 break;
1900 default:
1901 gcc_unreachable ();
1904 span = targetm.dwarf_register_span (src);
1906 /* ??? We'd like to use queue_reg_save, but we need to come up with
1907 a different flushing heuristic for epilogues. */
1908 if (!span)
1909 reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (src)), INVALID_REGNUM, offset);
1910 else
1912 /* We have a PARALLEL describing where the contents of SRC live.
1913 Queue register saves for each piece of the PARALLEL. */
1914 int par_index;
1915 int limit;
1916 HOST_WIDE_INT span_offset = offset;
1918 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (span) == PARALLEL);
1920 limit = XVECLEN (span, 0);
1921 for (par_index = 0; par_index < limit; par_index++)
1923 rtx elem = XVECEXP (span, 0, par_index);
1925 reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (elem)),
1926 INVALID_REGNUM, span_offset);
1927 span_offset += GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (elem));
1932 /* A subroutine of dwarf2out_frame_debug, process a REG_CFA_REGISTER note. */
1934 static void
1935 dwarf2out_frame_debug_cfa_register (rtx set, const char *label)
1937 rtx src, dest;
1938 unsigned sregno, dregno;
1940 src = XEXP (set, 1);
1941 dest = XEXP (set, 0);
1943 if (src == pc_rtx)
1944 sregno = DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN;
1945 else
1946 sregno = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (src));
1948 dregno = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (dest));
1950 /* ??? We'd like to use queue_reg_save, but we need to come up with
1951 a different flushing heuristic for epilogues. */
1952 reg_save (label, sregno, dregno, 0);
1955 /* A subroutine of dwarf2out_frame_debug, process a REG_CFA_RESTORE note. */
1957 static void
1958 dwarf2out_frame_debug_cfa_restore (rtx reg, const char *label)
1960 dw_cfi_ref cfi = new_cfi ();
1961 unsigned int regno = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (reg));
1963 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = (regno & ~0x3f ? DW_CFA_restore_extended : DW_CFA_restore);
1964 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = regno;
1966 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
1969 /* Record call frame debugging information for an expression EXPR,
1970 which either sets SP or FP (adjusting how we calculate the frame
1971 address) or saves a register to the stack or another register.
1972 LABEL indicates the address of EXPR.
1974 This function encodes a state machine mapping rtxes to actions on
1975 cfa, cfa_store, and cfa_temp.reg. We describe these rules so
1976 users need not read the source code.
1978 The High-Level Picture
1980 Changes in the register we use to calculate the CFA: Currently we
1981 assume that if you copy the CFA register into another register, we
1982 should take the other one as the new CFA register; this seems to
1983 work pretty well. If it's wrong for some target, it's simple
1984 enough not to set RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P on the insn in question.
1986 Changes in the register we use for saving registers to the stack:
1987 This is usually SP, but not always. Again, we deduce that if you
1988 copy SP into another register (and SP is not the CFA register),
1989 then the new register is the one we will be using for register
1990 saves. This also seems to work.
1992 Register saves: There's not much guesswork about this one; if
1993 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P is set on an insn which modifies memory, it's a
1994 register save, and the register used to calculate the destination
1995 had better be the one we think we're using for this purpose.
1996 It's also assumed that a copy from a call-saved register to another
1997 register is saving that register if RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P is set on
1998 that instruction. If the copy is from a call-saved register to
1999 the *same* register, that means that the register is now the same
2000 value as in the caller.
2002 Except: If the register being saved is the CFA register, and the
2003 offset is nonzero, we are saving the CFA, so we assume we have to
2004 use DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression. If the offset is 0, we assume that
2005 the intent is to save the value of SP from the previous frame.
2007 In addition, if a register has previously been saved to a different
2008 register,
2010 Invariants / Summaries of Rules
2012 cfa current rule for calculating the CFA. It usually
2013 consists of a register and an offset.
2014 cfa_store register used by prologue code to save things to the stack
2015 cfa_store.offset is the offset from the value of
2016 cfa_store.reg to the actual CFA
2017 cfa_temp register holding an integral value. cfa_temp.offset
2018 stores the value, which will be used to adjust the
2019 stack pointer. cfa_temp is also used like cfa_store,
2020 to track stores to the stack via fp or a temp reg.
2022 Rules 1- 4: Setting a register's value to cfa.reg or an expression
2023 with cfa.reg as the first operand changes the cfa.reg and its
2024 cfa.offset. Rule 1 and 4 also set cfa_temp.reg and
2025 cfa_temp.offset.
2027 Rules 6- 9: Set a non-cfa.reg register value to a constant or an
2028 expression yielding a constant. This sets cfa_temp.reg
2029 and cfa_temp.offset.
2031 Rule 5: Create a new register cfa_store used to save items to the
2032 stack.
2034 Rules 10-14: Save a register to the stack. Define offset as the
2035 difference of the original location and cfa_store's
2036 location (or cfa_temp's location if cfa_temp is used).
2038 Rules 16-20: If AND operation happens on sp in prologue, we assume
2039 stack is realigned. We will use a group of DW_OP_XXX
2040 expressions to represent the location of the stored
2041 register instead of CFA+offset.
2043 The Rules
2045 "{a,b}" indicates a choice of a xor b.
2046 "<reg>:cfa.reg" indicates that <reg> must equal cfa.reg.
2048 Rule 1:
2049 (set <reg1> <reg2>:cfa.reg)
2050 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
2051 cfa.offset unchanged
2052 cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
2053 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset
2055 Rule 2:
2056 (set sp ({minus,plus,losum} {sp,fp}:cfa.reg
2057 {<const_int>,<reg>:cfa_temp.reg}))
2058 effects: cfa.reg = sp if fp used
2059 cfa.offset += {+/- <const_int>, cfa_temp.offset} if cfa.reg==sp
2060 cfa_store.offset += {+/- <const_int>, cfa_temp.offset}
2061 if cfa_store.reg==sp
2063 Rule 3:
2064 (set fp ({minus,plus,losum} <reg>:cfa.reg <const_int>))
2065 effects: cfa.reg = fp
2066 cfa_offset += +/- <const_int>
2068 Rule 4:
2069 (set <reg1> ({plus,losum} <reg2>:cfa.reg <const_int>))
2070 constraints: <reg1> != fp
2071 <reg1> != sp
2072 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
2073 cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
2074 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset
2076 Rule 5:
2077 (set <reg1> (plus <reg2>:cfa_temp.reg sp:cfa.reg))
2078 constraints: <reg1> != fp
2079 <reg1> != sp
2080 effects: cfa_store.reg = <reg1>
2081 cfa_store.offset = cfa.offset - cfa_temp.offset
2083 Rule 6:
2084 (set <reg> <const_int>)
2085 effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg>
2086 cfa_temp.offset = <const_int>
2088 Rule 7:
2089 (set <reg1>:cfa_temp.reg (ior <reg2>:cfa_temp.reg <const_int>))
2090 effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
2091 cfa_temp.offset |= <const_int>
2093 Rule 8:
2094 (set <reg> (high <exp>))
2095 effects: none
2097 Rule 9:
2098 (set <reg> (lo_sum <exp> <const_int>))
2099 effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg>
2100 cfa_temp.offset = <const_int>
2102 Rule 10:
2103 (set (mem (pre_modify sp:cfa_store (???? <reg1> <const_int>))) <reg2>)
2104 effects: cfa_store.offset -= <const_int>
2105 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset if cfa.reg == sp
2106 cfa.reg = sp
2107 cfa.base_offset = -cfa_store.offset
2109 Rule 11:
2110 (set (mem ({pre_inc,pre_dec} sp:cfa_store.reg)) <reg>)
2111 effects: cfa_store.offset += -/+ mode_size(mem)
2112 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset if cfa.reg == sp
2113 cfa.reg = sp
2114 cfa.base_offset = -cfa_store.offset
2116 Rule 12:
2117 (set (mem ({minus,plus,losum} <reg1>:{cfa_store,cfa_temp} <const_int>))
2119 <reg2>)
2120 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
2121 cfa.base_offset = -/+ <const_int> - {cfa_store,cfa_temp}.offset
2123 Rule 13:
2124 (set (mem <reg1>:{cfa_store,cfa_temp}) <reg2>)
2125 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
2126 cfa.base_offset = -{cfa_store,cfa_temp}.offset
2128 Rule 14:
2129 (set (mem (postinc <reg1>:cfa_temp <const_int>)) <reg2>)
2130 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
2131 cfa.base_offset = -cfa_temp.offset
2132 cfa_temp.offset -= mode_size(mem)
2134 Rule 15:
2135 (set <reg> {unspec, unspec_volatile})
2136 effects: target-dependent
2138 Rule 16:
2139 (set sp (and: sp <const_int>))
2140 constraints: cfa_store.reg == sp
2141 effects: current_fde.stack_realign = 1
2142 cfa_store.offset = 0
2143 fde->drap_reg = cfa.reg if cfa.reg != sp and cfa.reg != fp
2145 Rule 17:
2146 (set (mem ({pre_inc, pre_dec} sp)) (mem (plus (cfa.reg) (const_int))))
2147 effects: cfa_store.offset += -/+ mode_size(mem)
2149 Rule 18:
2150 (set (mem ({pre_inc, pre_dec} sp)) fp)
2151 constraints: fde->stack_realign == 1
2152 effects: cfa_store.offset = 0
2153 cfa.reg != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
2155 Rule 19:
2156 (set (mem ({pre_inc, pre_dec} sp)) cfa.reg)
2157 constraints: fde->stack_realign == 1
2158 && cfa.offset == 0
2159 && cfa.indirect == 0
2160 && cfa.reg != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
2161 effects: Use DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression to define cfa
2162 cfa.reg == fde->drap_reg
2164 Rule 20:
2165 (set reg fde->drap_reg)
2166 constraints: fde->vdrap_reg == INVALID_REGNUM
2167 effects: fde->vdrap_reg = reg.
2168 (set mem fde->drap_reg)
2169 constraints: fde->drap_reg_saved == 1
2170 effects: none. */
2172 static void
2173 dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (rtx expr, const char *label)
2175 rtx src, dest, span;
2176 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
2177 dw_fde_ref fde;
2179 /* If RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P is set on a PARALLEL, process each member of
2180 the PARALLEL independently. The first element is always processed if
2181 it is a SET. This is for backward compatibility. Other elements
2182 are processed only if they are SETs and the RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P
2183 flag is set in them. */
2184 if (GET_CODE (expr) == PARALLEL || GET_CODE (expr) == SEQUENCE)
2186 int par_index;
2187 int limit = XVECLEN (expr, 0);
2188 rtx elem;
2190 /* PARALLELs have strict read-modify-write semantics, so we
2191 ought to evaluate every rvalue before changing any lvalue.
2192 It's cumbersome to do that in general, but there's an
2193 easy approximation that is enough for all current users:
2194 handle register saves before register assignments. */
2195 if (GET_CODE (expr) == PARALLEL)
2196 for (par_index = 0; par_index < limit; par_index++)
2198 elem = XVECEXP (expr, 0, par_index);
2199 if (GET_CODE (elem) == SET
2200 && MEM_P (SET_DEST (elem))
2201 && (RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (elem) || par_index == 0))
2202 dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (elem, label);
2205 for (par_index = 0; par_index < limit; par_index++)
2207 elem = XVECEXP (expr, 0, par_index);
2208 if (GET_CODE (elem) == SET
2209 && (!MEM_P (SET_DEST (elem)) || GET_CODE (expr) == SEQUENCE)
2210 && (RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (elem) || par_index == 0))
2211 dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (elem, label);
2212 else if (GET_CODE (elem) == SET
2213 && par_index != 0
2214 && !RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (elem))
2216 /* Stack adjustment combining might combine some post-prologue
2217 stack adjustment into a prologue stack adjustment. */
2218 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = stack_adjust_offset (elem, args_size, 0);
2220 if (offset != 0)
2221 dwarf2out_args_size_adjust (offset, label);
2224 return;
2227 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (expr) == SET);
2229 src = SET_SRC (expr);
2230 dest = SET_DEST (expr);
2232 if (REG_P (src))
2234 rtx rsi = reg_saved_in (src);
2235 if (rsi)
2236 src = rsi;
2239 fde = current_fde ();
2241 if (REG_P (src)
2242 && fde
2243 && fde->drap_reg == REGNO (src)
2244 && (fde->drap_reg_saved
2245 || REG_P (dest)))
2247 /* Rule 20 */
2248 /* If we are saving dynamic realign argument pointer to a
2249 register, the destination is virtual dynamic realign
2250 argument pointer. It may be used to access argument. */
2251 if (REG_P (dest))
2253 gcc_assert (fde->vdrap_reg == INVALID_REGNUM);
2254 fde->vdrap_reg = REGNO (dest);
2256 return;
2259 switch (GET_CODE (dest))
2261 case REG:
2262 switch (GET_CODE (src))
2264 /* Setting FP from SP. */
2265 case REG:
2266 if (cfa.reg == (unsigned) REGNO (src))
2268 /* Rule 1 */
2269 /* Update the CFA rule wrt SP or FP. Make sure src is
2270 relative to the current CFA register.
2272 We used to require that dest be either SP or FP, but the
2273 ARM copies SP to a temporary register, and from there to
2274 FP. So we just rely on the backends to only set
2275 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P on appropriate insns. */
2276 cfa.reg = REGNO (dest);
2277 cfa_temp.reg = cfa.reg;
2278 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset;
2280 else
2282 /* Saving a register in a register. */
2283 gcc_assert (!fixed_regs [REGNO (dest)]
2284 /* For the SPARC and its register window. */
2285 || (DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (src))
2286 == DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN));
2288 /* After stack is aligned, we can only save SP in FP
2289 if drap register is used. In this case, we have
2290 to restore stack pointer with the CFA value and we
2291 don't generate this DWARF information. */
2292 if (fde
2293 && fde->stack_realign
2294 && REGNO (src) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
2295 gcc_assert (REGNO (dest) == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
2296 && fde->drap_reg != INVALID_REGNUM
2297 && cfa.reg != REGNO (src));
2298 else
2299 queue_reg_save (label, src, dest, 0);
2301 break;
2303 case PLUS:
2304 case MINUS:
2305 case LO_SUM:
2306 if (dest == stack_pointer_rtx)
2308 /* Rule 2 */
2309 /* Adjusting SP. */
2310 switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)))
2312 case CONST_INT:
2313 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
2314 break;
2315 case REG:
2316 gcc_assert ((unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src, 1))
2317 == cfa_temp.reg);
2318 offset = cfa_temp.offset;
2319 break;
2320 default:
2321 gcc_unreachable ();
2324 if (XEXP (src, 0) == hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
2326 /* Restoring SP from FP in the epilogue. */
2327 gcc_assert (cfa.reg == (unsigned) HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);
2328 cfa.reg = STACK_POINTER_REGNUM;
2330 else if (GET_CODE (src) == LO_SUM)
2331 /* Assume we've set the source reg of the LO_SUM from sp. */
2333 else
2334 gcc_assert (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx);
2336 if (GET_CODE (src) != MINUS)
2337 offset = -offset;
2338 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
2339 cfa.offset += offset;
2340 if (cfa_store.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
2341 cfa_store.offset += offset;
2343 else if (dest == hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
2345 /* Rule 3 */
2346 /* Either setting the FP from an offset of the SP,
2347 or adjusting the FP */
2348 gcc_assert (frame_pointer_needed);
2350 gcc_assert (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
2351 && (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa.reg
2352 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (src, 1)));
2353 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
2354 if (GET_CODE (src) != MINUS)
2355 offset = -offset;
2356 cfa.offset += offset;
2357 cfa.reg = HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM;
2359 else
2361 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (src) != MINUS);
2363 /* Rule 4 */
2364 if (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
2365 && REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa.reg
2366 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (src, 1)))
2368 /* Setting a temporary CFA register that will be copied
2369 into the FP later on. */
2370 offset = - INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
2371 cfa.offset += offset;
2372 cfa.reg = REGNO (dest);
2373 /* Or used to save regs to the stack. */
2374 cfa_temp.reg = cfa.reg;
2375 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset;
2378 /* Rule 5 */
2379 else if (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
2380 && REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa_temp.reg
2381 && XEXP (src, 1) == stack_pointer_rtx)
2383 /* Setting a scratch register that we will use instead
2384 of SP for saving registers to the stack. */
2385 gcc_assert (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
2386 cfa_store.reg = REGNO (dest);
2387 cfa_store.offset = cfa.offset - cfa_temp.offset;
2390 /* Rule 9 */
2391 else if (GET_CODE (src) == LO_SUM
2392 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (src, 1)))
2394 cfa_temp.reg = REGNO (dest);
2395 cfa_temp.offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
2397 else
2398 gcc_unreachable ();
2400 break;
2402 /* Rule 6 */
2403 case CONST_INT:
2404 cfa_temp.reg = REGNO (dest);
2405 cfa_temp.offset = INTVAL (src);
2406 break;
2408 /* Rule 7 */
2409 case IOR:
2410 gcc_assert (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
2411 && (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa_temp.reg
2412 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (src, 1)));
2414 if ((unsigned) REGNO (dest) != cfa_temp.reg)
2415 cfa_temp.reg = REGNO (dest);
2416 cfa_temp.offset |= INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
2417 break;
2419 /* Skip over HIGH, assuming it will be followed by a LO_SUM,
2420 which will fill in all of the bits. */
2421 /* Rule 8 */
2422 case HIGH:
2423 break;
2425 /* Rule 15 */
2426 case UNSPEC:
2427 case UNSPEC_VOLATILE:
2428 gcc_assert (targetm.dwarf_handle_frame_unspec);
2429 targetm.dwarf_handle_frame_unspec (label, expr, XINT (src, 1));
2430 return;
2432 /* Rule 16 */
2433 case AND:
2434 /* If this AND operation happens on stack pointer in prologue,
2435 we assume the stack is realigned and we extract the
2436 alignment. */
2437 if (fde && XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
2439 gcc_assert (cfa_store.reg == REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)));
2440 fde->stack_realign = 1;
2441 fde->stack_realignment = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
2442 cfa_store.offset = 0;
2444 if (cfa.reg != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
2445 && cfa.reg != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)
2446 fde->drap_reg = cfa.reg;
2448 return;
2450 default:
2451 gcc_unreachable ();
2454 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
2455 break;
2457 case MEM:
2459 /* Saving a register to the stack. Make sure dest is relative to the
2460 CFA register. */
2461 switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)))
2463 /* Rule 10 */
2464 /* With a push. */
2465 case PRE_MODIFY:
2466 /* We can't handle variable size modifications. */
2467 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1), 1))
2468 == CONST_INT);
2469 offset = -INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1), 1));
2471 gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
2472 && cfa_store.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
2474 cfa_store.offset += offset;
2475 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
2476 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset;
2478 offset = -cfa_store.offset;
2479 break;
2481 /* Rule 11 */
2482 case PRE_INC:
2483 case PRE_DEC:
2484 offset = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
2485 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)) == PRE_INC)
2486 offset = -offset;
2488 gcc_assert ((REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0))
2489 == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
2490 && cfa_store.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
2492 cfa_store.offset += offset;
2494 /* Rule 18: If stack is aligned, we will use FP as a
2495 reference to represent the address of the stored
2496 regiser. */
2497 if (fde
2498 && fde->stack_realign
2499 && src == hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
2501 gcc_assert (cfa.reg != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);
2502 cfa_store.offset = 0;
2505 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
2506 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset;
2508 offset = -cfa_store.offset;
2509 break;
2511 /* Rule 12 */
2512 /* With an offset. */
2513 case PLUS:
2514 case MINUS:
2515 case LO_SUM:
2517 int regno;
2519 gcc_assert (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1))
2520 && REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)));
2521 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1));
2522 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)) == MINUS)
2523 offset = -offset;
2525 regno = REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0));
2527 if (cfa_store.reg == (unsigned) regno)
2528 offset -= cfa_store.offset;
2529 else
2531 gcc_assert (cfa_temp.reg == (unsigned) regno);
2532 offset -= cfa_temp.offset;
2535 break;
2537 /* Rule 13 */
2538 /* Without an offset. */
2539 case REG:
2541 int regno = REGNO (XEXP (dest, 0));
2543 if (cfa_store.reg == (unsigned) regno)
2544 offset = -cfa_store.offset;
2545 else
2547 gcc_assert (cfa_temp.reg == (unsigned) regno);
2548 offset = -cfa_temp.offset;
2551 break;
2553 /* Rule 14 */
2554 case POST_INC:
2555 gcc_assert (cfa_temp.reg
2556 == (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)));
2557 offset = -cfa_temp.offset;
2558 cfa_temp.offset -= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
2559 break;
2561 default:
2562 gcc_unreachable ();
2565 /* Rule 17 */
2566 /* If the source operand of this MEM operation is not a
2567 register, basically the source is return address. Here
2568 we only care how much stack grew and we don't save it. */
2569 if (!REG_P (src))
2570 break;
2572 if (REGNO (src) != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
2573 && REGNO (src) != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
2574 && (unsigned) REGNO (src) == cfa.reg)
2576 /* We're storing the current CFA reg into the stack. */
2578 if (cfa.offset == 0)
2580 /* Rule 19 */
2581 /* If stack is aligned, putting CFA reg into stack means
2582 we can no longer use reg + offset to represent CFA.
2583 Here we use DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression instead. The
2584 result of this expression equals to the original CFA
2585 value. */
2586 if (fde
2587 && fde->stack_realign
2588 && cfa.indirect == 0
2589 && cfa.reg != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)
2591 dw_cfa_location cfa_exp;
2593 gcc_assert (fde->drap_reg == cfa.reg);
2595 cfa_exp.indirect = 1;
2596 cfa_exp.reg = HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM;
2597 cfa_exp.base_offset = offset;
2598 cfa_exp.offset = 0;
2600 fde->drap_reg_saved = 1;
2602 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa_exp);
2603 break;
2606 /* If the source register is exactly the CFA, assume
2607 we're saving SP like any other register; this happens
2608 on the ARM. */
2609 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
2610 queue_reg_save (label, stack_pointer_rtx, NULL_RTX, offset);
2611 break;
2613 else
2615 /* Otherwise, we'll need to look in the stack to
2616 calculate the CFA. */
2617 rtx x = XEXP (dest, 0);
2619 if (!REG_P (x))
2620 x = XEXP (x, 0);
2621 gcc_assert (REG_P (x));
2623 cfa.reg = REGNO (x);
2624 cfa.base_offset = offset;
2625 cfa.indirect = 1;
2626 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
2627 break;
2631 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
2633 span = targetm.dwarf_register_span (src);
2635 if (!span)
2636 queue_reg_save (label, src, NULL_RTX, offset);
2637 else
2639 /* We have a PARALLEL describing where the contents of SRC
2640 live. Queue register saves for each piece of the
2641 PARALLEL. */
2642 int par_index;
2643 int limit;
2644 HOST_WIDE_INT span_offset = offset;
2646 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (span) == PARALLEL);
2648 limit = XVECLEN (span, 0);
2649 for (par_index = 0; par_index < limit; par_index++)
2651 rtx elem = XVECEXP (span, 0, par_index);
2653 queue_reg_save (label, elem, NULL_RTX, span_offset);
2654 span_offset += GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (elem));
2658 break;
2660 default:
2661 gcc_unreachable ();
2665 /* Record call frame debugging information for INSN, which either
2666 sets SP or FP (adjusting how we calculate the frame address) or saves a
2667 register to the stack. If INSN is NULL_RTX, initialize our state.
2669 If AFTER_P is false, we're being called before the insn is emitted,
2670 otherwise after. Call instructions get invoked twice. */
2672 void
2673 dwarf2out_frame_debug (rtx insn, bool after_p)
2675 const char *label;
2676 rtx note, n;
2677 bool handled_one = false;
2679 if (insn == NULL_RTX)
2681 size_t i;
2683 /* Flush any queued register saves. */
2684 flush_queued_reg_saves ();
2686 /* Set up state for generating call frame debug info. */
2687 lookup_cfa (&cfa);
2688 gcc_assert (cfa.reg
2689 == (unsigned long)DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (STACK_POINTER_REGNUM));
2691 cfa.reg = STACK_POINTER_REGNUM;
2692 cfa_store = cfa;
2693 cfa_temp.reg = -1;
2694 cfa_temp.offset = 0;
2696 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
2698 regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg = NULL_RTX;
2699 regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg = NULL_RTX;
2701 num_regs_saved_in_regs = 0;
2703 if (barrier_args_size)
2705 XDELETEVEC (barrier_args_size);
2706 barrier_args_size = NULL;
2708 return;
2711 if (!NONJUMP_INSN_P (insn) || clobbers_queued_reg_save (insn))
2712 flush_queued_reg_saves ();
2714 if (! RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn))
2716 if (!ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS)
2717 dwarf2out_stack_adjust (insn, after_p);
2718 return;
2721 label = dwarf2out_cfi_label (false);
2723 for (note = REG_NOTES (insn); note; note = XEXP (note, 1))
2724 switch (REG_NOTE_KIND (note))
2726 case REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR:
2727 insn = XEXP (note, 0);
2728 goto found;
2730 case REG_CFA_DEF_CFA:
2731 dwarf2out_frame_debug_def_cfa (XEXP (note, 0), label);
2732 handled_one = true;
2733 break;
2735 case REG_CFA_ADJUST_CFA:
2736 n = XEXP (note, 0);
2737 if (n == NULL)
2739 n = PATTERN (insn);
2740 if (GET_CODE (n) == PARALLEL)
2741 n = XVECEXP (n, 0, 0);
2743 dwarf2out_frame_debug_adjust_cfa (n, label);
2744 handled_one = true;
2745 break;
2747 case REG_CFA_OFFSET:
2748 n = XEXP (note, 0);
2749 if (n == NULL)
2750 n = single_set (insn);
2751 dwarf2out_frame_debug_cfa_offset (n, label);
2752 handled_one = true;
2753 break;
2755 case REG_CFA_REGISTER:
2756 n = XEXP (note, 0);
2757 if (n == NULL)
2759 n = PATTERN (insn);
2760 if (GET_CODE (n) == PARALLEL)
2761 n = XVECEXP (n, 0, 0);
2763 dwarf2out_frame_debug_cfa_register (n, label);
2764 handled_one = true;
2765 break;
2767 case REG_CFA_RESTORE:
2768 n = XEXP (note, 0);
2769 if (n == NULL)
2771 n = PATTERN (insn);
2772 if (GET_CODE (n) == PARALLEL)
2773 n = XVECEXP (n, 0, 0);
2774 n = XEXP (n, 0);
2776 dwarf2out_frame_debug_cfa_restore (n, label);
2777 handled_one = true;
2778 break;
2780 default:
2781 break;
2783 if (handled_one)
2784 return;
2786 insn = PATTERN (insn);
2787 found:
2788 dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (insn, label);
2791 /* Determine if we need to save and restore CFI information around this
2792 epilogue. If SIBCALL is true, then this is a sibcall epilogue. If
2793 we do need to save/restore, then emit the save now, and insert a
2794 NOTE_INSN_CFA_RESTORE_STATE at the appropriate place in the stream. */
2796 void
2797 dwarf2out_begin_epilogue (rtx insn)
2799 bool saw_frp = false;
2800 rtx i;
2802 /* Scan forward to the return insn, noticing if there are possible
2803 frame related insns. */
2804 for (i = NEXT_INSN (insn); i ; i = NEXT_INSN (i))
2806 if (!INSN_P (i))
2807 continue;
2809 /* Look for both regular and sibcalls to end the block. */
2810 if (returnjump_p (i))
2811 break;
2812 if (CALL_P (i) && SIBLING_CALL_P (i))
2813 break;
2815 if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (i)) == SEQUENCE)
2817 int idx;
2818 rtx seq = PATTERN (i);
2820 if (returnjump_p (XVECEXP (seq, 0, 0)))
2821 break;
2822 if (CALL_P (XVECEXP (seq, 0, 0))
2823 && SIBLING_CALL_P (XVECEXP (seq, 0, 0)))
2824 break;
2826 for (idx = 0; idx < XVECLEN (seq, 0); idx++)
2827 if (RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (XVECEXP (seq, 0, idx)))
2828 saw_frp = true;
2831 if (RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (i))
2832 saw_frp = true;
2835 /* If the port doesn't emit epilogue unwind info, we don't need a
2836 save/restore pair. */
2837 if (!saw_frp)
2838 return;
2840 /* Otherwise, search forward to see if the return insn was the last
2841 basic block of the function. If so, we don't need save/restore. */
2842 gcc_assert (i != NULL);
2843 i = next_real_insn (i);
2844 if (i == NULL)
2845 return;
2847 /* Insert the restore before that next real insn in the stream, and before
2848 a potential NOTE_INSN_EPILOGUE_BEG -- we do need these notes to be
2849 properly nested. This should be after any label or alignment. This
2850 will be pushed into the CFI stream by the function below. */
2851 while (1)
2853 rtx p = PREV_INSN (i);
2854 if (!NOTE_P (p))
2855 break;
2856 if (NOTE_KIND (p) == NOTE_INSN_BASIC_BLOCK)
2857 break;
2858 i = p;
2860 emit_note_before (NOTE_INSN_CFA_RESTORE_STATE, i);
2862 emit_cfa_remember = true;
2864 /* And emulate the state save. */
2865 gcc_assert (!cfa_remember.in_use);
2866 cfa_remember = cfa;
2867 cfa_remember.in_use = 1;
2870 /* A "subroutine" of dwarf2out_begin_epilogue. Emit the restore required. */
2872 void
2873 dwarf2out_frame_debug_restore_state (void)
2875 dw_cfi_ref cfi = new_cfi ();
2876 const char *label = dwarf2out_cfi_label (false);
2878 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_restore_state;
2879 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
2881 gcc_assert (cfa_remember.in_use);
2882 cfa = cfa_remember;
2883 cfa_remember.in_use = 0;
2886 #endif
2888 /* Describe for the GTY machinery what parts of dw_cfi_oprnd1 are used. */
2889 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc
2890 (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi);
2892 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type
2893 dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi)
2895 switch (cfi)
2897 case DW_CFA_nop:
2898 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
2899 case DW_CFA_remember_state:
2900 case DW_CFA_restore_state:
2901 return dw_cfi_oprnd_unused;
2903 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
2904 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
2905 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
2906 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
2907 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
2908 return dw_cfi_oprnd_addr;
2910 case DW_CFA_offset:
2911 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
2912 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
2913 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
2914 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
2915 case DW_CFA_restore:
2916 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
2917 case DW_CFA_undefined:
2918 case DW_CFA_same_value:
2919 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
2920 case DW_CFA_register:
2921 return dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num;
2923 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
2924 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
2925 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
2926 return dw_cfi_oprnd_offset;
2928 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
2929 case DW_CFA_expression:
2930 return dw_cfi_oprnd_loc;
2932 default:
2933 gcc_unreachable ();
2937 /* Describe for the GTY machinery what parts of dw_cfi_oprnd2 are used. */
2938 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc
2939 (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi);
2941 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type
2942 dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi)
2944 switch (cfi)
2946 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
2947 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
2948 case DW_CFA_offset:
2949 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
2950 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
2951 return dw_cfi_oprnd_offset;
2953 case DW_CFA_register:
2954 return dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num;
2956 default:
2957 return dw_cfi_oprnd_unused;
2961 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
2963 /* Switch [BACK] to eh_frame_section. If we don't have an eh_frame_section,
2964 switch to the data section instead, and write out a synthetic start label
2965 for collect2 the first time around. */
2967 static void
2968 switch_to_eh_frame_section (bool back)
2970 tree label;
2972 #ifdef EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
2973 if (eh_frame_section == 0)
2975 int flags;
2977 if (EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY)
2979 int fde_encoding;
2980 int per_encoding;
2981 int lsda_encoding;
2983 fde_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1,
2984 /*global=*/0);
2985 per_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2,
2986 /*global=*/1);
2987 lsda_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0,
2988 /*global=*/0);
2989 flags = ((! flag_pic
2990 || ((fde_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
2991 && (fde_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned
2992 && (per_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
2993 && (per_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned
2994 && (lsda_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
2995 && (lsda_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned))
2996 ? 0 : SECTION_WRITE);
2998 else
2999 flags = SECTION_WRITE;
3000 eh_frame_section = get_section (EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME, flags, NULL);
3002 #endif
3004 if (eh_frame_section)
3005 switch_to_section (eh_frame_section);
3006 else
3008 /* We have no special eh_frame section. Put the information in
3009 the data section and emit special labels to guide collect2. */
3010 switch_to_section (data_section);
3012 if (!back)
3014 label = get_file_function_name ("F");
3015 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, floor_log2 (PTR_SIZE));
3016 targetm.asm_out.globalize_label (asm_out_file,
3017 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (label));
3018 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (label));
3023 /* Switch [BACK] to the eh or debug frame table section, depending on
3024 FOR_EH. */
3026 static void
3027 switch_to_frame_table_section (int for_eh, bool back)
3029 if (for_eh)
3030 switch_to_eh_frame_section (back);
3031 else
3033 if (!debug_frame_section)
3034 debug_frame_section = get_section (DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION,
3035 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
3036 switch_to_section (debug_frame_section);
3040 /* Output a Call Frame Information opcode and its operand(s). */
3042 static void
3043 output_cfi (dw_cfi_ref cfi, dw_fde_ref fde, int for_eh)
3045 unsigned long r;
3046 HOST_WIDE_INT off;
3048 if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_advance_loc)
3049 dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi->dw_cfi_opc
3050 | (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset & 0x3f)),
3051 "DW_CFA_advance_loc " HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX,
3052 ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT)
3053 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset));
3054 else if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_offset)
3056 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
3057 dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi->dw_cfi_opc | (r & 0x3f)),
3058 "DW_CFA_offset, column 0x%lx", r);
3059 off = div_data_align (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset);
3060 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (off, NULL);
3062 else if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_restore)
3064 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
3065 dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi->dw_cfi_opc | (r & 0x3f)),
3066 "DW_CFA_restore, column 0x%lx", r);
3068 else
3070 dw2_asm_output_data (1, cfi->dw_cfi_opc,
3071 "%s", dwarf_cfi_name (cfi->dw_cfi_opc));
3073 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
3075 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
3076 if (for_eh)
3077 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (
3078 ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1, /*global=*/0),
3079 gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr),
3080 false, NULL);
3081 else
3082 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
3083 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr, NULL);
3084 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
3085 break;
3087 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
3088 dw2_asm_output_delta (1, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
3089 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
3090 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
3091 break;
3093 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
3094 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
3095 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
3096 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
3097 break;
3099 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
3100 dw2_asm_output_delta (4, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
3101 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
3102 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
3103 break;
3105 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
3106 dw2_asm_output_delta (8, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
3107 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
3108 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
3109 break;
3111 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
3112 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
3113 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
3114 off = div_data_align (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset);
3115 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (off, NULL);
3116 break;
3118 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
3119 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
3120 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
3121 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
3122 break;
3124 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
3125 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
3126 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
3127 off = div_data_align (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset);
3128 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (off, NULL);
3129 break;
3131 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
3132 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
3133 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
3134 off = div_data_align (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset);
3135 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (off, NULL);
3136 break;
3138 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
3139 case DW_CFA_undefined:
3140 case DW_CFA_same_value:
3141 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
3142 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
3143 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
3144 break;
3146 case DW_CFA_register:
3147 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
3148 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
3149 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
3150 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
3151 break;
3153 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
3154 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
3155 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
3156 break;
3158 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
3159 off = div_data_align (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset);
3160 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (off, NULL);
3161 break;
3163 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
3164 break;
3166 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
3167 case DW_CFA_expression:
3168 output_cfa_loc (cfi);
3169 break;
3171 case DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended:
3172 /* Obsoleted by DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf. */
3173 gcc_unreachable ();
3175 default:
3176 break;
3181 /* Similar, but do it via assembler directives instead. */
3183 static void
3184 output_cfi_directive (dw_cfi_ref cfi)
3186 unsigned long r, r2;
3188 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
3190 case DW_CFA_advance_loc:
3191 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
3192 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
3193 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
3194 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
3195 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
3196 /* Should only be created by add_fde_cfi in a code path not
3197 followed when emitting via directives. The assembler is
3198 going to take care of this for us. */
3199 gcc_unreachable ();
3201 case DW_CFA_offset:
3202 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
3203 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
3204 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, 1);
3205 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_offset %lu, "HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC"\n",
3206 r, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset);
3207 break;
3209 case DW_CFA_restore:
3210 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
3211 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, 1);
3212 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_restore %lu\n", r);
3213 break;
3215 case DW_CFA_undefined:
3216 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, 1);
3217 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_undefined %lu\n", r);
3218 break;
3220 case DW_CFA_same_value:
3221 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, 1);
3222 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_same_value %lu\n", r);
3223 break;
3225 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
3226 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
3227 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, 1);
3228 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_def_cfa %lu, "HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC"\n",
3229 r, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset);
3230 break;
3232 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
3233 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, 1);
3234 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_def_cfa_register %lu\n", r);
3235 break;
3237 case DW_CFA_register:
3238 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, 1);
3239 r2 = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num, 1);
3240 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_register %lu, %lu\n", r, r2);
3241 break;
3243 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
3244 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
3245 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_def_cfa_offset "
3246 HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC"\n",
3247 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset);
3248 break;
3250 case DW_CFA_remember_state:
3251 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_remember_state\n");
3252 break;
3253 case DW_CFA_restore_state:
3254 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_restore_state\n");
3255 break;
3257 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
3258 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_escape 0x%x,", DW_CFA_GNU_args_size);
3259 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset);
3260 if (flag_debug_asm)
3261 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t%s args_size "HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC,
3262 ASM_COMMENT_START, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset);
3263 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
3264 break;
3266 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
3267 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_window_save\n");
3268 break;
3270 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
3271 case DW_CFA_expression:
3272 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_escape 0x%x,", cfi->dw_cfi_opc);
3273 output_cfa_loc_raw (cfi);
3274 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
3275 break;
3277 default:
3278 gcc_unreachable ();
3282 DEF_VEC_P (dw_cfi_ref);
3283 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_P (dw_cfi_ref, heap);
3285 /* Output CFIs to bring current FDE to the same state as after executing
3286 CFIs in CFI chain. DO_CFI_ASM is true if .cfi_* directives shall
3287 be emitted, false otherwise. If it is false, FDE and FOR_EH are the
3288 other arguments to pass to output_cfi. */
3290 static void
3291 output_cfis (dw_cfi_ref cfi, bool do_cfi_asm, dw_fde_ref fde, bool for_eh)
3293 struct dw_cfi_struct cfi_buf;
3294 dw_cfi_ref cfi2;
3295 dw_cfi_ref cfi_args_size = NULL, cfi_cfa = NULL, cfi_cfa_offset = NULL;
3296 VEC (dw_cfi_ref, heap) *regs = VEC_alloc (dw_cfi_ref, heap, 32);
3297 unsigned int len, idx;
3299 for (;; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
3300 switch (cfi ? cfi->dw_cfi_opc : DW_CFA_nop)
3302 case DW_CFA_advance_loc:
3303 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
3304 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
3305 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
3306 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
3307 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
3308 /* All advances should be ignored. */
3309 break;
3310 case DW_CFA_remember_state:
3312 dw_cfi_ref args_size = cfi_args_size;
3314 /* Skip everything between .cfi_remember_state and
3315 .cfi_restore_state. */
3316 for (cfi2 = cfi->dw_cfi_next; cfi2; cfi2 = cfi2->dw_cfi_next)
3317 if (cfi2->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_restore_state)
3318 break;
3319 else if (cfi2->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_GNU_args_size)
3320 args_size = cfi2;
3321 else
3322 gcc_assert (cfi2->dw_cfi_opc != DW_CFA_remember_state);
3324 if (cfi2 == NULL)
3325 goto flush_all;
3326 else
3328 cfi = cfi2;
3329 cfi_args_size = args_size;
3331 break;
3333 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
3334 cfi_args_size = cfi;
3335 break;
3336 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
3337 goto flush_all;
3338 case DW_CFA_offset:
3339 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
3340 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
3341 case DW_CFA_restore:
3342 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
3343 case DW_CFA_undefined:
3344 case DW_CFA_same_value:
3345 case DW_CFA_register:
3346 case DW_CFA_val_offset:
3347 case DW_CFA_val_offset_sf:
3348 case DW_CFA_expression:
3349 case DW_CFA_val_expression:
3350 case DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended:
3351 if (VEC_length (dw_cfi_ref, regs) <= cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num)
3352 VEC_safe_grow_cleared (dw_cfi_ref, heap, regs,
3353 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num + 1);
3354 VEC_replace (dw_cfi_ref, regs, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, cfi);
3355 break;
3356 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
3357 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
3358 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
3359 cfi_cfa = cfi;
3360 cfi_cfa_offset = cfi;
3361 break;
3362 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
3363 cfi_cfa = cfi;
3364 break;
3365 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
3366 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
3367 cfi_cfa_offset = cfi;
3368 break;
3369 case DW_CFA_nop:
3370 gcc_assert (cfi == NULL);
3371 flush_all:
3372 len = VEC_length (dw_cfi_ref, regs);
3373 for (idx = 0; idx < len; idx++)
3375 cfi2 = VEC_replace (dw_cfi_ref, regs, idx, NULL);
3376 if (cfi2 != NULL
3377 && cfi2->dw_cfi_opc != DW_CFA_restore
3378 && cfi2->dw_cfi_opc != DW_CFA_restore_extended)
3380 if (do_cfi_asm)
3381 output_cfi_directive (cfi2);
3382 else
3383 output_cfi (cfi2, fde, for_eh);
3386 if (cfi_cfa && cfi_cfa_offset && cfi_cfa_offset != cfi_cfa)
3388 gcc_assert (cfi_cfa->dw_cfi_opc != DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression);
3389 cfi_buf = *cfi_cfa;
3390 switch (cfi_cfa_offset->dw_cfi_opc)
3392 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
3393 cfi_buf.dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa;
3394 cfi_buf.dw_cfi_oprnd2 = cfi_cfa_offset->dw_cfi_oprnd1;
3395 break;
3396 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
3397 cfi_buf.dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf;
3398 cfi_buf.dw_cfi_oprnd2 = cfi_cfa_offset->dw_cfi_oprnd1;
3399 break;
3400 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
3401 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
3402 cfi_buf.dw_cfi_opc = cfi_cfa_offset->dw_cfi_opc;
3403 cfi_buf.dw_cfi_oprnd2 = cfi_cfa_offset->dw_cfi_oprnd2;
3404 break;
3405 default:
3406 gcc_unreachable ();
3408 cfi_cfa = &cfi_buf;
3410 else if (cfi_cfa_offset)
3411 cfi_cfa = cfi_cfa_offset;
3412 if (cfi_cfa)
3414 if (do_cfi_asm)
3415 output_cfi_directive (cfi_cfa);
3416 else
3417 output_cfi (cfi_cfa, fde, for_eh);
3419 cfi_cfa = NULL;
3420 cfi_cfa_offset = NULL;
3421 if (cfi_args_size
3422 && cfi_args_size->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset)
3424 if (do_cfi_asm)
3425 output_cfi_directive (cfi_args_size);
3426 else
3427 output_cfi (cfi_args_size, fde, for_eh);
3429 cfi_args_size = NULL;
3430 if (cfi == NULL)
3432 VEC_free (dw_cfi_ref, heap, regs);
3433 return;
3435 else if (do_cfi_asm)
3436 output_cfi_directive (cfi);
3437 else
3438 output_cfi (cfi, fde, for_eh);
3439 break;
3440 default:
3441 gcc_unreachable ();
3445 /* Output one FDE. */
3447 static void
3448 output_fde (dw_fde_ref fde, bool for_eh, bool second,
3449 char *section_start_label, int fde_encoding, char *augmentation,
3450 bool any_lsda_needed, int lsda_encoding)
3452 const char *begin, *end;
3453 static unsigned int j;
3454 char l1[20], l2[20];
3455 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
3457 targetm.asm_out.unwind_label (asm_out_file, fde->decl, for_eh,
3458 /* empty */ 0);
3459 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, FDE_LABEL,
3460 for_eh + j);
3461 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, FDE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL, for_eh + j);
3462 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, FDE_END_LABEL, for_eh + j);
3463 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 && !for_eh)
3464 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff, "Initial length escape value"
3465 " indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
3466 dw2_asm_output_delta (for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
3467 "FDE Length");
3468 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
3470 if (for_eh)
3471 dw2_asm_output_delta (4, l1, section_start_label, "FDE CIE offset");
3472 else
3473 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, section_start_label,
3474 debug_frame_section, "FDE CIE offset");
3476 if (!fde->dw_fde_switched_sections)
3478 begin = fde->dw_fde_begin;
3479 end = fde->dw_fde_end;
3481 else
3483 /* For the first section, prefer dw_fde_begin over
3484 dw_fde_{hot,cold}_section_label, as the latter
3485 might be separated from the real start of the
3486 function by alignment padding. */
3487 if (!second)
3488 begin = fde->dw_fde_begin;
3489 else if (fde->dw_fde_switched_cold_to_hot)
3490 begin = fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label;
3491 else
3492 begin = fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label;
3493 if (second ^ fde->dw_fde_switched_cold_to_hot)
3494 end = fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label;
3495 else
3496 end = fde->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label;
3499 if (for_eh)
3501 rtx sym_ref = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, begin);
3502 SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (sym_ref) |= SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL;
3503 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (fde_encoding, sym_ref, false,
3504 "FDE initial location");
3505 dw2_asm_output_delta (size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding),
3506 end, begin, "FDE address range");
3508 else
3510 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, begin, "FDE initial location");
3511 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, end, begin, "FDE address range");
3514 if (augmentation[0])
3516 if (any_lsda_needed)
3518 int size = size_of_encoded_value (lsda_encoding);
3520 if (lsda_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
3522 int offset = ( 4 /* Length */
3523 + 4 /* CIE offset */
3524 + 2 * size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding)
3525 + 1 /* Augmentation size */ );
3526 int pad = -offset & (PTR_SIZE - 1);
3528 size += pad;
3529 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (size) == 1);
3532 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, "Augmentation size");
3534 if (fde->uses_eh_lsda)
3536 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, second ? "LLSDAC" : "LLSDA",
3537 fde->funcdef_number);
3538 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (lsda_encoding,
3539 gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, l1),
3540 false,
3541 "Language Specific Data Area");
3543 else
3545 if (lsda_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
3546 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, floor_log2 (PTR_SIZE));
3547 dw2_asm_output_data (size_of_encoded_value (lsda_encoding), 0,
3548 "Language Specific Data Area (none)");
3551 else
3552 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, "Augmentation size");
3555 /* Loop through the Call Frame Instructions associated with
3556 this FDE. */
3557 fde->dw_fde_current_label = begin;
3558 if (!fde->dw_fde_switched_sections)
3559 for (cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi; cfi != NULL; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
3560 output_cfi (cfi, fde, for_eh);
3561 else if (!second)
3563 if (fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi)
3564 for (cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi; cfi != NULL; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
3566 output_cfi (cfi, fde, for_eh);
3567 if (cfi == fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi)
3568 break;
3571 else
3573 dw_cfi_ref cfi_next = fde->dw_fde_cfi;
3575 if (fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi)
3577 cfi_next = fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi->dw_cfi_next;
3578 fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi->dw_cfi_next = NULL;
3579 output_cfis (fde->dw_fde_cfi, false, fde, for_eh);
3580 fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi->dw_cfi_next = cfi_next;
3582 for (cfi = cfi_next; cfi != NULL; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
3583 output_cfi (cfi, fde, for_eh);
3586 /* If we are to emit a ref/link from function bodies to their frame tables,
3587 do it now. This is typically performed to make sure that tables
3588 associated with functions are dragged with them and not discarded in
3589 garbage collecting links. We need to do this on a per function basis to
3590 cope with -ffunction-sections. */
3592 #ifdef ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF
3593 /* Switch to the function section, emit the ref to the tables, and
3594 switch *back* into the table section. */
3595 switch_to_section (function_section (fde->decl));
3596 ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF (section_start_label);
3597 switch_to_frame_table_section (for_eh, true);
3598 #endif
3600 /* Pad the FDE out to an address sized boundary. */
3601 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file,
3602 floor_log2 ((for_eh ? PTR_SIZE : DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)));
3603 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
3605 j += 2;
3608 /* Output the call frame information used to record information
3609 that relates to calculating the frame pointer, and records the
3610 location of saved registers. */
3612 static void
3613 output_call_frame_info (int for_eh)
3615 unsigned int i;
3616 dw_fde_ref fde;
3617 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
3618 char l1[20], l2[20], section_start_label[20];
3619 bool any_lsda_needed = false;
3620 char augmentation[6];
3621 int augmentation_size;
3622 int fde_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
3623 int per_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
3624 int lsda_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
3625 int return_reg;
3626 rtx personality = NULL;
3627 int dw_cie_version;
3629 /* Don't emit a CIE if there won't be any FDEs. */
3630 if (fde_table_in_use == 0)
3631 return;
3633 /* Nothing to do if the assembler's doing it all. */
3634 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
3635 return;
3637 /* If we make FDEs linkonce, we may have to emit an empty label for
3638 an FDE that wouldn't otherwise be emitted. We want to avoid
3639 having an FDE kept around when the function it refers to is
3640 discarded. Example where this matters: a primary function
3641 template in C++ requires EH information, but an explicit
3642 specialization doesn't. */
3643 if (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
3644 && ! flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables
3645 && flag_exceptions
3646 && for_eh)
3647 for (i = 0; i < fde_table_in_use; i++)
3648 if ((fde_table[i].nothrow || fde_table[i].all_throwers_are_sibcalls)
3649 && !fde_table[i].uses_eh_lsda
3650 && ! DECL_WEAK (fde_table[i].decl))
3651 targetm.asm_out.unwind_label (asm_out_file, fde_table[i].decl,
3652 for_eh, /* empty */ 1);
3654 /* If we don't have any functions we'll want to unwind out of, don't
3655 emit any EH unwind information. Note that if exceptions aren't
3656 enabled, we won't have collected nothrow information, and if we
3657 asked for asynchronous tables, we always want this info. */
3658 if (for_eh)
3660 bool any_eh_needed = !flag_exceptions || flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables;
3662 for (i = 0; i < fde_table_in_use; i++)
3663 if (fde_table[i].uses_eh_lsda)
3664 any_eh_needed = any_lsda_needed = true;
3665 else if (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO && DECL_WEAK (fde_table[i].decl))
3666 any_eh_needed = true;
3667 else if (! fde_table[i].nothrow
3668 && ! fde_table[i].all_throwers_are_sibcalls)
3669 any_eh_needed = true;
3671 if (! any_eh_needed)
3672 return;
3675 /* We're going to be generating comments, so turn on app. */
3676 if (flag_debug_asm)
3677 app_enable ();
3679 /* Switch to the proper frame section, first time. */
3680 switch_to_frame_table_section (for_eh, false);
3682 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (section_start_label, FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL, for_eh);
3683 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, section_start_label);
3685 /* Output the CIE. */
3686 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, CIE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL, for_eh);
3687 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, CIE_END_LABEL, for_eh);
3688 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 && !for_eh)
3689 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
3690 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
3691 dw2_asm_output_delta (for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
3692 "Length of Common Information Entry");
3693 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
3695 /* Now that the CIE pointer is PC-relative for EH,
3696 use 0 to identify the CIE. */
3697 dw2_asm_output_data ((for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE),
3698 (for_eh ? 0 : DWARF_CIE_ID),
3699 "CIE Identifier Tag");
3701 /* Use the CIE version 3 for DWARF3; allow DWARF2 to continue to
3702 use CIE version 1, unless that would produce incorrect results
3703 due to overflowing the return register column. */
3704 return_reg = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, for_eh);
3705 dw_cie_version = 1;
3706 if (return_reg >= 256 || dwarf_version > 2)
3707 dw_cie_version = 3;
3708 dw2_asm_output_data (1, dw_cie_version, "CIE Version");
3710 augmentation[0] = 0;
3711 augmentation_size = 0;
3713 personality = current_unit_personality;
3714 if (for_eh)
3716 char *p;
3718 /* Augmentation:
3719 z Indicates that a uleb128 is present to size the
3720 augmentation section.
3721 L Indicates the encoding (and thus presence) of
3722 an LSDA pointer in the FDE augmentation.
3723 R Indicates a non-default pointer encoding for
3724 FDE code pointers.
3725 P Indicates the presence of an encoding + language
3726 personality routine in the CIE augmentation. */
3728 fde_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1, /*global=*/0);
3729 per_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2, /*global=*/1);
3730 lsda_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0, /*global=*/0);
3732 p = augmentation + 1;
3733 if (personality)
3735 *p++ = 'P';
3736 augmentation_size += 1 + size_of_encoded_value (per_encoding);
3737 assemble_external_libcall (personality);
3739 if (any_lsda_needed)
3741 *p++ = 'L';
3742 augmentation_size += 1;
3744 if (fde_encoding != DW_EH_PE_absptr)
3746 *p++ = 'R';
3747 augmentation_size += 1;
3749 if (p > augmentation + 1)
3751 augmentation[0] = 'z';
3752 *p = '\0';
3755 /* Ug. Some platforms can't do unaligned dynamic relocations at all. */
3756 if (personality && per_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
3758 int offset = ( 4 /* Length */
3759 + 4 /* CIE Id */
3760 + 1 /* CIE version */
3761 + strlen (augmentation) + 1 /* Augmentation */
3762 + size_of_uleb128 (1) /* Code alignment */
3763 + size_of_sleb128 (DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT)
3764 + 1 /* RA column */
3765 + 1 /* Augmentation size */
3766 + 1 /* Personality encoding */ );
3767 int pad = -offset & (PTR_SIZE - 1);
3769 augmentation_size += pad;
3771 /* Augmentations should be small, so there's scarce need to
3772 iterate for a solution. Die if we exceed one uleb128 byte. */
3773 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (augmentation_size) == 1);
3777 dw2_asm_output_nstring (augmentation, -1, "CIE Augmentation");
3778 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, "CIE Code Alignment Factor");
3779 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT,
3780 "CIE Data Alignment Factor");
3782 if (dw_cie_version == 1)
3783 dw2_asm_output_data (1, return_reg, "CIE RA Column");
3784 else
3785 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (return_reg, "CIE RA Column");
3787 if (augmentation[0])
3789 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (augmentation_size, "Augmentation size");
3790 if (personality)
3792 dw2_asm_output_data (1, per_encoding, "Personality (%s)",
3793 eh_data_format_name (per_encoding));
3794 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (per_encoding,
3795 personality,
3796 true, NULL);
3799 if (any_lsda_needed)
3800 dw2_asm_output_data (1, lsda_encoding, "LSDA Encoding (%s)",
3801 eh_data_format_name (lsda_encoding));
3803 if (fde_encoding != DW_EH_PE_absptr)
3804 dw2_asm_output_data (1, fde_encoding, "FDE Encoding (%s)",
3805 eh_data_format_name (fde_encoding));
3808 for (cfi = cie_cfi_head; cfi != NULL; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
3809 output_cfi (cfi, NULL, for_eh);
3811 /* Pad the CIE out to an address sized boundary. */
3812 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file,
3813 floor_log2 (for_eh ? PTR_SIZE : DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE));
3814 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
3816 /* Loop through all of the FDE's. */
3817 for (i = 0; i < fde_table_in_use; i++)
3819 unsigned int k;
3820 fde = &fde_table[i];
3822 /* Don't emit EH unwind info for leaf functions that don't need it. */
3823 if (for_eh && !flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables && flag_exceptions
3824 && (fde->nothrow || fde->all_throwers_are_sibcalls)
3825 && ! (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO && DECL_WEAK (fde_table[i].decl))
3826 && !fde->uses_eh_lsda)
3827 continue;
3829 for (k = 0; k < (fde->dw_fde_switched_sections ? 2 : 1); k++)
3830 output_fde (fde, for_eh, k, section_start_label, fde_encoding,
3831 augmentation, any_lsda_needed, lsda_encoding);
3834 if (for_eh && targetm.terminate_dw2_eh_frame_info)
3835 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0, "End of Table");
3836 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
3837 /* Work around Irix 6 assembler bug whereby labels at the end of a section
3838 get a value of 0. Putting .align 0 after the label fixes it. */
3839 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, 0);
3840 #endif
3842 /* Turn off app to make assembly quicker. */
3843 if (flag_debug_asm)
3844 app_disable ();
3847 /* Emit .cfi_startproc and .cfi_personality/.cfi_lsda if needed. */
3849 static void
3850 dwarf2out_do_cfi_startproc (bool second)
3852 int enc;
3853 rtx ref;
3854 rtx personality = get_personality_function (current_function_decl);
3856 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_startproc\n");
3858 if (personality)
3860 enc = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2, /*global=*/1);
3861 ref = personality;
3863 /* ??? The GAS support isn't entirely consistent. We have to
3864 handle indirect support ourselves, but PC-relative is done
3865 in the assembler. Further, the assembler can't handle any
3866 of the weirder relocation types. */
3867 if (enc & DW_EH_PE_indirect)
3868 ref = dw2_force_const_mem (ref, true);
3870 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_personality 0x%x,", enc);
3871 output_addr_const (asm_out_file, ref);
3872 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
3875 if (crtl->uses_eh_lsda)
3877 char lab[20];
3879 enc = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0, /*global=*/0);
3880 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (lab, second ? "LLSDAC" : "LLSDA",
3881 current_function_funcdef_no);
3882 ref = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, lab);
3883 SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (ref) = SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL;
3885 if (enc & DW_EH_PE_indirect)
3886 ref = dw2_force_const_mem (ref, true);
3888 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_lsda 0x%x,", enc);
3889 output_addr_const (asm_out_file, ref);
3890 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
3894 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of a function, before
3895 the prologue. */
3897 void
3898 dwarf2out_begin_prologue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
3899 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
3901 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
3902 char * dup_label;
3903 dw_fde_ref fde;
3904 section *fnsec;
3906 current_function_func_begin_label = NULL;
3908 #ifdef TARGET_UNWIND_INFO
3909 /* ??? current_function_func_begin_label is also used by except.c
3910 for call-site information. We must emit this label if it might
3911 be used. */
3912 if ((! flag_exceptions || USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS)
3913 && ! dwarf2out_do_frame ())
3914 return;
3915 #else
3916 if (! dwarf2out_do_frame ())
3917 return;
3918 #endif
3920 fnsec = function_section (current_function_decl);
3921 switch_to_section (fnsec);
3922 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
3923 current_function_funcdef_no);
3924 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
3925 current_function_funcdef_no);
3926 dup_label = xstrdup (label);
3927 current_function_func_begin_label = dup_label;
3929 #ifdef TARGET_UNWIND_INFO
3930 /* We can elide the fde allocation if we're not emitting debug info. */
3931 if (! dwarf2out_do_frame ())
3932 return;
3933 #endif
3935 /* Expand the fde table if necessary. */
3936 if (fde_table_in_use == fde_table_allocated)
3938 fde_table_allocated += FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
3939 fde_table = GGC_RESIZEVEC (dw_fde_node, fde_table, fde_table_allocated);
3940 memset (fde_table + fde_table_in_use, 0,
3941 FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_fde_node));
3944 /* Record the FDE associated with this function. */
3945 current_funcdef_fde = fde_table_in_use;
3947 /* Add the new FDE at the end of the fde_table. */
3948 fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use++];
3949 fde->decl = current_function_decl;
3950 fde->dw_fde_begin = dup_label;
3951 fde->dw_fde_current_label = dup_label;
3952 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label = NULL;
3953 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label = NULL;
3954 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label = NULL;
3955 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label = NULL;
3956 fde->dw_fde_switched_sections = 0;
3957 fde->dw_fde_switched_cold_to_hot = 0;
3958 fde->dw_fde_end = NULL;
3959 fde->dw_fde_cfi = NULL;
3960 fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi = NULL;
3961 fde->funcdef_number = current_function_funcdef_no;
3962 fde->nothrow = crtl->nothrow;
3963 fde->uses_eh_lsda = crtl->uses_eh_lsda;
3964 fde->all_throwers_are_sibcalls = crtl->all_throwers_are_sibcalls;
3965 fde->drap_reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
3966 fde->vdrap_reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
3967 if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
3969 section *unlikelysec;
3970 if (first_function_block_is_cold)
3971 fde->in_std_section = 1;
3972 else
3973 fde->in_std_section
3974 = (fnsec == text_section
3975 || (cold_text_section && fnsec == cold_text_section));
3976 unlikelysec = unlikely_text_section ();
3977 fde->cold_in_std_section
3978 = (unlikelysec == text_section
3979 || (cold_text_section && unlikelysec == cold_text_section));
3981 else
3983 fde->in_std_section
3984 = (fnsec == text_section
3985 || (cold_text_section && fnsec == cold_text_section));
3986 fde->cold_in_std_section = 0;
3989 args_size = old_args_size = 0;
3991 /* We only want to output line number information for the genuine dwarf2
3992 prologue case, not the eh frame case. */
3993 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
3994 if (file)
3995 dwarf2out_source_line (line, file, 0, true);
3996 #endif
3998 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
3999 dwarf2out_do_cfi_startproc (false);
4000 else
4002 rtx personality = get_personality_function (current_function_decl);
4003 if (!current_unit_personality)
4004 current_unit_personality = personality;
4006 /* We cannot keep a current personality per function as without CFI
4007 asm at the point where we emit the CFI data there is no current
4008 function anymore. */
4009 if (personality
4010 && current_unit_personality != personality)
4011 sorry ("Multiple EH personalities are supported only with assemblers "
4012 "supporting .cfi.personality directive.");
4016 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the absolute end of the generated code
4017 for a function definition. This gets called *after* the epilogue code has
4018 been generated. */
4020 void
4021 dwarf2out_end_epilogue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
4022 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
4024 dw_fde_ref fde;
4025 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4027 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
4028 last_var_location_insn = NULL_RTX;
4029 #endif
4031 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
4032 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_endproc\n");
4034 /* Output a label to mark the endpoint of the code generated for this
4035 function. */
4036 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_END_LABEL,
4037 current_function_funcdef_no);
4038 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, label);
4039 fde = current_fde ();
4040 gcc_assert (fde != NULL);
4041 fde->dw_fde_end = xstrdup (label);
4044 void
4045 dwarf2out_frame_init (void)
4047 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the fde_table. */
4048 fde_table = GGC_CNEWVEC (dw_fde_node, FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT);
4049 fde_table_allocated = FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
4050 fde_table_in_use = 0;
4052 /* Generate the CFA instructions common to all FDE's. Do it now for the
4053 sake of lookup_cfa. */
4055 /* On entry, the Canonical Frame Address is at SP. */
4056 dwarf2out_def_cfa (NULL, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM, INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET);
4058 #ifdef DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
4059 if (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO || DWARF2_FRAME_INFO)
4060 initial_return_save (INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX);
4061 #endif
4064 void
4065 dwarf2out_frame_finish (void)
4067 /* Output call frame information. */
4068 if (DWARF2_FRAME_INFO)
4069 output_call_frame_info (0);
4071 #ifndef TARGET_UNWIND_INFO
4072 /* Output another copy for the unwinder. */
4073 if (! USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS && (flag_unwind_tables || flag_exceptions))
4074 output_call_frame_info (1);
4075 #endif
4078 /* Note that the current function section is being used for code. */
4080 static void
4081 dwarf2out_note_section_used (void)
4083 section *sec = current_function_section ();
4084 if (sec == text_section)
4085 text_section_used = true;
4086 else if (sec == cold_text_section)
4087 cold_text_section_used = true;
4090 void
4091 dwarf2out_switch_text_section (void)
4093 dw_fde_ref fde = current_fde ();
4095 gcc_assert (cfun && fde && !fde->dw_fde_switched_sections);
4097 fde->dw_fde_switched_sections = 1;
4098 fde->dw_fde_switched_cold_to_hot = !in_cold_section_p;
4100 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label = crtl->subsections.hot_section_label;
4101 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label = crtl->subsections.hot_section_end_label;
4102 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label = crtl->subsections.cold_section_label;
4103 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label = crtl->subsections.cold_section_end_label;
4104 have_multiple_function_sections = true;
4106 /* Reset the current label on switching text sections, so that we
4107 don't attempt to advance_loc4 between labels in different sections. */
4108 fde->dw_fde_current_label = NULL;
4110 /* There is no need to mark used sections when not debugging. */
4111 if (cold_text_section != NULL)
4112 dwarf2out_note_section_used ();
4114 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
4115 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_endproc\n");
4117 /* Now do the real section switch. */
4118 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
4120 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
4122 dwarf2out_do_cfi_startproc (true);
4123 /* As this is a different FDE, insert all current CFI instructions
4124 again. */
4125 output_cfis (fde->dw_fde_cfi, true, fde, true);
4127 else
4129 dw_cfi_ref cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi;
4131 cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi;
4132 if (cfi)
4133 while (cfi->dw_cfi_next != NULL)
4134 cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next;
4135 fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi = cfi;
4138 #endif
4140 /* And now, the subset of the debugging information support code necessary
4141 for emitting location expressions. */
4143 /* Data about a single source file. */
4144 struct GTY(()) dwarf_file_data {
4145 const char * filename;
4146 int emitted_number;
4149 typedef struct dw_val_struct *dw_val_ref;
4150 typedef struct die_struct *dw_die_ref;
4151 typedef const struct die_struct *const_dw_die_ref;
4152 typedef struct dw_loc_descr_struct *dw_loc_descr_ref;
4153 typedef struct dw_loc_list_struct *dw_loc_list_ref;
4155 typedef struct GTY(()) deferred_locations_struct
4157 tree variable;
4158 dw_die_ref die;
4159 } deferred_locations;
4161 DEF_VEC_O(deferred_locations);
4162 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_O(deferred_locations,gc);
4164 static GTY(()) VEC(deferred_locations, gc) *deferred_locations_list;
4166 DEF_VEC_P(dw_die_ref);
4167 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_P(dw_die_ref,heap);
4169 /* Each DIE may have a series of attribute/value pairs. Values
4170 can take on several forms. The forms that are used in this
4171 implementation are listed below. */
4173 enum dw_val_class
4175 dw_val_class_addr,
4176 dw_val_class_offset,
4177 dw_val_class_loc,
4178 dw_val_class_loc_list,
4179 dw_val_class_range_list,
4180 dw_val_class_const,
4181 dw_val_class_unsigned_const,
4182 dw_val_class_const_double,
4183 dw_val_class_vec,
4184 dw_val_class_flag,
4185 dw_val_class_die_ref,
4186 dw_val_class_fde_ref,
4187 dw_val_class_lbl_id,
4188 dw_val_class_lineptr,
4189 dw_val_class_str,
4190 dw_val_class_macptr,
4191 dw_val_class_file,
4192 dw_val_class_data8
4195 /* Describe a floating point constant value, or a vector constant value. */
4197 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_vec_struct {
4198 unsigned char * GTY((length ("%h.length"))) array;
4199 unsigned length;
4200 unsigned elt_size;
4202 dw_vec_const;
4204 /* The dw_val_node describes an attribute's value, as it is
4205 represented internally. */
4207 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_val_struct {
4208 enum dw_val_class val_class;
4209 union dw_val_struct_union
4211 rtx GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_addr"))) val_addr;
4212 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_offset"))) val_offset;
4213 dw_loc_list_ref GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_loc_list"))) val_loc_list;
4214 dw_loc_descr_ref GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_loc"))) val_loc;
4215 HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((default)) val_int;
4216 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_unsigned_const"))) val_unsigned;
4217 double_int GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_const_double"))) val_double;
4218 dw_vec_const GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_vec"))) val_vec;
4219 struct dw_val_die_union
4221 dw_die_ref die;
4222 int external;
4223 } GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_die_ref"))) val_die_ref;
4224 unsigned GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_fde_ref"))) val_fde_index;
4225 struct indirect_string_node * GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_str"))) val_str;
4226 char * GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_lbl_id"))) val_lbl_id;
4227 unsigned char GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_flag"))) val_flag;
4228 struct dwarf_file_data * GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_file"))) val_file;
4229 unsigned char GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_data8"))) val_data8[8];
4231 GTY ((desc ("%1.val_class"))) v;
4233 dw_val_node;
4235 /* Locations in memory are described using a sequence of stack machine
4236 operations. */
4238 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_loc_descr_struct {
4239 dw_loc_descr_ref dw_loc_next;
4240 ENUM_BITFIELD (dwarf_location_atom) dw_loc_opc : 8;
4241 /* Used to distinguish DW_OP_addr with a direct symbol relocation
4242 from DW_OP_addr with a dtp-relative symbol relocation. */
4243 unsigned int dtprel : 1;
4244 int dw_loc_addr;
4245 dw_val_node dw_loc_oprnd1;
4246 dw_val_node dw_loc_oprnd2;
4248 dw_loc_descr_node;
4250 /* Location lists are ranges + location descriptions for that range,
4251 so you can track variables that are in different places over
4252 their entire life. */
4253 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_loc_list_struct {
4254 dw_loc_list_ref dw_loc_next;
4255 const char *begin; /* Label for begin address of range */
4256 const char *end; /* Label for end address of range */
4257 char *ll_symbol; /* Label for beginning of location list.
4258 Only on head of list */
4259 const char *section; /* Section this loclist is relative to */
4260 dw_loc_descr_ref expr;
4261 } dw_loc_list_node;
4263 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
4265 static dw_loc_descr_ref int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT);
4267 /* Convert a DWARF stack opcode into its string name. */
4269 static const char *
4270 dwarf_stack_op_name (unsigned int op)
4272 switch (op)
4274 case DW_OP_addr:
4275 return "DW_OP_addr";
4276 case DW_OP_deref:
4277 return "DW_OP_deref";
4278 case DW_OP_const1u:
4279 return "DW_OP_const1u";
4280 case DW_OP_const1s:
4281 return "DW_OP_const1s";
4282 case DW_OP_const2u:
4283 return "DW_OP_const2u";
4284 case DW_OP_const2s:
4285 return "DW_OP_const2s";
4286 case DW_OP_const4u:
4287 return "DW_OP_const4u";
4288 case DW_OP_const4s:
4289 return "DW_OP_const4s";
4290 case DW_OP_const8u:
4291 return "DW_OP_const8u";
4292 case DW_OP_const8s:
4293 return "DW_OP_const8s";
4294 case DW_OP_constu:
4295 return "DW_OP_constu";
4296 case DW_OP_consts:
4297 return "DW_OP_consts";
4298 case DW_OP_dup:
4299 return "DW_OP_dup";
4300 case DW_OP_drop:
4301 return "DW_OP_drop";
4302 case DW_OP_over:
4303 return "DW_OP_over";
4304 case DW_OP_pick:
4305 return "DW_OP_pick";
4306 case DW_OP_swap:
4307 return "DW_OP_swap";
4308 case DW_OP_rot:
4309 return "DW_OP_rot";
4310 case DW_OP_xderef:
4311 return "DW_OP_xderef";
4312 case DW_OP_abs:
4313 return "DW_OP_abs";
4314 case DW_OP_and:
4315 return "DW_OP_and";
4316 case DW_OP_div:
4317 return "DW_OP_div";
4318 case DW_OP_minus:
4319 return "DW_OP_minus";
4320 case DW_OP_mod:
4321 return "DW_OP_mod";
4322 case DW_OP_mul:
4323 return "DW_OP_mul";
4324 case DW_OP_neg:
4325 return "DW_OP_neg";
4326 case DW_OP_not:
4327 return "DW_OP_not";
4328 case DW_OP_or:
4329 return "DW_OP_or";
4330 case DW_OP_plus:
4331 return "DW_OP_plus";
4332 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
4333 return "DW_OP_plus_uconst";
4334 case DW_OP_shl:
4335 return "DW_OP_shl";
4336 case DW_OP_shr:
4337 return "DW_OP_shr";
4338 case DW_OP_shra:
4339 return "DW_OP_shra";
4340 case DW_OP_xor:
4341 return "DW_OP_xor";
4342 case DW_OP_bra:
4343 return "DW_OP_bra";
4344 case DW_OP_eq:
4345 return "DW_OP_eq";
4346 case DW_OP_ge:
4347 return "DW_OP_ge";
4348 case DW_OP_gt:
4349 return "DW_OP_gt";
4350 case DW_OP_le:
4351 return "DW_OP_le";
4352 case DW_OP_lt:
4353 return "DW_OP_lt";
4354 case DW_OP_ne:
4355 return "DW_OP_ne";
4356 case DW_OP_skip:
4357 return "DW_OP_skip";
4358 case DW_OP_lit0:
4359 return "DW_OP_lit0";
4360 case DW_OP_lit1:
4361 return "DW_OP_lit1";
4362 case DW_OP_lit2:
4363 return "DW_OP_lit2";
4364 case DW_OP_lit3:
4365 return "DW_OP_lit3";
4366 case DW_OP_lit4:
4367 return "DW_OP_lit4";
4368 case DW_OP_lit5:
4369 return "DW_OP_lit5";
4370 case DW_OP_lit6:
4371 return "DW_OP_lit6";
4372 case DW_OP_lit7:
4373 return "DW_OP_lit7";
4374 case DW_OP_lit8:
4375 return "DW_OP_lit8";
4376 case DW_OP_lit9:
4377 return "DW_OP_lit9";
4378 case DW_OP_lit10:
4379 return "DW_OP_lit10";
4380 case DW_OP_lit11:
4381 return "DW_OP_lit11";
4382 case DW_OP_lit12:
4383 return "DW_OP_lit12";
4384 case DW_OP_lit13:
4385 return "DW_OP_lit13";
4386 case DW_OP_lit14:
4387 return "DW_OP_lit14";
4388 case DW_OP_lit15:
4389 return "DW_OP_lit15";
4390 case DW_OP_lit16:
4391 return "DW_OP_lit16";
4392 case DW_OP_lit17:
4393 return "DW_OP_lit17";
4394 case DW_OP_lit18:
4395 return "DW_OP_lit18";
4396 case DW_OP_lit19:
4397 return "DW_OP_lit19";
4398 case DW_OP_lit20:
4399 return "DW_OP_lit20";
4400 case DW_OP_lit21:
4401 return "DW_OP_lit21";
4402 case DW_OP_lit22:
4403 return "DW_OP_lit22";
4404 case DW_OP_lit23:
4405 return "DW_OP_lit23";
4406 case DW_OP_lit24:
4407 return "DW_OP_lit24";
4408 case DW_OP_lit25:
4409 return "DW_OP_lit25";
4410 case DW_OP_lit26:
4411 return "DW_OP_lit26";
4412 case DW_OP_lit27:
4413 return "DW_OP_lit27";
4414 case DW_OP_lit28:
4415 return "DW_OP_lit28";
4416 case DW_OP_lit29:
4417 return "DW_OP_lit29";
4418 case DW_OP_lit30:
4419 return "DW_OP_lit30";
4420 case DW_OP_lit31:
4421 return "DW_OP_lit31";
4422 case DW_OP_reg0:
4423 return "DW_OP_reg0";
4424 case DW_OP_reg1:
4425 return "DW_OP_reg1";
4426 case DW_OP_reg2:
4427 return "DW_OP_reg2";
4428 case DW_OP_reg3:
4429 return "DW_OP_reg3";
4430 case DW_OP_reg4:
4431 return "DW_OP_reg4";
4432 case DW_OP_reg5:
4433 return "DW_OP_reg5";
4434 case DW_OP_reg6:
4435 return "DW_OP_reg6";
4436 case DW_OP_reg7:
4437 return "DW_OP_reg7";
4438 case DW_OP_reg8:
4439 return "DW_OP_reg8";
4440 case DW_OP_reg9:
4441 return "DW_OP_reg9";
4442 case DW_OP_reg10:
4443 return "DW_OP_reg10";
4444 case DW_OP_reg11:
4445 return "DW_OP_reg11";
4446 case DW_OP_reg12:
4447 return "DW_OP_reg12";
4448 case DW_OP_reg13:
4449 return "DW_OP_reg13";
4450 case DW_OP_reg14:
4451 return "DW_OP_reg14";
4452 case DW_OP_reg15:
4453 return "DW_OP_reg15";
4454 case DW_OP_reg16:
4455 return "DW_OP_reg16";
4456 case DW_OP_reg17:
4457 return "DW_OP_reg17";
4458 case DW_OP_reg18:
4459 return "DW_OP_reg18";
4460 case DW_OP_reg19:
4461 return "DW_OP_reg19";
4462 case DW_OP_reg20:
4463 return "DW_OP_reg20";
4464 case DW_OP_reg21:
4465 return "DW_OP_reg21";
4466 case DW_OP_reg22:
4467 return "DW_OP_reg22";
4468 case DW_OP_reg23:
4469 return "DW_OP_reg23";
4470 case DW_OP_reg24:
4471 return "DW_OP_reg24";
4472 case DW_OP_reg25:
4473 return "DW_OP_reg25";
4474 case DW_OP_reg26:
4475 return "DW_OP_reg26";
4476 case DW_OP_reg27:
4477 return "DW_OP_reg27";
4478 case DW_OP_reg28:
4479 return "DW_OP_reg28";
4480 case DW_OP_reg29:
4481 return "DW_OP_reg29";
4482 case DW_OP_reg30:
4483 return "DW_OP_reg30";
4484 case DW_OP_reg31:
4485 return "DW_OP_reg31";
4486 case DW_OP_breg0:
4487 return "DW_OP_breg0";
4488 case DW_OP_breg1:
4489 return "DW_OP_breg1";
4490 case DW_OP_breg2:
4491 return "DW_OP_breg2";
4492 case DW_OP_breg3:
4493 return "DW_OP_breg3";
4494 case DW_OP_breg4:
4495 return "DW_OP_breg4";
4496 case DW_OP_breg5:
4497 return "DW_OP_breg5";
4498 case DW_OP_breg6:
4499 return "DW_OP_breg6";
4500 case DW_OP_breg7:
4501 return "DW_OP_breg7";
4502 case DW_OP_breg8:
4503 return "DW_OP_breg8";
4504 case DW_OP_breg9:
4505 return "DW_OP_breg9";
4506 case DW_OP_breg10:
4507 return "DW_OP_breg10";
4508 case DW_OP_breg11:
4509 return "DW_OP_breg11";
4510 case DW_OP_breg12:
4511 return "DW_OP_breg12";
4512 case DW_OP_breg13:
4513 return "DW_OP_breg13";
4514 case DW_OP_breg14:
4515 return "DW_OP_breg14";
4516 case DW_OP_breg15:
4517 return "DW_OP_breg15";
4518 case DW_OP_breg16:
4519 return "DW_OP_breg16";
4520 case DW_OP_breg17:
4521 return "DW_OP_breg17";
4522 case DW_OP_breg18:
4523 return "DW_OP_breg18";
4524 case DW_OP_breg19:
4525 return "DW_OP_breg19";
4526 case DW_OP_breg20:
4527 return "DW_OP_breg20";
4528 case DW_OP_breg21:
4529 return "DW_OP_breg21";
4530 case DW_OP_breg22:
4531 return "DW_OP_breg22";
4532 case DW_OP_breg23:
4533 return "DW_OP_breg23";
4534 case DW_OP_breg24:
4535 return "DW_OP_breg24";
4536 case DW_OP_breg25:
4537 return "DW_OP_breg25";
4538 case DW_OP_breg26:
4539 return "DW_OP_breg26";
4540 case DW_OP_breg27:
4541 return "DW_OP_breg27";
4542 case DW_OP_breg28:
4543 return "DW_OP_breg28";
4544 case DW_OP_breg29:
4545 return "DW_OP_breg29";
4546 case DW_OP_breg30:
4547 return "DW_OP_breg30";
4548 case DW_OP_breg31:
4549 return "DW_OP_breg31";
4550 case DW_OP_regx:
4551 return "DW_OP_regx";
4552 case DW_OP_fbreg:
4553 return "DW_OP_fbreg";
4554 case DW_OP_bregx:
4555 return "DW_OP_bregx";
4556 case DW_OP_piece:
4557 return "DW_OP_piece";
4558 case DW_OP_deref_size:
4559 return "DW_OP_deref_size";
4560 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
4561 return "DW_OP_xderef_size";
4562 case DW_OP_nop:
4563 return "DW_OP_nop";
4565 case DW_OP_push_object_address:
4566 return "DW_OP_push_object_address";
4567 case DW_OP_call2:
4568 return "DW_OP_call2";
4569 case DW_OP_call4:
4570 return "DW_OP_call4";
4571 case DW_OP_call_ref:
4572 return "DW_OP_call_ref";
4573 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
4574 return "DW_OP_implicit_value";
4575 case DW_OP_stack_value:
4576 return "DW_OP_stack_value";
4577 case DW_OP_form_tls_address:
4578 return "DW_OP_form_tls_address";
4579 case DW_OP_call_frame_cfa:
4580 return "DW_OP_call_frame_cfa";
4581 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
4582 return "DW_OP_bit_piece";
4584 case DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address:
4585 return "DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address";
4586 case DW_OP_GNU_uninit:
4587 return "DW_OP_GNU_uninit";
4588 case DW_OP_GNU_encoded_addr:
4589 return "DW_OP_GNU_encoded_addr";
4591 default:
4592 return "OP_<unknown>";
4596 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated location description. Location
4597 descriptions are simple expression terms that can be strung
4598 together to form more complicated location (address) descriptions. */
4600 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
4601 new_loc_descr (enum dwarf_location_atom op, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd1,
4602 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd2)
4604 dw_loc_descr_ref descr = GGC_CNEW (dw_loc_descr_node);
4606 descr->dw_loc_opc = op;
4607 descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
4608 descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned = oprnd1;
4609 descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
4610 descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_unsigned = oprnd2;
4612 return descr;
4615 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated location description for
4616 REG and OFFSET. */
4618 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
4619 new_reg_loc_descr (unsigned int reg, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
4621 if (reg <= 31)
4622 return new_loc_descr ((enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_breg0 + reg),
4623 offset, 0);
4624 else
4625 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, reg, offset);
4628 /* Add a location description term to a location description expression. */
4630 static inline void
4631 add_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, dw_loc_descr_ref descr)
4633 dw_loc_descr_ref *d;
4635 /* Find the end of the chain. */
4636 for (d = list_head; (*d) != NULL; d = &(*d)->dw_loc_next)
4639 *d = descr;
4642 /* Add a constant OFFSET to a location expression. */
4644 static void
4645 loc_descr_plus_const (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
4647 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
4648 HOST_WIDE_INT *p;
4650 gcc_assert (*list_head != NULL);
4652 if (!offset)
4653 return;
4655 /* Find the end of the chain. */
4656 for (loc = *list_head; loc->dw_loc_next != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
4659 p = NULL;
4660 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_fbreg
4661 || (loc->dw_loc_opc >= DW_OP_breg0 && loc->dw_loc_opc <= DW_OP_breg31))
4662 p = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
4663 else if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_bregx)
4664 p = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int;
4666 /* If the last operation is fbreg, breg{0..31,x}, optimize by adjusting its
4667 offset. Don't optimize if an signed integer overflow would happen. */
4668 if (p != NULL
4669 && ((offset > 0 && *p <= INTTYPE_MAXIMUM (HOST_WIDE_INT) - offset)
4670 || (offset < 0 && *p >= INTTYPE_MINIMUM (HOST_WIDE_INT) - offset)))
4671 *p += offset;
4673 else if (offset > 0)
4674 loc->dw_loc_next = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, offset, 0);
4676 else
4678 loc->dw_loc_next = int_loc_descriptor (offset);
4679 add_loc_descr (&loc->dw_loc_next, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
4683 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
4684 /* Add a constant OFFSET to a location list. */
4686 static void
4687 loc_list_plus_const (dw_loc_list_ref list_head, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
4689 dw_loc_list_ref d;
4690 for (d = list_head; d != NULL; d = d->dw_loc_next)
4691 loc_descr_plus_const (&d->expr, offset);
4693 #endif
4695 /* Return the size of a location descriptor. */
4697 static unsigned long
4698 size_of_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
4700 unsigned long size = 1;
4702 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
4704 case DW_OP_addr:
4705 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
4706 break;
4707 case DW_OP_const1u:
4708 case DW_OP_const1s:
4709 size += 1;
4710 break;
4711 case DW_OP_const2u:
4712 case DW_OP_const2s:
4713 size += 2;
4714 break;
4715 case DW_OP_const4u:
4716 case DW_OP_const4s:
4717 size += 4;
4718 break;
4719 case DW_OP_const8u:
4720 case DW_OP_const8s:
4721 size += 8;
4722 break;
4723 case DW_OP_constu:
4724 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
4725 break;
4726 case DW_OP_consts:
4727 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
4728 break;
4729 case DW_OP_pick:
4730 size += 1;
4731 break;
4732 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
4733 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
4734 break;
4735 case DW_OP_skip:
4736 case DW_OP_bra:
4737 size += 2;
4738 break;
4739 case DW_OP_breg0:
4740 case DW_OP_breg1:
4741 case DW_OP_breg2:
4742 case DW_OP_breg3:
4743 case DW_OP_breg4:
4744 case DW_OP_breg5:
4745 case DW_OP_breg6:
4746 case DW_OP_breg7:
4747 case DW_OP_breg8:
4748 case DW_OP_breg9:
4749 case DW_OP_breg10:
4750 case DW_OP_breg11:
4751 case DW_OP_breg12:
4752 case DW_OP_breg13:
4753 case DW_OP_breg14:
4754 case DW_OP_breg15:
4755 case DW_OP_breg16:
4756 case DW_OP_breg17:
4757 case DW_OP_breg18:
4758 case DW_OP_breg19:
4759 case DW_OP_breg20:
4760 case DW_OP_breg21:
4761 case DW_OP_breg22:
4762 case DW_OP_breg23:
4763 case DW_OP_breg24:
4764 case DW_OP_breg25:
4765 case DW_OP_breg26:
4766 case DW_OP_breg27:
4767 case DW_OP_breg28:
4768 case DW_OP_breg29:
4769 case DW_OP_breg30:
4770 case DW_OP_breg31:
4771 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
4772 break;
4773 case DW_OP_regx:
4774 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
4775 break;
4776 case DW_OP_fbreg:
4777 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
4778 break;
4779 case DW_OP_bregx:
4780 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
4781 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int);
4782 break;
4783 case DW_OP_piece:
4784 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
4785 break;
4786 case DW_OP_deref_size:
4787 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
4788 size += 1;
4789 break;
4790 case DW_OP_call2:
4791 size += 2;
4792 break;
4793 case DW_OP_call4:
4794 size += 4;
4795 break;
4796 case DW_OP_call_ref:
4797 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
4798 break;
4799 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
4800 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned)
4801 + loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned;
4802 break;
4803 default:
4804 break;
4807 return size;
4810 /* Return the size of a series of location descriptors. */
4812 static unsigned long
4813 size_of_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
4815 dw_loc_descr_ref l;
4816 unsigned long size;
4818 /* If there are no skip or bra opcodes, don't fill in the dw_loc_addr
4819 field, to avoid writing to a PCH file. */
4820 for (size = 0, l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
4822 if (l->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_skip || l->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_bra)
4823 break;
4824 size += size_of_loc_descr (l);
4826 if (! l)
4827 return size;
4829 for (size = 0, l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
4831 l->dw_loc_addr = size;
4832 size += size_of_loc_descr (l);
4835 return size;
4838 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
4839 static HOST_WIDE_INT extract_int (const unsigned char *, unsigned);
4840 #endif
4842 /* Output location description stack opcode's operands (if any). */
4844 static void
4845 output_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
4847 dw_val_ref val1 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1;
4848 dw_val_ref val2 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2;
4850 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
4852 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
4853 case DW_OP_const2u:
4854 case DW_OP_const2s:
4855 dw2_asm_output_data (2, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
4856 break;
4857 case DW_OP_const4u:
4858 case DW_OP_const4s:
4859 dw2_asm_output_data (4, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
4860 break;
4861 case DW_OP_const8u:
4862 case DW_OP_const8s:
4863 gcc_assert (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64);
4864 dw2_asm_output_data (8, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
4865 break;
4866 case DW_OP_skip:
4867 case DW_OP_bra:
4869 int offset;
4871 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc);
4872 offset = val1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr - (loc->dw_loc_addr + 3);
4874 dw2_asm_output_data (2, offset, NULL);
4876 break;
4877 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
4878 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
4879 switch (val2->val_class)
4881 case dw_val_class_const:
4882 dw2_asm_output_data (val1->v.val_unsigned, val2->v.val_int, NULL);
4883 break;
4884 case dw_val_class_vec:
4886 unsigned int elt_size = val2->v.val_vec.elt_size;
4887 unsigned int len = val2->v.val_vec.length;
4888 unsigned int i;
4889 unsigned char *p;
4891 if (elt_size > sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
4893 elt_size /= 2;
4894 len *= 2;
4896 for (i = 0, p = val2->v.val_vec.array;
4897 i < len;
4898 i++, p += elt_size)
4899 dw2_asm_output_data (elt_size, extract_int (p, elt_size),
4900 "fp or vector constant word %u", i);
4902 break;
4903 case dw_val_class_const_double:
4905 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first, second;
4907 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
4909 first = val2->v.val_double.high;
4910 second = val2->v.val_double.low;
4912 else
4914 first = val2->v.val_double.low;
4915 second = val2->v.val_double.high;
4917 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
4918 first, NULL);
4919 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
4920 second, NULL);
4922 break;
4923 case dw_val_class_addr:
4924 gcc_assert (val1->v.val_unsigned == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
4925 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, val2->v.val_addr, NULL);
4926 break;
4927 default:
4928 gcc_unreachable ();
4930 break;
4931 #else
4932 case DW_OP_const2u:
4933 case DW_OP_const2s:
4934 case DW_OP_const4u:
4935 case DW_OP_const4s:
4936 case DW_OP_const8u:
4937 case DW_OP_const8s:
4938 case DW_OP_skip:
4939 case DW_OP_bra:
4940 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
4941 /* We currently don't make any attempt to make sure these are
4942 aligned properly like we do for the main unwind info, so
4943 don't support emitting things larger than a byte if we're
4944 only doing unwinding. */
4945 gcc_unreachable ();
4946 #endif
4947 case DW_OP_const1u:
4948 case DW_OP_const1s:
4949 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
4950 break;
4951 case DW_OP_constu:
4952 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
4953 break;
4954 case DW_OP_consts:
4955 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
4956 break;
4957 case DW_OP_pick:
4958 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
4959 break;
4960 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
4961 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
4962 break;
4963 case DW_OP_breg0:
4964 case DW_OP_breg1:
4965 case DW_OP_breg2:
4966 case DW_OP_breg3:
4967 case DW_OP_breg4:
4968 case DW_OP_breg5:
4969 case DW_OP_breg6:
4970 case DW_OP_breg7:
4971 case DW_OP_breg8:
4972 case DW_OP_breg9:
4973 case DW_OP_breg10:
4974 case DW_OP_breg11:
4975 case DW_OP_breg12:
4976 case DW_OP_breg13:
4977 case DW_OP_breg14:
4978 case DW_OP_breg15:
4979 case DW_OP_breg16:
4980 case DW_OP_breg17:
4981 case DW_OP_breg18:
4982 case DW_OP_breg19:
4983 case DW_OP_breg20:
4984 case DW_OP_breg21:
4985 case DW_OP_breg22:
4986 case DW_OP_breg23:
4987 case DW_OP_breg24:
4988 case DW_OP_breg25:
4989 case DW_OP_breg26:
4990 case DW_OP_breg27:
4991 case DW_OP_breg28:
4992 case DW_OP_breg29:
4993 case DW_OP_breg30:
4994 case DW_OP_breg31:
4995 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
4996 break;
4997 case DW_OP_regx:
4998 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
4999 break;
5000 case DW_OP_fbreg:
5001 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
5002 break;
5003 case DW_OP_bregx:
5004 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
5005 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val2->v.val_int, NULL);
5006 break;
5007 case DW_OP_piece:
5008 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
5009 break;
5010 case DW_OP_deref_size:
5011 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
5012 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
5013 break;
5015 case DW_OP_addr:
5016 if (loc->dtprel)
5018 if (targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
5020 targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel (asm_out_file,
5021 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
5022 val1->v.val_addr);
5023 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
5025 else
5026 gcc_unreachable ();
5028 else
5030 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
5031 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, val1->v.val_addr, NULL);
5032 #else
5033 gcc_unreachable ();
5034 #endif
5036 break;
5038 default:
5039 /* Other codes have no operands. */
5040 break;
5044 /* Output a sequence of location operations. */
5046 static void
5047 output_loc_sequence (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
5049 for (; loc != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
5051 /* Output the opcode. */
5052 dw2_asm_output_data (1, loc->dw_loc_opc,
5053 "%s", dwarf_stack_op_name (loc->dw_loc_opc));
5055 /* Output the operand(s) (if any). */
5056 output_loc_operands (loc);
5060 /* Output location description stack opcode's operands (if any).
5061 The output is single bytes on a line, suitable for .cfi_escape. */
5063 static void
5064 output_loc_operands_raw (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
5066 dw_val_ref val1 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1;
5067 dw_val_ref val2 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2;
5069 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
5071 case DW_OP_addr:
5072 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
5073 /* We cannot output addresses in .cfi_escape, only bytes. */
5074 gcc_unreachable ();
5076 case DW_OP_const1u:
5077 case DW_OP_const1s:
5078 case DW_OP_pick:
5079 case DW_OP_deref_size:
5080 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
5081 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5082 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (1, val1->v.val_int);
5083 break;
5085 case DW_OP_const2u:
5086 case DW_OP_const2s:
5087 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5088 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (2, val1->v.val_int);
5089 break;
5091 case DW_OP_const4u:
5092 case DW_OP_const4s:
5093 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5094 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (4, val1->v.val_int);
5095 break;
5097 case DW_OP_const8u:
5098 case DW_OP_const8s:
5099 gcc_assert (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64);
5100 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5101 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (8, val1->v.val_int);
5102 break;
5104 case DW_OP_skip:
5105 case DW_OP_bra:
5107 int offset;
5109 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc);
5110 offset = val1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr - (loc->dw_loc_addr + 3);
5112 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5113 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (2, offset);
5115 break;
5117 case DW_OP_constu:
5118 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
5119 case DW_OP_regx:
5120 case DW_OP_piece:
5121 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5122 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (val1->v.val_unsigned);
5123 break;
5125 case DW_OP_consts:
5126 case DW_OP_breg0:
5127 case DW_OP_breg1:
5128 case DW_OP_breg2:
5129 case DW_OP_breg3:
5130 case DW_OP_breg4:
5131 case DW_OP_breg5:
5132 case DW_OP_breg6:
5133 case DW_OP_breg7:
5134 case DW_OP_breg8:
5135 case DW_OP_breg9:
5136 case DW_OP_breg10:
5137 case DW_OP_breg11:
5138 case DW_OP_breg12:
5139 case DW_OP_breg13:
5140 case DW_OP_breg14:
5141 case DW_OP_breg15:
5142 case DW_OP_breg16:
5143 case DW_OP_breg17:
5144 case DW_OP_breg18:
5145 case DW_OP_breg19:
5146 case DW_OP_breg20:
5147 case DW_OP_breg21:
5148 case DW_OP_breg22:
5149 case DW_OP_breg23:
5150 case DW_OP_breg24:
5151 case DW_OP_breg25:
5152 case DW_OP_breg26:
5153 case DW_OP_breg27:
5154 case DW_OP_breg28:
5155 case DW_OP_breg29:
5156 case DW_OP_breg30:
5157 case DW_OP_breg31:
5158 case DW_OP_fbreg:
5159 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5160 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128_raw (val1->v.val_int);
5161 break;
5163 case DW_OP_bregx:
5164 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5165 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (val1->v.val_unsigned);
5166 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5167 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128_raw (val2->v.val_int);
5168 break;
5170 default:
5171 /* Other codes have no operands. */
5172 break;
5176 static void
5177 output_loc_sequence_raw (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
5179 while (1)
5181 /* Output the opcode. */
5182 fprintf (asm_out_file, "0x%x", loc->dw_loc_opc);
5183 output_loc_operands_raw (loc);
5185 if (!loc->dw_loc_next)
5186 break;
5187 loc = loc->dw_loc_next;
5189 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5193 /* This routine will generate the correct assembly data for a location
5194 description based on a cfi entry with a complex address. */
5196 static void
5197 output_cfa_loc (dw_cfi_ref cfi)
5199 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
5200 unsigned long size;
5202 if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_expression)
5203 dw2_asm_output_data (1, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num, NULL);
5205 /* Output the size of the block. */
5206 loc = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc;
5207 size = size_of_locs (loc);
5208 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, NULL);
5210 /* Now output the operations themselves. */
5211 output_loc_sequence (loc);
5214 /* Similar, but used for .cfi_escape. */
5216 static void
5217 output_cfa_loc_raw (dw_cfi_ref cfi)
5219 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
5220 unsigned long size;
5222 if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_expression)
5223 fprintf (asm_out_file, "0x%x,", cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num);
5225 /* Output the size of the block. */
5226 loc = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc;
5227 size = size_of_locs (loc);
5228 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (size);
5229 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5231 /* Now output the operations themselves. */
5232 output_loc_sequence_raw (loc);
5235 /* This function builds a dwarf location descriptor sequence from a
5236 dw_cfa_location, adding the given OFFSET to the result of the
5237 expression. */
5239 static struct dw_loc_descr_struct *
5240 build_cfa_loc (dw_cfa_location *cfa, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
5242 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *head, *tmp;
5244 offset += cfa->offset;
5246 if (cfa->indirect)
5248 head = new_reg_loc_descr (cfa->reg, cfa->base_offset);
5249 head->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
5250 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
5251 add_loc_descr (&head, tmp);
5252 if (offset != 0)
5254 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, offset, 0);
5255 add_loc_descr (&head, tmp);
5258 else
5259 head = new_reg_loc_descr (cfa->reg, offset);
5261 return head;
5264 /* This function builds a dwarf location descriptor sequence for
5265 the address at OFFSET from the CFA when stack is aligned to
5266 ALIGNMENT byte. */
5268 static struct dw_loc_descr_struct *
5269 build_cfa_aligned_loc (HOST_WIDE_INT offset, HOST_WIDE_INT alignment)
5271 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *head;
5272 unsigned int dwarf_fp
5273 = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);
5275 /* When CFA is defined as FP+OFFSET, emulate stack alignment. */
5276 if (cfa.reg == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM && cfa.indirect == 0)
5278 head = new_reg_loc_descr (dwarf_fp, 0);
5279 add_loc_descr (&head, int_loc_descriptor (alignment));
5280 add_loc_descr (&head, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
5281 loc_descr_plus_const (&head, offset);
5283 else
5284 head = new_reg_loc_descr (dwarf_fp, offset);
5285 return head;
5288 /* This function fills in aa dw_cfa_location structure from a dwarf location
5289 descriptor sequence. */
5291 static void
5292 get_cfa_from_loc_descr (dw_cfa_location *cfa, struct dw_loc_descr_struct *loc)
5294 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *ptr;
5295 cfa->offset = 0;
5296 cfa->base_offset = 0;
5297 cfa->indirect = 0;
5298 cfa->reg = -1;
5300 for (ptr = loc; ptr != NULL; ptr = ptr->dw_loc_next)
5302 enum dwarf_location_atom op = ptr->dw_loc_opc;
5304 switch (op)
5306 case DW_OP_reg0:
5307 case DW_OP_reg1:
5308 case DW_OP_reg2:
5309 case DW_OP_reg3:
5310 case DW_OP_reg4:
5311 case DW_OP_reg5:
5312 case DW_OP_reg6:
5313 case DW_OP_reg7:
5314 case DW_OP_reg8:
5315 case DW_OP_reg9:
5316 case DW_OP_reg10:
5317 case DW_OP_reg11:
5318 case DW_OP_reg12:
5319 case DW_OP_reg13:
5320 case DW_OP_reg14:
5321 case DW_OP_reg15:
5322 case DW_OP_reg16:
5323 case DW_OP_reg17:
5324 case DW_OP_reg18:
5325 case DW_OP_reg19:
5326 case DW_OP_reg20:
5327 case DW_OP_reg21:
5328 case DW_OP_reg22:
5329 case DW_OP_reg23:
5330 case DW_OP_reg24:
5331 case DW_OP_reg25:
5332 case DW_OP_reg26:
5333 case DW_OP_reg27:
5334 case DW_OP_reg28:
5335 case DW_OP_reg29:
5336 case DW_OP_reg30:
5337 case DW_OP_reg31:
5338 cfa->reg = op - DW_OP_reg0;
5339 break;
5340 case DW_OP_regx:
5341 cfa->reg = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
5342 break;
5343 case DW_OP_breg0:
5344 case DW_OP_breg1:
5345 case DW_OP_breg2:
5346 case DW_OP_breg3:
5347 case DW_OP_breg4:
5348 case DW_OP_breg5:
5349 case DW_OP_breg6:
5350 case DW_OP_breg7:
5351 case DW_OP_breg8:
5352 case DW_OP_breg9:
5353 case DW_OP_breg10:
5354 case DW_OP_breg11:
5355 case DW_OP_breg12:
5356 case DW_OP_breg13:
5357 case DW_OP_breg14:
5358 case DW_OP_breg15:
5359 case DW_OP_breg16:
5360 case DW_OP_breg17:
5361 case DW_OP_breg18:
5362 case DW_OP_breg19:
5363 case DW_OP_breg20:
5364 case DW_OP_breg21:
5365 case DW_OP_breg22:
5366 case DW_OP_breg23:
5367 case DW_OP_breg24:
5368 case DW_OP_breg25:
5369 case DW_OP_breg26:
5370 case DW_OP_breg27:
5371 case DW_OP_breg28:
5372 case DW_OP_breg29:
5373 case DW_OP_breg30:
5374 case DW_OP_breg31:
5375 cfa->reg = op - DW_OP_breg0;
5376 cfa->base_offset = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
5377 break;
5378 case DW_OP_bregx:
5379 cfa->reg = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
5380 cfa->base_offset = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int;
5381 break;
5382 case DW_OP_deref:
5383 cfa->indirect = 1;
5384 break;
5385 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
5386 cfa->offset = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned;
5387 break;
5388 default:
5389 internal_error ("DW_LOC_OP %s not implemented",
5390 dwarf_stack_op_name (ptr->dw_loc_opc));
5394 #endif /* .debug_frame support */
5396 /* And now, the support for symbolic debugging information. */
5397 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
5399 /* .debug_str support. */
5400 static int output_indirect_string (void **, void *);
5402 static void dwarf2out_init (const char *);
5403 static void dwarf2out_finish (const char *);
5404 static void dwarf2out_assembly_start (void);
5405 static void dwarf2out_define (unsigned int, const char *);
5406 static void dwarf2out_undef (unsigned int, const char *);
5407 static void dwarf2out_start_source_file (unsigned, const char *);
5408 static void dwarf2out_end_source_file (unsigned);
5409 static void dwarf2out_begin_block (unsigned, unsigned);
5410 static void dwarf2out_end_block (unsigned, unsigned);
5411 static bool dwarf2out_ignore_block (const_tree);
5412 static void dwarf2out_global_decl (tree);
5413 static void dwarf2out_type_decl (tree, int);
5414 static void dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl (tree, tree, tree, bool);
5415 static void dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (tree, tree, tree,
5416 dw_die_ref);
5417 static void dwarf2out_abstract_function (tree);
5418 static void dwarf2out_var_location (rtx);
5419 static void dwarf2out_direct_call (tree);
5420 static void dwarf2out_virtual_call_token (tree, int);
5421 static void dwarf2out_copy_call_info (rtx, rtx);
5422 static void dwarf2out_virtual_call (int);
5423 static void dwarf2out_begin_function (tree);
5424 static void dwarf2out_set_name (tree, tree);
5426 /* The debug hooks structure. */
5428 const struct gcc_debug_hooks dwarf2_debug_hooks =
5430 dwarf2out_init,
5431 dwarf2out_finish,
5432 dwarf2out_assembly_start,
5433 dwarf2out_define,
5434 dwarf2out_undef,
5435 dwarf2out_start_source_file,
5436 dwarf2out_end_source_file,
5437 dwarf2out_begin_block,
5438 dwarf2out_end_block,
5439 dwarf2out_ignore_block,
5440 dwarf2out_source_line,
5441 dwarf2out_begin_prologue,
5442 debug_nothing_int_charstar, /* end_prologue */
5443 dwarf2out_end_epilogue,
5444 dwarf2out_begin_function,
5445 debug_nothing_int, /* end_function */
5446 dwarf2out_decl, /* function_decl */
5447 dwarf2out_global_decl,
5448 dwarf2out_type_decl, /* type_decl */
5449 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl,
5450 debug_nothing_tree, /* deferred_inline_function */
5451 /* The DWARF 2 backend tries to reduce debugging bloat by not
5452 emitting the abstract description of inline functions until
5453 something tries to reference them. */
5454 dwarf2out_abstract_function, /* outlining_inline_function */
5455 debug_nothing_rtx, /* label */
5456 debug_nothing_int, /* handle_pch */
5457 dwarf2out_var_location,
5458 dwarf2out_switch_text_section,
5459 dwarf2out_direct_call,
5460 dwarf2out_virtual_call_token,
5461 dwarf2out_copy_call_info,
5462 dwarf2out_virtual_call,
5463 dwarf2out_set_name,
5464 1 /* start_end_main_source_file */
5466 #endif
5468 /* NOTE: In the comments in this file, many references are made to
5469 "Debugging Information Entries". This term is abbreviated as `DIE'
5470 throughout the remainder of this file. */
5472 /* An internal representation of the DWARF output is built, and then
5473 walked to generate the DWARF debugging info. The walk of the internal
5474 representation is done after the entire program has been compiled.
5475 The types below are used to describe the internal representation. */
5477 /* Various DIE's use offsets relative to the beginning of the
5478 .debug_info section to refer to each other. */
5480 typedef long int dw_offset;
5482 /* Define typedefs here to avoid circular dependencies. */
5484 typedef struct dw_attr_struct *dw_attr_ref;
5485 typedef struct dw_line_info_struct *dw_line_info_ref;
5486 typedef struct dw_separate_line_info_struct *dw_separate_line_info_ref;
5487 typedef struct pubname_struct *pubname_ref;
5488 typedef struct dw_ranges_struct *dw_ranges_ref;
5489 typedef struct dw_ranges_by_label_struct *dw_ranges_by_label_ref;
5490 typedef struct comdat_type_struct *comdat_type_node_ref;
5492 /* Each entry in the line_info_table maintains the file and
5493 line number associated with the label generated for that
5494 entry. The label gives the PC value associated with
5495 the line number entry. */
5497 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_line_info_struct {
5498 unsigned long dw_file_num;
5499 unsigned long dw_line_num;
5501 dw_line_info_entry;
5503 /* Line information for functions in separate sections; each one gets its
5504 own sequence. */
5505 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_separate_line_info_struct {
5506 unsigned long dw_file_num;
5507 unsigned long dw_line_num;
5508 unsigned long function;
5510 dw_separate_line_info_entry;
5512 /* Each DIE attribute has a field specifying the attribute kind,
5513 a link to the next attribute in the chain, and an attribute value.
5514 Attributes are typically linked below the DIE they modify. */
5516 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_attr_struct {
5517 enum dwarf_attribute dw_attr;
5518 dw_val_node dw_attr_val;
5520 dw_attr_node;
5522 DEF_VEC_O(dw_attr_node);
5523 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_O(dw_attr_node,gc);
5525 /* The Debugging Information Entry (DIE) structure. DIEs form a tree.
5526 The children of each node form a circular list linked by
5527 die_sib. die_child points to the node *before* the "first" child node. */
5529 typedef struct GTY((chain_circular ("%h.die_sib"))) die_struct {
5530 enum dwarf_tag die_tag;
5531 union die_symbol_or_type_node
5533 char * GTY ((tag ("0"))) die_symbol;
5534 comdat_type_node_ref GTY ((tag ("1"))) die_type_node;
5536 GTY ((desc ("dwarf_version >= 4"))) die_id;
5537 VEC(dw_attr_node,gc) * die_attr;
5538 dw_die_ref die_parent;
5539 dw_die_ref die_child;
5540 dw_die_ref die_sib;
5541 dw_die_ref die_definition; /* ref from a specification to its definition */
5542 dw_offset die_offset;
5543 unsigned long die_abbrev;
5544 int die_mark;
5545 /* Die is used and must not be pruned as unused. */
5546 int die_perennial_p;
5547 unsigned int decl_id;
5549 die_node;
5551 /* Evaluate 'expr' while 'c' is set to each child of DIE in order. */
5552 #define FOR_EACH_CHILD(die, c, expr) do { \
5553 c = die->die_child; \
5554 if (c) do { \
5555 c = c->die_sib; \
5556 expr; \
5557 } while (c != die->die_child); \
5558 } while (0)
5560 /* The pubname structure */
5562 typedef struct GTY(()) pubname_struct {
5563 dw_die_ref die;
5564 const char *name;
5566 pubname_entry;
5568 DEF_VEC_O(pubname_entry);
5569 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_O(pubname_entry, gc);
5571 struct GTY(()) dw_ranges_struct {
5572 /* If this is positive, it's a block number, otherwise it's a
5573 bitwise-negated index into dw_ranges_by_label. */
5574 int num;
5577 struct GTY(()) dw_ranges_by_label_struct {
5578 const char *begin;
5579 const char *end;
5582 /* The comdat type node structure. */
5583 typedef struct GTY(()) comdat_type_struct
5585 dw_die_ref root_die;
5586 dw_die_ref type_die;
5587 char signature[DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE];
5588 struct comdat_type_struct *next;
5590 comdat_type_node;
5592 /* The limbo die list structure. */
5593 typedef struct GTY(()) limbo_die_struct {
5594 dw_die_ref die;
5595 tree created_for;
5596 struct limbo_die_struct *next;
5598 limbo_die_node;
5600 typedef struct GTY(()) skeleton_chain_struct
5602 dw_die_ref old_die;
5603 dw_die_ref new_die;
5604 struct skeleton_chain_struct *parent;
5606 skeleton_chain_node;
5608 /* How to start an assembler comment. */
5609 #ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
5610 #define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
5611 #endif
5613 /* Define a macro which returns nonzero for a TYPE_DECL which was
5614 implicitly generated for a tagged type.
5616 Note that unlike the gcc front end (which generates a NULL named
5617 TYPE_DECL node for each complete tagged type, each array type, and
5618 each function type node created) the g++ front end generates a
5619 _named_ TYPE_DECL node for each tagged type node created.
5620 These TYPE_DECLs have DECL_ARTIFICIAL set, so we know not to
5621 generate a DW_TAG_typedef DIE for them. */
5623 #define TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB(decl) \
5624 (DECL_NAME (decl) == NULL_TREE \
5625 || (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl) \
5626 && is_tagged_type (TREE_TYPE (decl)) \
5627 && ((decl == TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl))) \
5628 /* This is necessary for stub decls that \
5629 appear in nested inline functions. */ \
5630 || (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) != NULL_TREE \
5631 && (decl_ultimate_origin (decl) \
5632 == TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl)))))))
5634 /* Information concerning the compilation unit's programming
5635 language, and compiler version. */
5637 /* Fixed size portion of the DWARF compilation unit header. */
5638 #define DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE \
5639 (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 3)
5641 /* Fixed size portion of the DWARF comdat type unit header. */
5642 #define DWARF_COMDAT_TYPE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE \
5643 (DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE + DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE \
5644 + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE)
5646 /* Fixed size portion of public names info. */
5647 #define DWARF_PUBNAMES_HEADER_SIZE (2 * DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 2)
5649 /* Fixed size portion of the address range info. */
5650 #define DWARF_ARANGES_HEADER_SIZE \
5651 (DWARF_ROUND (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4, \
5652 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 2) \
5653 - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE)
5655 /* Size of padding portion in the address range info. It must be
5656 aligned to twice the pointer size. */
5657 #define DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE \
5658 (DWARF_ROUND (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4, \
5659 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 2) \
5660 - (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4))
5662 /* Use assembler line directives if available. */
5663 #ifndef DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
5664 #ifdef HAVE_AS_DWARF2_DEBUG_LINE
5665 #define DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 1
5666 #else
5667 #define DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 0
5668 #endif
5669 #endif
5671 /* Minimum line offset in a special line info. opcode.
5672 This value was chosen to give a reasonable range of values. */
5673 #define DWARF_LINE_BASE -10
5675 /* First special line opcode - leave room for the standard opcodes. */
5676 #define DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE 10
5678 /* Range of line offsets in a special line info. opcode. */
5679 #define DWARF_LINE_RANGE (254-DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE+1)
5681 /* Flag that indicates the initial value of the is_stmt_start flag.
5682 In the present implementation, we do not mark any lines as
5683 the beginning of a source statement, because that information
5684 is not made available by the GCC front-end. */
5685 #define DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START 1
5687 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
5688 /* This location is used by calc_die_sizes() to keep track
5689 the offset of each DIE within the .debug_info section. */
5690 static unsigned long next_die_offset;
5691 #endif
5693 /* Record the root of the DIE's built for the current compilation unit. */
5694 static GTY(()) dw_die_ref comp_unit_die;
5696 /* A list of type DIEs that have been separated into comdat sections. */
5697 static GTY(()) comdat_type_node *comdat_type_list;
5699 /* A list of DIEs with a NULL parent waiting to be relocated. */
5700 static GTY(()) limbo_die_node *limbo_die_list;
5702 /* A list of DIEs for which we may have to generate
5703 DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name once their DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAMEs are
5704 set. */
5705 static GTY(()) limbo_die_node *deferred_asm_name;
5707 /* Filenames referenced by this compilation unit. */
5708 static GTY((param_is (struct dwarf_file_data))) htab_t file_table;
5710 /* A hash table of references to DIE's that describe declarations.
5711 The key is a DECL_UID() which is a unique number identifying each decl. */
5712 static GTY ((param_is (struct die_struct))) htab_t decl_die_table;
5714 /* A hash table of references to DIE's that describe COMMON blocks.
5715 The key is DECL_UID() ^ die_parent. */
5716 static GTY ((param_is (struct die_struct))) htab_t common_block_die_table;
5718 typedef struct GTY(()) die_arg_entry_struct {
5719 dw_die_ref die;
5720 tree arg;
5721 } die_arg_entry;
5723 DEF_VEC_O(die_arg_entry);
5724 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_O(die_arg_entry,gc);
5726 /* Node of the variable location list. */
5727 struct GTY ((chain_next ("%h.next"))) var_loc_node {
5728 rtx GTY (()) var_loc_note;
5729 const char * GTY (()) label;
5730 const char * GTY (()) section_label;
5731 struct var_loc_node * GTY (()) next;
5734 /* Variable location list. */
5735 struct GTY (()) var_loc_list_def {
5736 struct var_loc_node * GTY (()) first;
5738 /* Do not mark the last element of the chained list because
5739 it is marked through the chain. */
5740 struct var_loc_node * GTY ((skip ("%h"))) last;
5742 /* DECL_UID of the variable decl. */
5743 unsigned int decl_id;
5745 typedef struct var_loc_list_def var_loc_list;
5748 /* Table of decl location linked lists. */
5749 static GTY ((param_is (var_loc_list))) htab_t decl_loc_table;
5751 /* A pointer to the base of a list of references to DIE's that
5752 are uniquely identified by their tag, presence/absence of
5753 children DIE's, and list of attribute/value pairs. */
5754 static GTY((length ("abbrev_die_table_allocated")))
5755 dw_die_ref *abbrev_die_table;
5757 /* Number of elements currently allocated for abbrev_die_table. */
5758 static GTY(()) unsigned abbrev_die_table_allocated;
5760 /* Number of elements in type_die_table currently in use. */
5761 static GTY(()) unsigned abbrev_die_table_in_use;
5763 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
5764 abbrev_die_table. */
5765 #define ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT 256
5767 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains line information
5768 for each source code line in .text in the compilation unit. */
5769 static GTY((length ("line_info_table_allocated")))
5770 dw_line_info_ref line_info_table;
5772 /* Number of elements currently allocated for line_info_table. */
5773 static GTY(()) unsigned line_info_table_allocated;
5775 /* Number of elements in line_info_table currently in use. */
5776 static GTY(()) unsigned line_info_table_in_use;
5778 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains line information
5779 for each source code line outside of .text in the compilation unit. */
5780 static GTY ((length ("separate_line_info_table_allocated")))
5781 dw_separate_line_info_ref separate_line_info_table;
5783 /* Number of elements currently allocated for separate_line_info_table. */
5784 static GTY(()) unsigned separate_line_info_table_allocated;
5786 /* Number of elements in separate_line_info_table currently in use. */
5787 static GTY(()) unsigned separate_line_info_table_in_use;
5789 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
5790 line_info_table. */
5791 #define LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT 1024
5793 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of publicly
5794 accessible names. */
5795 static GTY (()) VEC (pubname_entry, gc) * pubname_table;
5797 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of publicly
5798 accessible types. */
5799 static GTY (()) VEC (pubname_entry, gc) * pubtype_table;
5801 /* Array of dies for which we should generate .debug_arange info. */
5802 static GTY((length ("arange_table_allocated"))) dw_die_ref *arange_table;
5804 /* Number of elements currently allocated for arange_table. */
5805 static GTY(()) unsigned arange_table_allocated;
5807 /* Number of elements in arange_table currently in use. */
5808 static GTY(()) unsigned arange_table_in_use;
5810 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
5811 arange_table. */
5812 #define ARANGE_TABLE_INCREMENT 64
5814 /* Array of dies for which we should generate .debug_ranges info. */
5815 static GTY ((length ("ranges_table_allocated"))) dw_ranges_ref ranges_table;
5817 /* Number of elements currently allocated for ranges_table. */
5818 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_table_allocated;
5820 /* Number of elements in ranges_table currently in use. */
5821 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_table_in_use;
5823 /* Array of pairs of labels referenced in ranges_table. */
5824 static GTY ((length ("ranges_by_label_allocated")))
5825 dw_ranges_by_label_ref ranges_by_label;
5827 /* Number of elements currently allocated for ranges_by_label. */
5828 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_by_label_allocated;
5830 /* Number of elements in ranges_by_label currently in use. */
5831 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_by_label_in_use;
5833 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
5834 ranges_table. */
5835 #define RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT 64
5837 /* Whether we have location lists that need outputting */
5838 static GTY(()) bool have_location_lists;
5840 /* Unique label counter. */
5841 static GTY(()) unsigned int loclabel_num;
5843 /* Unique label counter for point-of-call tables. */
5844 static GTY(()) unsigned int poc_label_num;
5846 /* The direct call table structure. */
5848 typedef struct GTY(()) dcall_struct {
5849 unsigned int poc_label_num;
5850 tree poc_decl;
5851 dw_die_ref targ_die;
5853 dcall_entry;
5855 DEF_VEC_O(dcall_entry);
5856 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_O(dcall_entry, gc);
5858 /* The virtual call table structure. */
5860 typedef struct GTY(()) vcall_struct {
5861 unsigned int poc_label_num;
5862 unsigned int vtable_slot;
5864 vcall_entry;
5866 DEF_VEC_O(vcall_entry);
5867 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_O(vcall_entry, gc);
5869 /* Pointers to the direct and virtual call tables. */
5870 static GTY (()) VEC (dcall_entry, gc) * dcall_table = NULL;
5871 static GTY (()) VEC (vcall_entry, gc) * vcall_table = NULL;
5873 /* A hash table to map INSN_UIDs to vtable slot indexes. */
5875 struct GTY (()) vcall_insn {
5876 int insn_uid;
5877 unsigned int vtable_slot;
5880 static GTY ((param_is (struct vcall_insn))) htab_t vcall_insn_table;
5882 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
5883 /* Record whether the function being analyzed contains inlined functions. */
5884 static int current_function_has_inlines;
5885 #endif
5886 #if 0 && defined (MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO)
5887 static int comp_unit_has_inlines;
5888 #endif
5890 /* The last file entry emitted by maybe_emit_file(). */
5891 static GTY(()) struct dwarf_file_data * last_emitted_file;
5893 /* Number of internal labels generated by gen_internal_sym(). */
5894 static GTY(()) int label_num;
5896 /* Cached result of previous call to lookup_filename. */
5897 static GTY(()) struct dwarf_file_data * file_table_last_lookup;
5899 static GTY(()) VEC(die_arg_entry,gc) *tmpl_value_parm_die_table;
5901 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
5903 /* Offset from the "steady-state frame pointer" to the frame base,
5904 within the current function. */
5905 static HOST_WIDE_INT frame_pointer_fb_offset;
5907 /* Forward declarations for functions defined in this file. */
5909 static int is_pseudo_reg (const_rtx);
5910 static tree type_main_variant (tree);
5911 static int is_tagged_type (const_tree);
5912 static const char *dwarf_tag_name (unsigned);
5913 static const char *dwarf_attr_name (unsigned);
5914 static const char *dwarf_form_name (unsigned);
5915 static tree decl_ultimate_origin (const_tree);
5916 static tree decl_class_context (tree);
5917 static void add_dwarf_attr (dw_die_ref, dw_attr_ref);
5918 static inline enum dw_val_class AT_class (dw_attr_ref);
5919 static void add_AT_flag (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned);
5920 static inline unsigned AT_flag (dw_attr_ref);
5921 static void add_AT_int (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, HOST_WIDE_INT);
5922 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT AT_int (dw_attr_ref);
5923 static void add_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
5924 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT AT_unsigned (dw_attr_ref);
5925 static void add_AT_double (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
5926 HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
5927 static inline void add_AT_vec (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned int,
5928 unsigned int, unsigned char *);
5929 static void add_AT_data8 (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned char *);
5930 static hashval_t debug_str_do_hash (const void *);
5931 static int debug_str_eq (const void *, const void *);
5932 static void add_AT_string (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
5933 static inline const char *AT_string (dw_attr_ref);
5934 static enum dwarf_form AT_string_form (dw_attr_ref);
5935 static void add_AT_die_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, dw_die_ref);
5936 static void add_AT_specification (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
5937 static inline dw_die_ref AT_ref (dw_attr_ref);
5938 static inline int AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref);
5939 static inline void set_AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref, int);
5940 static void add_AT_fde_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned);
5941 static void add_AT_loc (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, dw_loc_descr_ref);
5942 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref AT_loc (dw_attr_ref);
5943 static void add_AT_loc_list (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
5944 dw_loc_list_ref);
5945 static inline dw_loc_list_ref AT_loc_list (dw_attr_ref);
5946 static void add_AT_addr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, rtx);
5947 static inline rtx AT_addr (dw_attr_ref);
5948 static void add_AT_lbl_id (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
5949 static void add_AT_lineptr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
5950 static void add_AT_macptr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
5951 static void add_AT_offset (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
5952 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
5953 static void add_AT_range_list (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
5954 unsigned long);
5955 static inline const char *AT_lbl (dw_attr_ref);
5956 static dw_attr_ref get_AT (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
5957 static const char *get_AT_low_pc (dw_die_ref);
5958 static const char *get_AT_hi_pc (dw_die_ref);
5959 static const char *get_AT_string (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
5960 static int get_AT_flag (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
5961 static unsigned get_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
5962 static inline dw_die_ref get_AT_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
5963 static bool is_c_family (void);
5964 static bool is_cxx (void);
5965 static bool is_java (void);
5966 static bool is_fortran (void);
5967 static bool is_ada (void);
5968 static void remove_AT (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
5969 static void remove_child_TAG (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_tag);
5970 static void add_child_die (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
5971 static dw_die_ref new_die (enum dwarf_tag, dw_die_ref, tree);
5972 static dw_die_ref lookup_type_die (tree);
5973 static void equate_type_number_to_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
5974 static hashval_t decl_die_table_hash (const void *);
5975 static int decl_die_table_eq (const void *, const void *);
5976 static dw_die_ref lookup_decl_die (tree);
5977 static hashval_t common_block_die_table_hash (const void *);
5978 static int common_block_die_table_eq (const void *, const void *);
5979 static hashval_t decl_loc_table_hash (const void *);
5980 static int decl_loc_table_eq (const void *, const void *);
5981 static var_loc_list *lookup_decl_loc (const_tree);
5982 static void equate_decl_number_to_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
5983 static void add_var_loc_to_decl (tree, struct var_loc_node *);
5984 static void print_spaces (FILE *);
5985 static void print_die (dw_die_ref, FILE *);
5986 static void print_dwarf_line_table (FILE *);
5987 static dw_die_ref push_new_compile_unit (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
5988 static dw_die_ref pop_compile_unit (dw_die_ref);
5989 static void loc_checksum (dw_loc_descr_ref, struct md5_ctx *);
5990 static void attr_checksum (dw_attr_ref, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
5991 static void die_checksum (dw_die_ref, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
5992 static void checksum_sleb128 (HOST_WIDE_INT, struct md5_ctx *);
5993 static void checksum_uleb128 (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT, struct md5_ctx *);
5994 static void loc_checksum_ordered (dw_loc_descr_ref, struct md5_ctx *);
5995 static void attr_checksum_ordered (enum dwarf_tag, dw_attr_ref,
5996 struct md5_ctx *, int *);
5997 struct checksum_attributes;
5998 static void collect_checksum_attributes (struct checksum_attributes *, dw_die_ref);
5999 static void die_checksum_ordered (dw_die_ref, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
6000 static void checksum_die_context (dw_die_ref, struct md5_ctx *);
6001 static void generate_type_signature (dw_die_ref, comdat_type_node *);
6002 static int same_loc_p (dw_loc_descr_ref, dw_loc_descr_ref, int *);
6003 static int same_dw_val_p (const dw_val_node *, const dw_val_node *, int *);
6004 static int same_attr_p (dw_attr_ref, dw_attr_ref, int *);
6005 static int same_die_p (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref, int *);
6006 static int same_die_p_wrap (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
6007 static void compute_section_prefix (dw_die_ref);
6008 static int is_type_die (dw_die_ref);
6009 static int is_comdat_die (dw_die_ref);
6010 static int is_symbol_die (dw_die_ref);
6011 static void assign_symbol_names (dw_die_ref);
6012 static void break_out_includes (dw_die_ref);
6013 static int is_declaration_die (dw_die_ref);
6014 static int should_move_die_to_comdat (dw_die_ref);
6015 static dw_die_ref clone_as_declaration (dw_die_ref);
6016 static dw_die_ref clone_die (dw_die_ref);
6017 static dw_die_ref clone_tree (dw_die_ref);
6018 static void copy_declaration_context (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
6019 static void generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (skeleton_chain_node *);
6020 static void generate_skeleton_bottom_up (skeleton_chain_node *);
6021 static dw_die_ref generate_skeleton (dw_die_ref);
6022 static dw_die_ref remove_child_or_replace_with_skeleton (dw_die_ref,
6023 dw_die_ref);
6024 static void break_out_comdat_types (dw_die_ref);
6025 static dw_die_ref copy_ancestor_tree (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref, htab_t);
6026 static void copy_decls_walk (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref, htab_t);
6027 static void copy_decls_for_unworthy_types (dw_die_ref);
6029 static hashval_t htab_cu_hash (const void *);
6030 static int htab_cu_eq (const void *, const void *);
6031 static void htab_cu_del (void *);
6032 static int check_duplicate_cu (dw_die_ref, htab_t, unsigned *);
6033 static void record_comdat_symbol_number (dw_die_ref, htab_t, unsigned);
6034 static void add_sibling_attributes (dw_die_ref);
6035 static void build_abbrev_table (dw_die_ref);
6036 static void output_location_lists (dw_die_ref);
6037 static int constant_size (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
6038 static unsigned long size_of_die (dw_die_ref);
6039 static void calc_die_sizes (dw_die_ref);
6040 static void mark_dies (dw_die_ref);
6041 static void unmark_dies (dw_die_ref);
6042 static void unmark_all_dies (dw_die_ref);
6043 static unsigned long size_of_pubnames (VEC (pubname_entry,gc) *);
6044 static unsigned long size_of_aranges (void);
6045 static enum dwarf_form value_format (dw_attr_ref);
6046 static void output_value_format (dw_attr_ref);
6047 static void output_abbrev_section (void);
6048 static void output_die_symbol (dw_die_ref);
6049 static void output_die (dw_die_ref);
6050 static void output_compilation_unit_header (void);
6051 static void output_comp_unit (dw_die_ref, int);
6052 static void output_comdat_type_unit (comdat_type_node *);
6053 static const char *dwarf2_name (tree, int);
6054 static void add_pubname (tree, dw_die_ref);
6055 static void add_pubname_string (const char *, dw_die_ref);
6056 static void add_pubtype (tree, dw_die_ref);
6057 static void output_pubnames (VEC (pubname_entry,gc) *);
6058 static void add_arange (tree, dw_die_ref);
6059 static void output_aranges (void);
6060 static unsigned int add_ranges_num (int);
6061 static unsigned int add_ranges (const_tree);
6062 static unsigned int add_ranges_by_labels (const char *, const char *);
6063 static void output_ranges (void);
6064 static void output_line_info (void);
6065 static void output_file_names (void);
6066 static dw_die_ref base_type_die (tree);
6067 static int is_base_type (tree);
6068 static dw_die_ref subrange_type_die (tree, tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
6069 static dw_die_ref modified_type_die (tree, int, int, dw_die_ref);
6070 static dw_die_ref generic_parameter_die (tree, tree, bool, dw_die_ref);
6071 static dw_die_ref template_parameter_pack_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
6072 static int type_is_enum (const_tree);
6073 static unsigned int dbx_reg_number (const_rtx);
6074 static void add_loc_descr_op_piece (dw_loc_descr_ref *, int);
6075 static dw_loc_descr_ref reg_loc_descriptor (rtx, enum var_init_status);
6076 static dw_loc_descr_ref one_reg_loc_descriptor (unsigned int,
6077 enum var_init_status);
6078 static dw_loc_descr_ref multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtx, rtx,
6079 enum var_init_status);
6080 static dw_loc_descr_ref based_loc_descr (rtx, HOST_WIDE_INT,
6081 enum var_init_status);
6082 static int is_based_loc (const_rtx);
6083 static int resolve_one_addr (rtx *, void *);
6084 static dw_loc_descr_ref mem_loc_descriptor (rtx, enum machine_mode mode,
6085 enum var_init_status);
6086 static dw_loc_descr_ref concat_loc_descriptor (rtx, rtx,
6087 enum var_init_status);
6088 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor (rtx, enum machine_mode mode,
6089 enum var_init_status);
6090 static dw_loc_list_ref loc_list_from_tree (tree, int);
6091 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree, int);
6092 static HOST_WIDE_INT ceiling (HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned int);
6093 static tree field_type (const_tree);
6094 static unsigned int simple_type_align_in_bits (const_tree);
6095 static unsigned int simple_decl_align_in_bits (const_tree);
6096 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT simple_type_size_in_bits (const_tree);
6097 static HOST_WIDE_INT field_byte_offset (const_tree);
6098 static void add_AT_location_description (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
6099 dw_loc_list_ref);
6100 static void add_data_member_location_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
6101 static bool add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, rtx);
6102 static void insert_int (HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned, unsigned char *);
6103 static void insert_float (const_rtx, unsigned char *);
6104 static rtx rtl_for_decl_location (tree);
6105 static bool add_location_or_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree,
6106 enum dwarf_attribute);
6107 static bool tree_add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
6108 static bool tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (dw_die_ref, tree);
6109 static void add_name_attribute (dw_die_ref, const char *);
6110 static void add_comp_dir_attribute (dw_die_ref);
6111 static void add_bound_info (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, tree);
6112 static void add_subscript_info (dw_die_ref, tree, bool);
6113 static void add_byte_size_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
6114 static void add_bit_offset_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
6115 static void add_bit_size_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
6116 static void add_prototyped_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
6117 static dw_die_ref add_abstract_origin_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
6118 static void add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
6119 static void add_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref, tree);
6120 static void add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref, tree);
6121 static void push_decl_scope (tree);
6122 static void pop_decl_scope (void);
6123 static dw_die_ref scope_die_for (tree, dw_die_ref);
6124 static inline int local_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
6125 static inline int class_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
6126 static inline int class_or_namespace_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
6127 static void add_type_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree, int, int, dw_die_ref);
6128 static void add_calling_convention_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
6129 static const char *type_tag (const_tree);
6130 static tree member_declared_type (const_tree);
6131 #if 0
6132 static const char *decl_start_label (tree);
6133 #endif
6134 static void gen_array_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6135 static void gen_descr_array_type_die (tree, struct array_descr_info *, dw_die_ref);
6136 #if 0
6137 static void gen_entry_point_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6138 #endif
6139 static dw_die_ref gen_enumeration_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6140 static dw_die_ref gen_formal_parameter_die (tree, tree, bool, dw_die_ref);
6141 static dw_die_ref gen_formal_parameter_pack_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref, tree*);
6142 static void gen_unspecified_parameters_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6143 static void gen_formal_types_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6144 static void gen_subprogram_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6145 static void gen_variable_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
6146 static void gen_const_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6147 static void gen_label_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6148 static void gen_lexical_block_die (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
6149 static void gen_inlined_subroutine_die (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
6150 static void gen_field_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6151 static void gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6152 static dw_die_ref gen_compile_unit_die (const char *);
6153 static void gen_inheritance_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
6154 static void gen_member_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6155 static void gen_struct_or_union_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref,
6156 enum debug_info_usage);
6157 static void gen_subroutine_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6158 static void gen_typedef_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6159 static void gen_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6160 static void gen_block_die (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
6161 static void decls_for_scope (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
6162 static int is_redundant_typedef (const_tree);
6163 static inline dw_die_ref get_context_die (tree);
6164 static void gen_namespace_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6165 static void gen_decl_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
6166 static dw_die_ref force_decl_die (tree);
6167 static dw_die_ref force_type_die (tree);
6168 static dw_die_ref setup_namespace_context (tree, dw_die_ref);
6169 static dw_die_ref declare_in_namespace (tree, dw_die_ref);
6170 static struct dwarf_file_data * lookup_filename (const char *);
6171 static void retry_incomplete_types (void);
6172 static void gen_type_die_for_member (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
6173 static void gen_generic_params_dies (tree);
6174 static void splice_child_die (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
6175 static int file_info_cmp (const void *, const void *);
6176 static dw_loc_list_ref new_loc_list (dw_loc_descr_ref, const char *,
6177 const char *, const char *, unsigned);
6178 static void add_loc_descr_to_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref *, dw_loc_descr_ref,
6179 const char *, const char *,
6180 const char *);
6181 static void output_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref);
6182 static char *gen_internal_sym (const char *);
6184 static void prune_unmark_dies (dw_die_ref);
6185 static void prune_unused_types_mark (dw_die_ref, int);
6186 static void prune_unused_types_walk (dw_die_ref);
6187 static void prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (dw_die_ref);
6188 static void prune_unused_types_prune (dw_die_ref);
6189 static void prune_unused_types (void);
6190 static int maybe_emit_file (struct dwarf_file_data *fd);
6191 static void append_entry_to_tmpl_value_parm_die_table (dw_die_ref, tree);
6192 static void gen_remaining_tmpl_value_param_die_attribute (void);
6194 /* Section names used to hold DWARF debugging information. */
6195 #ifndef DEBUG_INFO_SECTION
6196 #define DEBUG_INFO_SECTION ".debug_info"
6197 #endif
6198 #ifndef DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION
6199 #define DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION ".debug_abbrev"
6200 #endif
6201 #ifndef DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION
6202 #define DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION ".debug_aranges"
6203 #endif
6204 #ifndef DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION
6205 #define DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION ".debug_macinfo"
6206 #endif
6207 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_SECTION
6208 #define DEBUG_LINE_SECTION ".debug_line"
6209 #endif
6210 #ifndef DEBUG_LOC_SECTION
6211 #define DEBUG_LOC_SECTION ".debug_loc"
6212 #endif
6213 #ifndef DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION
6214 #define DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION ".debug_pubnames"
6215 #endif
6216 #ifndef DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION
6217 #define DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION ".debug_pubtypes"
6218 #endif
6219 #ifndef DEBUG_DCALL_SECTION
6220 #define DEBUG_DCALL_SECTION ".debug_dcall"
6221 #endif
6222 #ifndef DEBUG_VCALL_SECTION
6223 #define DEBUG_VCALL_SECTION ".debug_vcall"
6224 #endif
6225 #ifndef DEBUG_STR_SECTION
6226 #define DEBUG_STR_SECTION ".debug_str"
6227 #endif
6228 #ifndef DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION
6229 #define DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION ".debug_ranges"
6230 #endif
6232 /* Standard ELF section names for compiled code and data. */
6233 #ifndef TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6234 #define TEXT_SECTION_NAME ".text"
6235 #endif
6237 /* Section flags for .debug_str section. */
6238 #define DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS \
6239 (HAVE_GAS_SHF_MERGE && flag_merge_debug_strings \
6240 ? SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_MERGE | SECTION_STRINGS | 1 \
6241 : SECTION_DEBUG)
6243 /* Labels we insert at beginning sections we can reference instead of
6244 the section names themselves. */
6246 #ifndef TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
6247 #define TEXT_SECTION_LABEL "Ltext"
6248 #endif
6249 #ifndef COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
6250 #define COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL "Ltext_cold"
6251 #endif
6252 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL
6253 #define DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_line"
6254 #endif
6255 #ifndef DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL
6256 #define DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_info"
6257 #endif
6258 #ifndef DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL
6259 #define DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_abbrev"
6260 #endif
6261 #ifndef DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL
6262 #define DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_loc"
6263 #endif
6264 #ifndef DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL
6265 #define DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_ranges"
6266 #endif
6267 #ifndef DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL
6268 #define DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_macinfo"
6269 #endif
6271 /* Definitions of defaults for formats and names of various special
6272 (artificial) labels which may be generated within this file (when the -g
6273 options is used and DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO is in effect.
6274 If necessary, these may be overridden from within the tm.h file, but
6275 typically, overriding these defaults is unnecessary. */
6277 static char text_end_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
6278 static char text_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
6279 static char cold_text_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
6280 static char cold_end_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
6281 static char abbrev_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
6282 static char debug_info_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
6283 static char debug_line_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
6284 static char macinfo_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
6285 static char loc_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
6286 static char ranges_section_label[2 * MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
6288 #ifndef TEXT_END_LABEL
6289 #define TEXT_END_LABEL "Letext"
6290 #endif
6291 #ifndef COLD_END_LABEL
6292 #define COLD_END_LABEL "Letext_cold"
6293 #endif
6294 #ifndef BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL
6295 #define BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL "LBB"
6296 #endif
6297 #ifndef BLOCK_END_LABEL
6298 #define BLOCK_END_LABEL "LBE"
6299 #endif
6300 #ifndef LINE_CODE_LABEL
6301 #define LINE_CODE_LABEL "LM"
6302 #endif
6303 #ifndef SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL
6304 #define SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL "LSM"
6305 #endif
6308 /* We allow a language front-end to designate a function that is to be
6309 called to "demangle" any name before it is put into a DIE. */
6311 static const char *(*demangle_name_func) (const char *);
6313 void
6314 dwarf2out_set_demangle_name_func (const char *(*func) (const char *))
6316 demangle_name_func = func;
6319 /* Test if rtl node points to a pseudo register. */
6321 static inline int
6322 is_pseudo_reg (const_rtx rtl)
6324 return ((REG_P (rtl) && REGNO (rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
6325 || (GET_CODE (rtl) == SUBREG
6326 && REGNO (SUBREG_REG (rtl)) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER));
6329 /* Return a reference to a type, with its const and volatile qualifiers
6330 removed. */
6332 static inline tree
6333 type_main_variant (tree type)
6335 type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
6337 /* ??? There really should be only one main variant among any group of
6338 variants of a given type (and all of the MAIN_VARIANT values for all
6339 members of the group should point to that one type) but sometimes the C
6340 front-end messes this up for array types, so we work around that bug
6341 here. */
6342 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
6343 while (type != TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type))
6344 type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
6346 return type;
6349 /* Return nonzero if the given type node represents a tagged type. */
6351 static inline int
6352 is_tagged_type (const_tree type)
6354 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
6356 return (code == RECORD_TYPE || code == UNION_TYPE
6357 || code == QUAL_UNION_TYPE || code == ENUMERAL_TYPE);
6360 /* Convert a DIE tag into its string name. */
6362 static const char *
6363 dwarf_tag_name (unsigned int tag)
6365 switch (tag)
6367 case DW_TAG_padding:
6368 return "DW_TAG_padding";
6369 case DW_TAG_array_type:
6370 return "DW_TAG_array_type";
6371 case DW_TAG_class_type:
6372 return "DW_TAG_class_type";
6373 case DW_TAG_entry_point:
6374 return "DW_TAG_entry_point";
6375 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
6376 return "DW_TAG_enumeration_type";
6377 case DW_TAG_formal_parameter:
6378 return "DW_TAG_formal_parameter";
6379 case DW_TAG_imported_declaration:
6380 return "DW_TAG_imported_declaration";
6381 case DW_TAG_label:
6382 return "DW_TAG_label";
6383 case DW_TAG_lexical_block:
6384 return "DW_TAG_lexical_block";
6385 case DW_TAG_member:
6386 return "DW_TAG_member";
6387 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
6388 return "DW_TAG_pointer_type";
6389 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
6390 return "DW_TAG_reference_type";
6391 case DW_TAG_compile_unit:
6392 return "DW_TAG_compile_unit";
6393 case DW_TAG_string_type:
6394 return "DW_TAG_string_type";
6395 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
6396 return "DW_TAG_structure_type";
6397 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
6398 return "DW_TAG_subroutine_type";
6399 case DW_TAG_typedef:
6400 return "DW_TAG_typedef";
6401 case DW_TAG_union_type:
6402 return "DW_TAG_union_type";
6403 case DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters:
6404 return "DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters";
6405 case DW_TAG_variant:
6406 return "DW_TAG_variant";
6407 case DW_TAG_common_block:
6408 return "DW_TAG_common_block";
6409 case DW_TAG_common_inclusion:
6410 return "DW_TAG_common_inclusion";
6411 case DW_TAG_inheritance:
6412 return "DW_TAG_inheritance";
6413 case DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine:
6414 return "DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine";
6415 case DW_TAG_module:
6416 return "DW_TAG_module";
6417 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
6418 return "DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type";
6419 case DW_TAG_set_type:
6420 return "DW_TAG_set_type";
6421 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
6422 return "DW_TAG_subrange_type";
6423 case DW_TAG_with_stmt:
6424 return "DW_TAG_with_stmt";
6425 case DW_TAG_access_declaration:
6426 return "DW_TAG_access_declaration";
6427 case DW_TAG_base_type:
6428 return "DW_TAG_base_type";
6429 case DW_TAG_catch_block:
6430 return "DW_TAG_catch_block";
6431 case DW_TAG_const_type:
6432 return "DW_TAG_const_type";
6433 case DW_TAG_constant:
6434 return "DW_TAG_constant";
6435 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
6436 return "DW_TAG_enumerator";
6437 case DW_TAG_file_type:
6438 return "DW_TAG_file_type";
6439 case DW_TAG_friend:
6440 return "DW_TAG_friend";
6441 case DW_TAG_namelist:
6442 return "DW_TAG_namelist";
6443 case DW_TAG_namelist_item:
6444 return "DW_TAG_namelist_item";
6445 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
6446 return "DW_TAG_packed_type";
6447 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
6448 return "DW_TAG_subprogram";
6449 case DW_TAG_template_type_param:
6450 return "DW_TAG_template_type_param";
6451 case DW_TAG_template_value_param:
6452 return "DW_TAG_template_value_param";
6453 case DW_TAG_thrown_type:
6454 return "DW_TAG_thrown_type";
6455 case DW_TAG_try_block:
6456 return "DW_TAG_try_block";
6457 case DW_TAG_variant_part:
6458 return "DW_TAG_variant_part";
6459 case DW_TAG_variable:
6460 return "DW_TAG_variable";
6461 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
6462 return "DW_TAG_volatile_type";
6463 case DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure:
6464 return "DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure";
6465 case DW_TAG_restrict_type:
6466 return "DW_TAG_restrict_type";
6467 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
6468 return "DW_TAG_interface_type";
6469 case DW_TAG_namespace:
6470 return "DW_TAG_namespace";
6471 case DW_TAG_imported_module:
6472 return "DW_TAG_imported_module";
6473 case DW_TAG_unspecified_type:
6474 return "DW_TAG_unspecified_type";
6475 case DW_TAG_partial_unit:
6476 return "DW_TAG_partial_unit";
6477 case DW_TAG_imported_unit:
6478 return "DW_TAG_imported_unit";
6479 case DW_TAG_condition:
6480 return "DW_TAG_condition";
6481 case DW_TAG_shared_type:
6482 return "DW_TAG_shared_type";
6483 case DW_TAG_type_unit:
6484 return "DW_TAG_type_unit";
6485 case DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type:
6486 return "DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type";
6487 case DW_TAG_template_alias:
6488 return "DW_TAG_template_alias";
6489 case DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack:
6490 return "DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack";
6491 case DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack:
6492 return "DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack";
6493 case DW_TAG_MIPS_loop:
6494 return "DW_TAG_MIPS_loop";
6495 case DW_TAG_format_label:
6496 return "DW_TAG_format_label";
6497 case DW_TAG_function_template:
6498 return "DW_TAG_function_template";
6499 case DW_TAG_class_template:
6500 return "DW_TAG_class_template";
6501 case DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL:
6502 return "DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL";
6503 case DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL:
6504 return "DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL";
6505 case DW_TAG_GNU_template_template_param:
6506 return "DW_TAG_GNU_template_template_param";
6507 default:
6508 return "DW_TAG_<unknown>";
6512 /* Convert a DWARF attribute code into its string name. */
6514 static const char *
6515 dwarf_attr_name (unsigned int attr)
6517 switch (attr)
6519 case DW_AT_sibling:
6520 return "DW_AT_sibling";
6521 case DW_AT_location:
6522 return "DW_AT_location";
6523 case DW_AT_name:
6524 return "DW_AT_name";
6525 case DW_AT_ordering:
6526 return "DW_AT_ordering";
6527 case DW_AT_subscr_data:
6528 return "DW_AT_subscr_data";
6529 case DW_AT_byte_size:
6530 return "DW_AT_byte_size";
6531 case DW_AT_bit_offset:
6532 return "DW_AT_bit_offset";
6533 case DW_AT_bit_size:
6534 return "DW_AT_bit_size";
6535 case DW_AT_element_list:
6536 return "DW_AT_element_list";
6537 case DW_AT_stmt_list:
6538 return "DW_AT_stmt_list";
6539 case DW_AT_low_pc:
6540 return "DW_AT_low_pc";
6541 case DW_AT_high_pc:
6542 return "DW_AT_high_pc";
6543 case DW_AT_language:
6544 return "DW_AT_language";
6545 case DW_AT_member:
6546 return "DW_AT_member";
6547 case DW_AT_discr:
6548 return "DW_AT_discr";
6549 case DW_AT_discr_value:
6550 return "DW_AT_discr_value";
6551 case DW_AT_visibility:
6552 return "DW_AT_visibility";
6553 case DW_AT_import:
6554 return "DW_AT_import";
6555 case DW_AT_string_length:
6556 return "DW_AT_string_length";
6557 case DW_AT_common_reference:
6558 return "DW_AT_common_reference";
6559 case DW_AT_comp_dir:
6560 return "DW_AT_comp_dir";
6561 case DW_AT_const_value:
6562 return "DW_AT_const_value";
6563 case DW_AT_containing_type:
6564 return "DW_AT_containing_type";
6565 case DW_AT_default_value:
6566 return "DW_AT_default_value";
6567 case DW_AT_inline:
6568 return "DW_AT_inline";
6569 case DW_AT_is_optional:
6570 return "DW_AT_is_optional";
6571 case DW_AT_lower_bound:
6572 return "DW_AT_lower_bound";
6573 case DW_AT_producer:
6574 return "DW_AT_producer";
6575 case DW_AT_prototyped:
6576 return "DW_AT_prototyped";
6577 case DW_AT_return_addr:
6578 return "DW_AT_return_addr";
6579 case DW_AT_start_scope:
6580 return "DW_AT_start_scope";
6581 case DW_AT_bit_stride:
6582 return "DW_AT_bit_stride";
6583 case DW_AT_upper_bound:
6584 return "DW_AT_upper_bound";
6585 case DW_AT_abstract_origin:
6586 return "DW_AT_abstract_origin";
6587 case DW_AT_accessibility:
6588 return "DW_AT_accessibility";
6589 case DW_AT_address_class:
6590 return "DW_AT_address_class";
6591 case DW_AT_artificial:
6592 return "DW_AT_artificial";
6593 case DW_AT_base_types:
6594 return "DW_AT_base_types";
6595 case DW_AT_calling_convention:
6596 return "DW_AT_calling_convention";
6597 case DW_AT_count:
6598 return "DW_AT_count";
6599 case DW_AT_data_member_location:
6600 return "DW_AT_data_member_location";
6601 case DW_AT_decl_column:
6602 return "DW_AT_decl_column";
6603 case DW_AT_decl_file:
6604 return "DW_AT_decl_file";
6605 case DW_AT_decl_line:
6606 return "DW_AT_decl_line";
6607 case DW_AT_declaration:
6608 return "DW_AT_declaration";
6609 case DW_AT_discr_list:
6610 return "DW_AT_discr_list";
6611 case DW_AT_encoding:
6612 return "DW_AT_encoding";
6613 case DW_AT_external:
6614 return "DW_AT_external";
6615 case DW_AT_explicit:
6616 return "DW_AT_explicit";
6617 case DW_AT_frame_base:
6618 return "DW_AT_frame_base";
6619 case DW_AT_friend:
6620 return "DW_AT_friend";
6621 case DW_AT_identifier_case:
6622 return "DW_AT_identifier_case";
6623 case DW_AT_macro_info:
6624 return "DW_AT_macro_info";
6625 case DW_AT_namelist_items:
6626 return "DW_AT_namelist_items";
6627 case DW_AT_priority:
6628 return "DW_AT_priority";
6629 case DW_AT_segment:
6630 return "DW_AT_segment";
6631 case DW_AT_specification:
6632 return "DW_AT_specification";
6633 case DW_AT_static_link:
6634 return "DW_AT_static_link";
6635 case DW_AT_type:
6636 return "DW_AT_type";
6637 case DW_AT_use_location:
6638 return "DW_AT_use_location";
6639 case DW_AT_variable_parameter:
6640 return "DW_AT_variable_parameter";
6641 case DW_AT_virtuality:
6642 return "DW_AT_virtuality";
6643 case DW_AT_vtable_elem_location:
6644 return "DW_AT_vtable_elem_location";
6646 case DW_AT_allocated:
6647 return "DW_AT_allocated";
6648 case DW_AT_associated:
6649 return "DW_AT_associated";
6650 case DW_AT_data_location:
6651 return "DW_AT_data_location";
6652 case DW_AT_byte_stride:
6653 return "DW_AT_byte_stride";
6654 case DW_AT_entry_pc:
6655 return "DW_AT_entry_pc";
6656 case DW_AT_use_UTF8:
6657 return "DW_AT_use_UTF8";
6658 case DW_AT_extension:
6659 return "DW_AT_extension";
6660 case DW_AT_ranges:
6661 return "DW_AT_ranges";
6662 case DW_AT_trampoline:
6663 return "DW_AT_trampoline";
6664 case DW_AT_call_column:
6665 return "DW_AT_call_column";
6666 case DW_AT_call_file:
6667 return "DW_AT_call_file";
6668 case DW_AT_call_line:
6669 return "DW_AT_call_line";
6671 case DW_AT_signature:
6672 return "DW_AT_signature";
6673 case DW_AT_main_subprogram:
6674 return "DW_AT_main_subprogram";
6675 case DW_AT_data_bit_offset:
6676 return "DW_AT_data_bit_offset";
6677 case DW_AT_const_expr:
6678 return "DW_AT_const_expr";
6679 case DW_AT_enum_class:
6680 return "DW_AT_enum_class";
6681 case DW_AT_linkage_name:
6682 return "DW_AT_linkage_name";
6684 case DW_AT_MIPS_fde:
6685 return "DW_AT_MIPS_fde";
6686 case DW_AT_MIPS_loop_begin:
6687 return "DW_AT_MIPS_loop_begin";
6688 case DW_AT_MIPS_tail_loop_begin:
6689 return "DW_AT_MIPS_tail_loop_begin";
6690 case DW_AT_MIPS_epilog_begin:
6691 return "DW_AT_MIPS_epilog_begin";
6692 case DW_AT_MIPS_loop_unroll_factor:
6693 return "DW_AT_MIPS_loop_unroll_factor";
6694 case DW_AT_MIPS_software_pipeline_depth:
6695 return "DW_AT_MIPS_software_pipeline_depth";
6696 case DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name:
6697 return "DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name";
6698 case DW_AT_MIPS_stride:
6699 return "DW_AT_MIPS_stride";
6700 case DW_AT_MIPS_abstract_name:
6701 return "DW_AT_MIPS_abstract_name";
6702 case DW_AT_MIPS_clone_origin:
6703 return "DW_AT_MIPS_clone_origin";
6704 case DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines:
6705 return "DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines";
6707 case DW_AT_sf_names:
6708 return "DW_AT_sf_names";
6709 case DW_AT_src_info:
6710 return "DW_AT_src_info";
6711 case DW_AT_mac_info:
6712 return "DW_AT_mac_info";
6713 case DW_AT_src_coords:
6714 return "DW_AT_src_coords";
6715 case DW_AT_body_begin:
6716 return "DW_AT_body_begin";
6717 case DW_AT_body_end:
6718 return "DW_AT_body_end";
6719 case DW_AT_GNU_vector:
6720 return "DW_AT_GNU_vector";
6721 case DW_AT_GNU_guarded_by:
6722 return "DW_AT_GNU_guarded_by";
6723 case DW_AT_GNU_pt_guarded_by:
6724 return "DW_AT_GNU_pt_guarded_by";
6725 case DW_AT_GNU_guarded:
6726 return "DW_AT_GNU_guarded";
6727 case DW_AT_GNU_pt_guarded:
6728 return "DW_AT_GNU_pt_guarded";
6729 case DW_AT_GNU_locks_excluded:
6730 return "DW_AT_GNU_locks_excluded";
6731 case DW_AT_GNU_exclusive_locks_required:
6732 return "DW_AT_GNU_exclusive_locks_required";
6733 case DW_AT_GNU_shared_locks_required:
6734 return "DW_AT_GNU_shared_locks_required";
6735 case DW_AT_GNU_odr_signature:
6736 return "DW_AT_GNU_odr_signature";
6737 case DW_AT_GNU_template_name:
6738 return "DW_AT_GNU_template_name";
6740 case DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address:
6741 return "DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address";
6743 default:
6744 return "DW_AT_<unknown>";
6748 /* Convert a DWARF value form code into its string name. */
6750 static const char *
6751 dwarf_form_name (unsigned int form)
6753 switch (form)
6755 case DW_FORM_addr:
6756 return "DW_FORM_addr";
6757 case DW_FORM_block2:
6758 return "DW_FORM_block2";
6759 case DW_FORM_block4:
6760 return "DW_FORM_block4";
6761 case DW_FORM_data2:
6762 return "DW_FORM_data2";
6763 case DW_FORM_data4:
6764 return "DW_FORM_data4";
6765 case DW_FORM_data8:
6766 return "DW_FORM_data8";
6767 case DW_FORM_string:
6768 return "DW_FORM_string";
6769 case DW_FORM_block:
6770 return "DW_FORM_block";
6771 case DW_FORM_block1:
6772 return "DW_FORM_block1";
6773 case DW_FORM_data1:
6774 return "DW_FORM_data1";
6775 case DW_FORM_flag:
6776 return "DW_FORM_flag";
6777 case DW_FORM_sdata:
6778 return "DW_FORM_sdata";
6779 case DW_FORM_strp:
6780 return "DW_FORM_strp";
6781 case DW_FORM_udata:
6782 return "DW_FORM_udata";
6783 case DW_FORM_ref_addr:
6784 return "DW_FORM_ref_addr";
6785 case DW_FORM_ref1:
6786 return "DW_FORM_ref1";
6787 case DW_FORM_ref2:
6788 return "DW_FORM_ref2";
6789 case DW_FORM_ref4:
6790 return "DW_FORM_ref4";
6791 case DW_FORM_ref8:
6792 return "DW_FORM_ref8";
6793 case DW_FORM_ref_udata:
6794 return "DW_FORM_ref_udata";
6795 case DW_FORM_indirect:
6796 return "DW_FORM_indirect";
6797 case DW_FORM_sec_offset:
6798 return "DW_FORM_sec_offset";
6799 case DW_FORM_exprloc:
6800 return "DW_FORM_exprloc";
6801 case DW_FORM_flag_present:
6802 return "DW_FORM_flag_present";
6803 case DW_FORM_ref_sig8:
6804 return "DW_FORM_ref_sig8";
6805 default:
6806 return "DW_FORM_<unknown>";
6810 /* Determine the "ultimate origin" of a decl. The decl may be an inlined
6811 instance of an inlined instance of a decl which is local to an inline
6812 function, so we have to trace all of the way back through the origin chain
6813 to find out what sort of node actually served as the original seed for the
6814 given block. */
6816 static tree
6817 decl_ultimate_origin (const_tree decl)
6819 if (!CODE_CONTAINS_STRUCT (TREE_CODE (decl), TS_DECL_COMMON))
6820 return NULL_TREE;
6822 /* output_inline_function sets DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for all the
6823 nodes in the function to point to themselves; ignore that if
6824 we're trying to output the abstract instance of this function. */
6825 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl) && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == decl)
6826 return NULL_TREE;
6828 /* Since the DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for a DECL is supposed to be the
6829 most distant ancestor, this should never happen. */
6830 gcc_assert (!DECL_FROM_INLINE (DECL_ORIGIN (decl)));
6832 return DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl);
6835 /* Get the class to which DECL belongs, if any. In g++, the DECL_CONTEXT
6836 of a virtual function may refer to a base class, so we check the 'this'
6837 parameter. */
6839 static tree
6840 decl_class_context (tree decl)
6842 tree context = NULL_TREE;
6844 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != FUNCTION_DECL || ! DECL_VINDEX (decl))
6845 context = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
6846 else
6847 context = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT
6848 (TREE_TYPE (TREE_VALUE (TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (decl)))));
6850 if (context && !TYPE_P (context))
6851 context = NULL_TREE;
6853 return context;
6856 /* Add an attribute/value pair to a DIE. */
6858 static inline void
6859 add_dwarf_attr (dw_die_ref die, dw_attr_ref attr)
6861 /* Maybe this should be an assert? */
6862 if (die == NULL)
6863 return;
6865 if (die->die_attr == NULL)
6866 die->die_attr = VEC_alloc (dw_attr_node, gc, 1);
6867 VEC_safe_push (dw_attr_node, gc, die->die_attr, attr);
6870 static inline enum dw_val_class
6871 AT_class (dw_attr_ref a)
6873 return a->dw_attr_val.val_class;
6876 /* Add a flag value attribute to a DIE. */
6878 static inline void
6879 add_AT_flag (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, unsigned int flag)
6881 dw_attr_node attr;
6883 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
6884 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_flag;
6885 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_flag = flag;
6886 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
6889 static inline unsigned
6890 AT_flag (dw_attr_ref a)
6892 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_flag);
6893 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag;
6896 /* Add a signed integer attribute value to a DIE. */
6898 static inline void
6899 add_AT_int (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, HOST_WIDE_INT int_val)
6901 dw_attr_node attr;
6903 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
6904 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
6905 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_int = int_val;
6906 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
6909 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
6910 AT_int (dw_attr_ref a)
6912 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_const);
6913 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_int;
6916 /* Add an unsigned integer attribute value to a DIE. */
6918 static inline void
6919 add_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
6920 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT unsigned_val)
6922 dw_attr_node attr;
6924 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
6925 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
6926 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned = unsigned_val;
6927 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
6930 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
6931 AT_unsigned (dw_attr_ref a)
6933 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_unsigned_const);
6934 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned;
6937 /* Add an unsigned double integer attribute value to a DIE. */
6939 static inline void
6940 add_AT_double (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
6941 HOST_WIDE_INT high, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT low)
6943 dw_attr_node attr;
6945 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
6946 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_const_double;
6947 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_double.high = high;
6948 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_double.low = low;
6949 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
6952 /* Add a floating point attribute value to a DIE and return it. */
6954 static inline void
6955 add_AT_vec (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
6956 unsigned int length, unsigned int elt_size, unsigned char *array)
6958 dw_attr_node attr;
6960 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
6961 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
6962 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length = length;
6963 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size = elt_size;
6964 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array = array;
6965 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
6968 /* Add an 8-byte data attribute value to a DIE. */
6970 static inline void
6971 add_AT_data8 (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
6972 unsigned char data8[8])
6974 dw_attr_node attr;
6976 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
6977 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_data8;
6978 memcpy (attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_data8, data8, 8);
6979 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
6982 /* Hash and equality functions for debug_str_hash. */
6984 static hashval_t
6985 debug_str_do_hash (const void *x)
6987 return htab_hash_string (((const struct indirect_string_node *)x)->str);
6990 static int
6991 debug_str_eq (const void *x1, const void *x2)
6993 return strcmp ((((const struct indirect_string_node *)x1)->str),
6994 (const char *)x2) == 0;
6997 /* Add STR to the indirect string hash table. */
6999 static struct indirect_string_node *
7000 find_AT_string (const char *str)
7002 struct indirect_string_node *node;
7003 void **slot;
7005 if (! debug_str_hash)
7006 debug_str_hash = htab_create_ggc (10, debug_str_do_hash,
7007 debug_str_eq, NULL);
7009 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (debug_str_hash, str,
7010 htab_hash_string (str), INSERT);
7011 if (*slot == NULL)
7013 node = (struct indirect_string_node *)
7014 ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (struct indirect_string_node));
7015 node->str = ggc_strdup (str);
7016 *slot = node;
7018 else
7019 node = (struct indirect_string_node *) *slot;
7021 node->refcount++;
7022 return node;
7025 /* Add a string attribute value to a DIE. */
7027 static inline void
7028 add_AT_string (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, const char *str)
7030 dw_attr_node attr;
7031 struct indirect_string_node *node;
7033 node = find_AT_string (str);
7035 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7036 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_str;
7037 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_str = node;
7038 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7041 /* Create a label for an indirect string node, ensuring it is going to
7042 be output, unless its reference count goes down to zero. */
7044 static inline void
7045 gen_label_for_indirect_string (struct indirect_string_node *node)
7047 char label[32];
7049 if (node->label)
7050 return;
7052 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LASF", dw2_string_counter);
7053 ++dw2_string_counter;
7054 node->label = xstrdup (label);
7057 /* Create a SYMBOL_REF rtx whose value is the initial address of a
7058 debug string STR. */
7060 static inline rtx
7061 get_debug_string_label (const char *str)
7063 struct indirect_string_node *node = find_AT_string (str);
7065 debug_str_hash_forced = true;
7067 gen_label_for_indirect_string (node);
7069 return gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, node->label);
7072 static inline const char *
7073 AT_string (dw_attr_ref a)
7075 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str);
7076 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->str;
7079 /* Find out whether a string should be output inline in DIE
7080 or out-of-line in .debug_str section. */
7082 static enum dwarf_form
7083 AT_string_form (dw_attr_ref a)
7085 struct indirect_string_node *node;
7086 unsigned int len;
7088 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str);
7090 node = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str;
7091 if (node->form)
7092 return node->form;
7094 len = strlen (node->str) + 1;
7096 /* If the string is shorter or equal to the size of the reference, it is
7097 always better to put it inline. */
7098 if (len <= DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE || node->refcount == 0)
7099 return node->form = DW_FORM_string;
7101 /* If we cannot expect the linker to merge strings in .debug_str
7102 section, only put it into .debug_str if it is worth even in this
7103 single module. */
7104 if (DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET
7105 || ((debug_str_section->common.flags & SECTION_MERGE) == 0
7106 && (len - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE) * node->refcount <= len))
7107 return node->form = DW_FORM_string;
7109 gen_label_for_indirect_string (node);
7111 return node->form = DW_FORM_strp;
7114 /* Add a DIE reference attribute value to a DIE. */
7116 static inline void
7117 add_AT_die_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_die_ref targ_die)
7119 dw_attr_node attr;
7121 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7122 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
7123 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = targ_die;
7124 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
7125 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7128 /* Add an AT_specification attribute to a DIE, and also make the back
7129 pointer from the specification to the definition. */
7131 static inline void
7132 add_AT_specification (dw_die_ref die, dw_die_ref targ_die)
7134 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_specification, targ_die);
7135 gcc_assert (!targ_die->die_definition);
7136 targ_die->die_definition = die;
7139 static inline dw_die_ref
7140 AT_ref (dw_attr_ref a)
7142 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref);
7143 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die;
7146 static inline int
7147 AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref a)
7149 if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
7150 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external;
7152 return 0;
7155 static inline void
7156 set_AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref a, int i)
7158 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref);
7159 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = i;
7162 /* Add an FDE reference attribute value to a DIE. */
7164 static inline void
7165 add_AT_fde_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, unsigned int targ_fde)
7167 dw_attr_node attr;
7169 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7170 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_fde_ref;
7171 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_fde_index = targ_fde;
7172 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7175 /* Add a location description attribute value to a DIE. */
7177 static inline void
7178 add_AT_loc (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
7180 dw_attr_node attr;
7182 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7183 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
7184 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_loc = loc;
7185 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7188 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
7189 AT_loc (dw_attr_ref a)
7191 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc);
7192 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc;
7195 static inline void
7196 add_AT_loc_list (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_loc_list_ref loc_list)
7198 dw_attr_node attr;
7200 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7201 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc_list;
7202 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list = loc_list;
7203 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7204 have_location_lists = true;
7207 static inline dw_loc_list_ref
7208 AT_loc_list (dw_attr_ref a)
7210 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list);
7211 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list;
7214 /* Add an address constant attribute value to a DIE. */
7216 static inline void
7217 add_AT_addr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, rtx addr)
7219 dw_attr_node attr;
7221 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7222 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
7223 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_addr = addr;
7224 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7227 /* Get the RTX from to an address DIE attribute. */
7229 static inline rtx
7230 AT_addr (dw_attr_ref a)
7232 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_addr);
7233 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr;
7236 /* Add a file attribute value to a DIE. */
7238 static inline void
7239 add_AT_file (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
7240 struct dwarf_file_data *fd)
7242 dw_attr_node attr;
7244 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7245 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_file;
7246 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_file = fd;
7247 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7250 /* Get the dwarf_file_data from a file DIE attribute. */
7252 static inline struct dwarf_file_data *
7253 AT_file (dw_attr_ref a)
7255 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_file);
7256 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file;
7259 /* Add a label identifier attribute value to a DIE. */
7261 static inline void
7262 add_AT_lbl_id (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, const char *lbl_id)
7264 dw_attr_node attr;
7266 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7267 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lbl_id;
7268 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (lbl_id);
7269 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7272 /* Add a section offset attribute value to a DIE, an offset into the
7273 debug_line section. */
7275 static inline void
7276 add_AT_lineptr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
7277 const char *label)
7279 dw_attr_node attr;
7281 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7282 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lineptr;
7283 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (label);
7284 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7287 /* Add a section offset attribute value to a DIE, an offset into the
7288 debug_macinfo section. */
7290 static inline void
7291 add_AT_macptr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
7292 const char *label)
7294 dw_attr_node attr;
7296 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7297 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_macptr;
7298 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (label);
7299 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7302 /* Add an offset attribute value to a DIE. */
7304 static inline void
7305 add_AT_offset (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
7306 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
7308 dw_attr_node attr;
7310 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7311 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_offset;
7312 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_offset = offset;
7313 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7316 /* Add an range_list attribute value to a DIE. */
7318 static void
7319 add_AT_range_list (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
7320 long unsigned int offset)
7322 dw_attr_node attr;
7324 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7325 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_range_list;
7326 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_offset = offset;
7327 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7330 static inline const char *
7331 AT_lbl (dw_attr_ref a)
7333 gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_lbl_id
7334 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_lineptr
7335 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_macptr));
7336 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id;
7339 /* Get the attribute of type attr_kind. */
7341 static dw_attr_ref
7342 get_AT (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
7344 dw_attr_ref a;
7345 unsigned ix;
7346 dw_die_ref spec = NULL;
7348 if (! die)
7349 return NULL;
7351 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
7352 if (a->dw_attr == attr_kind)
7353 return a;
7354 else if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_specification
7355 || a->dw_attr == DW_AT_abstract_origin)
7356 spec = AT_ref (a);
7358 if (spec)
7359 return get_AT (spec, attr_kind);
7361 return NULL;
7364 /* Return the "low pc" attribute value, typically associated with a subprogram
7365 DIE. Return null if the "low pc" attribute is either not present, or if it
7366 cannot be represented as an assembler label identifier. */
7368 static inline const char *
7369 get_AT_low_pc (dw_die_ref die)
7371 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_low_pc);
7373 return a ? AT_lbl (a) : NULL;
7376 /* Return the "high pc" attribute value, typically associated with a subprogram
7377 DIE. Return null if the "high pc" attribute is either not present, or if it
7378 cannot be represented as an assembler label identifier. */
7380 static inline const char *
7381 get_AT_hi_pc (dw_die_ref die)
7383 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_high_pc);
7385 return a ? AT_lbl (a) : NULL;
7388 /* Return the value of the string attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or
7389 NULL if it is not present. */
7391 static inline const char *
7392 get_AT_string (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
7394 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
7396 return a ? AT_string (a) : NULL;
7399 /* Return the value of the flag attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or -1
7400 if it is not present. */
7402 static inline int
7403 get_AT_flag (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
7405 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
7407 return a ? AT_flag (a) : 0;
7410 /* Return the value of the unsigned attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or 0
7411 if it is not present. */
7413 static inline unsigned
7414 get_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
7416 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
7418 return a ? AT_unsigned (a) : 0;
7421 static inline dw_die_ref
7422 get_AT_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
7424 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
7426 return a ? AT_ref (a) : NULL;
7429 static inline struct dwarf_file_data *
7430 get_AT_file (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
7432 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
7434 return a ? AT_file (a) : NULL;
7437 /* Return TRUE if the language is C or C++. */
7439 static inline bool
7440 is_c_family (void)
7442 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
7444 return (lang == DW_LANG_C || lang == DW_LANG_C89 || lang == DW_LANG_ObjC
7445 || lang == DW_LANG_C99
7446 || lang == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus || lang == DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus);
7449 /* Return TRUE if the language is C++. */
7451 static inline bool
7452 is_cxx (void)
7454 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
7456 return lang == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus || lang == DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus;
7459 /* Return TRUE if the language is Fortran. */
7461 static inline bool
7462 is_fortran (void)
7464 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
7466 return (lang == DW_LANG_Fortran77
7467 || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran90
7468 || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran95);
7471 /* Return TRUE if the language is Java. */
7473 static inline bool
7474 is_java (void)
7476 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
7478 return lang == DW_LANG_Java;
7481 /* Return TRUE if the language is Ada. */
7483 static inline bool
7484 is_ada (void)
7486 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
7488 return lang == DW_LANG_Ada95 || lang == DW_LANG_Ada83;
7491 /* Remove the specified attribute if present. */
7493 static void
7494 remove_AT (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
7496 dw_attr_ref a;
7497 unsigned ix;
7499 if (! die)
7500 return;
7502 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
7503 if (a->dw_attr == attr_kind)
7505 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
7506 if (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount)
7507 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount--;
7509 /* VEC_ordered_remove should help reduce the number of abbrevs
7510 that are needed. */
7511 VEC_ordered_remove (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix);
7512 return;
7516 /* Remove CHILD from its parent. PREV must have the property that
7517 PREV->DIE_SIB == CHILD. Does not alter CHILD. */
7519 static void
7520 remove_child_with_prev (dw_die_ref child, dw_die_ref prev)
7522 gcc_assert (child->die_parent == prev->die_parent);
7523 gcc_assert (prev->die_sib == child);
7524 if (prev == child)
7526 gcc_assert (child->die_parent->die_child == child);
7527 prev = NULL;
7529 else
7530 prev->die_sib = child->die_sib;
7531 if (child->die_parent->die_child == child)
7532 child->die_parent->die_child = prev;
7535 /* Replace OLD_CHILD with NEW_CHILD. PREV must have the property that
7536 PREV->DIE_SIB == OLD_CHILD. Does not alter OLD_CHILD. */
7538 static void
7539 replace_child (dw_die_ref old_child, dw_die_ref new_child, dw_die_ref prev)
7541 dw_die_ref parent = old_child->die_parent;
7543 gcc_assert (parent == prev->die_parent);
7544 gcc_assert (prev->die_sib == old_child);
7546 new_child->die_parent = parent;
7547 if (prev == old_child)
7549 gcc_assert (parent->die_child == old_child);
7550 new_child->die_sib = new_child;
7552 else
7554 prev->die_sib = new_child;
7555 new_child->die_sib = old_child->die_sib;
7557 if (old_child->die_parent->die_child == old_child)
7558 old_child->die_parent->die_child = new_child;
7561 /* Move all children from OLD_PARENT to NEW_PARENT. */
7563 static void
7564 move_all_children (dw_die_ref old_parent, dw_die_ref new_parent)
7566 dw_die_ref c;
7567 new_parent->die_child = old_parent->die_child;
7568 old_parent->die_child = NULL;
7569 FOR_EACH_CHILD (new_parent, c, c->die_parent = new_parent);
7572 /* Remove child DIE whose die_tag is TAG. Do nothing if no child
7573 matches TAG. */
7575 static void
7576 remove_child_TAG (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_tag tag)
7578 dw_die_ref c;
7580 c = die->die_child;
7581 if (c) do {
7582 dw_die_ref prev = c;
7583 c = c->die_sib;
7584 while (c->die_tag == tag)
7586 remove_child_with_prev (c, prev);
7587 /* Might have removed every child. */
7588 if (c == c->die_sib)
7589 return;
7590 c = c->die_sib;
7592 } while (c != die->die_child);
7595 /* Add a CHILD_DIE as the last child of DIE. */
7597 static void
7598 add_child_die (dw_die_ref die, dw_die_ref child_die)
7600 /* FIXME this should probably be an assert. */
7601 if (! die || ! child_die)
7602 return;
7603 gcc_assert (die != child_die);
7605 child_die->die_parent = die;
7606 if (die->die_child)
7608 child_die->die_sib = die->die_child->die_sib;
7609 die->die_child->die_sib = child_die;
7611 else
7612 child_die->die_sib = child_die;
7613 die->die_child = child_die;
7616 /* Move CHILD, which must be a child of PARENT or the DIE for which PARENT
7617 is the specification, to the end of PARENT's list of children.
7618 This is done by removing and re-adding it. */
7620 static void
7621 splice_child_die (dw_die_ref parent, dw_die_ref child)
7623 dw_die_ref p;
7625 /* We want the declaration DIE from inside the class, not the
7626 specification DIE at toplevel. */
7627 if (child->die_parent != parent)
7629 dw_die_ref tmp = get_AT_ref (child, DW_AT_specification);
7631 if (tmp)
7632 child = tmp;
7635 gcc_assert (child->die_parent == parent
7636 || (child->die_parent
7637 == get_AT_ref (parent, DW_AT_specification)));
7639 for (p = child->die_parent->die_child; ; p = p->die_sib)
7640 if (p->die_sib == child)
7642 remove_child_with_prev (child, p);
7643 break;
7646 add_child_die (parent, child);
7649 /* Return a pointer to a newly created DIE node. */
7651 static inline dw_die_ref
7652 new_die (enum dwarf_tag tag_value, dw_die_ref parent_die, tree t)
7654 dw_die_ref die = GGC_CNEW (die_node);
7656 die->die_tag = tag_value;
7658 if (parent_die != NULL)
7659 add_child_die (parent_die, die);
7660 else
7662 limbo_die_node *limbo_node;
7664 limbo_node = GGC_CNEW (limbo_die_node);
7665 limbo_node->die = die;
7666 limbo_node->created_for = t;
7667 limbo_node->next = limbo_die_list;
7668 limbo_die_list = limbo_node;
7671 return die;
7674 /* Return the DIE associated with the given type specifier. */
7676 static inline dw_die_ref
7677 lookup_type_die (tree type)
7679 return TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type);
7682 /* Equate a DIE to a given type specifier. */
7684 static inline void
7685 equate_type_number_to_die (tree type, dw_die_ref type_die)
7687 TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type) = type_die;
7690 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a die_struct). */
7692 static hashval_t
7693 decl_die_table_hash (const void *x)
7695 return (hashval_t) ((const_dw_die_ref) x)->decl_id;
7698 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of die_struct X is the same as UID of decl *Y. */
7700 static int
7701 decl_die_table_eq (const void *x, const void *y)
7703 return (((const_dw_die_ref) x)->decl_id == DECL_UID ((const_tree) y));
7706 /* Return the DIE associated with a given declaration. */
7708 static inline dw_die_ref
7709 lookup_decl_die (tree decl)
7711 return (dw_die_ref) htab_find_with_hash (decl_die_table, decl, DECL_UID (decl));
7714 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a var_loc_list). */
7716 static hashval_t
7717 decl_loc_table_hash (const void *x)
7719 return (hashval_t) ((const var_loc_list *) x)->decl_id;
7722 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of var_loc_list X is the same as
7723 UID of decl *Y. */
7725 static int
7726 decl_loc_table_eq (const void *x, const void *y)
7728 return (((const var_loc_list *) x)->decl_id == DECL_UID ((const_tree) y));
7731 /* Return the var_loc list associated with a given declaration. */
7733 static inline var_loc_list *
7734 lookup_decl_loc (const_tree decl)
7736 if (!decl_loc_table)
7737 return NULL;
7738 return (var_loc_list *)
7739 htab_find_with_hash (decl_loc_table, decl, DECL_UID (decl));
7742 /* Equate a DIE to a particular declaration. */
7744 static void
7745 equate_decl_number_to_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref decl_die)
7747 unsigned int decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
7748 void **slot;
7750 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (decl_die_table, decl, decl_id, INSERT);
7751 *slot = decl_die;
7752 decl_die->decl_id = decl_id;
7755 /* Add a variable location node to the linked list for DECL. */
7757 static void
7758 add_var_loc_to_decl (tree decl, struct var_loc_node *loc)
7760 unsigned int decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
7761 var_loc_list *temp;
7762 void **slot;
7764 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (decl_loc_table, decl, decl_id, INSERT);
7765 if (*slot == NULL)
7767 temp = GGC_CNEW (var_loc_list);
7768 temp->decl_id = decl_id;
7769 *slot = temp;
7771 else
7772 temp = (var_loc_list *) *slot;
7774 if (temp->last)
7776 /* If the current location is the same as the end of the list,
7777 and either both or neither of the locations is uninitialized,
7778 we have nothing to do. */
7779 if ((!rtx_equal_p (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (temp->last->var_loc_note),
7780 NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc->var_loc_note)))
7781 || ((NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (temp->last->var_loc_note)
7782 != NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (loc->var_loc_note))
7783 && ((NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (temp->last->var_loc_note)
7784 == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
7785 || (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (loc->var_loc_note)
7786 == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED))))
7788 /* Add LOC to the end of list and update LAST. */
7789 temp->last->next = loc;
7790 temp->last = loc;
7793 /* Do not add empty location to the beginning of the list. */
7794 else if (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc->var_loc_note) != NULL_RTX)
7796 temp->first = loc;
7797 temp->last = loc;
7801 /* Keep track of the number of spaces used to indent the
7802 output of the debugging routines that print the structure of
7803 the DIE internal representation. */
7804 static int print_indent;
7806 /* Indent the line the number of spaces given by print_indent. */
7808 static inline void
7809 print_spaces (FILE *outfile)
7811 fprintf (outfile, "%*s", print_indent, "");
7814 /* Print a type signature in hex. */
7816 static inline void
7817 print_signature (FILE *outfile, char *sig)
7819 int i;
7821 for (i = 0; i < DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE; i++)
7822 fprintf (outfile, "%02x", sig[i] & 0xff);
7825 /* Print the information associated with a given DIE, and its children.
7826 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
7828 static void
7829 print_die (dw_die_ref die, FILE *outfile)
7831 dw_attr_ref a;
7832 dw_die_ref c;
7833 unsigned ix;
7835 print_spaces (outfile);
7836 fprintf (outfile, "DIE %4ld: %s\n",
7837 die->die_offset, dwarf_tag_name (die->die_tag));
7838 print_spaces (outfile);
7839 fprintf (outfile, " abbrev id: %lu", die->die_abbrev);
7840 fprintf (outfile, " offset: %ld\n", die->die_offset);
7841 if (dwarf_version >= 4 && die->die_id.die_type_node)
7843 print_spaces (outfile);
7844 fprintf (outfile, " signature: ");
7845 print_signature (outfile, die->die_id.die_type_node->signature);
7846 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
7849 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
7851 print_spaces (outfile);
7852 fprintf (outfile, " %s: ", dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr));
7854 switch (AT_class (a))
7856 case dw_val_class_addr:
7857 fprintf (outfile, "address");
7858 break;
7859 case dw_val_class_offset:
7860 fprintf (outfile, "offset");
7861 break;
7862 case dw_val_class_loc:
7863 fprintf (outfile, "location descriptor");
7864 break;
7865 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
7866 fprintf (outfile, "location list -> label:%s",
7867 AT_loc_list (a)->ll_symbol);
7868 break;
7869 case dw_val_class_range_list:
7870 fprintf (outfile, "range list");
7871 break;
7872 case dw_val_class_const:
7873 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, AT_int (a));
7874 break;
7875 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
7876 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED, AT_unsigned (a));
7877 break;
7878 case dw_val_class_const_double:
7879 fprintf (outfile, "constant ("HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC","\
7880 HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED")",
7881 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.high,
7882 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.low);
7883 break;
7884 case dw_val_class_vec:
7885 fprintf (outfile, "floating-point or vector constant");
7886 break;
7887 case dw_val_class_flag:
7888 fprintf (outfile, "%u", AT_flag (a));
7889 break;
7890 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
7891 if (AT_ref (a) != NULL)
7893 if (dwarf_version >= 4 && AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_type_node)
7895 fprintf (outfile, "die -> signature: ");
7896 print_signature (outfile,
7897 AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_type_node->signature);
7899 else if (dwarf_version < 4 && AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_symbol)
7900 fprintf (outfile, "die -> label: %s",
7901 AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_symbol);
7902 else
7903 fprintf (outfile, "die -> %ld", AT_ref (a)->die_offset);
7905 else
7906 fprintf (outfile, "die -> <null>");
7907 break;
7908 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
7909 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
7910 case dw_val_class_macptr:
7911 fprintf (outfile, "label: %s", AT_lbl (a));
7912 break;
7913 case dw_val_class_str:
7914 if (AT_string (a) != NULL)
7915 fprintf (outfile, "\"%s\"", AT_string (a));
7916 else
7917 fprintf (outfile, "<null>");
7918 break;
7919 case dw_val_class_file:
7920 fprintf (outfile, "\"%s\" (%d)", AT_file (a)->filename,
7921 AT_file (a)->emitted_number);
7922 break;
7923 case dw_val_class_data8:
7925 int i;
7927 for (i = 0; i < 8; i++)
7928 fprintf (outfile, "%02x", a->dw_attr_val.v.val_data8[i]);
7929 break;
7931 default:
7932 break;
7935 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
7938 if (die->die_child != NULL)
7940 print_indent += 4;
7941 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, print_die (c, outfile));
7942 print_indent -= 4;
7944 if (print_indent == 0)
7945 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
7948 /* Print the contents of the source code line number correspondence table.
7949 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
7951 static void
7952 print_dwarf_line_table (FILE *outfile)
7954 unsigned i;
7955 dw_line_info_ref line_info;
7957 fprintf (outfile, "\n\nDWARF source line information\n");
7958 for (i = 1; i < line_info_table_in_use; i++)
7960 line_info = &line_info_table[i];
7961 fprintf (outfile, "%5d: %4ld %6ld\n", i,
7962 line_info->dw_file_num,
7963 line_info->dw_line_num);
7966 fprintf (outfile, "\n\n");
7969 /* Print the information collected for a given DIE. */
7971 void
7972 debug_dwarf_die (dw_die_ref die)
7974 print_die (die, stderr);
7977 /* Print all DWARF information collected for the compilation unit.
7978 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
7980 void
7981 debug_dwarf (void)
7983 print_indent = 0;
7984 print_die (comp_unit_die, stderr);
7985 if (! DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
7986 print_dwarf_line_table (stderr);
7989 /* Start a new compilation unit DIE for an include file. OLD_UNIT is the CU
7990 for the enclosing include file, if any. BINCL_DIE is the DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL
7991 DIE that marks the start of the DIEs for this include file. */
7993 static dw_die_ref
7994 push_new_compile_unit (dw_die_ref old_unit, dw_die_ref bincl_die)
7996 const char *filename = get_AT_string (bincl_die, DW_AT_name);
7997 dw_die_ref new_unit = gen_compile_unit_die (filename);
7999 new_unit->die_sib = old_unit;
8000 return new_unit;
8003 /* Close an include-file CU and reopen the enclosing one. */
8005 static dw_die_ref
8006 pop_compile_unit (dw_die_ref old_unit)
8008 dw_die_ref new_unit = old_unit->die_sib;
8010 old_unit->die_sib = NULL;
8011 return new_unit;
8014 #define CHECKSUM(FOO) md5_process_bytes (&(FOO), sizeof (FOO), ctx)
8015 #define CHECKSUM_STRING(FOO) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), strlen (FOO), ctx)
8017 /* Calculate the checksum of a location expression. */
8019 static inline void
8020 loc_checksum (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
8022 int tem;
8024 tem = (loc->dtprel << 8) | ((unsigned int) loc->dw_loc_opc);
8025 CHECKSUM (tem);
8026 CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1);
8027 CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2);
8030 /* Calculate the checksum of an attribute. */
8032 static void
8033 attr_checksum (dw_attr_ref at, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
8035 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
8036 rtx r;
8038 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr);
8040 /* We don't care that this was compiled with a different compiler
8041 snapshot; if the output is the same, that's what matters. */
8042 if (at->dw_attr == DW_AT_producer)
8043 return;
8045 switch (AT_class (at))
8047 case dw_val_class_const:
8048 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_int);
8049 break;
8050 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
8051 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned);
8052 break;
8053 case dw_val_class_const_double:
8054 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_double);
8055 break;
8056 case dw_val_class_vec:
8057 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec);
8058 break;
8059 case dw_val_class_flag:
8060 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag);
8061 break;
8062 case dw_val_class_str:
8063 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (at));
8064 break;
8066 case dw_val_class_addr:
8067 r = AT_addr (at);
8068 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (r) == SYMBOL_REF);
8069 CHECKSUM_STRING (XSTR (r, 0));
8070 break;
8072 case dw_val_class_offset:
8073 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
8074 break;
8076 case dw_val_class_loc:
8077 for (loc = AT_loc (at); loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
8078 loc_checksum (loc, ctx);
8079 break;
8081 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
8082 die_checksum (AT_ref (at), ctx, mark);
8083 break;
8085 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
8086 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
8087 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
8088 case dw_val_class_macptr:
8089 break;
8091 case dw_val_class_file:
8092 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_file (at)->filename);
8093 break;
8095 case dw_val_class_data8:
8096 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_data8);
8097 break;
8099 default:
8100 break;
8104 /* Calculate the checksum of a DIE. */
8106 static void
8107 die_checksum (dw_die_ref die, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
8109 dw_die_ref c;
8110 dw_attr_ref a;
8111 unsigned ix;
8113 /* To avoid infinite recursion. */
8114 if (die->die_mark)
8116 CHECKSUM (die->die_mark);
8117 return;
8119 die->die_mark = ++(*mark);
8121 CHECKSUM (die->die_tag);
8123 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
8124 attr_checksum (a, ctx, mark);
8126 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, die_checksum (c, ctx, mark));
8129 #undef CHECKSUM
8130 #undef CHECKSUM_STRING
8132 /* For DWARF-4 types, include the trailing NULL when checksumming strings. */
8133 #define CHECKSUM(FOO) md5_process_bytes (&(FOO), sizeof (FOO), ctx)
8134 #define CHECKSUM_STRING(FOO) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), strlen (FOO) + 1, ctx)
8135 #define CHECKSUM_SLEB128(FOO) checksum_sleb128 ((FOO), ctx)
8136 #define CHECKSUM_ULEB128(FOO) checksum_uleb128 ((FOO), ctx)
8137 #define CHECKSUM_ATTR(FOO) \
8138 if (FOO) attr_checksum_ordered (die->die_tag, (FOO), ctx, mark)
8140 /* Calculate the checksum of a number in signed LEB128 format. */
8142 static void
8143 checksum_sleb128 (HOST_WIDE_INT value, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
8145 unsigned char byte;
8146 bool more;
8148 while (1)
8150 byte = (value & 0x7f);
8151 value >>= 7;
8152 more = !((value == 0 && (byte & 0x40) == 0)
8153 || (value == -1 && (byte & 0x40) != 0));
8154 if (more)
8155 byte |= 0x80;
8156 CHECKSUM (byte);
8157 if (!more)
8158 break;
8162 /* Calculate the checksum of a number in unsigned LEB128 format. */
8164 static void
8165 checksum_uleb128 (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT value, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
8167 while (1)
8169 unsigned char byte = (value & 0x7f);
8170 value >>= 7;
8171 if (value != 0)
8172 /* More bytes to follow. */
8173 byte |= 0x80;
8174 CHECKSUM (byte);
8175 if (value == 0)
8176 break;
8180 /* Checksum the context of the DIE. This adds the names of any
8181 surrounding namespaces or structures to the checksum. */
8183 static void
8184 checksum_die_context (dw_die_ref die, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
8186 const char *name;
8187 dw_die_ref spec;
8188 int tag = die->die_tag;
8190 if (tag != DW_TAG_namespace
8191 && tag != DW_TAG_structure_type
8192 && tag != DW_TAG_class_type)
8193 return;
8195 name = get_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name);
8197 spec = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
8198 if (spec != NULL)
8199 die = spec;
8201 if (die->die_parent != NULL)
8202 checksum_die_context (die->die_parent, ctx);
8204 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('C');
8205 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (tag);
8206 if (name != NULL)
8207 CHECKSUM_STRING (name);
8210 /* Calculate the checksum of a location expression. */
8212 static inline void
8213 loc_checksum_ordered (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
8215 /* Special case for lone DW_OP_plus_uconst: checksum as if the location
8216 were emitted as a DW_FORM_sdata instead of a location expression. */
8217 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_plus_uconst && loc->dw_loc_next == NULL)
8219 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_sdata);
8220 CHECKSUM_SLEB128 ((HOST_WIDE_INT) loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
8221 return;
8224 /* Otherwise, just checksum the raw location expression. */
8225 while (loc != NULL)
8227 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (loc->dw_loc_opc);
8228 CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1);
8229 CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2);
8230 loc = loc->dw_loc_next;
8234 /* Calculate the checksum of an attribute. */
8236 static void
8237 attr_checksum_ordered (enum dwarf_tag tag, dw_attr_ref at,
8238 struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
8240 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
8241 rtx r;
8243 if (AT_class (at) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
8245 dw_die_ref target_die = AT_ref (at);
8247 /* For pointer and reference types, we checksum only the (qualified)
8248 name of the target type (if there is a name). For friend entries,
8249 we checksum only the (qualified) name of the target type or function.
8250 This allows the checksum to remain the same whether the target type
8251 is complete or not. */
8252 if ((at->dw_attr == DW_AT_type
8253 && (tag == DW_TAG_pointer_type
8254 || tag == DW_TAG_reference_type
8255 || tag == DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type))
8256 || (at->dw_attr == DW_AT_friend
8257 && tag == DW_TAG_friend))
8259 dw_attr_ref name_attr = get_AT (target_die, DW_AT_name);
8261 if (name_attr != NULL)
8263 dw_die_ref decl = get_AT_ref (target_die, DW_AT_specification);
8265 if (decl == NULL)
8266 decl = target_die;
8267 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('N');
8268 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr);
8269 if (decl->die_parent != NULL)
8270 checksum_die_context (decl->die_parent, ctx);
8271 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('E');
8272 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (name_attr));
8273 return;
8277 /* For all other references to another DIE, we check to see if the
8278 target DIE has already been visited. If it has, we emit a
8279 backward reference; if not, we descend recursively. */
8280 if (target_die->die_mark > 0)
8282 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('R');
8283 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr);
8284 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (target_die->die_mark);
8286 else
8288 dw_die_ref decl = get_AT_ref (target_die, DW_AT_specification);
8290 if (decl == NULL)
8291 decl = target_die;
8292 target_die->die_mark = ++(*mark);
8293 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('T');
8294 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr);
8295 if (decl->die_parent != NULL)
8296 checksum_die_context (decl->die_parent, ctx);
8297 die_checksum_ordered (target_die, ctx, mark);
8299 return;
8302 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('A');
8303 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr);
8305 switch (AT_class (at))
8307 case dw_val_class_const:
8308 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_sdata);
8309 CHECKSUM_SLEB128 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_int);
8310 break;
8312 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
8313 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_sdata);
8314 CHECKSUM_SLEB128 ((int) at->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned);
8315 break;
8317 case dw_val_class_const_double:
8318 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_block);
8319 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (sizeof (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_double));
8320 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_double);
8321 break;
8323 case dw_val_class_vec:
8324 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_block);
8325 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (sizeof (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec));
8326 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec);
8327 break;
8329 case dw_val_class_flag:
8330 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_flag);
8331 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag ? 1 : 0);
8332 break;
8334 case dw_val_class_str:
8335 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_string);
8336 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (at));
8337 break;
8339 case dw_val_class_addr:
8340 r = AT_addr (at);
8341 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (r) == SYMBOL_REF);
8342 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_string);
8343 CHECKSUM_STRING (XSTR (r, 0));
8344 break;
8346 case dw_val_class_offset:
8347 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_sdata);
8348 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
8349 break;
8351 case dw_val_class_loc:
8352 for (loc = AT_loc (at); loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
8353 loc_checksum_ordered (loc, ctx);
8354 break;
8356 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
8357 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
8358 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
8359 case dw_val_class_macptr:
8360 break;
8362 case dw_val_class_file:
8363 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_string);
8364 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_file (at)->filename);
8365 break;
8367 case dw_val_class_data8:
8368 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_data8);
8369 break;
8371 default:
8372 break;
8376 struct checksum_attributes
8378 dw_attr_ref at_name;
8379 dw_attr_ref at_type;
8380 dw_attr_ref at_friend;
8381 dw_attr_ref at_accessibility;
8382 dw_attr_ref at_address_class;
8383 dw_attr_ref at_allocated;
8384 dw_attr_ref at_artificial;
8385 dw_attr_ref at_associated;
8386 dw_attr_ref at_binary_scale;
8387 dw_attr_ref at_bit_offset;
8388 dw_attr_ref at_bit_size;
8389 dw_attr_ref at_bit_stride;
8390 dw_attr_ref at_byte_size;
8391 dw_attr_ref at_byte_stride;
8392 dw_attr_ref at_const_value;
8393 dw_attr_ref at_containing_type;
8394 dw_attr_ref at_count;
8395 dw_attr_ref at_data_location;
8396 dw_attr_ref at_data_member_location;
8397 dw_attr_ref at_decimal_scale;
8398 dw_attr_ref at_decimal_sign;
8399 dw_attr_ref at_default_value;
8400 dw_attr_ref at_digit_count;
8401 dw_attr_ref at_discr;
8402 dw_attr_ref at_discr_list;
8403 dw_attr_ref at_discr_value;
8404 dw_attr_ref at_encoding;
8405 dw_attr_ref at_endianity;
8406 dw_attr_ref at_explicit;
8407 dw_attr_ref at_is_optional;
8408 dw_attr_ref at_location;
8409 dw_attr_ref at_lower_bound;
8410 dw_attr_ref at_mutable;
8411 dw_attr_ref at_ordering;
8412 dw_attr_ref at_picture_string;
8413 dw_attr_ref at_prototyped;
8414 dw_attr_ref at_small;
8415 dw_attr_ref at_segment;
8416 dw_attr_ref at_string_length;
8417 dw_attr_ref at_threads_scaled;
8418 dw_attr_ref at_upper_bound;
8419 dw_attr_ref at_use_location;
8420 dw_attr_ref at_use_UTF8;
8421 dw_attr_ref at_variable_parameter;
8422 dw_attr_ref at_virtuality;
8423 dw_attr_ref at_visibility;
8424 dw_attr_ref at_vtable_elem_location;
8427 /* Collect the attributes that we will want to use for the checksum. */
8429 static void
8430 collect_checksum_attributes (struct checksum_attributes *attrs, dw_die_ref die)
8432 dw_attr_ref a;
8433 unsigned ix;
8435 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
8437 switch (a->dw_attr)
8439 case DW_AT_name:
8440 attrs->at_name = a;
8441 break;
8442 case DW_AT_type:
8443 attrs->at_type = a;
8444 break;
8445 case DW_AT_friend:
8446 attrs->at_friend = a;
8447 break;
8448 case DW_AT_accessibility:
8449 attrs->at_accessibility = a;
8450 break;
8451 case DW_AT_address_class:
8452 attrs->at_address_class = a;
8453 break;
8454 case DW_AT_allocated:
8455 attrs->at_allocated = a;
8456 break;
8457 case DW_AT_artificial:
8458 attrs->at_artificial = a;
8459 break;
8460 case DW_AT_associated:
8461 attrs->at_associated = a;
8462 break;
8463 case DW_AT_binary_scale:
8464 attrs->at_binary_scale = a;
8465 break;
8466 case DW_AT_bit_offset:
8467 attrs->at_bit_offset = a;
8468 break;
8469 case DW_AT_bit_size:
8470 attrs->at_bit_size = a;
8471 break;
8472 case DW_AT_bit_stride:
8473 attrs->at_bit_stride = a;
8474 break;
8475 case DW_AT_byte_size:
8476 attrs->at_byte_size = a;
8477 break;
8478 case DW_AT_byte_stride:
8479 attrs->at_byte_stride = a;
8480 break;
8481 case DW_AT_const_value:
8482 attrs->at_const_value = a;
8483 break;
8484 case DW_AT_containing_type:
8485 attrs->at_containing_type = a;
8486 break;
8487 case DW_AT_count:
8488 attrs->at_count = a;
8489 break;
8490 case DW_AT_data_location:
8491 attrs->at_data_location = a;
8492 break;
8493 case DW_AT_data_member_location:
8494 attrs->at_data_member_location = a;
8495 break;
8496 case DW_AT_decimal_scale:
8497 attrs->at_decimal_scale = a;
8498 break;
8499 case DW_AT_decimal_sign:
8500 attrs->at_decimal_sign = a;
8501 break;
8502 case DW_AT_default_value:
8503 attrs->at_default_value = a;
8504 break;
8505 case DW_AT_digit_count:
8506 attrs->at_digit_count = a;
8507 break;
8508 case DW_AT_discr:
8509 attrs->at_discr = a;
8510 break;
8511 case DW_AT_discr_list:
8512 attrs->at_discr_list = a;
8513 break;
8514 case DW_AT_discr_value:
8515 attrs->at_discr_value = a;
8516 break;
8517 case DW_AT_encoding:
8518 attrs->at_encoding = a;
8519 break;
8520 case DW_AT_endianity:
8521 attrs->at_endianity = a;
8522 break;
8523 case DW_AT_explicit:
8524 attrs->at_explicit = a;
8525 break;
8526 case DW_AT_is_optional:
8527 attrs->at_is_optional = a;
8528 break;
8529 case DW_AT_location:
8530 attrs->at_location = a;
8531 break;
8532 case DW_AT_lower_bound:
8533 attrs->at_lower_bound = a;
8534 break;
8535 case DW_AT_mutable:
8536 attrs->at_mutable = a;
8537 break;
8538 case DW_AT_ordering:
8539 attrs->at_ordering = a;
8540 break;
8541 case DW_AT_picture_string:
8542 attrs->at_picture_string = a;
8543 break;
8544 case DW_AT_prototyped:
8545 attrs->at_prototyped = a;
8546 break;
8547 case DW_AT_small:
8548 attrs->at_small = a;
8549 break;
8550 case DW_AT_segment:
8551 attrs->at_segment = a;
8552 break;
8553 case DW_AT_string_length:
8554 attrs->at_string_length = a;
8555 break;
8556 case DW_AT_threads_scaled:
8557 attrs->at_threads_scaled = a;
8558 break;
8559 case DW_AT_upper_bound:
8560 attrs->at_upper_bound = a;
8561 break;
8562 case DW_AT_use_location:
8563 attrs->at_use_location = a;
8564 break;
8565 case DW_AT_use_UTF8:
8566 attrs->at_use_UTF8 = a;
8567 break;
8568 case DW_AT_variable_parameter:
8569 attrs->at_variable_parameter = a;
8570 break;
8571 case DW_AT_virtuality:
8572 attrs->at_virtuality = a;
8573 break;
8574 case DW_AT_visibility:
8575 attrs->at_visibility = a;
8576 break;
8577 case DW_AT_vtable_elem_location:
8578 attrs->at_vtable_elem_location = a;
8579 break;
8580 default:
8581 break;
8586 /* Calculate the checksum of a DIE, using an ordered subset of attributes. */
8588 static void
8589 die_checksum_ordered (dw_die_ref die, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
8591 dw_die_ref c;
8592 dw_die_ref decl;
8593 struct checksum_attributes attrs;
8595 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('D');
8596 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (die->die_tag);
8598 memset (&attrs, 0, sizeof (attrs));
8600 decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
8601 if (decl != NULL)
8602 collect_checksum_attributes (&attrs, decl);
8603 collect_checksum_attributes (&attrs, die);
8605 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_name);
8606 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_accessibility);
8607 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_address_class);
8608 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_allocated);
8609 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_artificial);
8610 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_associated);
8611 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_binary_scale);
8612 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_bit_offset);
8613 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_bit_size);
8614 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_bit_stride);
8615 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_byte_size);
8616 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_byte_stride);
8617 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_const_value);
8618 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_containing_type);
8619 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_count);
8620 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_data_location);
8621 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_data_member_location);
8622 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_decimal_scale);
8623 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_decimal_sign);
8624 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_default_value);
8625 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_digit_count);
8626 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_discr);
8627 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_discr_list);
8628 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_discr_value);
8629 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_encoding);
8630 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_endianity);
8631 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_explicit);
8632 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_is_optional);
8633 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_location);
8634 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_lower_bound);
8635 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_mutable);
8636 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_ordering);
8637 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_picture_string);
8638 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_prototyped);
8639 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_small);
8640 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_segment);
8641 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_string_length);
8642 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_threads_scaled);
8643 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_upper_bound);
8644 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_use_location);
8645 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_use_UTF8);
8646 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_variable_parameter);
8647 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_virtuality);
8648 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_visibility);
8649 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_vtable_elem_location);
8650 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_type);
8651 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_friend);
8653 /* Checksum the child DIEs, except for nested types and member functions. */
8654 c = die->die_child;
8655 if (c) do {
8656 dw_attr_ref name_attr;
8658 c = c->die_sib;
8659 name_attr = get_AT (c, DW_AT_name);
8660 if ((is_type_die (c) || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
8661 && name_attr != NULL)
8663 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('S');
8664 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (c->die_tag);
8665 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (name_attr));
8667 else
8669 /* Mark this DIE so it gets processed when unmarking. */
8670 if (c->die_mark == 0)
8671 c->die_mark = -1;
8672 die_checksum_ordered (c, ctx, mark);
8674 } while (c != die->die_child);
8676 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (0);
8679 #undef CHECKSUM
8680 #undef CHECKSUM_STRING
8681 #undef CHECKSUM_ATTR
8682 #undef CHECKSUM_LEB128
8683 #undef CHECKSUM_ULEB128
8685 /* Generate the type signature for DIE. This is computed by generating an
8686 MD5 checksum over the DIE's tag, its relevant attributes, and its
8687 children. Attributes that are references to other DIEs are processed
8688 by recursion, using the MARK field to prevent infinite recursion.
8689 If the DIE is nested inside a namespace or another type, we also
8690 need to include that context in the signature. The lower 64 bits
8691 of the resulting MD5 checksum comprise the signature. */
8693 static void
8694 generate_type_signature (dw_die_ref die, comdat_type_node *type_node)
8696 int mark;
8697 const char *name;
8698 unsigned char checksum[16];
8699 struct md5_ctx ctx;
8700 dw_die_ref decl;
8702 name = get_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name);
8703 decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
8705 /* First, compute a signature for just the type name (and its surrounding
8706 context, if any. This is stored in the type unit DIE for link-time
8707 ODR (one-definition rule) checking. */
8709 if (is_cxx() && name != NULL)
8711 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
8713 /* Checksum the names of surrounding namespaces and structures. */
8714 if (decl != NULL && decl->die_parent != NULL)
8715 checksum_die_context (decl->die_parent, &ctx);
8717 md5_process_bytes (&die->die_tag, sizeof (die->die_tag), &ctx);
8718 md5_process_bytes (name, strlen (name) + 1, &ctx);
8719 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
8721 add_AT_data8 (type_node->root_die, DW_AT_GNU_odr_signature, &checksum[8]);
8724 /* Next, compute the complete type signature. */
8726 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
8727 mark = 1;
8728 die->die_mark = mark;
8730 /* Checksum the names of surrounding namespaces and structures. */
8731 if (decl != NULL && decl->die_parent != NULL)
8732 checksum_die_context (decl->die_parent, &ctx);
8734 /* Checksum the DIE and its children. */
8735 die_checksum_ordered (die, &ctx, &mark);
8736 unmark_all_dies (die);
8737 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
8739 /* Store the signature in the type node and link the type DIE and the
8740 type node together. */
8741 memcpy (type_node->signature, &checksum[16 - DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE],
8742 DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE);
8743 die->die_id.die_type_node = type_node;
8744 type_node->type_die = die;
8746 /* If the DIE is a specification, link its declaration to the type node
8747 as well. */
8748 if (decl != NULL)
8749 decl->die_id.die_type_node = type_node;
8752 /* Do the location expressions look same? */
8753 static inline int
8754 same_loc_p (dw_loc_descr_ref loc1, dw_loc_descr_ref loc2, int *mark)
8756 return loc1->dw_loc_opc == loc2->dw_loc_opc
8757 && same_dw_val_p (&loc1->dw_loc_oprnd1, &loc2->dw_loc_oprnd1, mark)
8758 && same_dw_val_p (&loc1->dw_loc_oprnd2, &loc2->dw_loc_oprnd2, mark);
8761 /* Do the values look the same? */
8762 static int
8763 same_dw_val_p (const dw_val_node *v1, const dw_val_node *v2, int *mark)
8765 dw_loc_descr_ref loc1, loc2;
8766 rtx r1, r2;
8768 if (v1->val_class != v2->val_class)
8769 return 0;
8771 switch (v1->val_class)
8773 case dw_val_class_const:
8774 return v1->v.val_int == v2->v.val_int;
8775 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
8776 return v1->v.val_unsigned == v2->v.val_unsigned;
8777 case dw_val_class_const_double:
8778 return v1->v.val_double.high == v2->v.val_double.high
8779 && v1->v.val_double.low == v2->v.val_double.low;
8780 case dw_val_class_vec:
8781 if (v1->v.val_vec.length != v2->v.val_vec.length
8782 || v1->v.val_vec.elt_size != v2->v.val_vec.elt_size)
8783 return 0;
8784 if (memcmp (v1->v.val_vec.array, v2->v.val_vec.array,
8785 v1->v.val_vec.length * v1->v.val_vec.elt_size))
8786 return 0;
8787 return 1;
8788 case dw_val_class_flag:
8789 return v1->v.val_flag == v2->v.val_flag;
8790 case dw_val_class_str:
8791 return !strcmp(v1->v.val_str->str, v2->v.val_str->str);
8793 case dw_val_class_addr:
8794 r1 = v1->v.val_addr;
8795 r2 = v2->v.val_addr;
8796 if (GET_CODE (r1) != GET_CODE (r2))
8797 return 0;
8798 return !rtx_equal_p (r1, r2);
8800 case dw_val_class_offset:
8801 return v1->v.val_offset == v2->v.val_offset;
8803 case dw_val_class_loc:
8804 for (loc1 = v1->v.val_loc, loc2 = v2->v.val_loc;
8805 loc1 && loc2;
8806 loc1 = loc1->dw_loc_next, loc2 = loc2->dw_loc_next)
8807 if (!same_loc_p (loc1, loc2, mark))
8808 return 0;
8809 return !loc1 && !loc2;
8811 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
8812 return same_die_p (v1->v.val_die_ref.die, v2->v.val_die_ref.die, mark);
8814 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
8815 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
8816 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
8817 case dw_val_class_macptr:
8818 return 1;
8820 case dw_val_class_file:
8821 return v1->v.val_file == v2->v.val_file;
8823 case dw_val_class_data8:
8824 return !memcmp (v1->v.val_data8, v2->v.val_data8, 8);
8826 default:
8827 return 1;
8831 /* Do the attributes look the same? */
8833 static int
8834 same_attr_p (dw_attr_ref at1, dw_attr_ref at2, int *mark)
8836 if (at1->dw_attr != at2->dw_attr)
8837 return 0;
8839 /* We don't care that this was compiled with a different compiler
8840 snapshot; if the output is the same, that's what matters. */
8841 if (at1->dw_attr == DW_AT_producer)
8842 return 1;
8844 return same_dw_val_p (&at1->dw_attr_val, &at2->dw_attr_val, mark);
8847 /* Do the dies look the same? */
8849 static int
8850 same_die_p (dw_die_ref die1, dw_die_ref die2, int *mark)
8852 dw_die_ref c1, c2;
8853 dw_attr_ref a1;
8854 unsigned ix;
8856 /* To avoid infinite recursion. */
8857 if (die1->die_mark)
8858 return die1->die_mark == die2->die_mark;
8859 die1->die_mark = die2->die_mark = ++(*mark);
8861 if (die1->die_tag != die2->die_tag)
8862 return 0;
8864 if (VEC_length (dw_attr_node, die1->die_attr)
8865 != VEC_length (dw_attr_node, die2->die_attr))
8866 return 0;
8868 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die1->die_attr, ix, a1); ix++)
8869 if (!same_attr_p (a1, VEC_index (dw_attr_node, die2->die_attr, ix), mark))
8870 return 0;
8872 c1 = die1->die_child;
8873 c2 = die2->die_child;
8874 if (! c1)
8876 if (c2)
8877 return 0;
8879 else
8880 for (;;)
8882 if (!same_die_p (c1, c2, mark))
8883 return 0;
8884 c1 = c1->die_sib;
8885 c2 = c2->die_sib;
8886 if (c1 == die1->die_child)
8888 if (c2 == die2->die_child)
8889 break;
8890 else
8891 return 0;
8895 return 1;
8898 /* Do the dies look the same? Wrapper around same_die_p. */
8900 static int
8901 same_die_p_wrap (dw_die_ref die1, dw_die_ref die2)
8903 int mark = 0;
8904 int ret = same_die_p (die1, die2, &mark);
8906 unmark_all_dies (die1);
8907 unmark_all_dies (die2);
8909 return ret;
8912 /* The prefix to attach to symbols on DIEs in the current comdat debug
8913 info section. */
8914 static char *comdat_symbol_id;
8916 /* The index of the current symbol within the current comdat CU. */
8917 static unsigned int comdat_symbol_number;
8919 /* Calculate the MD5 checksum of the compilation unit DIE UNIT_DIE and its
8920 children, and set comdat_symbol_id accordingly. */
8922 static void
8923 compute_section_prefix (dw_die_ref unit_die)
8925 const char *die_name = get_AT_string (unit_die, DW_AT_name);
8926 const char *base = die_name ? lbasename (die_name) : "anonymous";
8927 char *name = XALLOCAVEC (char, strlen (base) + 64);
8928 char *p;
8929 int i, mark;
8930 unsigned char checksum[16];
8931 struct md5_ctx ctx;
8933 /* Compute the checksum of the DIE, then append part of it as hex digits to
8934 the name filename of the unit. */
8936 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
8937 mark = 0;
8938 die_checksum (unit_die, &ctx, &mark);
8939 unmark_all_dies (unit_die);
8940 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
8942 sprintf (name, "%s.", base);
8943 clean_symbol_name (name);
8945 p = name + strlen (name);
8946 for (i = 0; i < 4; i++)
8948 sprintf (p, "%.2x", checksum[i]);
8949 p += 2;
8952 comdat_symbol_id = unit_die->die_id.die_symbol = xstrdup (name);
8953 comdat_symbol_number = 0;
8956 /* Returns nonzero if DIE represents a type, in the sense of TYPE_P. */
8958 static int
8959 is_type_die (dw_die_ref die)
8961 switch (die->die_tag)
8963 case DW_TAG_array_type:
8964 case DW_TAG_class_type:
8965 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
8966 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
8967 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
8968 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
8969 case DW_TAG_string_type:
8970 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
8971 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
8972 case DW_TAG_union_type:
8973 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
8974 case DW_TAG_set_type:
8975 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
8976 case DW_TAG_base_type:
8977 case DW_TAG_const_type:
8978 case DW_TAG_file_type:
8979 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
8980 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
8981 case DW_TAG_typedef:
8982 return 1;
8983 default:
8984 return 0;
8988 /* Returns 1 iff C is the sort of DIE that should go into a COMDAT CU.
8989 Basically, we want to choose the bits that are likely to be shared between
8990 compilations (types) and leave out the bits that are specific to individual
8991 compilations (functions). */
8993 static int
8994 is_comdat_die (dw_die_ref c)
8996 /* I think we want to leave base types and __vtbl_ptr_type in the main CU, as
8997 we do for stabs. The advantage is a greater likelihood of sharing between
8998 objects that don't include headers in the same order (and therefore would
8999 put the base types in a different comdat). jason 8/28/00 */
9001 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type)
9002 return 0;
9004 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_pointer_type
9005 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_reference_type
9006 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_const_type
9007 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_volatile_type)
9009 dw_die_ref t = get_AT_ref (c, DW_AT_type);
9011 return t ? is_comdat_die (t) : 0;
9014 return is_type_die (c);
9017 /* Returns 1 iff C is the sort of DIE that might be referred to from another
9018 compilation unit. */
9020 static int
9021 is_symbol_die (dw_die_ref c)
9023 return (is_type_die (c)
9024 || is_declaration_die (c)
9025 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace
9026 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_module);
9029 static char *
9030 gen_internal_sym (const char *prefix)
9032 char buf[256];
9034 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (buf, prefix, label_num++);
9035 return xstrdup (buf);
9038 /* Assign symbols to all worthy DIEs under DIE. */
9040 static void
9041 assign_symbol_names (dw_die_ref die)
9043 dw_die_ref c;
9045 if (is_symbol_die (die))
9047 if (comdat_symbol_id)
9049 char *p = XALLOCAVEC (char, strlen (comdat_symbol_id) + 64);
9051 sprintf (p, "%s.%s.%x", DIE_LABEL_PREFIX,
9052 comdat_symbol_id, comdat_symbol_number++);
9053 die->die_id.die_symbol = xstrdup (p);
9055 else
9056 die->die_id.die_symbol = gen_internal_sym ("LDIE");
9059 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, assign_symbol_names (c));
9062 struct cu_hash_table_entry
9064 dw_die_ref cu;
9065 unsigned min_comdat_num, max_comdat_num;
9066 struct cu_hash_table_entry *next;
9069 /* Routines to manipulate hash table of CUs. */
9070 static hashval_t
9071 htab_cu_hash (const void *of)
9073 const struct cu_hash_table_entry *const entry =
9074 (const struct cu_hash_table_entry *) of;
9076 return htab_hash_string (entry->cu->die_id.die_symbol);
9079 static int
9080 htab_cu_eq (const void *of1, const void *of2)
9082 const struct cu_hash_table_entry *const entry1 =
9083 (const struct cu_hash_table_entry *) of1;
9084 const struct die_struct *const entry2 = (const struct die_struct *) of2;
9086 return !strcmp (entry1->cu->die_id.die_symbol, entry2->die_id.die_symbol);
9089 static void
9090 htab_cu_del (void *what)
9092 struct cu_hash_table_entry *next,
9093 *entry = (struct cu_hash_table_entry *) what;
9095 while (entry)
9097 next = entry->next;
9098 free (entry);
9099 entry = next;
9103 /* Check whether we have already seen this CU and set up SYM_NUM
9104 accordingly. */
9105 static int
9106 check_duplicate_cu (dw_die_ref cu, htab_t htable, unsigned int *sym_num)
9108 struct cu_hash_table_entry dummy;
9109 struct cu_hash_table_entry **slot, *entry, *last = &dummy;
9111 dummy.max_comdat_num = 0;
9113 slot = (struct cu_hash_table_entry **)
9114 htab_find_slot_with_hash (htable, cu, htab_hash_string (cu->die_id.die_symbol),
9115 INSERT);
9116 entry = *slot;
9118 for (; entry; last = entry, entry = entry->next)
9120 if (same_die_p_wrap (cu, entry->cu))
9121 break;
9124 if (entry)
9126 *sym_num = entry->min_comdat_num;
9127 return 1;
9130 entry = XCNEW (struct cu_hash_table_entry);
9131 entry->cu = cu;
9132 entry->min_comdat_num = *sym_num = last->max_comdat_num;
9133 entry->next = *slot;
9134 *slot = entry;
9136 return 0;
9139 /* Record SYM_NUM to record of CU in HTABLE. */
9140 static void
9141 record_comdat_symbol_number (dw_die_ref cu, htab_t htable, unsigned int sym_num)
9143 struct cu_hash_table_entry **slot, *entry;
9145 slot = (struct cu_hash_table_entry **)
9146 htab_find_slot_with_hash (htable, cu, htab_hash_string (cu->die_id.die_symbol),
9147 NO_INSERT);
9148 entry = *slot;
9150 entry->max_comdat_num = sym_num;
9153 /* Traverse the DIE (which is always comp_unit_die), and set up
9154 additional compilation units for each of the include files we see
9155 bracketed by BINCL/EINCL. */
9157 static void
9158 break_out_includes (dw_die_ref die)
9160 dw_die_ref c;
9161 dw_die_ref unit = NULL;
9162 limbo_die_node *node, **pnode;
9163 htab_t cu_hash_table;
9165 c = die->die_child;
9166 if (c) do {
9167 dw_die_ref prev = c;
9168 c = c->die_sib;
9169 while (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL
9170 || (unit && is_comdat_die (c)))
9172 dw_die_ref next = c->die_sib;
9174 /* This DIE is for a secondary CU; remove it from the main one. */
9175 remove_child_with_prev (c, prev);
9177 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL)
9178 unit = push_new_compile_unit (unit, c);
9179 else if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL)
9180 unit = pop_compile_unit (unit);
9181 else
9182 add_child_die (unit, c);
9183 c = next;
9184 if (c == die->die_child)
9185 break;
9187 } while (c != die->die_child);
9189 #if 0
9190 /* We can only use this in debugging, since the frontend doesn't check
9191 to make sure that we leave every include file we enter. */
9192 gcc_assert (!unit);
9193 #endif
9195 assign_symbol_names (die);
9196 cu_hash_table = htab_create (10, htab_cu_hash, htab_cu_eq, htab_cu_del);
9197 for (node = limbo_die_list, pnode = &limbo_die_list;
9198 node;
9199 node = node->next)
9201 int is_dupl;
9203 compute_section_prefix (node->die);
9204 is_dupl = check_duplicate_cu (node->die, cu_hash_table,
9205 &comdat_symbol_number);
9206 assign_symbol_names (node->die);
9207 if (is_dupl)
9208 *pnode = node->next;
9209 else
9211 pnode = &node->next;
9212 record_comdat_symbol_number (node->die, cu_hash_table,
9213 comdat_symbol_number);
9216 htab_delete (cu_hash_table);
9219 /* Return non-zero if this DIE is a declaration. */
9221 static int
9222 is_declaration_die (dw_die_ref die)
9224 dw_attr_ref a;
9225 unsigned ix;
9227 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
9228 if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_declaration)
9229 return 1;
9231 return 0;
9234 /* Return non-zero if this is a type DIE that should be moved to a
9235 COMDAT .debug_types section. */
9237 static int
9238 should_move_die_to_comdat (dw_die_ref die)
9240 switch (die->die_tag)
9242 case DW_TAG_class_type:
9243 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
9244 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
9245 case DW_TAG_union_type:
9246 /* Don't move declarations or inlined instances. */
9247 if (is_declaration_die (die) || get_AT (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin))
9248 return 0;
9249 return 1;
9250 case DW_TAG_array_type:
9251 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
9252 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
9253 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
9254 case DW_TAG_string_type:
9255 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
9256 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
9257 case DW_TAG_set_type:
9258 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
9259 case DW_TAG_base_type:
9260 case DW_TAG_const_type:
9261 case DW_TAG_file_type:
9262 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
9263 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
9264 case DW_TAG_typedef:
9265 default:
9266 return 0;
9270 /* Make a clone of DIE. */
9272 static dw_die_ref
9273 clone_die (dw_die_ref die)
9275 dw_die_ref clone;
9276 dw_attr_ref a;
9277 unsigned ix;
9279 clone = GGC_CNEW (die_node);
9280 clone->die_tag = die->die_tag;
9282 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
9283 add_dwarf_attr (clone, a);
9285 return clone;
9288 /* Make a clone of the tree rooted at DIE. */
9290 static dw_die_ref
9291 clone_tree (dw_die_ref die)
9293 dw_die_ref c;
9294 dw_die_ref clone = clone_die (die);
9296 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, add_child_die (clone, clone_tree(c)));
9298 return clone;
9301 /* Make a clone of DIE as a declaration. */
9303 static dw_die_ref
9304 clone_as_declaration (dw_die_ref die)
9306 dw_die_ref clone;
9307 dw_die_ref decl;
9308 dw_attr_ref a;
9309 unsigned ix;
9311 /* If the DIE is already a declaration, just clone it. */
9312 if (is_declaration_die (die))
9313 return clone_die (die);
9315 /* If the DIE is a specification, just clone its declaration DIE. */
9316 decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
9317 if (decl != NULL)
9318 return clone_die (decl);
9320 clone = GGC_CNEW (die_node);
9321 clone->die_tag = die->die_tag;
9323 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
9325 /* We don't want to copy over all attributes.
9326 For example we don't want DW_AT_byte_size because otherwise we will no
9327 longer have a declaration and GDB will treat it as a definition. */
9329 switch (a->dw_attr)
9331 case DW_AT_artificial:
9332 case DW_AT_containing_type:
9333 case DW_AT_external:
9334 case DW_AT_name:
9335 case DW_AT_type:
9336 case DW_AT_virtuality:
9337 case DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name:
9338 add_dwarf_attr (clone, a);
9339 break;
9340 case DW_AT_byte_size:
9341 default:
9342 break;
9346 if (die->die_id.die_type_node)
9347 add_AT_die_ref (clone, DW_AT_signature, die);
9349 add_AT_flag (clone, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
9350 return clone;
9353 /* Copy the declaration context to the new compile unit DIE. This includes
9354 any surrounding namespace or type declarations. If the DIE has an
9355 AT_specification attribute, it also includes attributes and children
9356 attached to the specification. */
9358 static void
9359 copy_declaration_context (dw_die_ref unit, dw_die_ref die)
9361 dw_die_ref decl;
9362 dw_die_ref new_decl;
9364 decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
9365 if (decl == NULL)
9366 decl = die;
9367 else
9369 unsigned ix;
9370 dw_die_ref c;
9371 dw_attr_ref a;
9373 /* Copy the type node pointer from the new DIE to the original
9374 declaration DIE so we can forward references later. */
9375 decl->die_id.die_type_node = die->die_id.die_type_node;
9377 remove_AT (die, DW_AT_specification);
9379 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, decl->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
9381 if (a->dw_attr != DW_AT_name
9382 && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_declaration
9383 && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_external)
9384 add_dwarf_attr (die, a);
9387 FOR_EACH_CHILD (decl, c, add_child_die (die, clone_tree(c)));
9390 if (decl->die_parent != NULL
9391 && decl->die_parent->die_tag != DW_TAG_compile_unit
9392 && decl->die_parent->die_tag != DW_TAG_type_unit)
9394 new_decl = copy_ancestor_tree (unit, decl, NULL);
9395 if (new_decl != NULL)
9397 remove_AT (new_decl, DW_AT_signature);
9398 add_AT_specification (die, new_decl);
9403 /* Generate the skeleton ancestor tree for the given NODE, then clone
9404 the DIE and add the clone into the tree. */
9406 static void
9407 generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (skeleton_chain_node *node)
9409 if (node->new_die != NULL)
9410 return;
9412 node->new_die = clone_as_declaration (node->old_die);
9414 if (node->parent != NULL)
9416 generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (node->parent);
9417 add_child_die (node->parent->new_die, node->new_die);
9421 /* Generate a skeleton tree of DIEs containing any declarations that are
9422 found in the original tree. We traverse the tree looking for declaration
9423 DIEs, and construct the skeleton from the bottom up whenever we find one. */
9425 static void
9426 generate_skeleton_bottom_up (skeleton_chain_node *parent)
9428 skeleton_chain_node node;
9429 dw_die_ref c;
9430 dw_die_ref first;
9431 dw_die_ref prev = NULL;
9432 dw_die_ref next = NULL;
9434 node.parent = parent;
9436 first = c = parent->old_die->die_child;
9437 if (c)
9438 next = c->die_sib;
9439 if (c) do {
9440 if (prev == NULL || prev->die_sib == c)
9441 prev = c;
9442 c = next;
9443 next = (c == first ? NULL : c->die_sib);
9444 node.old_die = c;
9445 node.new_die = NULL;
9446 if (is_declaration_die (c))
9448 /* Clone the existing DIE, move the original to the skeleton
9449 tree (which is in the main CU), and put the clone, with
9450 all the original's children, where the original came from. */
9451 dw_die_ref clone = clone_die (c);
9452 move_all_children (c, clone);
9454 replace_child (c, clone, prev);
9455 generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (parent);
9456 add_child_die (parent->new_die, c);
9457 node.new_die = c;
9458 c = clone;
9460 generate_skeleton_bottom_up (&node);
9461 } while (next != NULL);
9464 /* Wrapper function for generate_skeleton_bottom_up. */
9466 static dw_die_ref
9467 generate_skeleton (dw_die_ref die)
9469 skeleton_chain_node node;
9471 node.old_die = die;
9472 node.new_die = NULL;
9473 node.parent = NULL;
9475 /* If this type definition is nested inside another type,
9476 always leave at least a declaration in its place. */
9477 if (die->die_parent != NULL && is_type_die (die->die_parent))
9478 node.new_die = clone_as_declaration (die);
9480 generate_skeleton_bottom_up (&node);
9481 return node.new_die;
9484 /* Remove the DIE from its parent, possibly replacing it with a cloned
9485 declaration. The original DIE will be moved to a new compile unit
9486 so that existing references to it follow it to the new location. If
9487 any of the original DIE's descendants is a declaration, we need to
9488 replace the original DIE with a skeleton tree and move the
9489 declarations back into the skeleton tree. */
9491 static dw_die_ref
9492 remove_child_or_replace_with_skeleton (dw_die_ref child, dw_die_ref prev)
9494 dw_die_ref skeleton;
9496 skeleton = generate_skeleton (child);
9497 if (skeleton == NULL)
9498 remove_child_with_prev (child, prev);
9499 else
9501 skeleton->die_id.die_type_node = child->die_id.die_type_node;
9502 replace_child (child, skeleton, prev);
9505 return skeleton;
9508 /* Traverse the DIE and set up additional .debug_types sections for each
9509 type worthy of being placed in a COMDAT section. */
9511 static void
9512 break_out_comdat_types (dw_die_ref die)
9514 dw_die_ref c;
9515 dw_die_ref first;
9516 dw_die_ref prev = NULL;
9517 dw_die_ref next = NULL;
9518 dw_die_ref unit = NULL;
9520 first = c = die->die_child;
9521 if (c)
9522 next = c->die_sib;
9523 if (c) do {
9524 if (prev == NULL || prev->die_sib == c)
9525 prev = c;
9526 c = next;
9527 next = (c == first ? NULL : c->die_sib);
9528 if (should_move_die_to_comdat (c))
9530 dw_die_ref replacement;
9531 comdat_type_node_ref type_node;
9533 /* Create a new type unit DIE as the root for the new tree, and
9534 add it to the list of comdat types. */
9535 unit = new_die (DW_TAG_type_unit, NULL, NULL);
9536 add_AT_unsigned (unit, DW_AT_language,
9537 get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language));
9538 type_node = GGC_CNEW (comdat_type_node);
9539 type_node->root_die = unit;
9540 type_node->next = comdat_type_list;
9541 comdat_type_list = type_node;
9543 /* Generate the type signature. */
9544 generate_type_signature (c, type_node);
9546 /* Copy the declaration context, attributes, and children of the
9547 declaration into the new compile unit DIE. */
9548 copy_declaration_context (unit, c);
9550 /* Remove this DIE from the main CU. */
9551 replacement = remove_child_or_replace_with_skeleton (c, prev);
9553 /* Break out nested types into their own type units. */
9554 break_out_comdat_types (c);
9556 /* Add the DIE to the new compunit. */
9557 add_child_die (unit, c);
9559 if (replacement != NULL)
9560 c = replacement;
9562 else if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace
9563 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type
9564 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_structure_type
9565 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_union_type)
9567 /* Look for nested types that can be broken out. */
9568 break_out_comdat_types (c);
9570 } while (next != NULL);
9573 /* Structure to map a DIE in one CU to its copy in a comdat type unit. */
9575 struct decl_table_entry
9577 dw_die_ref orig;
9578 dw_die_ref copy;
9581 /* Routines to manipulate hash table of copied declarations. */
9583 static hashval_t
9584 htab_decl_hash (const void *of)
9586 const struct decl_table_entry *const entry =
9587 (const struct decl_table_entry *) of;
9589 return htab_hash_pointer (entry->orig);
9592 static int
9593 htab_decl_eq (const void *of1, const void *of2)
9595 const struct decl_table_entry *const entry1 =
9596 (const struct decl_table_entry *) of1;
9597 const struct die_struct *const entry2 = (const struct die_struct *) of2;
9599 return entry1->orig == entry2;
9602 static void
9603 htab_decl_del (void *what)
9605 struct decl_table_entry *entry = (struct decl_table_entry *) what;
9607 free (entry);
9610 /* Copy DIE and its ancestors, up to, but not including, the compile unit
9611 or type unit entry, to a new tree. Adds the new tree to UNIT and returns
9612 a pointer to the copy of DIE. If DECL_TABLE is provided, it is used
9613 to check if the ancestor has already been copied into UNIT. */
9615 static dw_die_ref
9616 copy_ancestor_tree (dw_die_ref unit, dw_die_ref die, htab_t decl_table)
9618 dw_die_ref parent = die->die_parent;
9619 dw_die_ref new_parent = unit;
9620 dw_die_ref copy;
9621 void **slot = NULL;
9622 struct decl_table_entry *entry = NULL;
9624 if (decl_table)
9626 /* Check if the entry has already been copied to UNIT. */
9627 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (decl_table, die,
9628 htab_hash_pointer (die), INSERT);
9629 if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
9631 entry = (struct decl_table_entry *) *slot;
9632 return entry->copy;
9635 /* Record in DECL_TABLE that DIE has been copied to UNIT. */
9636 entry = XCNEW (struct decl_table_entry);
9637 entry->orig = die;
9638 entry->copy = NULL;
9639 *slot = entry;
9642 if (parent != NULL)
9644 dw_die_ref spec = get_AT_ref (parent, DW_AT_specification);
9645 if (spec != NULL)
9646 parent = spec;
9647 if (parent->die_tag != DW_TAG_compile_unit
9648 && parent->die_tag != DW_TAG_type_unit)
9649 new_parent = copy_ancestor_tree (unit, parent, decl_table);
9652 copy = clone_as_declaration (die);
9653 add_child_die (new_parent, copy);
9655 if (decl_table != NULL)
9657 /* Make sure the copy is marked as part of the type unit. */
9658 copy->die_mark = 1;
9659 /* Record the pointer to the copy. */
9660 entry->copy = copy;
9663 return copy;
9666 /* Walk the DIE and its children, looking for references to incomplete
9667 or trivial types that are unmarked (i.e., that are not in the current
9668 type_unit). */
9670 static void
9671 copy_decls_walk (dw_die_ref unit, dw_die_ref die, htab_t decl_table)
9673 dw_die_ref c;
9674 dw_attr_ref a;
9675 unsigned ix;
9677 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
9679 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
9681 dw_die_ref targ = AT_ref (a);
9682 comdat_type_node_ref type_node = targ->die_id.die_type_node;
9683 void **slot;
9684 struct decl_table_entry *entry;
9686 if (targ->die_mark != 0 || type_node != NULL)
9687 continue;
9689 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (decl_table, targ,
9690 htab_hash_pointer (targ), INSERT);
9692 if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
9694 /* TARG has already been copied, so we just need to
9695 modify the reference to point to the copy. */
9696 entry = (struct decl_table_entry *) *slot;
9697 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = entry->copy;
9699 else
9701 dw_die_ref parent = unit;
9702 dw_die_ref copy = clone_tree (targ);
9704 /* Make sure the cloned tree is marked as part of the
9705 type unit. */
9706 mark_dies (copy);
9708 /* Record in DECL_TABLE that TARG has been copied.
9709 Need to do this now, before the recursive call,
9710 because DECL_TABLE may be expanded and SLOT
9711 would no longer be a valid pointer. */
9712 entry = XCNEW (struct decl_table_entry);
9713 entry->orig = targ;
9714 entry->copy = copy;
9715 *slot = entry;
9717 /* If TARG has surrounding context, copy its ancestor tree
9718 into the new type unit. */
9719 if (targ->die_parent != NULL
9720 && targ->die_parent->die_tag != DW_TAG_compile_unit
9721 && targ->die_parent->die_tag != DW_TAG_type_unit)
9722 parent = copy_ancestor_tree (unit, targ->die_parent,
9723 decl_table);
9725 add_child_die (parent, copy);
9726 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = copy;
9728 /* Make sure the newly-copied DIE is walked. If it was
9729 installed in a previously-added context, it won't
9730 get visited otherwise. */
9731 if (parent != unit)
9732 copy_decls_walk (unit, parent, decl_table);
9737 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, copy_decls_walk (unit, c, decl_table));
9740 /* Copy declarations for "unworthy" types into the new comdat section.
9741 Incomplete types, modified types, and certain other types aren't broken
9742 out into comdat sections of their own, so they don't have a signature,
9743 and we need to copy the declaration into the same section so that we
9744 don't have an external reference. */
9746 static void
9747 copy_decls_for_unworthy_types (dw_die_ref unit)
9749 htab_t decl_table;
9751 mark_dies (unit);
9752 decl_table = htab_create (10, htab_decl_hash, htab_decl_eq, htab_decl_del);
9753 copy_decls_walk (unit, unit, decl_table);
9754 htab_delete (decl_table);
9755 unmark_dies (unit);
9758 /* Traverse the DIE and add a sibling attribute if it may have the
9759 effect of speeding up access to siblings. To save some space,
9760 avoid generating sibling attributes for DIE's without children. */
9762 static void
9763 add_sibling_attributes (dw_die_ref die)
9765 dw_die_ref c;
9767 if (! die->die_child)
9768 return;
9770 if (die->die_parent && die != die->die_parent->die_child)
9771 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_sibling, die->die_sib);
9773 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, add_sibling_attributes (c));
9776 /* Output all location lists for the DIE and its children. */
9778 static void
9779 output_location_lists (dw_die_ref die)
9781 dw_die_ref c;
9782 dw_attr_ref a;
9783 unsigned ix;
9785 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
9786 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
9787 output_loc_list (AT_loc_list (a));
9789 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, output_location_lists (c));
9792 /* The format of each DIE (and its attribute value pairs) is encoded in an
9793 abbreviation table. This routine builds the abbreviation table and assigns
9794 a unique abbreviation id for each abbreviation entry. The children of each
9795 die are visited recursively. */
9797 static void
9798 build_abbrev_table (dw_die_ref die)
9800 unsigned long abbrev_id;
9801 unsigned int n_alloc;
9802 dw_die_ref c;
9803 dw_attr_ref a;
9804 unsigned ix;
9806 /* Scan the DIE references, and mark as external any that refer to
9807 DIEs from other CUs (i.e. those which are not marked). */
9808 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
9809 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref
9810 && AT_ref (a)->die_mark == 0)
9812 gcc_assert (dwarf_version >= 4 || AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_symbol);
9813 set_AT_ref_external (a, 1);
9816 for (abbrev_id = 1; abbrev_id < abbrev_die_table_in_use; ++abbrev_id)
9818 dw_die_ref abbrev = abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id];
9819 dw_attr_ref die_a, abbrev_a;
9820 unsigned ix;
9821 bool ok = true;
9823 if (abbrev->die_tag != die->die_tag)
9824 continue;
9825 if ((abbrev->die_child != NULL) != (die->die_child != NULL))
9826 continue;
9828 if (VEC_length (dw_attr_node, abbrev->die_attr)
9829 != VEC_length (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr))
9830 continue;
9832 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, die_a); ix++)
9834 abbrev_a = VEC_index (dw_attr_node, abbrev->die_attr, ix);
9835 if ((abbrev_a->dw_attr != die_a->dw_attr)
9836 || (value_format (abbrev_a) != value_format (die_a)))
9838 ok = false;
9839 break;
9842 if (ok)
9843 break;
9846 if (abbrev_id >= abbrev_die_table_in_use)
9848 if (abbrev_die_table_in_use >= abbrev_die_table_allocated)
9850 n_alloc = abbrev_die_table_allocated + ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
9851 abbrev_die_table = GGC_RESIZEVEC (dw_die_ref, abbrev_die_table,
9852 n_alloc);
9854 memset (&abbrev_die_table[abbrev_die_table_allocated], 0,
9855 (n_alloc - abbrev_die_table_allocated) * sizeof (dw_die_ref));
9856 abbrev_die_table_allocated = n_alloc;
9859 ++abbrev_die_table_in_use;
9860 abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id] = die;
9863 die->die_abbrev = abbrev_id;
9864 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, build_abbrev_table (c));
9867 /* Return the power-of-two number of bytes necessary to represent VALUE. */
9869 static int
9870 constant_size (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT value)
9872 int log;
9874 if (value == 0)
9875 log = 0;
9876 else
9877 log = floor_log2 (value);
9879 log = log / 8;
9880 log = 1 << (floor_log2 (log) + 1);
9882 return log;
9885 /* Return the size of a DIE as it is represented in the
9886 .debug_info section. */
9888 static unsigned long
9889 size_of_die (dw_die_ref die)
9891 unsigned long size = 0;
9892 dw_attr_ref a;
9893 unsigned ix;
9895 size += size_of_uleb128 (die->die_abbrev);
9896 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
9898 switch (AT_class (a))
9900 case dw_val_class_addr:
9901 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
9902 break;
9903 case dw_val_class_offset:
9904 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9905 break;
9906 case dw_val_class_loc:
9908 unsigned long lsize = size_of_locs (AT_loc (a));
9910 /* Block length. */
9911 size += constant_size (lsize);
9912 size += lsize;
9914 break;
9915 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
9916 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9917 break;
9918 case dw_val_class_range_list:
9919 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9920 break;
9921 case dw_val_class_const:
9922 size += size_of_sleb128 (AT_int (a));
9923 break;
9924 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
9925 size += constant_size (AT_unsigned (a));
9926 break;
9927 case dw_val_class_const_double:
9928 size += 2 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR;
9929 if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64)
9930 size++; /* block */
9931 break;
9932 case dw_val_class_vec:
9933 size += constant_size (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
9934 * a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size)
9935 + a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
9936 * a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size; /* block */
9937 break;
9938 case dw_val_class_flag:
9939 size += 1;
9940 break;
9941 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
9942 if (AT_ref_external (a))
9944 /* In DWARF4, we use DW_FORM_sig8; for earlier versions
9945 we use DW_FORM_ref_addr. In DWARF2, DW_FORM_ref_addr
9946 is sized by target address length, whereas in DWARF3
9947 it's always sized as an offset. */
9948 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
9949 size += DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE;
9950 else if (dwarf_version == 2)
9951 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
9952 else
9953 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9955 else
9956 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9957 break;
9958 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
9959 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9960 break;
9961 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
9962 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
9963 break;
9964 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
9965 case dw_val_class_macptr:
9966 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9967 break;
9968 case dw_val_class_str:
9969 if (AT_string_form (a) == DW_FORM_strp)
9970 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
9971 else
9972 size += strlen (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->str) + 1;
9973 break;
9974 case dw_val_class_file:
9975 size += constant_size (maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file));
9976 break;
9977 case dw_val_class_data8:
9978 size += 8;
9979 break;
9980 default:
9981 gcc_unreachable ();
9985 return size;
9988 /* Size the debugging information associated with a given DIE. Visits the
9989 DIE's children recursively. Updates the global variable next_die_offset, on
9990 each time through. Uses the current value of next_die_offset to update the
9991 die_offset field in each DIE. */
9993 static void
9994 calc_die_sizes (dw_die_ref die)
9996 dw_die_ref c;
9998 die->die_offset = next_die_offset;
9999 next_die_offset += size_of_die (die);
10001 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, calc_die_sizes (c));
10003 if (die->die_child != NULL)
10004 /* Count the null byte used to terminate sibling lists. */
10005 next_die_offset += 1;
10008 /* Set the marks for a die and its children. We do this so
10009 that we know whether or not a reference needs to use FORM_ref_addr; only
10010 DIEs in the same CU will be marked. We used to clear out the offset
10011 and use that as the flag, but ran into ordering problems. */
10013 static void
10014 mark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
10016 dw_die_ref c;
10018 gcc_assert (!die->die_mark);
10020 die->die_mark = 1;
10021 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, mark_dies (c));
10024 /* Clear the marks for a die and its children. */
10026 static void
10027 unmark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
10029 dw_die_ref c;
10031 if (dwarf_version < 4)
10032 gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
10034 die->die_mark = 0;
10035 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, unmark_dies (c));
10038 /* Clear the marks for a die, its children and referred dies. */
10040 static void
10041 unmark_all_dies (dw_die_ref die)
10043 dw_die_ref c;
10044 dw_attr_ref a;
10045 unsigned ix;
10047 if (!die->die_mark)
10048 return;
10049 die->die_mark = 0;
10051 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, unmark_all_dies (c));
10053 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
10054 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
10055 unmark_all_dies (AT_ref (a));
10058 /* Return the size of the .debug_pubnames or .debug_pubtypes table
10059 generated for the compilation unit. */
10061 static unsigned long
10062 size_of_pubnames (VEC (pubname_entry, gc) * names)
10064 unsigned long size;
10065 unsigned i;
10066 pubname_ref p;
10068 size = DWARF_PUBNAMES_HEADER_SIZE;
10069 for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (pubname_entry, names, i, p); i++)
10070 if (names != pubtype_table
10071 || p->die->die_offset != 0
10072 || !flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types)
10073 size += strlen (p->name) + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 1;
10075 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
10076 return size;
10079 /* Return the size of the information in the .debug_aranges section. */
10081 static unsigned long
10082 size_of_aranges (void)
10084 unsigned long size;
10086 size = DWARF_ARANGES_HEADER_SIZE;
10088 /* Count the address/length pair for this compilation unit. */
10089 if (text_section_used)
10090 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
10091 if (cold_text_section_used)
10092 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
10093 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * arange_table_in_use;
10095 /* Count the two zero words used to terminated the address range table. */
10096 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
10097 return size;
10100 /* Select the encoding of an attribute value. */
10102 static enum dwarf_form
10103 value_format (dw_attr_ref a)
10105 switch (a->dw_attr_val.val_class)
10107 case dw_val_class_addr:
10108 /* Only very few attributes allow DW_FORM_addr. */
10109 switch (a->dw_attr)
10111 case DW_AT_low_pc:
10112 case DW_AT_high_pc:
10113 case DW_AT_entry_pc:
10114 case DW_AT_trampoline:
10115 return DW_FORM_addr;
10116 default:
10117 break;
10119 switch (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
10121 case 1:
10122 return DW_FORM_data1;
10123 case 2:
10124 return DW_FORM_data2;
10125 case 4:
10126 return DW_FORM_data4;
10127 case 8:
10128 return DW_FORM_data8;
10129 default:
10130 gcc_unreachable ();
10132 case dw_val_class_range_list:
10133 case dw_val_class_offset:
10134 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
10135 switch (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE)
10137 case 4:
10138 return DW_FORM_data4;
10139 case 8:
10140 return DW_FORM_data8;
10141 default:
10142 gcc_unreachable ();
10144 case dw_val_class_loc:
10145 switch (constant_size (size_of_locs (AT_loc (a))))
10147 case 1:
10148 return DW_FORM_block1;
10149 case 2:
10150 return DW_FORM_block2;
10151 default:
10152 gcc_unreachable ();
10154 case dw_val_class_const:
10155 return DW_FORM_sdata;
10156 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
10157 switch (constant_size (AT_unsigned (a)))
10159 case 1:
10160 return DW_FORM_data1;
10161 case 2:
10162 return DW_FORM_data2;
10163 case 4:
10164 return DW_FORM_data4;
10165 case 8:
10166 return DW_FORM_data8;
10167 default:
10168 gcc_unreachable ();
10170 case dw_val_class_const_double:
10171 switch (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
10173 case 8:
10174 return DW_FORM_data2;
10175 case 16:
10176 return DW_FORM_data4;
10177 case 32:
10178 return DW_FORM_data8;
10179 case 64:
10180 default:
10181 return DW_FORM_block1;
10183 case dw_val_class_vec:
10184 switch (constant_size (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
10185 * a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size))
10187 case 1:
10188 return DW_FORM_block1;
10189 case 2:
10190 return DW_FORM_block2;
10191 case 4:
10192 return DW_FORM_block4;
10193 default:
10194 gcc_unreachable ();
10196 case dw_val_class_flag:
10197 return DW_FORM_flag;
10198 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
10199 if (AT_ref_external (a))
10200 return dwarf_version >= 4 ? DW_FORM_sig8 : DW_FORM_ref_addr;
10201 else
10202 return DW_FORM_ref;
10203 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
10204 return DW_FORM_data;
10205 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
10206 return DW_FORM_addr;
10207 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
10208 case dw_val_class_macptr:
10209 return DW_FORM_data;
10210 case dw_val_class_str:
10211 return AT_string_form (a);
10212 case dw_val_class_file:
10213 switch (constant_size (maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file)))
10215 case 1:
10216 return DW_FORM_data1;
10217 case 2:
10218 return DW_FORM_data2;
10219 case 4:
10220 return DW_FORM_data4;
10221 default:
10222 gcc_unreachable ();
10225 case dw_val_class_data8:
10226 return DW_FORM_data8;
10228 default:
10229 gcc_unreachable ();
10233 /* Output the encoding of an attribute value. */
10235 static void
10236 output_value_format (dw_attr_ref a)
10238 enum dwarf_form form = value_format (a);
10240 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (form, "(%s)", dwarf_form_name (form));
10243 /* Output the .debug_abbrev section which defines the DIE abbreviation
10244 table. */
10246 static void
10247 output_abbrev_section (void)
10249 unsigned long abbrev_id;
10251 for (abbrev_id = 1; abbrev_id < abbrev_die_table_in_use; ++abbrev_id)
10253 dw_die_ref abbrev = abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id];
10254 unsigned ix;
10255 dw_attr_ref a_attr;
10257 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (abbrev_id, "(abbrev code)");
10258 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (abbrev->die_tag, "(TAG: %s)",
10259 dwarf_tag_name (abbrev->die_tag));
10261 if (abbrev->die_child != NULL)
10262 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_children_yes, "DW_children_yes");
10263 else
10264 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_children_no, "DW_children_no");
10266 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, abbrev->die_attr, ix, a_attr);
10267 ix++)
10269 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (a_attr->dw_attr, "(%s)",
10270 dwarf_attr_name (a_attr->dw_attr));
10271 output_value_format (a_attr);
10274 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
10275 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
10278 /* Terminate the table. */
10279 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
10282 /* Output a symbol we can use to refer to this DIE from another CU. */
10284 static inline void
10285 output_die_symbol (dw_die_ref die)
10287 char *sym = die->die_id.die_symbol;
10289 if (sym == 0)
10290 return;
10292 if (strncmp (sym, DIE_LABEL_PREFIX, sizeof (DIE_LABEL_PREFIX) - 1) == 0)
10293 /* We make these global, not weak; if the target doesn't support
10294 .linkonce, it doesn't support combining the sections, so debugging
10295 will break. */
10296 targetm.asm_out.globalize_label (asm_out_file, sym);
10298 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, sym);
10301 /* Return a new location list, given the begin and end range, and the
10302 expression. gensym tells us whether to generate a new internal symbol for
10303 this location list node, which is done for the head of the list only. */
10305 static inline dw_loc_list_ref
10306 new_loc_list (dw_loc_descr_ref expr, const char *begin, const char *end,
10307 const char *section, unsigned int gensym)
10309 dw_loc_list_ref retlist = GGC_CNEW (dw_loc_list_node);
10311 retlist->begin = begin;
10312 retlist->end = end;
10313 retlist->expr = expr;
10314 retlist->section = section;
10315 if (gensym)
10316 retlist->ll_symbol = gen_internal_sym ("LLST");
10318 return retlist;
10321 /* Add a location description expression to a location list. */
10323 static inline void
10324 add_loc_descr_to_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref *list_head, dw_loc_descr_ref descr,
10325 const char *begin, const char *end,
10326 const char *section)
10328 dw_loc_list_ref *d;
10330 /* Find the end of the chain. */
10331 for (d = list_head; (*d) != NULL; d = &(*d)->dw_loc_next)
10334 /* Add a new location list node to the list. */
10335 *d = new_loc_list (descr, begin, end, section, 0);
10338 /* Output the location list given to us. */
10340 static void
10341 output_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref list_head)
10343 dw_loc_list_ref curr = list_head;
10345 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, list_head->ll_symbol);
10347 /* Walk the location list, and output each range + expression. */
10348 for (curr = list_head; curr != NULL; curr = curr->dw_loc_next)
10350 unsigned long size;
10351 /* Don't output an entry that starts and ends at the same address. */
10352 if (strcmp (curr->begin, curr->end) == 0)
10353 continue;
10354 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
10356 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin, curr->section,
10357 "Location list begin address (%s)",
10358 list_head->ll_symbol);
10359 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->end, curr->section,
10360 "Location list end address (%s)",
10361 list_head->ll_symbol);
10363 else
10365 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin,
10366 "Location list begin address (%s)",
10367 list_head->ll_symbol);
10368 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->end,
10369 "Location list end address (%s)",
10370 list_head->ll_symbol);
10372 size = size_of_locs (curr->expr);
10374 /* Output the block length for this list of location operations. */
10375 gcc_assert (size <= 0xffff);
10376 dw2_asm_output_data (2, size, "%s", "Location expression size");
10378 output_loc_sequence (curr->expr);
10381 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0,
10382 "Location list terminator begin (%s)",
10383 list_head->ll_symbol);
10384 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0,
10385 "Location list terminator end (%s)",
10386 list_head->ll_symbol);
10389 /* Output a type signature. */
10391 static inline void
10392 output_signature (const char *sig, const char *name)
10394 int i;
10396 for (i = 0; i < DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE; i++)
10397 dw2_asm_output_data (1, sig[i], i == 0 ? "%s" : NULL, name);
10400 /* Output the DIE and its attributes. Called recursively to generate
10401 the definitions of each child DIE. */
10403 static void
10404 output_die (dw_die_ref die)
10406 dw_attr_ref a;
10407 dw_die_ref c;
10408 unsigned long size;
10409 unsigned ix;
10411 /* If someone in another CU might refer to us, set up a symbol for
10412 them to point to. */
10413 if (dwarf_version < 4 && die->die_id.die_symbol)
10414 output_die_symbol (die);
10416 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (die->die_abbrev, "(DIE (0x%lx) %s)",
10417 (unsigned long)die->die_offset,
10418 dwarf_tag_name (die->die_tag));
10420 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
10422 const char *name = dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr);
10424 switch (AT_class (a))
10426 case dw_val_class_addr:
10427 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_addr (a), "%s", name);
10428 break;
10430 case dw_val_class_offset:
10431 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset,
10432 "%s", name);
10433 break;
10435 case dw_val_class_range_list:
10437 char *p = strchr (ranges_section_label, '\0');
10439 sprintf (p, "+" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX,
10440 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
10441 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, ranges_section_label,
10442 debug_ranges_section, "%s", name);
10443 *p = '\0';
10445 break;
10447 case dw_val_class_loc:
10448 size = size_of_locs (AT_loc (a));
10450 /* Output the block length for this list of location operations. */
10451 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (size), size, "%s", name);
10453 output_loc_sequence (AT_loc (a));
10454 break;
10456 case dw_val_class_const:
10457 /* ??? It would be slightly more efficient to use a scheme like is
10458 used for unsigned constants below, but gdb 4.x does not sign
10459 extend. Gdb 5.x does sign extend. */
10460 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (AT_int (a), "%s", name);
10461 break;
10463 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
10464 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (AT_unsigned (a)),
10465 AT_unsigned (a), "%s", name);
10466 break;
10468 case dw_val_class_const_double:
10470 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first, second;
10472 if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64)
10473 dw2_asm_output_data (1,
10474 2 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
10475 / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
10476 NULL);
10478 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
10480 first = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.high;
10481 second = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.low;
10483 else
10485 first = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.low;
10486 second = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.high;
10489 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
10490 first, name);
10491 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
10492 second, NULL);
10494 break;
10496 case dw_val_class_vec:
10498 unsigned int elt_size = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size;
10499 unsigned int len = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length;
10500 unsigned int i;
10501 unsigned char *p;
10503 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (len * elt_size),
10504 len * elt_size, "%s", name);
10505 if (elt_size > sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
10507 elt_size /= 2;
10508 len *= 2;
10510 for (i = 0, p = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array;
10511 i < len;
10512 i++, p += elt_size)
10513 dw2_asm_output_data (elt_size, extract_int (p, elt_size),
10514 "fp or vector constant word %u", i);
10515 break;
10518 case dw_val_class_flag:
10519 dw2_asm_output_data (1, AT_flag (a), "%s", name);
10520 break;
10522 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
10524 char *sym = AT_loc_list (a)->ll_symbol;
10526 gcc_assert (sym);
10527 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, sym, debug_loc_section,
10528 "%s", name);
10530 break;
10532 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
10533 if (AT_ref_external (a))
10535 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
10537 comdat_type_node_ref type_node =
10538 AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_type_node;
10540 gcc_assert (type_node);
10541 output_signature (type_node->signature, name);
10543 else
10545 char *sym = AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_symbol;
10546 int size;
10548 gcc_assert (sym);
10549 /* In DWARF2, DW_FORM_ref_addr is sized by target address
10550 length, whereas in DWARF3 it's always sized as an
10551 offset. */
10552 if (dwarf_version == 2)
10553 size = DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
10554 else
10555 size = DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
10556 dw2_asm_output_offset (size, sym, debug_info_section, "%s",
10557 name);
10560 else
10562 gcc_assert (AT_ref (a)->die_offset);
10563 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_ref (a)->die_offset,
10564 "%s", name);
10566 break;
10568 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
10570 char l1[20];
10572 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, FDE_LABEL,
10573 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_fde_index * 2);
10574 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l1, debug_frame_section,
10575 "%s", name);
10577 break;
10579 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
10580 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_lbl (a), "%s", name);
10581 break;
10583 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
10584 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_lbl (a),
10585 debug_line_section, "%s", name);
10586 break;
10588 case dw_val_class_macptr:
10589 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_lbl (a),
10590 debug_macinfo_section, "%s", name);
10591 break;
10593 case dw_val_class_str:
10594 if (AT_string_form (a) == DW_FORM_strp)
10595 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
10596 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->label,
10597 debug_str_section,
10598 "%s: \"%s\"", name, AT_string (a));
10599 else
10600 dw2_asm_output_nstring (AT_string (a), -1, "%s", name);
10601 break;
10603 case dw_val_class_file:
10605 int f = maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file);
10607 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (f), f, "%s (%s)", name,
10608 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file->filename);
10609 break;
10612 case dw_val_class_data8:
10614 int i;
10616 for (i = 0; i < 8; i++)
10617 dw2_asm_output_data (1, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_data8[i],
10618 i == 0 ? "%s" : NULL, name);
10619 break;
10622 default:
10623 gcc_unreachable ();
10627 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, output_die (c));
10629 /* Add null byte to terminate sibling list. */
10630 if (die->die_child != NULL)
10631 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "end of children of DIE 0x%lx",
10632 (unsigned long) die->die_offset);
10635 /* Output the compilation unit that appears at the beginning of the
10636 .debug_info section, and precedes the DIE descriptions. */
10638 static void
10639 output_compilation_unit_header (void)
10641 int ver = dwarf_version;
10643 /* Don't mark the output as DWARF-4 until we make full use of the
10644 version 4 extensions, and gdb supports them. For now, -gdwarf-4
10645 selects only a few extensions from the DWARF-4 spec. */
10646 if (ver > 3)
10647 ver = 3;
10648 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
10649 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
10650 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
10651 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
10652 next_die_offset - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE,
10653 "Length of Compilation Unit Info");
10654 dw2_asm_output_data (2, ver, "DWARF version number");
10655 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, abbrev_section_label,
10656 debug_abbrev_section,
10657 "Offset Into Abbrev. Section");
10658 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Pointer Size (in bytes)");
10661 /* Output the compilation unit DIE and its children. */
10663 static void
10664 output_comp_unit (dw_die_ref die, int output_if_empty)
10666 const char *secname;
10667 char *oldsym, *tmp;
10669 /* Unless we are outputting main CU, we may throw away empty ones. */
10670 if (!output_if_empty && die->die_child == NULL)
10671 return;
10673 /* Even if there are no children of this DIE, we must output the information
10674 about the compilation unit. Otherwise, on an empty translation unit, we
10675 will generate a present, but empty, .debug_info section. IRIX 6.5 `nm'
10676 will then complain when examining the file. First mark all the DIEs in
10677 this CU so we know which get local refs. */
10678 mark_dies (die);
10680 build_abbrev_table (die);
10682 /* Initialize the beginning DIE offset - and calculate sizes/offsets. */
10683 next_die_offset = DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE;
10684 calc_die_sizes (die);
10686 oldsym = die->die_id.die_symbol;
10687 if (oldsym)
10689 tmp = XALLOCAVEC (char, strlen (oldsym) + 24);
10691 sprintf (tmp, ".gnu.linkonce.wi.%s", oldsym);
10692 secname = tmp;
10693 die->die_id.die_symbol = NULL;
10694 switch_to_section (get_section (secname, SECTION_DEBUG, NULL));
10696 else
10697 switch_to_section (debug_info_section);
10699 /* Output debugging information. */
10700 output_compilation_unit_header ();
10701 output_die (die);
10703 /* Leave the marks on the main CU, so we can check them in
10704 output_pubnames. */
10705 if (oldsym)
10707 unmark_dies (die);
10708 die->die_id.die_symbol = oldsym;
10712 /* Output a comdat type unit DIE and its children. */
10714 static void
10715 output_comdat_type_unit (comdat_type_node *node)
10717 const char *secname;
10718 char *tmp;
10719 int i;
10720 #if defined (OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF)
10721 tree comdat_key;
10722 #endif
10724 /* First mark all the DIEs in this CU so we know which get local refs. */
10725 mark_dies (node->root_die);
10727 build_abbrev_table (node->root_die);
10729 /* Initialize the beginning DIE offset - and calculate sizes/offsets. */
10730 next_die_offset = DWARF_COMDAT_TYPE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE;
10731 calc_die_sizes (node->root_die);
10733 #if defined (OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF)
10734 secname = ".debug_types";
10735 tmp = XALLOCAVEC (char, 4 + DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE * 2);
10736 sprintf (tmp, "wt.");
10737 for (i = 0; i < DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE; i++)
10738 sprintf (tmp + 3 + i * 2, "%02x", node->signature[i] & 0xff);
10739 comdat_key = get_identifier (tmp);
10740 targetm.asm_out.named_section (secname,
10741 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_LINKONCE,
10742 comdat_key);
10743 #else
10744 tmp = XALLOCAVEC (char, 18 + DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE * 2);
10745 sprintf (tmp, ".gnu.linkonce.wt.");
10746 for (i = 0; i < DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE; i++)
10747 sprintf (tmp + 17 + i * 2, "%02x", node->signature[i] & 0xff);
10748 secname = tmp;
10749 switch_to_section (get_section (secname, SECTION_DEBUG, NULL));
10750 #endif
10752 /* Output debugging information. */
10753 output_compilation_unit_header ();
10754 output_signature (node->signature, "Type Signature");
10755 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, node->type_die->die_offset,
10756 "Offset to Type DIE");
10757 output_die (node->root_die);
10759 unmark_dies (node->root_die);
10762 /* Return the DWARF2/3 pubname associated with a decl. */
10764 static const char *
10765 dwarf2_name (tree decl, int scope)
10767 return lang_hooks.dwarf_name (decl, scope ? 1 : 0);
10770 /* Add a new entry to .debug_pubnames if appropriate. */
10772 static void
10773 add_pubname_string (const char *str, dw_die_ref die)
10775 pubname_entry e;
10777 e.die = die;
10778 e.name = xstrdup (str);
10779 VEC_safe_push (pubname_entry, gc, pubname_table, &e);
10782 static void
10783 add_pubname (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
10785 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
10787 const char *name = dwarf2_name (decl, 1);
10788 if (name)
10789 add_pubname_string (name, die);
10793 /* Add a new entry to .debug_pubtypes if appropriate. */
10795 static void
10796 add_pubtype (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
10798 pubname_entry e;
10800 e.name = NULL;
10801 if ((TREE_PUBLIC (decl)
10802 || die->die_parent == comp_unit_die)
10803 && (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_typedef || COMPLETE_TYPE_P (decl)))
10805 e.die = die;
10806 if (TYPE_P (decl))
10808 if (TYPE_NAME (decl))
10810 if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (decl)) == IDENTIFIER_NODE)
10811 e.name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (TYPE_NAME (decl));
10812 else if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (decl)) == TYPE_DECL
10813 && DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (decl)))
10814 e.name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (decl)));
10815 else
10816 e.name = xstrdup ((const char *) get_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name));
10819 else
10821 e.name = dwarf2_name (decl, 1);
10822 if (e.name)
10823 e.name = xstrdup (e.name);
10826 /* If we don't have a name for the type, there's no point in adding
10827 it to the table. */
10828 if (e.name && e.name[0] != '\0')
10829 VEC_safe_push (pubname_entry, gc, pubtype_table, &e);
10833 /* Output the public names table used to speed up access to externally
10834 visible names; or the public types table used to find type definitions. */
10836 static void
10837 output_pubnames (VEC (pubname_entry, gc) * names)
10839 unsigned i;
10840 unsigned long pubnames_length = size_of_pubnames (names);
10841 pubname_ref pub;
10843 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
10844 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
10845 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
10846 if (names == pubname_table)
10847 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, pubnames_length,
10848 "Length of Public Names Info");
10849 else
10850 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, pubnames_length,
10851 "Length of Public Type Names Info");
10852 /* Version number for pubnames/pubtypes is still 2, even in DWARF3. */
10853 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 2, "DWARF Version");
10854 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
10855 debug_info_section,
10856 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
10857 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, next_die_offset,
10858 "Compilation Unit Length");
10860 for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (pubname_entry, names, i, pub); i++)
10862 /* We shouldn't see pubnames for DIEs outside of the main CU. */
10863 if (names == pubname_table)
10864 gcc_assert (pub->die->die_mark);
10866 if (names != pubtype_table
10867 || pub->die->die_offset != 0
10868 || !flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types)
10870 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, pub->die->die_offset,
10871 "DIE offset");
10873 dw2_asm_output_nstring (pub->name, -1, "external name");
10877 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, 0, NULL);
10880 /* Add a new entry to .debug_aranges if appropriate. */
10882 static void
10883 add_arange (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
10885 if (! DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl))
10886 return;
10888 if (arange_table_in_use == arange_table_allocated)
10890 arange_table_allocated += ARANGE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
10891 arange_table = GGC_RESIZEVEC (dw_die_ref, arange_table,
10892 arange_table_allocated);
10893 memset (arange_table + arange_table_in_use, 0,
10894 ARANGE_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_die_ref));
10897 arange_table[arange_table_in_use++] = die;
10900 /* Output the information that goes into the .debug_aranges table.
10901 Namely, define the beginning and ending address range of the
10902 text section generated for this compilation unit. */
10904 static void
10905 output_aranges (void)
10907 unsigned i;
10908 unsigned long aranges_length = size_of_aranges ();
10910 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
10911 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
10912 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
10913 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, aranges_length,
10914 "Length of Address Ranges Info");
10915 /* Version number for aranges is still 2, even in DWARF3. */
10916 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 2, "DWARF Version");
10917 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
10918 debug_info_section,
10919 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
10920 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Size of Address");
10921 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Size of Segment Descriptor");
10923 /* We need to align to twice the pointer size here. */
10924 if (DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE)
10926 /* Pad using a 2 byte words so that padding is correct for any
10927 pointer size. */
10928 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, "Pad to %d byte boundary",
10929 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
10930 for (i = 2; i < (unsigned) DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE; i += 2)
10931 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, NULL);
10934 /* It is necessary not to output these entries if the sections were
10935 not used; if the sections were not used, the length will be 0 and
10936 the address may end up as 0 if the section is discarded by ld
10937 --gc-sections, leaving an invalid (0, 0) entry that can be
10938 confused with the terminator. */
10939 if (text_section_used)
10941 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_section_label, "Address");
10942 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_end_label,
10943 text_section_label, "Length");
10945 if (cold_text_section_used)
10947 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, cold_text_section_label,
10948 "Address");
10949 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, cold_end_label,
10950 cold_text_section_label, "Length");
10953 for (i = 0; i < arange_table_in_use; i++)
10955 dw_die_ref die = arange_table[i];
10957 /* We shouldn't see aranges for DIEs outside of the main CU. */
10958 gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
10960 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
10962 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, get_AT_low_pc (die),
10963 "Address");
10964 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, get_AT_hi_pc (die),
10965 get_AT_low_pc (die), "Length");
10967 else
10969 /* A static variable; extract the symbol from DW_AT_location.
10970 Note that this code isn't currently hit, as we only emit
10971 aranges for functions (jason 9/23/99). */
10972 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_location);
10973 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
10975 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc);
10977 loc = AT_loc (a);
10978 gcc_assert (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_addr);
10980 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
10981 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr, "Address");
10982 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
10983 get_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_byte_size),
10984 "Length");
10988 /* Output the terminator words. */
10989 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
10990 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
10993 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges. Return the offset at which it
10994 was placed. */
10996 static unsigned int
10997 add_ranges_num (int num)
10999 unsigned int in_use = ranges_table_in_use;
11001 if (in_use == ranges_table_allocated)
11003 ranges_table_allocated += RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT;
11004 ranges_table = GGC_RESIZEVEC (struct dw_ranges_struct, ranges_table,
11005 ranges_table_allocated);
11006 memset (ranges_table + ranges_table_in_use, 0,
11007 RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (struct dw_ranges_struct));
11010 ranges_table[in_use].num = num;
11011 ranges_table_in_use = in_use + 1;
11013 return in_use * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
11016 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges corresponding to a block, or a
11017 range terminator if BLOCK is NULL. */
11019 static unsigned int
11020 add_ranges (const_tree block)
11022 return add_ranges_num (block ? BLOCK_NUMBER (block) : 0);
11025 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges corresponding to a pair of
11026 labels. */
11028 static unsigned int
11029 add_ranges_by_labels (const char *begin, const char *end)
11031 unsigned int in_use = ranges_by_label_in_use;
11033 if (in_use == ranges_by_label_allocated)
11035 ranges_by_label_allocated += RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT;
11036 ranges_by_label = GGC_RESIZEVEC (struct dw_ranges_by_label_struct,
11037 ranges_by_label,
11038 ranges_by_label_allocated);
11039 memset (ranges_by_label + ranges_by_label_in_use, 0,
11040 RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT
11041 * sizeof (struct dw_ranges_by_label_struct));
11044 ranges_by_label[in_use].begin = begin;
11045 ranges_by_label[in_use].end = end;
11046 ranges_by_label_in_use = in_use + 1;
11048 return add_ranges_num (-(int)in_use - 1);
11051 static void
11052 output_ranges (void)
11054 unsigned i;
11055 static const char *const start_fmt = "Offset 0x%x";
11056 const char *fmt = start_fmt;
11058 for (i = 0; i < ranges_table_in_use; i++)
11060 int block_num = ranges_table[i].num;
11062 if (block_num > 0)
11064 char blabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11065 char elabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11067 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (blabel, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, block_num);
11068 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (elabel, BLOCK_END_LABEL, block_num);
11070 /* If all code is in the text section, then the compilation
11071 unit base address defaults to DW_AT_low_pc, which is the
11072 base of the text section. */
11073 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
11075 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
11076 text_section_label,
11077 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
11078 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel,
11079 text_section_label, NULL);
11082 /* Otherwise, the compilation unit base address is zero,
11083 which allows us to use absolute addresses, and not worry
11084 about whether the target supports cross-section
11085 arithmetic. */
11086 else
11088 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
11089 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
11090 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel, NULL);
11093 fmt = NULL;
11096 /* Negative block_num stands for an index into ranges_by_label. */
11097 else if (block_num < 0)
11099 int lab_idx = - block_num - 1;
11101 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
11103 gcc_unreachable ();
11104 #if 0
11105 /* If we ever use add_ranges_by_labels () for a single
11106 function section, all we have to do is to take out
11107 the #if 0 above. */
11108 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
11109 ranges_by_label[lab_idx].begin,
11110 text_section_label,
11111 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
11112 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
11113 ranges_by_label[lab_idx].end,
11114 text_section_label, NULL);
11115 #endif
11117 else
11119 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
11120 ranges_by_label[lab_idx].begin,
11121 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
11122 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
11123 ranges_by_label[lab_idx].end,
11124 NULL);
11127 else
11129 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
11130 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
11131 fmt = start_fmt;
11136 /* Data structure containing information about input files. */
11137 struct file_info
11139 const char *path; /* Complete file name. */
11140 const char *fname; /* File name part. */
11141 int length; /* Length of entire string. */
11142 struct dwarf_file_data * file_idx; /* Index in input file table. */
11143 int dir_idx; /* Index in directory table. */
11146 /* Data structure containing information about directories with source
11147 files. */
11148 struct dir_info
11150 const char *path; /* Path including directory name. */
11151 int length; /* Path length. */
11152 int prefix; /* Index of directory entry which is a prefix. */
11153 int count; /* Number of files in this directory. */
11154 int dir_idx; /* Index of directory used as base. */
11157 /* Callback function for file_info comparison. We sort by looking at
11158 the directories in the path. */
11160 static int
11161 file_info_cmp (const void *p1, const void *p2)
11163 const struct file_info *const s1 = (const struct file_info *) p1;
11164 const struct file_info *const s2 = (const struct file_info *) p2;
11165 const unsigned char *cp1;
11166 const unsigned char *cp2;
11168 /* Take care of file names without directories. We need to make sure that
11169 we return consistent values to qsort since some will get confused if
11170 we return the same value when identical operands are passed in opposite
11171 orders. So if neither has a directory, return 0 and otherwise return
11172 1 or -1 depending on which one has the directory. */
11173 if ((s1->path == s1->fname || s2->path == s2->fname))
11174 return (s2->path == s2->fname) - (s1->path == s1->fname);
11176 cp1 = (const unsigned char *) s1->path;
11177 cp2 = (const unsigned char *) s2->path;
11179 while (1)
11181 ++cp1;
11182 ++cp2;
11183 /* Reached the end of the first path? If so, handle like above. */
11184 if ((cp1 == (const unsigned char *) s1->fname)
11185 || (cp2 == (const unsigned char *) s2->fname))
11186 return ((cp2 == (const unsigned char *) s2->fname)
11187 - (cp1 == (const unsigned char *) s1->fname));
11189 /* Character of current path component the same? */
11190 else if (*cp1 != *cp2)
11191 return *cp1 - *cp2;
11195 struct file_name_acquire_data
11197 struct file_info *files;
11198 int used_files;
11199 int max_files;
11202 /* Traversal function for the hash table. */
11204 static int
11205 file_name_acquire (void ** slot, void *data)
11207 struct file_name_acquire_data *fnad = (struct file_name_acquire_data *) data;
11208 struct dwarf_file_data *d = (struct dwarf_file_data *) *slot;
11209 struct file_info *fi;
11210 const char *f;
11212 gcc_assert (fnad->max_files >= d->emitted_number);
11214 if (! d->emitted_number)
11215 return 1;
11217 gcc_assert (fnad->max_files != fnad->used_files);
11219 fi = fnad->files + fnad->used_files++;
11221 /* Skip all leading "./". */
11222 f = d->filename;
11223 while (f[0] == '.' && IS_DIR_SEPARATOR (f[1]))
11224 f += 2;
11226 /* Create a new array entry. */
11227 fi->path = f;
11228 fi->length = strlen (f);
11229 fi->file_idx = d;
11231 /* Search for the file name part. */
11232 f = strrchr (f, DIR_SEPARATOR);
11233 #if defined (DIR_SEPARATOR_2)
11235 char *g = strrchr (fi->path, DIR_SEPARATOR_2);
11237 if (g != NULL)
11239 if (f == NULL || f < g)
11240 f = g;
11243 #endif
11245 fi->fname = f == NULL ? fi->path : f + 1;
11246 return 1;
11249 /* Output the directory table and the file name table. We try to minimize
11250 the total amount of memory needed. A heuristic is used to avoid large
11251 slowdowns with many input files. */
11253 static void
11254 output_file_names (void)
11256 struct file_name_acquire_data fnad;
11257 int numfiles;
11258 struct file_info *files;
11259 struct dir_info *dirs;
11260 int *saved;
11261 int *savehere;
11262 int *backmap;
11263 int ndirs;
11264 int idx_offset;
11265 int i;
11266 int idx;
11268 if (!last_emitted_file)
11270 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End directory table");
11271 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End file name table");
11272 return;
11275 numfiles = last_emitted_file->emitted_number;
11277 /* Allocate the various arrays we need. */
11278 files = XALLOCAVEC (struct file_info, numfiles);
11279 dirs = XALLOCAVEC (struct dir_info, numfiles);
11281 fnad.files = files;
11282 fnad.used_files = 0;
11283 fnad.max_files = numfiles;
11284 htab_traverse (file_table, file_name_acquire, &fnad);
11285 gcc_assert (fnad.used_files == fnad.max_files);
11287 qsort (files, numfiles, sizeof (files[0]), file_info_cmp);
11289 /* Find all the different directories used. */
11290 dirs[0].path = files[0].path;
11291 dirs[0].length = files[0].fname - files[0].path;
11292 dirs[0].prefix = -1;
11293 dirs[0].count = 1;
11294 dirs[0].dir_idx = 0;
11295 files[0].dir_idx = 0;
11296 ndirs = 1;
11298 for (i = 1; i < numfiles; i++)
11299 if (files[i].fname - files[i].path == dirs[ndirs - 1].length
11300 && memcmp (dirs[ndirs - 1].path, files[i].path,
11301 dirs[ndirs - 1].length) == 0)
11303 /* Same directory as last entry. */
11304 files[i].dir_idx = ndirs - 1;
11305 ++dirs[ndirs - 1].count;
11307 else
11309 int j;
11311 /* This is a new directory. */
11312 dirs[ndirs].path = files[i].path;
11313 dirs[ndirs].length = files[i].fname - files[i].path;
11314 dirs[ndirs].count = 1;
11315 dirs[ndirs].dir_idx = ndirs;
11316 files[i].dir_idx = ndirs;
11318 /* Search for a prefix. */
11319 dirs[ndirs].prefix = -1;
11320 for (j = 0; j < ndirs; j++)
11321 if (dirs[j].length < dirs[ndirs].length
11322 && dirs[j].length > 1
11323 && (dirs[ndirs].prefix == -1
11324 || dirs[j].length > dirs[dirs[ndirs].prefix].length)
11325 && memcmp (dirs[j].path, dirs[ndirs].path, dirs[j].length) == 0)
11326 dirs[ndirs].prefix = j;
11328 ++ndirs;
11331 /* Now to the actual work. We have to find a subset of the directories which
11332 allow expressing the file name using references to the directory table
11333 with the least amount of characters. We do not do an exhaustive search
11334 where we would have to check out every combination of every single
11335 possible prefix. Instead we use a heuristic which provides nearly optimal
11336 results in most cases and never is much off. */
11337 saved = XALLOCAVEC (int, ndirs);
11338 savehere = XALLOCAVEC (int, ndirs);
11340 memset (saved, '\0', ndirs * sizeof (saved[0]));
11341 for (i = 0; i < ndirs; i++)
11343 int j;
11344 int total;
11346 /* We can always save some space for the current directory. But this
11347 does not mean it will be enough to justify adding the directory. */
11348 savehere[i] = dirs[i].length;
11349 total = (savehere[i] - saved[i]) * dirs[i].count;
11351 for (j = i + 1; j < ndirs; j++)
11353 savehere[j] = 0;
11354 if (saved[j] < dirs[i].length)
11356 /* Determine whether the dirs[i] path is a prefix of the
11357 dirs[j] path. */
11358 int k;
11360 k = dirs[j].prefix;
11361 while (k != -1 && k != (int) i)
11362 k = dirs[k].prefix;
11364 if (k == (int) i)
11366 /* Yes it is. We can possibly save some memory by
11367 writing the filenames in dirs[j] relative to
11368 dirs[i]. */
11369 savehere[j] = dirs[i].length;
11370 total += (savehere[j] - saved[j]) * dirs[j].count;
11375 /* Check whether we can save enough to justify adding the dirs[i]
11376 directory. */
11377 if (total > dirs[i].length + 1)
11379 /* It's worthwhile adding. */
11380 for (j = i; j < ndirs; j++)
11381 if (savehere[j] > 0)
11383 /* Remember how much we saved for this directory so far. */
11384 saved[j] = savehere[j];
11386 /* Remember the prefix directory. */
11387 dirs[j].dir_idx = i;
11392 /* Emit the directory name table. */
11393 idx = 1;
11394 idx_offset = dirs[0].length > 0 ? 1 : 0;
11395 for (i = 1 - idx_offset; i < ndirs; i++)
11396 dw2_asm_output_nstring (dirs[i].path,
11397 dirs[i].length
11398 - !DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR,
11399 "Directory Entry: 0x%x", i + idx_offset);
11401 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End directory table");
11403 /* We have to emit them in the order of emitted_number since that's
11404 used in the debug info generation. To do this efficiently we
11405 generate a back-mapping of the indices first. */
11406 backmap = XALLOCAVEC (int, numfiles);
11407 for (i = 0; i < numfiles; i++)
11408 backmap[files[i].file_idx->emitted_number - 1] = i;
11410 /* Now write all the file names. */
11411 for (i = 0; i < numfiles; i++)
11413 int file_idx = backmap[i];
11414 int dir_idx = dirs[files[file_idx].dir_idx].dir_idx;
11416 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11417 #define MAX_VMS_VERSION_LEN 6 /* ";32768" */
11419 /* Setting these fields can lead to debugger miscomparisons,
11420 but VMS Debug requires them to be set correctly. */
11422 int ver;
11423 long long cdt;
11424 long siz;
11425 int maxfilelen = strlen (files[file_idx].path)
11426 + dirs[dir_idx].length
11427 + MAX_VMS_VERSION_LEN + 1;
11428 char *filebuf = XALLOCAVEC (char, maxfilelen);
11430 vms_file_stats_name (files[file_idx].path, 0, 0, 0, &ver);
11431 snprintf (filebuf, maxfilelen, "%s;%d",
11432 files[file_idx].path + dirs[dir_idx].length, ver);
11434 dw2_asm_output_nstring
11435 (filebuf, -1, "File Entry: 0x%x", (unsigned) i + 1);
11437 /* Include directory index. */
11438 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (dir_idx + idx_offset, NULL);
11440 /* Modification time. */
11441 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128
11442 ((vms_file_stats_name (files[file_idx].path, &cdt, 0, 0, 0) == 0)
11443 ? cdt : 0,
11444 NULL);
11446 /* File length in bytes. */
11447 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128
11448 ((vms_file_stats_name (files[file_idx].path, 0, &siz, 0, 0) == 0)
11449 ? siz : 0,
11450 NULL);
11451 #else
11452 dw2_asm_output_nstring (files[file_idx].path + dirs[dir_idx].length, -1,
11453 "File Entry: 0x%x", (unsigned) i + 1);
11455 /* Include directory index. */
11456 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (dir_idx + idx_offset, NULL);
11458 /* Modification time. */
11459 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
11461 /* File length in bytes. */
11462 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
11463 #endif
11466 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End file name table");
11470 /* Output the source line number correspondence information. This
11471 information goes into the .debug_line section. */
11473 static void
11474 output_line_info (void)
11476 char l1[20], l2[20], p1[20], p2[20];
11477 char line_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11478 char prev_line_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11479 unsigned opc;
11480 unsigned n_op_args;
11481 unsigned long lt_index;
11482 unsigned long current_line;
11483 long line_offset;
11484 long line_delta;
11485 unsigned long current_file;
11486 unsigned long function;
11487 int ver = dwarf_version;
11489 /* Don't mark the output as DWARF-4 until we make full use of the
11490 version 4 extensions, and gdb supports them. For now, -gdwarf-4
11491 selects only a few extensions from the DWARF-4 spec. */
11492 if (ver > 3)
11493 ver = 3;
11495 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, LINE_NUMBER_BEGIN_LABEL, 0);
11496 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, LINE_NUMBER_END_LABEL, 0);
11497 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (p1, LN_PROLOG_AS_LABEL, 0);
11498 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (p2, LN_PROLOG_END_LABEL, 0);
11500 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
11501 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
11502 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
11503 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
11504 "Length of Source Line Info");
11505 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
11507 dw2_asm_output_data (2, ver, "DWARF Version");
11508 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, p2, p1, "Prolog Length");
11509 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, p1);
11511 /* Define the architecture-dependent minimum instruction length (in
11512 bytes). In this implementation of DWARF, this field is used for
11513 information purposes only. Since GCC generates assembly language,
11514 we have no a priori knowledge of how many instruction bytes are
11515 generated for each source line, and therefore can use only the
11516 DW_LNE_set_address and DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc line information
11517 commands. Accordingly, we fix this as `1', which is "correct
11518 enough" for all architectures, and don't let the target override. */
11519 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 1,
11520 "Minimum Instruction Length");
11522 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START,
11523 "Default is_stmt_start flag");
11524 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_BASE,
11525 "Line Base Value (Special Opcodes)");
11526 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_RANGE,
11527 "Line Range Value (Special Opcodes)");
11528 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE,
11529 "Special Opcode Base");
11531 for (opc = 1; opc < DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE; opc++)
11533 switch (opc)
11535 case DW_LNS_advance_pc:
11536 case DW_LNS_advance_line:
11537 case DW_LNS_set_file:
11538 case DW_LNS_set_column:
11539 case DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc:
11540 n_op_args = 1;
11541 break;
11542 default:
11543 n_op_args = 0;
11544 break;
11547 dw2_asm_output_data (1, n_op_args, "opcode: 0x%x has %d args",
11548 opc, n_op_args);
11551 /* Write out the information about the files we use. */
11552 output_file_names ();
11553 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, p2);
11555 /* We used to set the address register to the first location in the text
11556 section here, but that didn't accomplish anything since we already
11557 have a line note for the opening brace of the first function. */
11559 /* Generate the line number to PC correspondence table, encoded as
11560 a series of state machine operations. */
11561 current_file = 1;
11562 current_line = 1;
11564 if (cfun && in_cold_section_p)
11565 strcpy (prev_line_label, crtl->subsections.cold_section_label);
11566 else
11567 strcpy (prev_line_label, text_section_label);
11568 for (lt_index = 1; lt_index < line_info_table_in_use; ++lt_index)
11570 dw_line_info_ref line_info = &line_info_table[lt_index];
11572 #if 0
11573 /* Disable this optimization for now; GDB wants to see two line notes
11574 at the beginning of a function so it can find the end of the
11575 prologue. */
11577 /* Don't emit anything for redundant notes. Just updating the
11578 address doesn't accomplish anything, because we already assume
11579 that anything after the last address is this line. */
11580 if (line_info->dw_line_num == current_line
11581 && line_info->dw_file_num == current_file)
11582 continue;
11583 #endif
11585 /* Emit debug info for the address of the current line.
11587 Unfortunately, we have little choice here currently, and must always
11588 use the most general form. GCC does not know the address delta
11589 itself, so we can't use DW_LNS_advance_pc. Many ports do have length
11590 attributes which will give an upper bound on the address range. We
11591 could perhaps use length attributes to determine when it is safe to
11592 use DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc. */
11594 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, LINE_CODE_LABEL, lt_index);
11595 if (0)
11597 /* This can handle deltas up to 0xffff. This takes 3 bytes. */
11598 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
11599 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
11600 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
11602 else
11604 /* This can handle any delta. This takes
11605 4+DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE bytes. */
11606 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
11607 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
11608 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
11609 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
11612 strcpy (prev_line_label, line_label);
11614 /* Emit debug info for the source file of the current line, if
11615 different from the previous line. */
11616 if (line_info->dw_file_num != current_file)
11618 current_file = line_info->dw_file_num;
11619 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_file, "DW_LNS_set_file");
11620 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (current_file, "%lu", current_file);
11623 /* Emit debug info for the current line number, choosing the encoding
11624 that uses the least amount of space. */
11625 if (line_info->dw_line_num != current_line)
11627 line_offset = line_info->dw_line_num - current_line;
11628 line_delta = line_offset - DWARF_LINE_BASE;
11629 current_line = line_info->dw_line_num;
11630 if (line_delta >= 0 && line_delta < (DWARF_LINE_RANGE - 1))
11631 /* This can handle deltas from -10 to 234, using the current
11632 definitions of DWARF_LINE_BASE and DWARF_LINE_RANGE. This
11633 takes 1 byte. */
11634 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE + line_delta,
11635 "line %lu", current_line);
11636 else
11638 /* This can handle any delta. This takes at least 4 bytes,
11639 depending on the value being encoded. */
11640 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_advance_line,
11641 "advance to line %lu", current_line);
11642 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (line_offset, NULL);
11643 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
11646 else
11647 /* We still need to start a new row, so output a copy insn. */
11648 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
11651 /* Emit debug info for the address of the end of the function. */
11652 if (0)
11654 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
11655 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
11656 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, text_end_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
11658 else
11660 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
11661 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
11662 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
11663 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_end_label, NULL);
11666 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_end_sequence");
11667 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, NULL);
11668 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_end_sequence, NULL);
11670 function = 0;
11671 current_file = 1;
11672 current_line = 1;
11673 for (lt_index = 0; lt_index < separate_line_info_table_in_use;)
11675 dw_separate_line_info_ref line_info
11676 = &separate_line_info_table[lt_index];
11678 #if 0
11679 /* Don't emit anything for redundant notes. */
11680 if (line_info->dw_line_num == current_line
11681 && line_info->dw_file_num == current_file
11682 && line_info->function == function)
11683 goto cont;
11684 #endif
11686 /* Emit debug info for the address of the current line. If this is
11687 a new function, or the first line of a function, then we need
11688 to handle it differently. */
11689 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL,
11690 lt_index);
11691 if (function != line_info->function)
11693 function = line_info->function;
11695 /* Set the address register to the first line in the function. */
11696 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
11697 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
11698 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
11699 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
11701 else
11703 /* ??? See the DW_LNS_advance_pc comment above. */
11704 if (0)
11706 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
11707 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
11708 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
11710 else
11712 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
11713 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
11714 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
11715 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
11719 strcpy (prev_line_label, line_label);
11721 /* Emit debug info for the source file of the current line, if
11722 different from the previous line. */
11723 if (line_info->dw_file_num != current_file)
11725 current_file = line_info->dw_file_num;
11726 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_file, "DW_LNS_set_file");
11727 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (current_file, "%lu", current_file);
11730 /* Emit debug info for the current line number, choosing the encoding
11731 that uses the least amount of space. */
11732 if (line_info->dw_line_num != current_line)
11734 line_offset = line_info->dw_line_num - current_line;
11735 line_delta = line_offset - DWARF_LINE_BASE;
11736 current_line = line_info->dw_line_num;
11737 if (line_delta >= 0 && line_delta < (DWARF_LINE_RANGE - 1))
11738 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE + line_delta,
11739 "line %lu", current_line);
11740 else
11742 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_advance_line,
11743 "advance to line %lu", current_line);
11744 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (line_offset, NULL);
11745 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
11748 else
11749 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
11751 #if 0
11752 cont:
11753 #endif
11755 lt_index++;
11757 /* If we're done with a function, end its sequence. */
11758 if (lt_index == separate_line_info_table_in_use
11759 || separate_line_info_table[lt_index].function != function)
11761 current_file = 1;
11762 current_line = 1;
11764 /* Emit debug info for the address of the end of the function. */
11765 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, FUNC_END_LABEL, function);
11766 if (0)
11768 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
11769 "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
11770 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
11772 else
11774 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
11775 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
11776 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
11777 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
11780 /* Output the marker for the end of this sequence. */
11781 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_end_sequence");
11782 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, NULL);
11783 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_end_sequence, NULL);
11787 /* Output the marker for the end of the line number info. */
11788 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
11791 /* Return the size of the .debug_dcall table for the compilation unit. */
11793 static unsigned long
11794 size_of_dcall_table (void)
11796 unsigned long size;
11797 unsigned int i;
11798 dcall_entry *p;
11799 tree last_poc_decl = NULL;
11801 /* Header: version + debug info section pointer + pointer size. */
11802 size = 2 + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 1;
11804 /* Each entry: code label + DIE offset. */
11805 for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (dcall_entry, dcall_table, i, p); i++)
11807 gcc_assert (p->targ_die != NULL);
11808 /* Insert a "from" entry when the point-of-call DIE offset changes. */
11809 if (p->poc_decl != last_poc_decl)
11811 dw_die_ref poc_die = lookup_decl_die (p->poc_decl);
11812 gcc_assert (poc_die);
11813 last_poc_decl = p->poc_decl;
11814 if (poc_die)
11815 size += (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
11816 + size_of_uleb128 (poc_die->die_offset));
11818 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + size_of_uleb128 (p->targ_die->die_offset);
11821 return size;
11824 /* Output the direct call table used to disambiguate PC values when
11825 identical function have been merged. */
11827 static void
11828 output_dcall_table (void)
11830 unsigned i;
11831 unsigned long dcall_length = size_of_dcall_table ();
11832 dcall_entry *p;
11833 char poc_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11834 tree last_poc_decl = NULL;
11836 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
11837 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
11838 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
11839 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, dcall_length,
11840 "Length of Direct Call Table");
11841 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 4, "Version number");
11842 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
11843 debug_info_section,
11844 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
11845 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Pointer Size (in bytes)");
11847 for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (dcall_entry, dcall_table, i, p); i++)
11849 /* Insert a "from" entry when the point-of-call DIE offset changes. */
11850 if (p->poc_decl != last_poc_decl)
11852 dw_die_ref poc_die = lookup_decl_die (p->poc_decl);
11853 last_poc_decl = p->poc_decl;
11854 if (poc_die)
11856 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, 0, "New caller");
11857 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (poc_die->die_offset,
11858 "Caller DIE offset");
11861 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (poc_label, "LPOC", p->poc_label_num);
11862 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, poc_label, "Point of call");
11863 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (p->targ_die->die_offset,
11864 "Callee DIE offset");
11868 /* Return the size of the .debug_vcall table for the compilation unit. */
11870 static unsigned long
11871 size_of_vcall_table (void)
11873 unsigned long size;
11874 unsigned int i;
11875 vcall_entry *p;
11877 /* Header: version + pointer size. */
11878 size = 2 + 1;
11880 /* Each entry: code label + vtable slot index. */
11881 for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (vcall_entry, vcall_table, i, p); i++)
11882 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + size_of_uleb128 (p->vtable_slot);
11884 return size;
11887 /* Output the virtual call table used to disambiguate PC values when
11888 identical function have been merged. */
11890 static void
11891 output_vcall_table (void)
11893 unsigned i;
11894 unsigned long vcall_length = size_of_vcall_table ();
11895 vcall_entry *p;
11896 char poc_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11898 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
11899 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
11900 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
11901 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, vcall_length,
11902 "Length of Virtual Call Table");
11903 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 4, "Version number");
11904 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Pointer Size (in bytes)");
11906 for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (vcall_entry, vcall_table, i, p); i++)
11908 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (poc_label, "LPOC", p->poc_label_num);
11909 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, poc_label, "Point of call");
11910 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (p->vtable_slot, "Vtable slot");
11914 /* Given a pointer to a tree node for some base type, return a pointer to
11915 a DIE that describes the given type.
11917 This routine must only be called for GCC type nodes that correspond to
11918 Dwarf base (fundamental) types. */
11920 static dw_die_ref
11921 base_type_die (tree type)
11923 dw_die_ref base_type_result;
11924 enum dwarf_type encoding;
11926 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK || TREE_CODE (type) == VOID_TYPE)
11927 return 0;
11929 /* If this is a subtype that should not be emitted as a subrange type,
11930 use the base type. See subrange_type_for_debug_p. */
11931 if (TREE_CODE (type) == INTEGER_TYPE && TREE_TYPE (type) != NULL_TREE)
11932 type = TREE_TYPE (type);
11934 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
11936 case INTEGER_TYPE:
11937 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (type))
11939 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
11940 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned_char;
11941 else
11942 encoding = DW_ATE_signed_char;
11944 else if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
11945 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned;
11946 else
11947 encoding = DW_ATE_signed;
11948 break;
11950 case REAL_TYPE:
11951 if (DECIMAL_FLOAT_MODE_P (TYPE_MODE (type)))
11953 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
11954 encoding = DW_ATE_decimal_float;
11955 else
11956 encoding = DW_ATE_lo_user;
11958 else
11959 encoding = DW_ATE_float;
11960 break;
11962 case FIXED_POINT_TYPE:
11963 if (!(dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
11964 encoding = DW_ATE_lo_user;
11965 else if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
11966 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned_fixed;
11967 else
11968 encoding = DW_ATE_signed_fixed;
11969 break;
11971 /* Dwarf2 doesn't know anything about complex ints, so use
11972 a user defined type for it. */
11973 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
11974 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == REAL_TYPE)
11975 encoding = DW_ATE_complex_float;
11976 else
11977 encoding = DW_ATE_lo_user;
11978 break;
11980 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
11981 /* GNU FORTRAN/Ada/C++ BOOLEAN type. */
11982 encoding = DW_ATE_boolean;
11983 break;
11985 default:
11986 /* No other TREE_CODEs are Dwarf fundamental types. */
11987 gcc_unreachable ();
11990 base_type_result = new_die (DW_TAG_base_type, comp_unit_die, type);
11992 /* This probably indicates a bug. */
11993 if (! TYPE_NAME (type))
11994 add_name_attribute (base_type_result, "__unknown__");
11996 add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_byte_size,
11997 int_size_in_bytes (type));
11998 add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_encoding, encoding);
12000 return base_type_result;
12003 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return nonzero if the
12004 given input type is a Dwarf "fundamental" type. Otherwise return null. */
12006 static inline int
12007 is_base_type (tree type)
12009 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
12011 case ERROR_MARK:
12012 case VOID_TYPE:
12013 case INTEGER_TYPE:
12014 case REAL_TYPE:
12015 case FIXED_POINT_TYPE:
12016 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
12017 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
12018 return 1;
12020 case ARRAY_TYPE:
12021 case RECORD_TYPE:
12022 case UNION_TYPE:
12023 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
12024 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
12025 case FUNCTION_TYPE:
12026 case METHOD_TYPE:
12027 case POINTER_TYPE:
12028 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
12029 case OFFSET_TYPE:
12030 case LANG_TYPE:
12031 case VECTOR_TYPE:
12032 return 0;
12034 default:
12035 gcc_unreachable ();
12038 return 0;
12041 /* Given a pointer to a tree node, assumed to be some kind of a ..._TYPE
12042 node, return the size in bits for the type if it is a constant, or else
12043 return the alignment for the type if the type's size is not constant, or
12044 else return BITS_PER_WORD if the type actually turns out to be an
12045 ERROR_MARK node. */
12047 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
12048 simple_type_size_in_bits (const_tree type)
12050 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK)
12051 return BITS_PER_WORD;
12052 else if (TYPE_SIZE (type) == NULL_TREE)
12053 return 0;
12054 else if (host_integerp (TYPE_SIZE (type), 1))
12055 return tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (type), 1);
12056 else
12057 return TYPE_ALIGN (type);
12060 /* Given a pointer to a tree node for a subrange type, return a pointer
12061 to a DIE that describes the given type. */
12063 static dw_die_ref
12064 subrange_type_die (tree type, tree low, tree high, dw_die_ref context_die)
12066 dw_die_ref subrange_die;
12067 const HOST_WIDE_INT size_in_bytes = int_size_in_bytes (type);
12069 if (context_die == NULL)
12070 context_die = comp_unit_die;
12072 subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, context_die, type);
12074 if (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (type)) != size_in_bytes)
12076 /* The size of the subrange type and its base type do not match,
12077 so we need to generate a size attribute for the subrange type. */
12078 add_AT_unsigned (subrange_die, DW_AT_byte_size, size_in_bytes);
12081 if (low)
12082 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound, low);
12083 if (high)
12084 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound, high);
12086 return subrange_die;
12089 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return a debugging
12090 entry that chains various modifiers in front of the given type. */
12092 static dw_die_ref
12093 modified_type_die (tree type, int is_const_type, int is_volatile_type,
12094 dw_die_ref context_die)
12096 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
12097 dw_die_ref mod_type_die;
12098 dw_die_ref sub_die = NULL;
12099 tree item_type = NULL;
12100 tree qualified_type;
12101 tree name, low, high;
12103 if (code == ERROR_MARK)
12104 return NULL;
12106 /* See if we already have the appropriately qualified variant of
12107 this type. */
12108 qualified_type
12109 = get_qualified_type (type,
12110 ((is_const_type ? TYPE_QUAL_CONST : 0)
12111 | (is_volatile_type ? TYPE_QUAL_VOLATILE : 0)));
12113 /* If we do, then we can just use its DIE, if it exists. */
12114 if (qualified_type)
12116 mod_type_die = lookup_type_die (qualified_type);
12117 if (mod_type_die)
12118 return mod_type_die;
12121 name = qualified_type ? TYPE_NAME (qualified_type) : NULL;
12123 /* Handle C typedef types. */
12124 if (name && TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name))
12126 tree dtype = TREE_TYPE (name);
12128 if (qualified_type == dtype)
12130 /* For a named type, use the typedef. */
12131 gen_type_die (qualified_type, context_die);
12132 return lookup_type_die (qualified_type);
12134 else if (is_const_type < TYPE_READONLY (dtype)
12135 || is_volatile_type < TYPE_VOLATILE (dtype)
12136 || (is_const_type <= TYPE_READONLY (dtype)
12137 && is_volatile_type <= TYPE_VOLATILE (dtype)
12138 && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name) != type))
12139 /* cv-unqualified version of named type. Just use the unnamed
12140 type to which it refers. */
12141 return modified_type_die (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name),
12142 is_const_type, is_volatile_type,
12143 context_die);
12144 /* Else cv-qualified version of named type; fall through. */
12147 if (is_const_type)
12149 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_const_type, comp_unit_die, type);
12150 sub_die = modified_type_die (type, 0, is_volatile_type, context_die);
12152 else if (is_volatile_type)
12154 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_volatile_type, comp_unit_die, type);
12155 sub_die = modified_type_die (type, 0, 0, context_die);
12157 else if (code == POINTER_TYPE)
12159 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_pointer_type, comp_unit_die, type);
12160 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size,
12161 simple_type_size_in_bits (type) / BITS_PER_UNIT);
12162 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
12163 if (!ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC_P (TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (item_type)))
12164 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_address_class,
12165 TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (item_type));
12167 else if (code == REFERENCE_TYPE)
12169 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_reference_type, comp_unit_die, type);
12170 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size,
12171 simple_type_size_in_bits (type) / BITS_PER_UNIT);
12172 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
12173 if (!ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC_P (TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (item_type)))
12174 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_address_class,
12175 TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (item_type));
12177 else if (code == INTEGER_TYPE
12178 && TREE_TYPE (type) != NULL_TREE
12179 && subrange_type_for_debug_p (type, &low, &high))
12181 mod_type_die = subrange_type_die (type, low, high, context_die);
12182 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
12184 else if (is_base_type (type))
12185 mod_type_die = base_type_die (type);
12186 else
12188 gen_type_die (type, context_die);
12190 /* We have to get the type_main_variant here (and pass that to the
12191 `lookup_type_die' routine) because the ..._TYPE node we have
12192 might simply be a *copy* of some original type node (where the
12193 copy was created to help us keep track of typedef names) and
12194 that copy might have a different TYPE_UID from the original
12195 ..._TYPE node. */
12196 if (TREE_CODE (type) != VECTOR_TYPE)
12197 return lookup_type_die (type_main_variant (type));
12198 else
12199 /* Vectors have the debugging information in the type,
12200 not the main variant. */
12201 return lookup_type_die (type);
12204 /* Builtin types don't have a DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE. For those,
12205 don't output a DW_TAG_typedef, since there isn't one in the
12206 user's program; just attach a DW_AT_name to the type.
12207 Don't attach a DW_AT_name to DW_TAG_const_type or DW_TAG_volatile_type
12208 if the base type already has the same name. */
12209 if (name
12210 && ((TREE_CODE (name) != TYPE_DECL
12211 && (qualified_type == TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type)
12212 || (!is_const_type && !is_volatile_type)))
12213 || (TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL
12214 && TREE_TYPE (name) == qualified_type
12215 && DECL_NAME (name))))
12217 if (TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL)
12218 /* Could just call add_name_and_src_coords_attributes here,
12219 but since this is a builtin type it doesn't have any
12220 useful source coordinates anyway. */
12221 name = DECL_NAME (name);
12222 add_name_attribute (mod_type_die, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
12225 if (qualified_type)
12226 equate_type_number_to_die (qualified_type, mod_type_die);
12228 if (item_type)
12229 /* We must do this after the equate_type_number_to_die call, in case
12230 this is a recursive type. This ensures that the modified_type_die
12231 recursion will terminate even if the type is recursive. Recursive
12232 types are possible in Ada. */
12233 sub_die = modified_type_die (item_type,
12234 TYPE_READONLY (item_type),
12235 TYPE_VOLATILE (item_type),
12236 context_die);
12238 if (sub_die != NULL)
12239 add_AT_die_ref (mod_type_die, DW_AT_type, sub_die);
12241 return mod_type_die;
12244 /* Generate DIEs for the generic parameters of T.
12245 T must be either a generic type or a generic function.
12246 See http://gcc.gnu.org/wiki/TemplateParmsDwarf for more. */
12248 static void
12249 gen_generic_params_dies (tree t)
12251 tree parms, args;
12252 int parms_num, i;
12253 dw_die_ref die = NULL;
12255 if (!t || (TYPE_P (t) && !COMPLETE_TYPE_P (t)))
12256 return;
12258 if (TYPE_P (t))
12259 die = lookup_type_die (t);
12260 else if (DECL_P (t))
12261 die = lookup_decl_die (t);
12263 gcc_assert (die);
12265 parms = lang_hooks.get_innermost_generic_parms (t);
12266 if (!parms)
12267 /* T has no generic parameter. It means T is neither a generic type
12268 or function. End of story. */
12269 return;
12271 parms_num = TREE_VEC_LENGTH (parms);
12272 args = lang_hooks.get_innermost_generic_args (t);
12273 for (i = 0; i < parms_num; i++)
12275 tree parm, arg, arg_pack_elems;
12277 parm = TREE_VEC_ELT (parms, i);
12278 arg = TREE_VEC_ELT (args, i);
12279 arg_pack_elems = lang_hooks.types.get_argument_pack_elems (arg);
12280 gcc_assert (parm && TREE_VALUE (parm) && arg);
12282 if (parm && TREE_VALUE (parm) && arg)
12284 /* If PARM represents a template parameter pack,
12285 emit a DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack DIE, followed
12286 by DW_TAG_template_*_parameter DIEs for the argument
12287 pack elements of ARG. Note that ARG would then be
12288 an argument pack. */
12289 if (arg_pack_elems)
12290 template_parameter_pack_die (TREE_VALUE (parm),
12291 arg_pack_elems,
12292 die);
12293 else
12294 generic_parameter_die (TREE_VALUE (parm), arg,
12295 true /* Emit DW_AT_name */, die);
12300 /* Create and return a DIE for PARM which should be
12301 the representation of a generic type parameter.
12302 For instance, in the C++ front end, PARM would be a template parameter.
12303 ARG is the argument to PARM.
12304 EMIT_NAME_P if tree, the DIE will have DW_AT_name attribute set to the
12305 name of the PARM.
12306 PARENT_DIE is the parent DIE which the new created DIE should be added to,
12307 as a child node. */
12309 static dw_die_ref
12310 generic_parameter_die (tree parm, tree arg,
12311 bool emit_name_p,
12312 dw_die_ref parent_die)
12314 dw_die_ref tmpl_die = NULL;
12315 const char *name = NULL;
12317 if (!parm || !DECL_NAME (parm) || !arg)
12318 return NULL;
12320 /* We support non-type generic parameters and arguments,
12321 type generic parameters and arguments, as well as
12322 generic generic parameters (a.k.a. template template parameters in C++)
12323 and arguments. */
12324 if (TREE_CODE (parm) == PARM_DECL)
12325 /* PARM is a nontype generic parameter */
12326 tmpl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_template_value_param, parent_die, parm);
12327 else if (TREE_CODE (parm) == TYPE_DECL)
12328 /* PARM is a type generic parameter. */
12329 tmpl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_template_type_param, parent_die, parm);
12330 else if (lang_hooks.decls.generic_generic_parameter_decl_p (parm))
12331 /* PARM is a generic generic parameter.
12332 Its DIE is a GNU extension. It shall have a
12333 DW_AT_name attribute to represent the name of the template template
12334 parameter, and a DW_AT_GNU_template_name attribute to represent the
12335 name of the template template argument. */
12336 tmpl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_template_template_param,
12337 parent_die, parm);
12338 else
12339 gcc_unreachable ();
12341 if (tmpl_die)
12343 tree tmpl_type;
12345 /* If PARM is a generic parameter pack, it means we are
12346 emitting debug info for a template argument pack element.
12347 In other terms, ARG is a template argument pack element.
12348 In that case, we don't emit any DW_AT_name attribute for
12349 the die. */
12350 if (emit_name_p)
12352 name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (parm));
12353 gcc_assert (name);
12354 add_AT_string (tmpl_die, DW_AT_name, name);
12357 if (!lang_hooks.decls.generic_generic_parameter_decl_p (parm))
12359 /* DWARF3, 5.6.8 says if PARM is a non-type generic parameter
12360 TMPL_DIE should have a child DW_AT_type attribute that is set
12361 to the type of the argument to PARM, which is ARG.
12362 If PARM is a type generic parameter, TMPL_DIE should have a
12363 child DW_AT_type that is set to ARG. */
12364 tmpl_type = TYPE_P (arg) ? arg : TREE_TYPE (arg);
12365 add_type_attribute (tmpl_die, tmpl_type, 0,
12366 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (tmpl_type),
12367 parent_die);
12369 else
12371 /* So TMPL_DIE is a DIE representing a
12372 a generic generic template parameter, a.k.a template template
12373 parameter in C++ and arg is a template. */
12375 /* The DW_AT_GNU_template_name attribute of the DIE must be set
12376 to the name of the argument. */
12377 name = dwarf2_name (TYPE_P (arg) ? TYPE_NAME (arg) : arg, 1);
12378 if (name)
12379 add_AT_string (tmpl_die, DW_AT_GNU_template_name, name);
12382 if (TREE_CODE (parm) == PARM_DECL)
12383 /* So PARM is a non-type generic parameter.
12384 DWARF3 5.6.8 says we must set a DW_AT_const_value child
12385 attribute of TMPL_DIE which value represents the value
12386 of ARG.
12387 We must be careful here:
12388 The value of ARG might reference some function decls.
12389 We might currently be emitting debug info for a generic
12390 type and types are emitted before function decls, we don't
12391 know if the function decls referenced by ARG will actually be
12392 emitted after cgraph computations.
12393 So must defer the generation of the DW_AT_const_value to
12394 after cgraph is ready. */
12395 append_entry_to_tmpl_value_parm_die_table (tmpl_die, arg);
12398 return tmpl_die;
12401 /* Generate and return a DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack DIE representing.
12402 PARM_PACK must be a template parameter pack. The returned DIE
12403 will be child DIE of PARENT_DIE. */
12405 static dw_die_ref
12406 template_parameter_pack_die (tree parm_pack,
12407 tree parm_pack_args,
12408 dw_die_ref parent_die)
12410 dw_die_ref die;
12411 int j;
12413 gcc_assert (parent_die && parm_pack);
12415 die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack, parent_die, parm_pack);
12416 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (die, parm_pack);
12417 for (j = 0; j < TREE_VEC_LENGTH (parm_pack_args); j++)
12418 generic_parameter_die (parm_pack,
12419 TREE_VEC_ELT (parm_pack_args, j),
12420 false /* Don't emit DW_AT_name */,
12421 die);
12422 return die;
12425 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return true if it is
12426 an enumerated type. */
12428 static inline int
12429 type_is_enum (const_tree type)
12431 return TREE_CODE (type) == ENUMERAL_TYPE;
12434 /* Return the DBX register number described by a given RTL node. */
12436 static unsigned int
12437 dbx_reg_number (const_rtx rtl)
12439 unsigned regno = REGNO (rtl);
12441 gcc_assert (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
12443 #ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
12444 if (current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs)
12446 int leaf_reg = LEAF_REG_REMAP (regno);
12447 if (leaf_reg != -1)
12448 regno = (unsigned) leaf_reg;
12450 #endif
12452 return DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (regno);
12455 /* Optionally add a DW_OP_piece term to a location description expression.
12456 DW_OP_piece is only added if the location description expression already
12457 doesn't end with DW_OP_piece. */
12459 static void
12460 add_loc_descr_op_piece (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, int size)
12462 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
12464 if (*list_head != NULL)
12466 /* Find the end of the chain. */
12467 for (loc = *list_head; loc->dw_loc_next != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
12470 if (loc->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_piece)
12471 loc->dw_loc_next = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece, size, 0);
12475 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a machine register or
12476 zero if there is none. */
12478 static dw_loc_descr_ref
12479 reg_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, enum var_init_status initialized)
12481 rtx regs;
12483 if (REGNO (rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
12484 return 0;
12486 regs = targetm.dwarf_register_span (rtl);
12488 if (hard_regno_nregs[REGNO (rtl)][GET_MODE (rtl)] > 1 || regs)
12489 return multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtl, regs, initialized);
12490 else
12491 return one_reg_loc_descriptor (dbx_reg_number (rtl), initialized);
12494 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a machine register for
12495 a given hard register number. */
12497 static dw_loc_descr_ref
12498 one_reg_loc_descriptor (unsigned int regno, enum var_init_status initialized)
12500 dw_loc_descr_ref reg_loc_descr;
12502 if (regno <= 31)
12503 reg_loc_descr
12504 = new_loc_descr ((enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_reg0 + regno), 0, 0);
12505 else
12506 reg_loc_descr = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_regx, regno, 0);
12508 if (initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
12509 add_loc_descr (&reg_loc_descr, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
12511 return reg_loc_descr;
12514 /* Given an RTL of a register, return a location descriptor that
12515 designates a value that spans more than one register. */
12517 static dw_loc_descr_ref
12518 multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, rtx regs,
12519 enum var_init_status initialized)
12521 int nregs, size, i;
12522 unsigned reg;
12523 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
12525 reg = REGNO (rtl);
12526 #ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
12527 if (current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs)
12529 int leaf_reg = LEAF_REG_REMAP (reg);
12530 if (leaf_reg != -1)
12531 reg = (unsigned) leaf_reg;
12533 #endif
12534 gcc_assert ((unsigned) DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (reg) == dbx_reg_number (rtl));
12535 nregs = hard_regno_nregs[REGNO (rtl)][GET_MODE (rtl)];
12537 /* Simple, contiguous registers. */
12538 if (regs == NULL_RTX)
12540 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) / nregs;
12542 loc_result = NULL;
12543 while (nregs--)
12545 dw_loc_descr_ref t;
12547 t = one_reg_loc_descriptor (DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (reg),
12548 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12549 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, t);
12550 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, size);
12551 ++reg;
12553 return loc_result;
12556 /* Now onto stupid register sets in non contiguous locations. */
12558 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (regs) == PARALLEL);
12560 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XVECEXP (regs, 0, 0)));
12561 loc_result = NULL;
12563 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (regs, 0); ++i)
12565 dw_loc_descr_ref t;
12567 t = one_reg_loc_descriptor (REGNO (XVECEXP (regs, 0, i)),
12568 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12569 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, t);
12570 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XVECEXP (regs, 0, 0)));
12571 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, size);
12574 if (loc_result && initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
12575 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
12576 return loc_result;
12579 #endif /* DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO */
12581 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
12583 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a constant. */
12585 static dw_loc_descr_ref
12586 int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT i)
12588 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
12590 /* Pick the smallest representation of a constant, rather than just
12591 defaulting to the LEB encoding. */
12592 if (i >= 0)
12594 if (i <= 31)
12595 op = (enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_lit0 + i);
12596 else if (i <= 0xff)
12597 op = DW_OP_const1u;
12598 else if (i <= 0xffff)
12599 op = DW_OP_const2u;
12600 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
12601 || i <= 0xffffffff)
12602 op = DW_OP_const4u;
12603 else
12604 op = DW_OP_constu;
12606 else
12608 if (i >= -0x80)
12609 op = DW_OP_const1s;
12610 else if (i >= -0x8000)
12611 op = DW_OP_const2s;
12612 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
12613 || i >= -0x80000000)
12614 op = DW_OP_const4s;
12615 else
12616 op = DW_OP_consts;
12619 return new_loc_descr (op, i, 0);
12621 #endif
12623 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
12624 /* Return loc description representing "address" of integer value.
12625 This can appear only as toplevel expression. */
12627 static dw_loc_descr_ref
12628 address_of_int_loc_descriptor (int size, HOST_WIDE_INT i)
12630 int litsize;
12631 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
12633 if (!(dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
12634 return NULL;
12636 if (i >= 0)
12638 if (i <= 31)
12639 litsize = 1;
12640 else if (i <= 0xff)
12641 litsize = 2;
12642 else if (i <= 0xffff)
12643 litsize = 3;
12644 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
12645 || i <= 0xffffffff)
12646 litsize = 5;
12647 else
12648 litsize = 1 + size_of_uleb128 ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) i);
12650 else
12652 if (i >= -0x80)
12653 litsize = 2;
12654 else if (i >= -0x8000)
12655 litsize = 3;
12656 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
12657 || i >= -0x80000000)
12658 litsize = 5;
12659 else
12660 litsize = 1 + size_of_sleb128 (i);
12662 /* Determine if DW_OP_stack_value or DW_OP_implicit_value
12663 is more compact. For DW_OP_stack_value we need:
12664 litsize + 1 (DW_OP_stack_value)
12665 and for DW_OP_implicit_value:
12666 1 (DW_OP_implicit_value) + 1 (length) + size. */
12667 if ((int) DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE >= size && litsize + 1 <= 1 + 1 + size)
12669 loc_result = int_loc_descriptor (i);
12670 add_loc_descr (&loc_result,
12671 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
12672 return loc_result;
12675 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value,
12676 size, 0);
12677 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
12678 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int = i;
12679 return loc_result;
12682 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a base+offset location. */
12684 static dw_loc_descr_ref
12685 based_loc_descr (rtx reg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset,
12686 enum var_init_status initialized)
12688 unsigned int regno;
12689 dw_loc_descr_ref result;
12690 dw_fde_ref fde = current_fde ();
12692 /* We only use "frame base" when we're sure we're talking about the
12693 post-prologue local stack frame. We do this by *not* running
12694 register elimination until this point, and recognizing the special
12695 argument pointer and soft frame pointer rtx's. */
12696 if (reg == arg_pointer_rtx || reg == frame_pointer_rtx)
12698 rtx elim = eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX);
12700 if (elim != reg)
12702 if (GET_CODE (elim) == PLUS)
12704 offset += INTVAL (XEXP (elim, 1));
12705 elim = XEXP (elim, 0);
12707 gcc_assert ((SUPPORTS_STACK_ALIGNMENT
12708 && (elim == hard_frame_pointer_rtx
12709 || elim == stack_pointer_rtx))
12710 || elim == (frame_pointer_needed
12711 ? hard_frame_pointer_rtx
12712 : stack_pointer_rtx));
12714 /* If drap register is used to align stack, use frame
12715 pointer + offset to access stack variables. If stack
12716 is aligned without drap, use stack pointer + offset to
12717 access stack variables. */
12718 if (crtl->stack_realign_tried
12719 && reg == frame_pointer_rtx)
12721 int base_reg
12722 = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM ((fde && fde->drap_reg != INVALID_REGNUM)
12723 ? HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
12724 : STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
12725 return new_reg_loc_descr (base_reg, offset);
12728 offset += frame_pointer_fb_offset;
12729 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_fbreg, offset, 0);
12732 else if (fde
12733 && fde->drap_reg != INVALID_REGNUM
12734 && (fde->drap_reg == REGNO (reg)
12735 || fde->vdrap_reg == REGNO (reg)))
12737 /* Use cfa+offset to represent the location of arguments passed
12738 on stack when drap is used to align stack. */
12739 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_fbreg, offset, 0);
12742 regno = dbx_reg_number (reg);
12743 if (regno <= 31)
12744 result = new_loc_descr ((enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_breg0 + regno),
12745 offset, 0);
12746 else
12747 result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, regno, offset);
12749 if (initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
12750 add_loc_descr (&result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
12752 return result;
12755 /* Return true if this RTL expression describes a base+offset calculation. */
12757 static inline int
12758 is_based_loc (const_rtx rtl)
12760 return (GET_CODE (rtl) == PLUS
12761 && ((REG_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
12762 && REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
12763 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))));
12766 /* Try to handle TLS MEMs, for which mem_loc_descriptor on XEXP (mem, 0)
12767 failed. */
12769 static dw_loc_descr_ref
12770 tls_mem_loc_descriptor (rtx mem)
12772 tree base;
12773 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result;
12775 if (MEM_EXPR (mem) == NULL_TREE || MEM_OFFSET (mem) == NULL_RTX)
12776 return NULL;
12778 base = get_base_address (MEM_EXPR (mem));
12779 if (base == NULL
12780 || TREE_CODE (base) != VAR_DECL
12781 || !DECL_THREAD_LOCAL_P (base))
12782 return NULL;
12784 loc_result = loc_descriptor_from_tree (MEM_EXPR (mem), 1);
12785 if (loc_result == NULL)
12786 return NULL;
12788 if (INTVAL (MEM_OFFSET (mem)))
12789 loc_descr_plus_const (&loc_result, INTVAL (MEM_OFFSET (mem)));
12791 return loc_result;
12794 /* Output debug info about reason why we failed to expand expression as dwarf
12795 expression. */
12797 static void
12798 expansion_failed (tree expr, rtx rtl, char const *reason)
12800 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
12802 fprintf (dump_file, "Failed to expand as dwarf: ");
12803 if (expr)
12804 print_generic_expr (dump_file, expr, dump_flags);
12805 if (rtl)
12807 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
12808 print_rtl (dump_file, rtl);
12810 fprintf (dump_file, "\nReason: %s\n", reason);
12814 /* Helper function for const_ok_for_output, called either directly
12815 or via for_each_rtx. */
12817 static int
12818 const_ok_for_output_1 (rtx *rtlp, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
12820 rtx rtl = *rtlp;
12822 if (GET_CODE (rtl) != SYMBOL_REF)
12823 return 0;
12825 if (CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (rtl))
12827 bool marked;
12828 get_pool_constant_mark (rtl, &marked);
12829 /* If all references to this pool constant were optimized away,
12830 it was not output and thus we can't represent it. */
12831 if (!marked)
12833 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
12834 "Constant was removed from constant pool.\n");
12835 return 1;
12839 if (SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (rtl) != TLS_MODEL_NONE)
12840 return 1;
12842 /* Avoid references to external symbols in debug info, on several targets
12843 the linker might even refuse to link when linking a shared library,
12844 and in many other cases the relocations for .debug_info/.debug_loc are
12845 dropped, so the address becomes zero anyway. Hidden symbols, guaranteed
12846 to be defined within the same shared library or executable are fine. */
12847 if (SYMBOL_REF_EXTERNAL_P (rtl))
12849 tree decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl);
12851 if (decl == NULL || !targetm.binds_local_p (decl))
12853 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
12854 "Symbol not defined in current TU.\n");
12855 return 1;
12859 return 0;
12862 /* Return true if constant RTL can be emitted in DW_OP_addr or
12863 DW_AT_const_value. TLS SYMBOL_REFs, external SYMBOL_REFs or
12864 non-marked constant pool SYMBOL_REFs can't be referenced in it. */
12866 static bool
12867 const_ok_for_output (rtx rtl)
12869 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF)
12870 return const_ok_for_output_1 (&rtl, NULL) == 0;
12872 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST)
12873 return for_each_rtx (&XEXP (rtl, 0), const_ok_for_output_1, NULL) == 0;
12875 return true;
12878 /* The following routine converts the RTL for a variable or parameter
12879 (resident in memory) into an equivalent Dwarf representation of a
12880 mechanism for getting the address of that same variable onto the top of a
12881 hypothetical "address evaluation" stack.
12883 When creating memory location descriptors, we are effectively transforming
12884 the RTL for a memory-resident object into its Dwarf postfix expression
12885 equivalent. This routine recursively descends an RTL tree, turning
12886 it into Dwarf postfix code as it goes.
12888 MODE is the mode of the memory reference, needed to handle some
12889 autoincrement addressing modes.
12891 CAN_USE_FBREG is a flag whether we can use DW_AT_frame_base in the
12892 location list for RTL.
12894 Return 0 if we can't represent the location. */
12896 static dw_loc_descr_ref
12897 mem_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, enum machine_mode mode,
12898 enum var_init_status initialized)
12900 dw_loc_descr_ref mem_loc_result = NULL;
12901 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
12902 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, op1;
12904 /* Note that for a dynamically sized array, the location we will generate a
12905 description of here will be the lowest numbered location which is
12906 actually within the array. That's *not* necessarily the same as the
12907 zeroth element of the array. */
12909 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
12911 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
12913 case POST_INC:
12914 case POST_DEC:
12915 case POST_MODIFY:
12916 return mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, initialized);
12918 case SUBREG:
12919 /* The case of a subreg may arise when we have a local (register)
12920 variable or a formal (register) parameter which doesn't quite fill
12921 up an entire register. For now, just assume that it is
12922 legitimate to make the Dwarf info refer to the whole register which
12923 contains the given subreg. */
12924 if (!subreg_lowpart_p (rtl))
12925 break;
12926 rtl = SUBREG_REG (rtl);
12927 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
12928 break;
12929 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (rtl)) != MODE_INT)
12930 break;
12931 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, initialized);
12932 break;
12934 case REG:
12935 /* Whenever a register number forms a part of the description of the
12936 method for calculating the (dynamic) address of a memory resident
12937 object, DWARF rules require the register number be referred to as
12938 a "base register". This distinction is not based in any way upon
12939 what category of register the hardware believes the given register
12940 belongs to. This is strictly DWARF terminology we're dealing with
12941 here. Note that in cases where the location of a memory-resident
12942 data object could be expressed as: OP_ADD (OP_BASEREG (basereg),
12943 OP_CONST (0)) the actual DWARF location descriptor that we generate
12944 may just be OP_BASEREG (basereg). This may look deceptively like
12945 the object in question was allocated to a register (rather than in
12946 memory) so DWARF consumers need to be aware of the subtle
12947 distinction between OP_REG and OP_BASEREG. */
12948 if (REGNO (rtl) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
12949 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (rtl, 0, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12950 else if (stack_realign_drap
12951 && crtl->drap_reg
12952 && crtl->args.internal_arg_pointer == rtl
12953 && REGNO (crtl->drap_reg) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
12955 /* If RTL is internal_arg_pointer, which has been optimized
12956 out, use DRAP instead. */
12957 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (crtl->drap_reg, 0,
12958 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12960 break;
12962 case SIGN_EXTEND:
12963 case ZERO_EXTEND:
12964 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode,
12965 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12966 if (op0 == 0)
12967 break;
12968 else
12970 int shift = DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
12971 - GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)));
12972 shift *= BITS_PER_UNIT;
12973 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SIGN_EXTEND)
12974 op = DW_OP_shra;
12975 else
12976 op = DW_OP_shr;
12977 mem_loc_result = op0;
12978 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
12979 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
12980 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
12981 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
12983 break;
12985 case MEM:
12986 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), GET_MODE (rtl),
12987 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
12988 if (mem_loc_result == NULL)
12989 mem_loc_result = tls_mem_loc_descriptor (rtl);
12990 if (mem_loc_result != 0)
12991 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0));
12992 break;
12994 case LO_SUM:
12995 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
12997 /* ... fall through ... */
12999 case LABEL_REF:
13000 /* Some ports can transform a symbol ref into a label ref, because
13001 the symbol ref is too far away and has to be dumped into a constant
13002 pool. */
13003 case CONST:
13004 case SYMBOL_REF:
13005 /* Alternatively, the symbol in the constant pool might be referenced
13006 by a different symbol. */
13007 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF && CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (rtl))
13009 bool marked;
13010 rtx tmp = get_pool_constant_mark (rtl, &marked);
13012 if (GET_CODE (tmp) == SYMBOL_REF)
13014 rtl = tmp;
13015 if (CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (tmp))
13016 get_pool_constant_mark (tmp, &marked);
13017 else
13018 marked = true;
13021 /* If all references to this pool constant were optimized away,
13022 it was not output and thus we can't represent it.
13023 FIXME: might try to use DW_OP_const_value here, though
13024 DW_OP_piece complicates it. */
13025 if (!marked)
13027 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
13028 "Constant was removed from constant pool.\n");
13029 return 0;
13033 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF
13034 && SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (rtl) != TLS_MODEL_NONE)
13036 dw_loc_descr_ref temp;
13038 /* If this is not defined, we have no way to emit the data. */
13039 if (!targetm.have_tls || !targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
13040 break;
13042 temp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_addr, 0, 0);
13043 temp->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
13044 temp->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
13045 temp->dtprel = true;
13047 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address, 0, 0);
13048 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, temp);
13050 break;
13053 if (!const_ok_for_output (rtl))
13054 break;
13056 symref:
13057 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_addr, 0, 0);
13058 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
13059 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
13060 VEC_safe_push (rtx, gc, used_rtx_array, rtl);
13061 break;
13063 case CONCAT:
13064 case CONCATN:
13065 case VAR_LOCATION:
13066 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
13067 "CONCAT/CONCATN/VAR_LOCATION is handled only by loc_descriptor");
13068 return 0;
13070 case PRE_MODIFY:
13071 /* Extract the PLUS expression nested inside and fall into
13072 PLUS code below. */
13073 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
13074 goto plus;
13076 case PRE_INC:
13077 case PRE_DEC:
13078 /* Turn these into a PLUS expression and fall into the PLUS code
13079 below. */
13080 rtl = gen_rtx_PLUS (word_mode, XEXP (rtl, 0),
13081 GEN_INT (GET_CODE (rtl) == PRE_INC
13082 ? GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode)
13083 : -GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode)));
13085 /* ... fall through ... */
13087 case PLUS:
13088 plus:
13089 if (is_based_loc (rtl))
13090 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (XEXP (rtl, 0),
13091 INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)),
13092 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13093 else
13095 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode,
13096 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13097 if (mem_loc_result == 0)
13098 break;
13100 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
13101 loc_descr_plus_const (&mem_loc_result, INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)));
13102 else
13104 dw_loc_descr_ref mem_loc_result2
13105 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode,
13106 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13107 if (mem_loc_result2 == 0)
13108 break;
13109 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, mem_loc_result2);
13110 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
13111 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
13114 break;
13116 /* If a pseudo-reg is optimized away, it is possible for it to
13117 be replaced with a MEM containing a multiply or shift. */
13118 case MINUS:
13119 op = DW_OP_minus;
13120 goto do_binop;
13122 case MULT:
13123 op = DW_OP_mul;
13124 goto do_binop;
13126 case DIV:
13127 op = DW_OP_div;
13128 goto do_binop;
13130 case MOD:
13131 op = DW_OP_mod;
13132 goto do_binop;
13134 case ASHIFT:
13135 op = DW_OP_shl;
13136 goto do_binop;
13138 case ASHIFTRT:
13139 op = DW_OP_shra;
13140 goto do_binop;
13142 case LSHIFTRT:
13143 op = DW_OP_shr;
13144 goto do_binop;
13146 case AND:
13147 op = DW_OP_and;
13148 goto do_binop;
13150 case IOR:
13151 op = DW_OP_or;
13152 goto do_binop;
13154 case XOR:
13155 op = DW_OP_xor;
13156 goto do_binop;
13158 do_binop:
13159 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode,
13160 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13161 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode,
13162 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13164 if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
13165 break;
13167 mem_loc_result = op0;
13168 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
13169 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
13170 break;
13172 case NOT:
13173 op = DW_OP_not;
13174 goto do_unop;
13176 case ABS:
13177 op = DW_OP_abs;
13178 goto do_unop;
13180 case NEG:
13181 op = DW_OP_neg;
13182 goto do_unop;
13184 do_unop:
13185 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode,
13186 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13188 if (op0 == 0)
13189 break;
13191 mem_loc_result = op0;
13192 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
13193 break;
13195 case CONST_INT:
13196 mem_loc_result = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (rtl));
13197 break;
13199 case EQ:
13200 op = DW_OP_eq;
13201 goto do_scompare;
13203 case GE:
13204 op = DW_OP_ge;
13205 goto do_scompare;
13207 case GT:
13208 op = DW_OP_gt;
13209 goto do_scompare;
13211 case LE:
13212 op = DW_OP_le;
13213 goto do_scompare;
13215 case LT:
13216 op = DW_OP_lt;
13217 goto do_scompare;
13219 case NE:
13220 op = DW_OP_ne;
13221 goto do_scompare;
13223 do_scompare:
13224 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0))) != MODE_INT
13225 || GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0))) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
13226 || GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
13227 break;
13229 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode,
13230 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13231 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode,
13232 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13234 if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
13235 break;
13237 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0))) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13239 int shift = DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
13240 - GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)));
13241 shift *= BITS_PER_UNIT;
13242 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
13243 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
13244 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
13245 op1 = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) << shift);
13246 else
13248 add_loc_descr (&op1, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
13249 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
13253 do_compare:
13254 mem_loc_result = op0;
13255 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
13256 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
13257 if (STORE_FLAG_VALUE != 1)
13259 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
13260 int_loc_descriptor (STORE_FLAG_VALUE));
13261 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_mul, 0, 0));
13263 break;
13265 case GEU:
13266 op = DW_OP_ge;
13267 goto do_ucompare;
13269 case GTU:
13270 op = DW_OP_gt;
13271 goto do_ucompare;
13273 case LEU:
13274 op = DW_OP_le;
13275 goto do_ucompare;
13277 case LTU:
13278 op = DW_OP_lt;
13279 goto do_ucompare;
13281 do_ucompare:
13282 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0))) != MODE_INT
13283 || GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0))) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
13284 || GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
13285 break;
13287 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode,
13288 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13289 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode,
13290 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13292 if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
13293 break;
13295 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0))) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13297 HOST_WIDE_INT mask = GET_MODE_MASK (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)));
13298 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (mask));
13299 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
13300 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
13301 op1 = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) & mask);
13302 else
13304 add_loc_descr (&op1, int_loc_descriptor (mask));
13305 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
13308 else
13310 HOST_WIDE_INT bias = 1;
13311 bias <<= (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * BITS_PER_UNIT - 1);
13312 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bias, 0));
13313 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
13314 op1 = int_loc_descriptor ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) bias
13315 + INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)));
13316 else
13317 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bias, 0));
13319 goto do_compare;
13321 case SMIN:
13322 case SMAX:
13323 case UMIN:
13324 case UMAX:
13325 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0))) != MODE_INT
13326 || GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0))) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
13327 || GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
13328 break;
13330 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode,
13331 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13332 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode,
13333 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13335 if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
13336 break;
13338 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0));
13339 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
13340 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
13341 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == UMIN || GET_CODE (rtl) == UMAX)
13343 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0))) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13345 HOST_WIDE_INT mask = GET_MODE_MASK (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)));
13346 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (mask));
13347 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
13348 add_loc_descr (&op1, int_loc_descriptor (mask));
13349 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
13351 else
13353 HOST_WIDE_INT bias = 1;
13354 bias <<= (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * BITS_PER_UNIT - 1);
13355 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bias, 0));
13356 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bias, 0));
13359 else if (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0))) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13361 int shift = DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
13362 - GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)));
13363 shift *= BITS_PER_UNIT;
13364 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
13365 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
13366 add_loc_descr (&op1, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
13367 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
13370 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SMIN || GET_CODE (rtl) == UMIN)
13371 op = DW_OP_lt;
13372 else
13373 op = DW_OP_gt;
13374 mem_loc_result = op0;
13375 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
13376 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
13378 dw_loc_descr_ref bra_node, drop_node;
13380 bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
13381 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, bra_node);
13382 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
13383 drop_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
13384 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, drop_node);
13385 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
13386 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = drop_node;
13388 break;
13390 case ZERO_EXTRACT:
13391 case SIGN_EXTRACT:
13392 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1))
13393 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 2))
13394 && ((unsigned) INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1))
13395 + (unsigned) INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 2))
13396 <= GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)))
13397 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
13398 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0))) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13400 int shift, size;
13401 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode,
13402 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13403 if (op0 == 0)
13404 break;
13405 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SIGN_EXTRACT)
13406 op = DW_OP_shra;
13407 else
13408 op = DW_OP_shr;
13409 mem_loc_result = op0;
13410 size = INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1));
13411 shift = INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 2));
13412 if (BITS_BIG_ENDIAN)
13413 shift = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
13414 - shift - size;
13415 if (shift + size != (int) DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13417 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
13418 int_loc_descriptor (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
13419 - shift - size));
13420 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
13422 if (size != (int) DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13424 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
13425 int_loc_descriptor (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE - size));
13426 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
13429 break;
13431 case COMPARE:
13432 case IF_THEN_ELSE:
13433 case ROTATE:
13434 case ROTATERT:
13435 case TRUNCATE:
13436 /* In theory, we could implement the above. */
13437 /* DWARF cannot represent the unsigned compare operations
13438 natively. */
13439 case SS_MULT:
13440 case US_MULT:
13441 case SS_DIV:
13442 case US_DIV:
13443 case UDIV:
13444 case UMOD:
13445 case UNORDERED:
13446 case ORDERED:
13447 case UNEQ:
13448 case UNGE:
13449 case UNGT:
13450 case UNLE:
13451 case UNLT:
13452 case LTGT:
13453 case FLOAT_EXTEND:
13454 case FLOAT_TRUNCATE:
13455 case FLOAT:
13456 case UNSIGNED_FLOAT:
13457 case FIX:
13458 case UNSIGNED_FIX:
13459 case FRACT_CONVERT:
13460 case UNSIGNED_FRACT_CONVERT:
13461 case SAT_FRACT:
13462 case UNSIGNED_SAT_FRACT:
13463 case SQRT:
13464 case BSWAP:
13465 case FFS:
13466 case CLZ:
13467 case CTZ:
13468 case POPCOUNT:
13469 case PARITY:
13470 case ASM_OPERANDS:
13471 case UNSPEC:
13472 case HIGH:
13473 /* If delegitimize_address couldn't do anything with the UNSPEC, we
13474 can't express it in the debug info. This can happen e.g. with some
13475 TLS UNSPECs. */
13476 break;
13478 case CONST_STRING:
13479 resolve_one_addr (&rtl, NULL);
13480 goto symref;
13482 default:
13483 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
13484 print_rtl (stderr, rtl);
13485 gcc_unreachable ();
13486 #else
13487 break;
13488 #endif
13491 if (mem_loc_result && initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
13492 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
13494 return mem_loc_result;
13497 /* Return a descriptor that describes the concatenation of two locations.
13498 This is typically a complex variable. */
13500 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13501 concat_loc_descriptor (rtx x0, rtx x1, enum var_init_status initialized)
13503 dw_loc_descr_ref cc_loc_result = NULL;
13504 dw_loc_descr_ref x0_ref
13505 = loc_descriptor (x0, VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13506 dw_loc_descr_ref x1_ref
13507 = loc_descriptor (x1, VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13509 if (x0_ref == 0 || x1_ref == 0)
13510 return 0;
13512 cc_loc_result = x0_ref;
13513 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x0)));
13515 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, x1_ref);
13516 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x1)));
13518 if (initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
13519 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
13521 return cc_loc_result;
13524 /* Return a descriptor that describes the concatenation of N
13525 locations. */
13527 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13528 concatn_loc_descriptor (rtx concatn, enum var_init_status initialized)
13530 unsigned int i;
13531 dw_loc_descr_ref cc_loc_result = NULL;
13532 unsigned int n = XVECLEN (concatn, 0);
13534 for (i = 0; i < n; ++i)
13536 dw_loc_descr_ref ref;
13537 rtx x = XVECEXP (concatn, 0, i);
13539 ref = loc_descriptor (x, VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13540 if (ref == NULL)
13541 return NULL;
13543 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, ref);
13544 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x)));
13547 if (cc_loc_result && initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
13548 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
13550 return cc_loc_result;
13553 /* Output a proper Dwarf location descriptor for a variable or parameter
13554 which is either allocated in a register or in a memory location. For a
13555 register, we just generate an OP_REG and the register number. For a
13556 memory location we provide a Dwarf postfix expression describing how to
13557 generate the (dynamic) address of the object onto the address stack.
13559 MODE is mode of the decl if this loc_descriptor is going to be used in
13560 .debug_loc section where DW_OP_stack_value and DW_OP_implicit_value are
13561 allowed, VOIDmode otherwise.
13563 If we don't know how to describe it, return 0. */
13565 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13566 loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, enum machine_mode mode,
13567 enum var_init_status initialized)
13569 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
13571 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
13573 case SUBREG:
13574 /* The case of a subreg may arise when we have a local (register)
13575 variable or a formal (register) parameter which doesn't quite fill
13576 up an entire register. For now, just assume that it is
13577 legitimate to make the Dwarf info refer to the whole register which
13578 contains the given subreg. */
13579 loc_result = loc_descriptor (SUBREG_REG (rtl), mode, initialized);
13580 break;
13582 case REG:
13583 loc_result = reg_loc_descriptor (rtl, initialized);
13584 break;
13586 case SIGN_EXTEND:
13587 case ZERO_EXTEND:
13588 loc_result = loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, initialized);
13589 break;
13591 case MEM:
13592 loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), GET_MODE (rtl),
13593 initialized);
13594 if (loc_result == NULL)
13595 loc_result = tls_mem_loc_descriptor (rtl);
13596 break;
13598 case CONCAT:
13599 loc_result = concat_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), XEXP (rtl, 1),
13600 initialized);
13601 break;
13603 case CONCATN:
13604 loc_result = concatn_loc_descriptor (rtl, initialized);
13605 break;
13607 case VAR_LOCATION:
13608 /* Single part. */
13609 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)) != PARALLEL)
13611 loc_result = loc_descriptor (XEXP (XEXP (rtl, 1), 0), mode,
13612 initialized);
13613 break;
13616 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
13617 /* FALLTHRU */
13619 case PARALLEL:
13621 rtvec par_elems = XVEC (rtl, 0);
13622 int num_elem = GET_NUM_ELEM (par_elems);
13623 enum machine_mode mode;
13624 int i;
13626 /* Create the first one, so we have something to add to. */
13627 loc_result = loc_descriptor (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, 0), 0),
13628 VOIDmode, initialized);
13629 if (loc_result == NULL)
13630 return NULL;
13631 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, 0), 0));
13632 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
13633 for (i = 1; i < num_elem; i++)
13635 dw_loc_descr_ref temp;
13637 temp = loc_descriptor (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, i), 0),
13638 VOIDmode, initialized);
13639 if (temp == NULL)
13640 return NULL;
13641 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, temp);
13642 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, i), 0));
13643 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
13646 break;
13648 case CONST_INT:
13649 if (mode != VOIDmode && mode != BLKmode)
13650 loc_result = address_of_int_loc_descriptor (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode),
13651 INTVAL (rtl));
13652 break;
13654 case CONST_DOUBLE:
13655 if (mode != VOIDmode && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
13657 /* Note that a CONST_DOUBLE rtx could represent either an integer
13658 or a floating-point constant. A CONST_DOUBLE is used whenever
13659 the constant requires more than one word in order to be
13660 adequately represented. We output CONST_DOUBLEs as blocks. */
13661 if (GET_MODE (rtl) != VOIDmode)
13662 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
13664 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value,
13665 GET_MODE_SIZE (mode), 0);
13666 if (SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (mode))
13668 unsigned int length = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
13669 unsigned char *array = GGC_NEWVEC (unsigned char, length);
13671 insert_float (rtl, array);
13672 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
13673 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.length = length / 4;
13674 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.elt_size = 4;
13675 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.array = array;
13677 else
13679 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_const_double;
13680 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_double.high
13681 = CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (rtl);
13682 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_double.low
13683 = CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (rtl);
13686 break;
13688 case CONST_VECTOR:
13689 if (mode != VOIDmode && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
13691 unsigned int elt_size = GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl));
13692 unsigned int length = CONST_VECTOR_NUNITS (rtl);
13693 unsigned char *array = GGC_NEWVEC (unsigned char, length * elt_size);
13694 unsigned int i;
13695 unsigned char *p;
13697 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
13698 switch (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode))
13700 case MODE_VECTOR_INT:
13701 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
13703 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
13704 HOST_WIDE_INT lo, hi;
13706 switch (GET_CODE (elt))
13708 case CONST_INT:
13709 lo = INTVAL (elt);
13710 hi = -(lo < 0);
13711 break;
13713 case CONST_DOUBLE:
13714 lo = CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (elt);
13715 hi = CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (elt);
13716 break;
13718 default:
13719 gcc_unreachable ();
13722 if (elt_size <= sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
13723 insert_int (lo, elt_size, p);
13724 else
13726 unsigned char *p0 = p;
13727 unsigned char *p1 = p + sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT);
13729 gcc_assert (elt_size == 2 * sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT));
13730 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
13732 p0 = p1;
13733 p1 = p;
13735 insert_int (lo, sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT), p0);
13736 insert_int (hi, sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT), p1);
13739 break;
13741 case MODE_VECTOR_FLOAT:
13742 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
13744 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
13745 insert_float (elt, p);
13747 break;
13749 default:
13750 gcc_unreachable ();
13753 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value,
13754 length * elt_size, 0);
13755 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
13756 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.length = length;
13757 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.elt_size = elt_size;
13758 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.array = array;
13760 break;
13762 case CONST:
13763 if (mode == VOIDmode
13764 || GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == CONST_INT
13765 || GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == CONST_DOUBLE
13766 || GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == CONST_VECTOR)
13768 loc_result = loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, initialized);
13769 break;
13771 /* FALLTHROUGH */
13772 case SYMBOL_REF:
13773 if (!const_ok_for_output (rtl))
13774 break;
13775 case LABEL_REF:
13776 if (mode != VOIDmode && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
13777 && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
13779 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value,
13780 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0);
13781 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
13782 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_addr = rtl;
13783 VEC_safe_push (rtx, gc, used_rtx_array, rtl);
13785 break;
13787 default:
13788 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT && GET_MODE (rtl) == mode
13789 && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
13790 && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
13792 /* Value expression. */
13793 loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, VOIDmode, initialized);
13794 if (loc_result)
13795 add_loc_descr (&loc_result,
13796 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
13798 break;
13801 return loc_result;
13804 /* We need to figure out what section we should use as the base for the
13805 address ranges where a given location is valid.
13806 1. If this particular DECL has a section associated with it, use that.
13807 2. If this function has a section associated with it, use that.
13808 3. Otherwise, use the text section.
13809 XXX: If you split a variable across multiple sections, we won't notice. */
13811 static const char *
13812 secname_for_decl (const_tree decl)
13814 const char *secname;
13816 if (VAR_OR_FUNCTION_DECL_P (decl) && DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl))
13818 tree sectree = DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl);
13819 secname = TREE_STRING_POINTER (sectree);
13821 else if (current_function_decl && DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl))
13823 tree sectree = DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl);
13824 secname = TREE_STRING_POINTER (sectree);
13826 else if (cfun && in_cold_section_p)
13827 secname = crtl->subsections.cold_section_label;
13828 else
13829 secname = text_section_label;
13831 return secname;
13834 /* Return true when DECL_BY_REFERENCE is defined and set for DECL. */
13836 static bool
13837 decl_by_reference_p (tree decl)
13839 return ((TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == RESULT_DECL
13840 || TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL)
13841 && DECL_BY_REFERENCE (decl));
13844 /* Return single element location list containing loc descr REF. */
13846 static dw_loc_list_ref
13847 single_element_loc_list (dw_loc_descr_ref ref)
13849 return new_loc_list (ref, NULL, NULL, NULL, 0);
13852 /* Helper function for dw_loc_list. Compute proper Dwarf location descriptor
13853 for VARLOC. */
13855 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13856 dw_loc_list_1 (tree loc, rtx varloc, int want_address,
13857 enum var_init_status initialized)
13859 int have_address = 0;
13860 dw_loc_descr_ref descr;
13861 enum machine_mode mode;
13863 if (want_address != 2)
13865 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (varloc) == VAR_LOCATION);
13866 /* Single part. */
13867 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (varloc, 1)) != PARALLEL)
13869 varloc = XEXP (XEXP (varloc, 1), 0);
13870 mode = GET_MODE (varloc);
13871 if (MEM_P (varloc))
13873 varloc = XEXP (varloc, 0);
13874 have_address = 1;
13876 descr = mem_loc_descriptor (varloc, mode, initialized);
13878 else
13879 return 0;
13881 else
13883 descr = loc_descriptor (varloc, DECL_MODE (loc), initialized);
13884 have_address = 1;
13887 if (!descr)
13888 return 0;
13890 if (want_address == 2 && !have_address
13891 && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
13893 if (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc)) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13895 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
13896 "DWARF address size mismatch");
13897 return 0;
13899 add_loc_descr (&descr, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
13900 have_address = 1;
13902 /* Show if we can't fill the request for an address. */
13903 if (want_address && !have_address)
13905 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
13906 "Want address and only have value");
13907 return 0;
13910 /* If we've got an address and don't want one, dereference. */
13911 if (!want_address && have_address)
13913 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc));
13914 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
13916 if (size > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE || size == -1)
13918 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
13919 "DWARF address size mismatch");
13920 return 0;
13922 else if (size == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13923 op = DW_OP_deref;
13924 else
13925 op = DW_OP_deref_size;
13927 add_loc_descr (&descr, new_loc_descr (op, size, 0));
13930 return descr;
13933 /* Return dwarf representation of location list representing for
13934 LOC_LIST of DECL. WANT_ADDRESS has the same meaning as in
13935 loc_list_from_tree function. */
13937 static dw_loc_list_ref
13938 dw_loc_list (var_loc_list * loc_list, tree decl, int want_address)
13940 const char *endname, *secname;
13941 dw_loc_list_ref list;
13942 rtx varloc;
13943 enum var_init_status initialized;
13944 struct var_loc_node *node;
13945 dw_loc_descr_ref descr;
13946 char label_id[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
13948 /* Now that we know what section we are using for a base,
13949 actually construct the list of locations.
13950 The first location information is what is passed to the
13951 function that creates the location list, and the remaining
13952 locations just get added on to that list.
13953 Note that we only know the start address for a location
13954 (IE location changes), so to build the range, we use
13955 the range [current location start, next location start].
13956 This means we have to special case the last node, and generate
13957 a range of [last location start, end of function label]. */
13959 node = loc_list->first;
13960 secname = secname_for_decl (decl);
13962 if (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (node->var_loc_note))
13963 initialized = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (node->var_loc_note);
13964 else
13965 initialized = VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED;
13966 varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->var_loc_note);
13967 descr = dw_loc_list_1 (decl, varloc, want_address, initialized);
13969 if (loc_list && loc_list->first != loc_list->last)
13970 list = new_loc_list (descr, node->label, node->next->label, secname, 1);
13971 else
13972 return single_element_loc_list (descr);
13973 node = node->next;
13975 if (!node)
13976 return NULL;
13978 for (; node->next; node = node->next)
13979 if (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (node->var_loc_note) != NULL_RTX)
13981 /* The variable has a location between NODE->LABEL and
13982 NODE->NEXT->LABEL. */
13983 initialized = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (node->var_loc_note);
13984 varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->var_loc_note);
13985 descr = dw_loc_list_1 (decl, varloc, want_address, initialized);
13986 add_loc_descr_to_loc_list (&list, descr,
13987 node->label, node->next->label, secname);
13990 /* If the variable has a location at the last label
13991 it keeps its location until the end of function. */
13992 if (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (node->var_loc_note) != NULL_RTX)
13994 if (!current_function_decl)
13995 endname = text_end_label;
13996 else
13998 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_END_LABEL,
13999 current_function_funcdef_no);
14000 endname = ggc_strdup (label_id);
14003 initialized = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (node->var_loc_note);
14004 varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->var_loc_note);
14005 descr = dw_loc_list_1 (decl, varloc, want_address, initialized);
14006 add_loc_descr_to_loc_list (&list, descr, node->label, endname, secname);
14008 return list;
14011 /* Return if the loc_list has only single element and thus can be represented
14012 as location description. */
14014 static bool
14015 single_element_loc_list_p (dw_loc_list_ref list)
14017 return (!list->dw_loc_next && !list->begin && !list->end);
14020 /* To each location in list LIST add loc descr REF. */
14022 static void
14023 add_loc_descr_to_each (dw_loc_list_ref list, dw_loc_descr_ref ref)
14025 dw_loc_descr_ref copy;
14026 add_loc_descr (&list->expr, ref);
14027 list = list->dw_loc_next;
14028 while (list)
14030 copy = GGC_CNEW (dw_loc_descr_node);
14031 memcpy (copy, ref, sizeof (dw_loc_descr_node));
14032 add_loc_descr (&list->expr, copy);
14033 while (copy->dw_loc_next)
14035 dw_loc_descr_ref new_copy = GGC_CNEW (dw_loc_descr_node);
14036 memcpy (new_copy, copy->dw_loc_next, sizeof (dw_loc_descr_node));
14037 copy->dw_loc_next = new_copy;
14038 copy = new_copy;
14040 list = list->dw_loc_next;
14044 /* Given two lists RET and LIST
14045 produce location list that is result of adding expression in LIST
14046 to expression in RET on each possition in program.
14047 Might be destructive on both RET and LIST.
14049 TODO: We handle only simple cases of RET or LIST having at most one
14050 element. General case would inolve sorting the lists in program order
14051 and merging them that will need some additional work.
14052 Adding that will improve quality of debug info especially for SRA-ed
14053 structures. */
14055 static void
14056 add_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref *ret, dw_loc_list_ref list)
14058 if (!list)
14059 return;
14060 if (!*ret)
14062 *ret = list;
14063 return;
14065 if (!list->dw_loc_next)
14067 add_loc_descr_to_each (*ret, list->expr);
14068 return;
14070 if (!(*ret)->dw_loc_next)
14072 add_loc_descr_to_each (list, (*ret)->expr);
14073 *ret = list;
14074 return;
14076 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, NULL_RTX,
14077 "Don't know how to merge two non-trivial"
14078 " location lists.\n");
14079 *ret = NULL;
14080 return;
14083 /* LOC is constant expression. Try a luck, look it up in constant
14084 pool and return its loc_descr of its address. */
14086 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14087 cst_pool_loc_descr (tree loc)
14089 /* Get an RTL for this, if something has been emitted. */
14090 rtx rtl = lookup_constant_def (loc);
14091 enum machine_mode mode;
14093 if (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl))
14095 gcc_assert (!rtl);
14096 return 0;
14098 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == SYMBOL_REF);
14100 /* TODO: We might get more coverage if we was actually delaying expansion
14101 of all expressions till end of compilation when constant pools are fully
14102 populated. */
14103 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (rtl, 0))))
14105 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
14106 "CST value in contant pool but not marked.");
14107 return 0;
14109 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
14110 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
14111 return mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14114 /* Return dw_loc_list representing address of addr_expr LOC
14115 by looking for innder INDIRECT_REF expression and turing it
14116 into simple arithmetics. */
14118 static dw_loc_list_ref
14119 loc_list_for_address_of_addr_expr_of_indirect_ref (tree loc, bool toplev)
14121 tree obj, offset;
14122 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos, bytepos;
14123 enum machine_mode mode;
14124 int volatilep;
14125 int unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc));
14126 dw_loc_list_ref list_ret = NULL, list_ret1 = NULL;
14128 obj = get_inner_reference (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0),
14129 &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode,
14130 &unsignedp, &volatilep, false);
14131 STRIP_NOPS (obj);
14132 if (bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT)
14134 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "bitfield access");
14135 return 0;
14137 if (!INDIRECT_REF_P (obj))
14139 expansion_failed (obj,
14140 NULL_RTX, "no indirect ref in inner refrence");
14141 return 0;
14143 if (!offset && !bitpos)
14144 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (obj, 0), toplev ? 2 : 1);
14145 else if (toplev
14146 && int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc)) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
14147 && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
14149 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (obj, 0), 0);
14150 if (!list_ret)
14151 return 0;
14152 if (offset)
14154 /* Variable offset. */
14155 list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree (offset, 0);
14156 if (list_ret1 == 0)
14157 return 0;
14158 add_loc_list (&list_ret, list_ret1);
14159 if (!list_ret)
14160 return 0;
14161 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
14162 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
14164 bytepos = bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT;
14165 if (bytepos > 0)
14166 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
14167 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
14168 bytepos, 0));
14169 else if (bytepos < 0)
14170 loc_list_plus_const (list_ret, bytepos);
14171 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
14172 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
14174 return list_ret;
14178 /* Generate Dwarf location list representing LOC.
14179 If WANT_ADDRESS is false, expression computing LOC will be computed
14180 If WANT_ADDRESS is 1, expression computing address of LOC will be returned
14181 if WANT_ADDRESS is 2, expression computing address useable in location
14182 will be returned (i.e. DW_OP_reg can be used
14183 to refer to register values). */
14185 static dw_loc_list_ref
14186 loc_list_from_tree (tree loc, int want_address)
14188 dw_loc_descr_ref ret = NULL, ret1 = NULL;
14189 dw_loc_list_ref list_ret = NULL, list_ret1 = NULL;
14190 int have_address = 0;
14191 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
14193 /* ??? Most of the time we do not take proper care for sign/zero
14194 extending the values properly. Hopefully this won't be a real
14195 problem... */
14197 switch (TREE_CODE (loc))
14199 case ERROR_MARK:
14200 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "ERROR_MARK");
14201 return 0;
14203 case PLACEHOLDER_EXPR:
14204 /* This case involves extracting fields from an object to determine the
14205 position of other fields. We don't try to encode this here. The
14206 only user of this is Ada, which encodes the needed information using
14207 the names of types. */
14208 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "PLACEHOLDER_EXPR");
14209 return 0;
14211 case CALL_EXPR:
14212 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "CALL_EXPR");
14213 /* There are no opcodes for these operations. */
14214 return 0;
14216 case PREINCREMENT_EXPR:
14217 case PREDECREMENT_EXPR:
14218 case POSTINCREMENT_EXPR:
14219 case POSTDECREMENT_EXPR:
14220 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "PRE/POST INDCREMENT/DECREMENT");
14221 /* There are no opcodes for these operations. */
14222 return 0;
14224 case ADDR_EXPR:
14225 /* If we already want an address, see if there is INDIRECT_REF inside
14226 e.g. for &this->field. */
14227 if (want_address)
14229 list_ret = loc_list_for_address_of_addr_expr_of_indirect_ref
14230 (loc, want_address == 2);
14231 if (list_ret)
14232 have_address = 1;
14233 else if (decl_address_ip_invariant_p (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))
14234 && (ret = cst_pool_loc_descr (loc)))
14235 have_address = 1;
14237 /* Otherwise, process the argument and look for the address. */
14238 if (!list_ret && !ret)
14239 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 1);
14240 else
14242 if (want_address)
14243 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "need address of ADDR_EXPR");
14244 return NULL;
14246 break;
14248 case VAR_DECL:
14249 if (DECL_THREAD_LOCAL_P (loc))
14251 rtx rtl;
14252 enum dwarf_location_atom first_op;
14253 enum dwarf_location_atom second_op;
14254 bool dtprel = false;
14256 if (targetm.have_tls)
14258 /* If this is not defined, we have no way to emit the
14259 data. */
14260 if (!targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
14261 return 0;
14263 /* The way DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address is specified, we
14264 can only look up addresses of objects in the current
14265 module. */
14266 if (DECL_EXTERNAL (loc) && !targetm.binds_local_p (loc))
14267 return 0;
14268 first_op = DW_OP_addr;
14269 dtprel = true;
14270 second_op = DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address;
14272 else
14274 if (!targetm.emutls.debug_form_tls_address
14275 || !(dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
14276 return 0;
14277 loc = emutls_decl (loc);
14278 first_op = DW_OP_addr;
14279 second_op = DW_OP_form_tls_address;
14282 rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (loc);
14283 if (rtl == NULL_RTX)
14284 return 0;
14286 if (!MEM_P (rtl))
14287 return 0;
14288 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
14289 if (! CONSTANT_P (rtl))
14290 return 0;
14292 ret = new_loc_descr (first_op, 0, 0);
14293 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
14294 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
14295 ret->dtprel = dtprel;
14297 ret1 = new_loc_descr (second_op, 0, 0);
14298 add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
14300 have_address = 1;
14301 break;
14303 /* FALLTHRU */
14305 case PARM_DECL:
14306 if (DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P (loc))
14307 return loc_list_from_tree (DECL_VALUE_EXPR (loc),
14308 want_address);
14309 /* FALLTHRU */
14311 case RESULT_DECL:
14312 case FUNCTION_DECL:
14314 rtx rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (loc);
14315 var_loc_list *loc_list = lookup_decl_loc (loc);
14317 if (loc_list && loc_list->first
14318 && (list_ret = dw_loc_list (loc_list, loc, want_address)))
14319 have_address = want_address != 0;
14320 else if (rtl == NULL_RTX)
14322 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "DECL has no RTL");
14323 return 0;
14325 else if (CONST_INT_P (rtl))
14327 HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (rtl);
14328 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)))
14329 val &= GET_MODE_MASK (DECL_MODE (loc));
14330 ret = int_loc_descriptor (val);
14332 else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
14334 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "CONST_STRING");
14335 return 0;
14337 else if (CONSTANT_P (rtl) && const_ok_for_output (rtl))
14339 ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_addr, 0, 0);
14340 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
14341 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
14343 else
14345 enum machine_mode mode;
14347 /* Certain constructs can only be represented at top-level. */
14348 if (want_address == 2)
14350 ret = loc_descriptor (rtl, VOIDmode,
14351 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14352 have_address = 1;
14354 else
14356 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
14357 if (MEM_P (rtl))
14359 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
14360 have_address = 1;
14362 ret = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14364 if (!ret)
14365 expansion_failed (loc, rtl,
14366 "failed to produce loc descriptor for rtl");
14369 break;
14371 case INDIRECT_REF:
14372 case ALIGN_INDIRECT_REF:
14373 case MISALIGNED_INDIRECT_REF:
14374 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
14375 have_address = 1;
14376 break;
14378 case COMPOUND_EXPR:
14379 return loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), want_address);
14381 CASE_CONVERT:
14382 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
14383 case SAVE_EXPR:
14384 case MODIFY_EXPR:
14385 return loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), want_address);
14387 case COMPONENT_REF:
14388 case BIT_FIELD_REF:
14389 case ARRAY_REF:
14390 case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
14391 case REALPART_EXPR:
14392 case IMAGPART_EXPR:
14394 tree obj, offset;
14395 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos, bytepos;
14396 enum machine_mode mode;
14397 int volatilep;
14398 int unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc));
14400 obj = get_inner_reference (loc, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode,
14401 &unsignedp, &volatilep, false);
14403 gcc_assert (obj != loc);
14405 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (obj,
14406 want_address == 2
14407 && !bitpos && !offset ? 2 : 1);
14408 /* TODO: We can extract value of the small expression via shifting even
14409 for nonzero bitpos. */
14410 if (list_ret == 0)
14411 return 0;
14412 if (bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0 || bitsize % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0)
14414 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
14415 "bitfield access");
14416 return 0;
14419 if (offset != NULL_TREE)
14421 /* Variable offset. */
14422 list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree (offset, 0);
14423 if (list_ret1 == 0)
14424 return 0;
14425 add_loc_list (&list_ret, list_ret1);
14426 if (!list_ret)
14427 return 0;
14428 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
14431 bytepos = bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT;
14432 if (bytepos > 0)
14433 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bytepos, 0));
14434 else if (bytepos < 0)
14435 loc_list_plus_const (list_ret, bytepos);
14437 have_address = 1;
14438 break;
14441 case INTEGER_CST:
14442 if ((want_address || !host_integerp (loc, 0))
14443 && (ret = cst_pool_loc_descr (loc)))
14444 have_address = 1;
14445 else if (want_address == 2
14446 && host_integerp (loc, 0)
14447 && (ret = address_of_int_loc_descriptor
14448 (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc)),
14449 tree_low_cst (loc, 0))))
14450 have_address = 1;
14451 else if (host_integerp (loc, 0))
14452 ret = int_loc_descriptor (tree_low_cst (loc, 0));
14453 else
14455 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
14456 "Integer operand is not host integer");
14457 return 0;
14459 break;
14461 case CONSTRUCTOR:
14462 case REAL_CST:
14463 case STRING_CST:
14464 case COMPLEX_CST:
14465 if ((ret = cst_pool_loc_descr (loc)))
14466 have_address = 1;
14467 else
14468 /* We can construct small constants here using int_loc_descriptor. */
14469 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
14470 "constructor or constant not in constant pool");
14471 break;
14473 case TRUTH_AND_EXPR:
14474 case TRUTH_ANDIF_EXPR:
14475 case BIT_AND_EXPR:
14476 op = DW_OP_and;
14477 goto do_binop;
14479 case TRUTH_XOR_EXPR:
14480 case BIT_XOR_EXPR:
14481 op = DW_OP_xor;
14482 goto do_binop;
14484 case TRUTH_OR_EXPR:
14485 case TRUTH_ORIF_EXPR:
14486 case BIT_IOR_EXPR:
14487 op = DW_OP_or;
14488 goto do_binop;
14490 case FLOOR_DIV_EXPR:
14491 case CEIL_DIV_EXPR:
14492 case ROUND_DIV_EXPR:
14493 case TRUNC_DIV_EXPR:
14494 op = DW_OP_div;
14495 goto do_binop;
14497 case MINUS_EXPR:
14498 op = DW_OP_minus;
14499 goto do_binop;
14501 case FLOOR_MOD_EXPR:
14502 case CEIL_MOD_EXPR:
14503 case ROUND_MOD_EXPR:
14504 case TRUNC_MOD_EXPR:
14505 op = DW_OP_mod;
14506 goto do_binop;
14508 case MULT_EXPR:
14509 op = DW_OP_mul;
14510 goto do_binop;
14512 case LSHIFT_EXPR:
14513 op = DW_OP_shl;
14514 goto do_binop;
14516 case RSHIFT_EXPR:
14517 op = (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)) ? DW_OP_shr : DW_OP_shra);
14518 goto do_binop;
14520 case POINTER_PLUS_EXPR:
14521 case PLUS_EXPR:
14522 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)) == INTEGER_CST
14523 && host_integerp (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0))
14525 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
14526 if (list_ret == 0)
14527 return 0;
14529 loc_list_plus_const (list_ret, tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0));
14530 break;
14533 op = DW_OP_plus;
14534 goto do_binop;
14536 case LE_EXPR:
14537 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
14538 return 0;
14540 op = DW_OP_le;
14541 goto do_binop;
14543 case GE_EXPR:
14544 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
14545 return 0;
14547 op = DW_OP_ge;
14548 goto do_binop;
14550 case LT_EXPR:
14551 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
14552 return 0;
14554 op = DW_OP_lt;
14555 goto do_binop;
14557 case GT_EXPR:
14558 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
14559 return 0;
14561 op = DW_OP_gt;
14562 goto do_binop;
14564 case EQ_EXPR:
14565 op = DW_OP_eq;
14566 goto do_binop;
14568 case NE_EXPR:
14569 op = DW_OP_ne;
14570 goto do_binop;
14572 do_binop:
14573 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
14574 list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0);
14575 if (list_ret == 0 || list_ret1 == 0)
14576 return 0;
14578 add_loc_list (&list_ret, list_ret1);
14579 if (list_ret == 0)
14580 return 0;
14581 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
14582 break;
14584 case TRUTH_NOT_EXPR:
14585 case BIT_NOT_EXPR:
14586 op = DW_OP_not;
14587 goto do_unop;
14589 case ABS_EXPR:
14590 op = DW_OP_abs;
14591 goto do_unop;
14593 case NEGATE_EXPR:
14594 op = DW_OP_neg;
14595 goto do_unop;
14597 do_unop:
14598 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
14599 if (list_ret == 0)
14600 return 0;
14602 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
14603 break;
14605 case MIN_EXPR:
14606 case MAX_EXPR:
14608 const enum tree_code code =
14609 TREE_CODE (loc) == MIN_EXPR ? GT_EXPR : LT_EXPR;
14611 loc = build3 (COND_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (loc),
14612 build2 (code, integer_type_node,
14613 TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)),
14614 TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0));
14617 /* ... fall through ... */
14619 case COND_EXPR:
14621 dw_loc_descr_ref lhs
14622 = loc_descriptor_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0);
14623 dw_loc_list_ref rhs
14624 = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 2), 0);
14625 dw_loc_descr_ref bra_node, jump_node, tmp;
14627 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
14628 if (list_ret == 0 || lhs == 0 || rhs == 0)
14629 return 0;
14631 bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
14632 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, bra_node);
14634 add_loc_list (&list_ret, rhs);
14635 jump_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
14636 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, jump_node);
14638 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, lhs);
14639 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
14640 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = lhs;
14642 /* ??? Need a node to point the skip at. Use a nop. */
14643 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_nop, 0, 0);
14644 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, tmp);
14645 jump_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
14646 jump_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = tmp;
14648 break;
14650 case FIX_TRUNC_EXPR:
14651 return 0;
14653 default:
14654 /* Leave front-end specific codes as simply unknown. This comes
14655 up, for instance, with the C STMT_EXPR. */
14656 if ((unsigned int) TREE_CODE (loc)
14657 >= (unsigned int) LAST_AND_UNUSED_TREE_CODE)
14659 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
14660 "language specific tree node");
14661 return 0;
14664 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
14665 /* Otherwise this is a generic code; we should just lists all of
14666 these explicitly. We forgot one. */
14667 gcc_unreachable ();
14668 #else
14669 /* In a release build, we want to degrade gracefully: better to
14670 generate incomplete debugging information than to crash. */
14671 return NULL;
14672 #endif
14675 if (!ret && !list_ret)
14676 return 0;
14678 if (want_address == 2 && !have_address
14679 && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
14681 if (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc)) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14683 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
14684 "DWARF address size mismatch");
14685 return 0;
14687 if (ret)
14688 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
14689 else
14690 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
14691 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
14692 have_address = 1;
14694 /* Show if we can't fill the request for an address. */
14695 if (want_address && !have_address)
14697 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
14698 "Want address and only have value");
14699 return 0;
14702 gcc_assert (!ret || !list_ret);
14704 /* If we've got an address and don't want one, dereference. */
14705 if (!want_address && have_address)
14707 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc));
14709 if (size > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE || size == -1)
14711 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
14712 "DWARF address size mismatch");
14713 return 0;
14715 else if (size == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14716 op = DW_OP_deref;
14717 else
14718 op = DW_OP_deref_size;
14720 if (ret)
14721 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, size, 0));
14722 else
14723 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (op, size, 0));
14725 if (ret)
14726 list_ret = single_element_loc_list (ret);
14728 return list_ret;
14731 /* Same as above but return only single location expression. */
14732 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14733 loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree loc, int want_address)
14735 dw_loc_list_ref ret = loc_list_from_tree (loc, want_address);
14736 if (!ret)
14737 return NULL;
14738 if (ret->dw_loc_next)
14740 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
14741 "Location list where only loc descriptor needed");
14742 return NULL;
14744 return ret->expr;
14747 /* Given a value, round it up to the lowest multiple of `boundary'
14748 which is not less than the value itself. */
14750 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
14751 ceiling (HOST_WIDE_INT value, unsigned int boundary)
14753 return (((value + boundary - 1) / boundary) * boundary);
14756 /* Given a pointer to what is assumed to be a FIELD_DECL node, return a
14757 pointer to the declared type for the relevant field variable, or return
14758 `integer_type_node' if the given node turns out to be an
14759 ERROR_MARK node. */
14761 static inline tree
14762 field_type (const_tree decl)
14764 tree type;
14766 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
14767 return integer_type_node;
14769 type = DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl);
14770 if (type == NULL_TREE)
14771 type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
14773 return type;
14776 /* Given a pointer to a tree node, return the alignment in bits for
14777 it, or else return BITS_PER_WORD if the node actually turns out to
14778 be an ERROR_MARK node. */
14780 static inline unsigned
14781 simple_type_align_in_bits (const_tree type)
14783 return (TREE_CODE (type) != ERROR_MARK) ? TYPE_ALIGN (type) : BITS_PER_WORD;
14786 static inline unsigned
14787 simple_decl_align_in_bits (const_tree decl)
14789 return (TREE_CODE (decl) != ERROR_MARK) ? DECL_ALIGN (decl) : BITS_PER_WORD;
14792 /* Return the result of rounding T up to ALIGN. */
14794 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
14795 round_up_to_align (HOST_WIDE_INT t, unsigned int align)
14797 /* We must be careful if T is negative because HOST_WIDE_INT can be
14798 either "above" or "below" unsigned int as per the C promotion
14799 rules, depending on the host, thus making the signedness of the
14800 direct multiplication and division unpredictable. */
14801 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT u = (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) t;
14803 u += align - 1;
14804 u /= align;
14805 u *= align;
14807 return (HOST_WIDE_INT) u;
14810 /* Given a pointer to a FIELD_DECL, compute and return the byte offset of the
14811 lowest addressed byte of the "containing object" for the given FIELD_DECL,
14812 or return 0 if we are unable to determine what that offset is, either
14813 because the argument turns out to be a pointer to an ERROR_MARK node, or
14814 because the offset is actually variable. (We can't handle the latter case
14815 just yet). */
14817 static HOST_WIDE_INT
14818 field_byte_offset (const_tree decl)
14820 HOST_WIDE_INT object_offset_in_bits;
14821 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos_int;
14823 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
14824 return 0;
14826 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL);
14828 /* We cannot yet cope with fields whose positions are variable, so
14829 for now, when we see such things, we simply return 0. Someday, we may
14830 be able to handle such cases, but it will be damn difficult. */
14831 if (! host_integerp (bit_position (decl), 0))
14832 return 0;
14834 bitpos_int = int_bit_position (decl);
14836 #ifdef PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
14837 if (PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS)
14839 tree type;
14840 tree field_size_tree;
14841 HOST_WIDE_INT deepest_bitpos;
14842 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT field_size_in_bits;
14843 unsigned int type_align_in_bits;
14844 unsigned int decl_align_in_bits;
14845 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT type_size_in_bits;
14847 type = field_type (decl);
14848 type_size_in_bits = simple_type_size_in_bits (type);
14849 type_align_in_bits = simple_type_align_in_bits (type);
14851 field_size_tree = DECL_SIZE (decl);
14853 /* The size could be unspecified if there was an error, or for
14854 a flexible array member. */
14855 if (!field_size_tree)
14856 field_size_tree = bitsize_zero_node;
14858 /* If the size of the field is not constant, use the type size. */
14859 if (host_integerp (field_size_tree, 1))
14860 field_size_in_bits = tree_low_cst (field_size_tree, 1);
14861 else
14862 field_size_in_bits = type_size_in_bits;
14864 decl_align_in_bits = simple_decl_align_in_bits (decl);
14866 /* The GCC front-end doesn't make any attempt to keep track of the
14867 starting bit offset (relative to the start of the containing
14868 structure type) of the hypothetical "containing object" for a
14869 bit-field. Thus, when computing the byte offset value for the
14870 start of the "containing object" of a bit-field, we must deduce
14871 this information on our own. This can be rather tricky to do in
14872 some cases. For example, handling the following structure type
14873 definition when compiling for an i386/i486 target (which only
14874 aligns long long's to 32-bit boundaries) can be very tricky:
14876 struct S { int field1; long long field2:31; };
14878 Fortunately, there is a simple rule-of-thumb which can be used
14879 in such cases. When compiling for an i386/i486, GCC will
14880 allocate 8 bytes for the structure shown above. It decides to
14881 do this based upon one simple rule for bit-field allocation.
14882 GCC allocates each "containing object" for each bit-field at
14883 the first (i.e. lowest addressed) legitimate alignment boundary
14884 (based upon the required minimum alignment for the declared
14885 type of the field) which it can possibly use, subject to the
14886 condition that there is still enough available space remaining
14887 in the containing object (when allocated at the selected point)
14888 to fully accommodate all of the bits of the bit-field itself.
14890 This simple rule makes it obvious why GCC allocates 8 bytes for
14891 each object of the structure type shown above. When looking
14892 for a place to allocate the "containing object" for `field2',
14893 the compiler simply tries to allocate a 64-bit "containing
14894 object" at each successive 32-bit boundary (starting at zero)
14895 until it finds a place to allocate that 64- bit field such that
14896 at least 31 contiguous (and previously unallocated) bits remain
14897 within that selected 64 bit field. (As it turns out, for the
14898 example above, the compiler finds it is OK to allocate the
14899 "containing object" 64-bit field at bit-offset zero within the
14900 structure type.)
14902 Here we attempt to work backwards from the limited set of facts
14903 we're given, and we try to deduce from those facts, where GCC
14904 must have believed that the containing object started (within
14905 the structure type). The value we deduce is then used (by the
14906 callers of this routine) to generate DW_AT_location and
14907 DW_AT_bit_offset attributes for fields (both bit-fields and, in
14908 the case of DW_AT_location, regular fields as well). */
14910 /* Figure out the bit-distance from the start of the structure to
14911 the "deepest" bit of the bit-field. */
14912 deepest_bitpos = bitpos_int + field_size_in_bits;
14914 /* This is the tricky part. Use some fancy footwork to deduce
14915 where the lowest addressed bit of the containing object must
14916 be. */
14917 object_offset_in_bits = deepest_bitpos - type_size_in_bits;
14919 /* Round up to type_align by default. This works best for
14920 bitfields. */
14921 object_offset_in_bits
14922 = round_up_to_align (object_offset_in_bits, type_align_in_bits);
14924 if (object_offset_in_bits > bitpos_int)
14926 object_offset_in_bits = deepest_bitpos - type_size_in_bits;
14928 /* Round up to decl_align instead. */
14929 object_offset_in_bits
14930 = round_up_to_align (object_offset_in_bits, decl_align_in_bits);
14933 else
14934 #endif
14935 object_offset_in_bits = bitpos_int;
14937 return object_offset_in_bits / BITS_PER_UNIT;
14940 /* The following routines define various Dwarf attributes and any data
14941 associated with them. */
14943 /* Add a location description attribute value to a DIE.
14945 This emits location attributes suitable for whole variables and
14946 whole parameters. Note that the location attributes for struct fields are
14947 generated by the routine `data_member_location_attribute' below. */
14949 static inline void
14950 add_AT_location_description (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
14951 dw_loc_list_ref descr)
14953 if (descr == 0)
14954 return;
14955 if (single_element_loc_list_p (descr))
14956 add_AT_loc (die, attr_kind, descr->expr);
14957 else
14958 add_AT_loc_list (die, attr_kind, descr);
14961 /* Attach the specialized form of location attribute used for data members of
14962 struct and union types. In the special case of a FIELD_DECL node which
14963 represents a bit-field, the "offset" part of this special location
14964 descriptor must indicate the distance in bytes from the lowest-addressed
14965 byte of the containing struct or union type to the lowest-addressed byte of
14966 the "containing object" for the bit-field. (See the `field_byte_offset'
14967 function above).
14969 For any given bit-field, the "containing object" is a hypothetical object
14970 (of some integral or enum type) within which the given bit-field lives. The
14971 type of this hypothetical "containing object" is always the same as the
14972 declared type of the individual bit-field itself (for GCC anyway... the
14973 DWARF spec doesn't actually mandate this). Note that it is the size (in
14974 bytes) of the hypothetical "containing object" which will be given in the
14975 DW_AT_byte_size attribute for this bit-field. (See the
14976 `byte_size_attribute' function below.) It is also used when calculating the
14977 value of the DW_AT_bit_offset attribute. (See the `bit_offset_attribute'
14978 function below.) */
14980 static void
14981 add_data_member_location_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
14983 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
14984 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descr = 0;
14986 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TREE_BINFO)
14988 /* We're working on the TAG_inheritance for a base class. */
14989 if (BINFO_VIRTUAL_P (decl) && is_cxx ())
14991 /* For C++ virtual bases we can't just use BINFO_OFFSET, as they
14992 aren't at a fixed offset from all (sub)objects of the same
14993 type. We need to extract the appropriate offset from our
14994 vtable. The following dwarf expression means
14996 BaseAddr = ObAddr + *((*ObAddr) - Offset)
14998 This is specific to the V3 ABI, of course. */
15000 dw_loc_descr_ref tmp;
15002 /* Make a copy of the object address. */
15003 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0);
15004 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
15006 /* Extract the vtable address. */
15007 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
15008 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
15010 /* Calculate the address of the offset. */
15011 offset = tree_low_cst (BINFO_VPTR_FIELD (decl), 0);
15012 gcc_assert (offset < 0);
15014 tmp = int_loc_descriptor (-offset);
15015 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
15016 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0);
15017 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
15019 /* Extract the offset. */
15020 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
15021 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
15023 /* Add it to the object address. */
15024 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0);
15025 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
15027 else
15028 offset = tree_low_cst (BINFO_OFFSET (decl), 0);
15030 else
15031 offset = field_byte_offset (decl);
15033 if (! loc_descr)
15035 if (dwarf_version > 2)
15037 /* Don't need to output a location expression, just the constant. */
15038 add_AT_int (die, DW_AT_data_member_location, offset);
15039 return;
15041 else
15043 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
15045 /* The DWARF2 standard says that we should assume that the structure
15046 address is already on the stack, so we can specify a structure
15047 field address by using DW_OP_plus_uconst. */
15049 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
15050 /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader does not handle the DW_OP_plus_uconst
15051 operator correctly. It works only if we leave the offset on the
15052 stack. */
15053 op = DW_OP_constu;
15054 #else
15055 op = DW_OP_plus_uconst;
15056 #endif
15058 loc_descr = new_loc_descr (op, offset, 0);
15062 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_data_member_location, loc_descr);
15065 /* Writes integer values to dw_vec_const array. */
15067 static void
15068 insert_int (HOST_WIDE_INT val, unsigned int size, unsigned char *dest)
15070 while (size != 0)
15072 *dest++ = val & 0xff;
15073 val >>= 8;
15074 --size;
15078 /* Reads integers from dw_vec_const array. Inverse of insert_int. */
15080 static HOST_WIDE_INT
15081 extract_int (const unsigned char *src, unsigned int size)
15083 HOST_WIDE_INT val = 0;
15085 src += size;
15086 while (size != 0)
15088 val <<= 8;
15089 val |= *--src & 0xff;
15090 --size;
15092 return val;
15095 /* Writes floating point values to dw_vec_const array. */
15097 static void
15098 insert_float (const_rtx rtl, unsigned char *array)
15100 REAL_VALUE_TYPE rv;
15101 long val[4];
15102 int i;
15104 REAL_VALUE_FROM_CONST_DOUBLE (rv, rtl);
15105 real_to_target (val, &rv, GET_MODE (rtl));
15107 /* real_to_target puts 32-bit pieces in each long. Pack them. */
15108 for (i = 0; i < GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) / 4; i++)
15110 insert_int (val[i], 4, array);
15111 array += 4;
15115 /* Attach a DW_AT_const_value attribute for a variable or a parameter which
15116 does not have a "location" either in memory or in a register. These
15117 things can arise in GNU C when a constant is passed as an actual parameter
15118 to an inlined function. They can also arise in C++ where declared
15119 constants do not necessarily get memory "homes". */
15121 static bool
15122 add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, rtx rtl)
15124 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
15126 case CONST_INT:
15128 HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (rtl);
15130 if (val < 0)
15131 add_AT_int (die, DW_AT_const_value, val);
15132 else
15133 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_const_value, (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) val);
15135 return true;
15137 case CONST_DOUBLE:
15138 /* Note that a CONST_DOUBLE rtx could represent either an integer or a
15139 floating-point constant. A CONST_DOUBLE is used whenever the
15140 constant requires more than one word in order to be adequately
15141 represented. */
15143 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
15145 if (SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (mode))
15147 unsigned int length = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
15148 unsigned char *array = GGC_NEWVEC (unsigned char, length);
15150 insert_float (rtl, array);
15151 add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, length / 4, 4, array);
15153 else
15154 add_AT_double (die, DW_AT_const_value,
15155 CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (rtl), CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (rtl));
15157 return true;
15159 case CONST_VECTOR:
15161 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
15162 unsigned int elt_size = GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode);
15163 unsigned int length = CONST_VECTOR_NUNITS (rtl);
15164 unsigned char *array = GGC_NEWVEC (unsigned char, length * elt_size);
15165 unsigned int i;
15166 unsigned char *p;
15168 switch (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode))
15170 case MODE_VECTOR_INT:
15171 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
15173 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
15174 HOST_WIDE_INT lo, hi;
15176 switch (GET_CODE (elt))
15178 case CONST_INT:
15179 lo = INTVAL (elt);
15180 hi = -(lo < 0);
15181 break;
15183 case CONST_DOUBLE:
15184 lo = CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (elt);
15185 hi = CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (elt);
15186 break;
15188 default:
15189 gcc_unreachable ();
15192 if (elt_size <= sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
15193 insert_int (lo, elt_size, p);
15194 else
15196 unsigned char *p0 = p;
15197 unsigned char *p1 = p + sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT);
15199 gcc_assert (elt_size == 2 * sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT));
15200 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
15202 p0 = p1;
15203 p1 = p;
15205 insert_int (lo, sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT), p0);
15206 insert_int (hi, sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT), p1);
15209 break;
15211 case MODE_VECTOR_FLOAT:
15212 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
15214 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
15215 insert_float (elt, p);
15217 break;
15219 default:
15220 gcc_unreachable ();
15223 add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, length, elt_size, array);
15225 return true;
15227 case CONST_STRING:
15228 resolve_one_addr (&rtl, NULL);
15229 add_AT_addr (die, DW_AT_const_value, rtl);
15230 VEC_safe_push (rtx, gc, used_rtx_array, rtl);
15231 return true;
15233 case CONST:
15234 if (CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
15235 return add_const_value_attribute (die, XEXP (rtl, 0));
15236 /* FALLTHROUGH */
15237 case SYMBOL_REF:
15238 if (!const_ok_for_output (rtl))
15239 return false;
15240 case LABEL_REF:
15241 add_AT_addr (die, DW_AT_const_value, rtl);
15242 VEC_safe_push (rtx, gc, used_rtx_array, rtl);
15243 return true;
15245 case PLUS:
15246 /* In cases where an inlined instance of an inline function is passed
15247 the address of an `auto' variable (which is local to the caller) we
15248 can get a situation where the DECL_RTL of the artificial local
15249 variable (for the inlining) which acts as a stand-in for the
15250 corresponding formal parameter (of the inline function) will look
15251 like (plus:SI (reg:SI FRAME_PTR) (const_int ...)). This is not
15252 exactly a compile-time constant expression, but it isn't the address
15253 of the (artificial) local variable either. Rather, it represents the
15254 *value* which the artificial local variable always has during its
15255 lifetime. We currently have no way to represent such quasi-constant
15256 values in Dwarf, so for now we just punt and generate nothing. */
15257 return false;
15259 case HIGH:
15260 case CONST_FIXED:
15261 return false;
15263 case MEM:
15264 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == CONST_STRING
15265 && MEM_READONLY_P (rtl)
15266 && GET_MODE (rtl) == BLKmode)
15268 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_const_value, XSTR (XEXP (rtl, 0), 0));
15269 return true;
15271 return false;
15273 default:
15274 /* No other kinds of rtx should be possible here. */
15275 gcc_unreachable ();
15277 return false;
15280 /* Determine whether the evaluation of EXPR references any variables
15281 or functions which aren't otherwise used (and therefore may not be
15282 output). */
15283 static tree
15284 reference_to_unused (tree * tp, int * walk_subtrees,
15285 void * data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
15287 if (! EXPR_P (*tp) && ! CONSTANT_CLASS_P (*tp))
15288 *walk_subtrees = 0;
15290 if (DECL_P (*tp) && ! TREE_PUBLIC (*tp) && ! TREE_USED (*tp)
15291 && ! TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (*tp))
15292 return *tp;
15293 /* ??? The C++ FE emits debug information for using decls, so
15294 putting gcc_unreachable here falls over. See PR31899. For now
15295 be conservative. */
15296 else if (!cgraph_global_info_ready
15297 && (TREE_CODE (*tp) == VAR_DECL || TREE_CODE (*tp) == FUNCTION_DECL))
15298 return *tp;
15299 else if (TREE_CODE (*tp) == VAR_DECL)
15301 struct varpool_node *node = varpool_node (*tp);
15302 if (!node->needed)
15303 return *tp;
15305 else if (TREE_CODE (*tp) == FUNCTION_DECL
15306 && (!DECL_EXTERNAL (*tp) || DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (*tp)))
15308 /* The call graph machinery must have finished analyzing,
15309 optimizing and gimplifying the CU by now.
15310 So if *TP has no call graph node associated
15311 to it, it means *TP will not be emitted. */
15312 if (!cgraph_get_node (*tp))
15313 return *tp;
15315 else if (TREE_CODE (*tp) == STRING_CST && !TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (*tp))
15316 return *tp;
15318 return NULL_TREE;
15321 /* Generate an RTL constant from a decl initializer INIT with decl type TYPE,
15322 for use in a later add_const_value_attribute call. */
15324 static rtx
15325 rtl_for_decl_init (tree init, tree type)
15327 rtx rtl = NULL_RTX;
15329 /* If a variable is initialized with a string constant without embedded
15330 zeros, build CONST_STRING. */
15331 if (TREE_CODE (init) == STRING_CST && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
15333 tree enttype = TREE_TYPE (type);
15334 tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
15335 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (enttype);
15337 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 1
15338 && domain
15339 && integer_zerop (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain))
15340 && compare_tree_int (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain),
15341 TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init) - 1) == 0
15342 && ((size_t) TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init)
15343 == strlen (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)) + 1))
15345 rtl = gen_rtx_CONST_STRING (VOIDmode,
15346 ggc_strdup (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)));
15347 rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, rtl);
15348 MEM_READONLY_P (rtl) = 1;
15351 /* Other aggregates, and complex values, could be represented using
15352 CONCAT: FIXME! */
15353 else if (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (type) || TREE_CODE (type) == COMPLEX_TYPE)
15355 /* Vectors only work if their mode is supported by the target.
15356 FIXME: generic vectors ought to work too. */
15357 else if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE && TYPE_MODE (type) == BLKmode)
15359 /* If the initializer is something that we know will expand into an
15360 immediate RTL constant, expand it now. We must be careful not to
15361 reference variables which won't be output. */
15362 else if (initializer_constant_valid_p (init, type)
15363 && ! walk_tree (&init, reference_to_unused, NULL, NULL))
15365 /* Convert vector CONSTRUCTOR initializers to VECTOR_CST if
15366 possible. */
15367 if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
15368 switch (TREE_CODE (init))
15370 case VECTOR_CST:
15371 break;
15372 case CONSTRUCTOR:
15373 if (TREE_CONSTANT (init))
15375 VEC(constructor_elt,gc) *elts = CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init);
15376 bool constant_p = true;
15377 tree value;
15378 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT ix;
15380 /* Even when ctor is constant, it might contain non-*_CST
15381 elements (e.g. { 1.0/0.0 - 1.0/0.0, 0.0 }) and those don't
15382 belong into VECTOR_CST nodes. */
15383 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_VALUE (elts, ix, value)
15384 if (!CONSTANT_CLASS_P (value))
15386 constant_p = false;
15387 break;
15390 if (constant_p)
15392 init = build_vector_from_ctor (type, elts);
15393 break;
15396 /* FALLTHRU */
15398 default:
15399 return NULL;
15402 rtl = expand_expr (init, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_INITIALIZER);
15404 /* If expand_expr returns a MEM, it wasn't immediate. */
15405 gcc_assert (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl));
15408 return rtl;
15411 /* Generate RTL for the variable DECL to represent its location. */
15413 static rtx
15414 rtl_for_decl_location (tree decl)
15416 rtx rtl;
15418 /* Here we have to decide where we are going to say the parameter "lives"
15419 (as far as the debugger is concerned). We only have a couple of
15420 choices. GCC provides us with DECL_RTL and with DECL_INCOMING_RTL.
15422 DECL_RTL normally indicates where the parameter lives during most of the
15423 activation of the function. If optimization is enabled however, this
15424 could be either NULL or else a pseudo-reg. Both of those cases indicate
15425 that the parameter doesn't really live anywhere (as far as the code
15426 generation parts of GCC are concerned) during most of the function's
15427 activation. That will happen (for example) if the parameter is never
15428 referenced within the function.
15430 We could just generate a location descriptor here for all non-NULL
15431 non-pseudo values of DECL_RTL and ignore all of the rest, but we can be
15432 a little nicer than that if we also consider DECL_INCOMING_RTL in cases
15433 where DECL_RTL is NULL or is a pseudo-reg.
15435 Note however that we can only get away with using DECL_INCOMING_RTL as
15436 a backup substitute for DECL_RTL in certain limited cases. In cases
15437 where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) indicates the same type as TREE_TYPE (decl),
15438 we can be sure that the parameter was passed using the same type as it is
15439 declared to have within the function, and that its DECL_INCOMING_RTL
15440 points us to a place where a value of that type is passed.
15442 In cases where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) and TREE_TYPE (decl) are different,
15443 we cannot (in general) use DECL_INCOMING_RTL as a substitute for DECL_RTL
15444 because in these cases DECL_INCOMING_RTL points us to a value of some
15445 type which is *different* from the type of the parameter itself. Thus,
15446 if we tried to use DECL_INCOMING_RTL to generate a location attribute in
15447 such cases, the debugger would end up (for example) trying to fetch a
15448 `float' from a place which actually contains the first part of a
15449 `double'. That would lead to really incorrect and confusing
15450 output at debug-time.
15452 So, in general, we *do not* use DECL_INCOMING_RTL as a backup for DECL_RTL
15453 in cases where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) != TREE_TYPE (decl). There
15454 are a couple of exceptions however. On little-endian machines we can
15455 get away with using DECL_INCOMING_RTL even when DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) is
15456 not the same as TREE_TYPE (decl), but only when DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) is
15457 an integral type that is smaller than TREE_TYPE (decl). These cases arise
15458 when (on a little-endian machine) a non-prototyped function has a
15459 parameter declared to be of type `short' or `char'. In such cases,
15460 TREE_TYPE (decl) will be `short' or `char', DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) will
15461 be `int', and DECL_INCOMING_RTL will point to the lowest-order byte of the
15462 passed `int' value. If the debugger then uses that address to fetch
15463 a `short' or a `char' (on a little-endian machine) the result will be
15464 the correct data, so we allow for such exceptional cases below.
15466 Note that our goal here is to describe the place where the given formal
15467 parameter lives during most of the function's activation (i.e. between the
15468 end of the prologue and the start of the epilogue). We'll do that as best
15469 as we can. Note however that if the given formal parameter is modified
15470 sometime during the execution of the function, then a stack backtrace (at
15471 debug-time) will show the function as having been called with the *new*
15472 value rather than the value which was originally passed in. This happens
15473 rarely enough that it is not a major problem, but it *is* a problem, and
15474 I'd like to fix it.
15476 A future version of dwarf2out.c may generate two additional attributes for
15477 any given DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE which will describe the "passed
15478 type" and the "passed location" for the given formal parameter in addition
15479 to the attributes we now generate to indicate the "declared type" and the
15480 "active location" for each parameter. This additional set of attributes
15481 could be used by debuggers for stack backtraces. Separately, note that
15482 sometimes DECL_RTL can be NULL and DECL_INCOMING_RTL can be NULL also.
15483 This happens (for example) for inlined-instances of inline function formal
15484 parameters which are never referenced. This really shouldn't be
15485 happening. All PARM_DECL nodes should get valid non-NULL
15486 DECL_INCOMING_RTL values. FIXME. */
15488 /* Use DECL_RTL as the "location" unless we find something better. */
15489 rtl = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (decl);
15491 /* When generating abstract instances, ignore everything except
15492 constants, symbols living in memory, and symbols living in
15493 fixed registers. */
15494 if (! reload_completed)
15496 if (rtl
15497 && (CONSTANT_P (rtl)
15498 || (MEM_P (rtl)
15499 && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
15500 || (REG_P (rtl)
15501 && TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
15502 && TREE_STATIC (decl))))
15504 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
15505 return rtl;
15507 rtl = NULL_RTX;
15509 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL)
15511 if (rtl == NULL_RTX || is_pseudo_reg (rtl))
15513 tree declared_type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
15514 tree passed_type = DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl);
15515 enum machine_mode dmode = TYPE_MODE (declared_type);
15516 enum machine_mode pmode = TYPE_MODE (passed_type);
15518 /* This decl represents a formal parameter which was optimized out.
15519 Note that DECL_INCOMING_RTL may be NULL in here, but we handle
15520 all cases where (rtl == NULL_RTX) just below. */
15521 if (dmode == pmode)
15522 rtl = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl);
15523 else if (SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (dmode)
15524 && GET_MODE_SIZE (dmode) <= GET_MODE_SIZE (pmode)
15525 && DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
15527 rtx inc = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl);
15528 if (REG_P (inc))
15529 rtl = inc;
15530 else if (MEM_P (inc))
15532 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
15533 rtl = adjust_address_nv (inc, dmode,
15534 GET_MODE_SIZE (pmode)
15535 - GET_MODE_SIZE (dmode));
15536 else
15537 rtl = inc;
15542 /* If the parm was passed in registers, but lives on the stack, then
15543 make a big endian correction if the mode of the type of the
15544 parameter is not the same as the mode of the rtl. */
15545 /* ??? This is the same series of checks that are made in dbxout.c before
15546 we reach the big endian correction code there. It isn't clear if all
15547 of these checks are necessary here, but keeping them all is the safe
15548 thing to do. */
15549 else if (MEM_P (rtl)
15550 && XEXP (rtl, 0) != const0_rtx
15551 && ! CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
15552 /* Not passed in memory. */
15553 && !MEM_P (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
15554 /* Not passed by invisible reference. */
15555 && (!REG_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
15556 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
15557 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
15558 #if ARG_POINTER_REGNUM != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
15559 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
15560 #endif
15562 /* Big endian correction check. */
15563 && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
15564 && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) != GET_MODE (rtl)
15565 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
15566 < UNITS_PER_WORD))
15568 int offset = (UNITS_PER_WORD
15569 - GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))));
15571 rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
15572 plus_constant (XEXP (rtl, 0), offset));
15575 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
15576 && rtl
15577 && MEM_P (rtl)
15578 && GET_MODE (rtl) != TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))
15579 && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
15581 int rsize = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl));
15582 int dsize = GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)));
15584 /* If a variable is declared "register" yet is smaller than
15585 a register, then if we store the variable to memory, it
15586 looks like we're storing a register-sized value, when in
15587 fact we are not. We need to adjust the offset of the
15588 storage location to reflect the actual value's bytes,
15589 else gdb will not be able to display it. */
15590 if (rsize > dsize)
15591 rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
15592 plus_constant (XEXP (rtl, 0), rsize-dsize));
15595 /* A variable with no DECL_RTL but a DECL_INITIAL is a compile-time constant,
15596 and will have been substituted directly into all expressions that use it.
15597 C does not have such a concept, but C++ and other languages do. */
15598 if (!rtl && TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL && DECL_INITIAL (decl))
15599 rtl = rtl_for_decl_init (DECL_INITIAL (decl), TREE_TYPE (decl));
15601 if (rtl)
15602 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
15604 /* If we don't look past the constant pool, we risk emitting a
15605 reference to a constant pool entry that isn't referenced from
15606 code, and thus is not emitted. */
15607 if (rtl)
15608 rtl = avoid_constant_pool_reference (rtl);
15610 return rtl;
15613 /* Check whether decl is a Fortran COMMON symbol. If not, NULL_TREE is
15614 returned. If so, the decl for the COMMON block is returned, and the
15615 value is the offset into the common block for the symbol. */
15617 static tree
15618 fortran_common (tree decl, HOST_WIDE_INT *value)
15620 tree val_expr, cvar;
15621 enum machine_mode mode;
15622 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos;
15623 tree offset;
15624 int volatilep = 0, unsignedp = 0;
15626 /* If the decl isn't a VAR_DECL, or if it isn't static, or if
15627 it does not have a value (the offset into the common area), or if it
15628 is thread local (as opposed to global) then it isn't common, and shouldn't
15629 be handled as such. */
15630 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != VAR_DECL
15631 || !TREE_STATIC (decl)
15632 || !DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P (decl)
15633 || !is_fortran ())
15634 return NULL_TREE;
15636 val_expr = DECL_VALUE_EXPR (decl);
15637 if (TREE_CODE (val_expr) != COMPONENT_REF)
15638 return NULL_TREE;
15640 cvar = get_inner_reference (val_expr, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset,
15641 &mode, &unsignedp, &volatilep, true);
15643 if (cvar == NULL_TREE
15644 || TREE_CODE (cvar) != VAR_DECL
15645 || DECL_ARTIFICIAL (cvar)
15646 || !TREE_PUBLIC (cvar))
15647 return NULL_TREE;
15649 *value = 0;
15650 if (offset != NULL)
15652 if (!host_integerp (offset, 0))
15653 return NULL_TREE;
15654 *value = tree_low_cst (offset, 0);
15656 if (bitpos != 0)
15657 *value += bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT;
15659 return cvar;
15662 /* Generate *either* a DW_AT_location attribute or else a DW_AT_const_value
15663 data attribute for a variable or a parameter. We generate the
15664 DW_AT_const_value attribute only in those cases where the given variable
15665 or parameter does not have a true "location" either in memory or in a
15666 register. This can happen (for example) when a constant is passed as an
15667 actual argument in a call to an inline function. (It's possible that
15668 these things can crop up in other ways also.) Note that one type of
15669 constant value which can be passed into an inlined function is a constant
15670 pointer. This can happen for example if an actual argument in an inlined
15671 function call evaluates to a compile-time constant address. */
15673 static bool
15674 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl,
15675 enum dwarf_attribute attr)
15677 rtx rtl;
15678 dw_loc_list_ref list;
15679 var_loc_list *loc_list;
15681 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
15682 return false;
15684 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL
15685 || TREE_CODE (decl) == RESULT_DECL);
15687 /* Try to get some constant RTL for this decl, and use that as the value of
15688 the location. */
15690 rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (decl);
15691 if (rtl && (CONSTANT_P (rtl) || GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
15692 && add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl))
15693 return true;
15695 /* See if we have single element location list that is equivalent to
15696 a constant value. That way we are better to use add_const_value_attribute
15697 rather than expanding constant value equivalent. */
15698 loc_list = lookup_decl_loc (decl);
15699 if (loc_list && loc_list->first && loc_list->first == loc_list->last)
15701 enum var_init_status status;
15702 struct var_loc_node *node;
15704 node = loc_list->first;
15705 status = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (node->var_loc_note);
15706 rtl = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->var_loc_note);
15707 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == VAR_LOCATION
15708 && GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)) != PARALLEL)
15709 rtl = XEXP (XEXP (rtl, 1), 0);
15710 if ((CONSTANT_P (rtl) || GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
15711 && add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl))
15712 return true;
15714 list = loc_list_from_tree (decl, decl_by_reference_p (decl) ? 0 : 2);
15715 if (list)
15717 add_AT_location_description (die, attr, list);
15718 return true;
15720 /* None of that worked, so it must not really have a location;
15721 try adding a constant value attribute from the DECL_INITIAL. */
15722 return tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (die, decl);
15725 /* Add VARIABLE and DIE into deferred locations list. */
15727 static void
15728 defer_location (tree variable, dw_die_ref die)
15730 deferred_locations entry;
15731 entry.variable = variable;
15732 entry.die = die;
15733 VEC_safe_push (deferred_locations, gc, deferred_locations_list, &entry);
15736 /* Helper function for tree_add_const_value_attribute. Natively encode
15737 initializer INIT into an array. Return true if successful. */
15739 static bool
15740 native_encode_initializer (tree init, unsigned char *array, int size)
15742 tree type;
15744 if (init == NULL_TREE)
15745 return false;
15747 STRIP_NOPS (init);
15748 switch (TREE_CODE (init))
15750 case STRING_CST:
15751 type = TREE_TYPE (init);
15752 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
15754 tree enttype = TREE_TYPE (type);
15755 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (enttype);
15757 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT || GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) != 1)
15758 return false;
15759 if (int_size_in_bytes (type) != size)
15760 return false;
15761 if (size > TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init))
15763 memcpy (array, TREE_STRING_POINTER (init),
15764 TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init));
15765 memset (array + TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init),
15766 '\0', size - TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init));
15768 else
15769 memcpy (array, TREE_STRING_POINTER (init), size);
15770 return true;
15772 return false;
15773 case CONSTRUCTOR:
15774 type = TREE_TYPE (init);
15775 if (int_size_in_bytes (type) != size)
15776 return false;
15777 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
15779 HOST_WIDE_INT min_index;
15780 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT cnt;
15781 int curpos = 0, fieldsize;
15782 constructor_elt *ce;
15784 if (TYPE_DOMAIN (type) == NULL_TREE
15785 || !host_integerp (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type)), 0))
15786 return false;
15788 fieldsize = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (type));
15789 if (fieldsize <= 0)
15790 return false;
15792 min_index = tree_low_cst (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type)), 0);
15793 memset (array, '\0', size);
15794 for (cnt = 0;
15795 VEC_iterate (constructor_elt, CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init), cnt, ce);
15796 cnt++)
15798 tree val = ce->value;
15799 tree index = ce->index;
15800 int pos = curpos;
15801 if (index && TREE_CODE (index) == RANGE_EXPR)
15802 pos = (tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (index, 0), 0) - min_index)
15803 * fieldsize;
15804 else if (index)
15805 pos = (tree_low_cst (index, 0) - min_index) * fieldsize;
15807 if (val)
15809 STRIP_NOPS (val);
15810 if (!native_encode_initializer (val, array + pos, fieldsize))
15811 return false;
15813 curpos = pos + fieldsize;
15814 if (index && TREE_CODE (index) == RANGE_EXPR)
15816 int count = tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (index, 1), 0)
15817 - tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (index, 0), 0);
15818 while (count > 0)
15820 if (val)
15821 memcpy (array + curpos, array + pos, fieldsize);
15822 curpos += fieldsize;
15825 gcc_assert (curpos <= size);
15827 return true;
15829 else if (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE
15830 || TREE_CODE (type) == UNION_TYPE)
15832 tree field = NULL_TREE;
15833 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT cnt;
15834 constructor_elt *ce;
15836 if (int_size_in_bytes (type) != size)
15837 return false;
15839 if (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE)
15840 field = TYPE_FIELDS (type);
15842 for (cnt = 0;
15843 VEC_iterate (constructor_elt, CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init), cnt, ce);
15844 cnt++, field = field ? TREE_CHAIN (field) : 0)
15846 tree val = ce->value;
15847 int pos, fieldsize;
15849 if (ce->index != 0)
15850 field = ce->index;
15852 if (val)
15853 STRIP_NOPS (val);
15855 if (field == NULL_TREE || DECL_BIT_FIELD (field))
15856 return false;
15858 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (field)) == ARRAY_TYPE
15859 && TYPE_DOMAIN (TREE_TYPE (field))
15860 && ! TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (TREE_TYPE (field))))
15861 return false;
15862 else if (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (field) == NULL_TREE
15863 || !host_integerp (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (field), 0))
15864 return false;
15865 fieldsize = tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (field), 0);
15866 pos = int_byte_position (field);
15867 gcc_assert (pos + fieldsize <= size);
15868 if (val
15869 && !native_encode_initializer (val, array + pos, fieldsize))
15870 return false;
15872 return true;
15874 return false;
15875 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
15876 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
15877 return native_encode_initializer (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0), array, size);
15878 default:
15879 return native_encode_expr (init, array, size) == size;
15883 /* Attach a DW_AT_const_value attribute to DIE. The value of the
15884 attribute is the const value T. */
15886 static bool
15887 tree_add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree t)
15889 tree init;
15890 tree type = TREE_TYPE (t);
15891 rtx rtl;
15893 if (!t || !TREE_TYPE (t) || TREE_TYPE (t) == error_mark_node)
15894 return false;
15896 init = t;
15897 gcc_assert (!DECL_P (init));
15899 rtl = rtl_for_decl_init (init, type);
15900 if (rtl)
15901 return add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl);
15902 /* If the host and target are sane, try harder. */
15903 else if (CHAR_BIT == 8 && BITS_PER_UNIT == 8
15904 && initializer_constant_valid_p (init, type))
15906 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (init));
15907 if (size > 0 && (int) size == size)
15909 unsigned char *array = GGC_CNEWVEC (unsigned char, size);
15911 if (native_encode_initializer (init, array, size))
15913 add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, size, 1, array);
15914 return true;
15918 return false;
15921 /* Attach a DW_AT_const_value attribute to VAR_DIE. The value of the
15922 attribute is the const value of T, where T is an integral constant
15923 variable with static storage duration
15924 (so it can't be a PARM_DECL or a RESULT_DECL). */
15926 static bool
15927 tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (dw_die_ref var_die, tree decl)
15930 if (!decl
15931 || (TREE_CODE (decl) != VAR_DECL
15932 && TREE_CODE (decl) != CONST_DECL))
15933 return false;
15935 if (TREE_READONLY (decl)
15936 && ! TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl)
15937 && DECL_INITIAL (decl))
15938 /* OK */;
15939 else
15940 return false;
15942 /* Don't add DW_AT_const_value if abstract origin already has one. */
15943 if (get_AT (var_die, DW_AT_const_value))
15944 return false;
15946 return tree_add_const_value_attribute (var_die, DECL_INITIAL (decl));
15949 /* Convert the CFI instructions for the current function into a
15950 location list. This is used for DW_AT_frame_base when we targeting
15951 a dwarf2 consumer that does not support the dwarf3
15952 DW_OP_call_frame_cfa. OFFSET is a constant to be added to all CFA
15953 expressions. */
15955 static dw_loc_list_ref
15956 convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list (HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
15958 dw_fde_ref fde;
15959 dw_loc_list_ref list, *list_tail;
15960 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
15961 dw_cfa_location last_cfa, next_cfa;
15962 const char *start_label, *last_label, *section;
15963 dw_cfa_location remember;
15965 fde = current_fde ();
15966 gcc_assert (fde != NULL);
15968 section = secname_for_decl (current_function_decl);
15969 list_tail = &list;
15970 list = NULL;
15972 memset (&next_cfa, 0, sizeof (next_cfa));
15973 next_cfa.reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
15974 remember = next_cfa;
15976 start_label = fde->dw_fde_begin;
15978 /* ??? Bald assumption that the CIE opcode list does not contain
15979 advance opcodes. */
15980 for (cfi = cie_cfi_head; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
15981 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, &next_cfa, &remember);
15983 last_cfa = next_cfa;
15984 last_label = start_label;
15986 for (cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
15987 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
15989 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
15990 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
15991 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
15992 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
15993 if (!cfa_equal_p (&last_cfa, &next_cfa))
15995 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
15996 start_label, last_label, section,
15997 list == NULL);
15999 list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
16000 last_cfa = next_cfa;
16001 start_label = last_label;
16003 last_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
16004 break;
16006 case DW_CFA_advance_loc:
16007 /* The encoding is complex enough that we should never emit this. */
16008 gcc_unreachable ();
16010 default:
16011 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, &next_cfa, &remember);
16012 break;
16015 if (!cfa_equal_p (&last_cfa, &next_cfa))
16017 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
16018 start_label, last_label, section,
16019 list == NULL);
16020 list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
16021 start_label = last_label;
16023 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&next_cfa, offset),
16024 start_label, fde->dw_fde_end, section,
16025 list == NULL);
16027 return list;
16030 /* Compute a displacement from the "steady-state frame pointer" to the
16031 frame base (often the same as the CFA), and store it in
16032 frame_pointer_fb_offset. OFFSET is added to the displacement
16033 before the latter is negated. */
16035 static void
16036 compute_frame_pointer_to_fb_displacement (HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
16038 rtx reg, elim;
16040 #ifdef FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET
16041 reg = frame_pointer_rtx;
16042 offset += FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
16043 #else
16044 reg = arg_pointer_rtx;
16045 offset += ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
16046 #endif
16048 elim = eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX);
16049 if (GET_CODE (elim) == PLUS)
16051 offset += INTVAL (XEXP (elim, 1));
16052 elim = XEXP (elim, 0);
16055 gcc_assert ((SUPPORTS_STACK_ALIGNMENT
16056 && (elim == hard_frame_pointer_rtx
16057 || elim == stack_pointer_rtx))
16058 || elim == (frame_pointer_needed
16059 ? hard_frame_pointer_rtx
16060 : stack_pointer_rtx));
16062 frame_pointer_fb_offset = -offset;
16065 /* Generate a DW_AT_name attribute given some string value to be included as
16066 the value of the attribute. */
16068 static void
16069 add_name_attribute (dw_die_ref die, const char *name_string)
16071 if (name_string != NULL && *name_string != 0)
16073 if (demangle_name_func)
16074 name_string = (*demangle_name_func) (name_string);
16076 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name, name_string);
16080 /* Generate a DW_AT_comp_dir attribute for DIE. */
16082 static void
16083 add_comp_dir_attribute (dw_die_ref die)
16085 const char *wd = get_src_pwd ();
16086 char *wd1;
16088 if (wd == NULL)
16089 return;
16091 if (DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR)
16093 int wdlen;
16095 wdlen = strlen (wd);
16096 wd1 = GGC_NEWVEC (char, wdlen + 2);
16097 strcpy (wd1, wd);
16098 wd1 [wdlen] = DIR_SEPARATOR;
16099 wd1 [wdlen + 1] = 0;
16100 wd = wd1;
16103 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_comp_dir, remap_debug_filename (wd));
16106 /* Given a tree node describing an array bound (either lower or upper) output
16107 a representation for that bound. */
16109 static void
16110 add_bound_info (dw_die_ref subrange_die, enum dwarf_attribute bound_attr, tree bound)
16112 switch (TREE_CODE (bound))
16114 case ERROR_MARK:
16115 return;
16117 /* All fixed-bounds are represented by INTEGER_CST nodes. */
16118 case INTEGER_CST:
16120 unsigned int prec = simple_type_size_in_bits (TREE_TYPE (bound));
16122 /* Use the default if possible. */
16123 if (bound_attr == DW_AT_lower_bound
16124 && (((is_c_family () || is_java ()) && integer_zerop (bound))
16125 || (is_fortran () && integer_onep (bound))))
16128 /* Otherwise represent the bound as an unsigned value with the
16129 precision of its type. The precision and signedness of the
16130 type will be necessary to re-interpret it unambiguously. */
16131 else if (prec < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
16133 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT mask
16134 = ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << prec) - 1;
16135 add_AT_unsigned (subrange_die, bound_attr,
16136 TREE_INT_CST_LOW (bound) & mask);
16138 else if (prec == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
16139 || TREE_INT_CST_HIGH (bound) == 0)
16140 add_AT_unsigned (subrange_die, bound_attr,
16141 TREE_INT_CST_LOW (bound));
16142 else
16143 add_AT_double (subrange_die, bound_attr, TREE_INT_CST_HIGH (bound),
16144 TREE_INT_CST_LOW (bound));
16146 break;
16148 CASE_CONVERT:
16149 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
16150 add_bound_info (subrange_die, bound_attr, TREE_OPERAND (bound, 0));
16151 break;
16153 case SAVE_EXPR:
16154 break;
16156 case VAR_DECL:
16157 case PARM_DECL:
16158 case RESULT_DECL:
16160 dw_die_ref decl_die = lookup_decl_die (bound);
16161 dw_loc_list_ref loc;
16163 /* ??? Can this happen, or should the variable have been bound
16164 first? Probably it can, since I imagine that we try to create
16165 the types of parameters in the order in which they exist in
16166 the list, and won't have created a forward reference to a
16167 later parameter. */
16168 if (decl_die != NULL)
16169 add_AT_die_ref (subrange_die, bound_attr, decl_die);
16170 else
16172 loc = loc_list_from_tree (bound, 0);
16173 add_AT_location_description (subrange_die, bound_attr, loc);
16175 break;
16178 default:
16180 /* Otherwise try to create a stack operation procedure to
16181 evaluate the value of the array bound. */
16183 dw_die_ref ctx, decl_die;
16184 dw_loc_list_ref list;
16186 list = loc_list_from_tree (bound, 2);
16187 if (list == NULL)
16188 break;
16190 if (current_function_decl == 0)
16191 ctx = comp_unit_die;
16192 else
16193 ctx = lookup_decl_die (current_function_decl);
16195 decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, ctx, bound);
16196 add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
16197 add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (bound), 1, 0, ctx);
16198 if (list->dw_loc_next)
16199 add_AT_loc_list (decl_die, DW_AT_location, list);
16200 else
16201 add_AT_loc (decl_die, DW_AT_location, list->expr);
16203 add_AT_die_ref (subrange_die, bound_attr, decl_die);
16204 break;
16209 /* Add subscript info to TYPE_DIE, describing an array TYPE, collapsing
16210 possibly nested array subscripts in a flat sequence if COLLAPSE_P is true.
16211 Note that the block of subscript information for an array type also
16212 includes information about the element type of the given array type. */
16214 static void
16215 add_subscript_info (dw_die_ref type_die, tree type, bool collapse_p)
16217 unsigned dimension_number;
16218 tree lower, upper;
16219 dw_die_ref subrange_die;
16221 for (dimension_number = 0;
16222 TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE && (dimension_number == 0 || collapse_p);
16223 type = TREE_TYPE (type), dimension_number++)
16225 tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
16227 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (type) && is_fortran () && dimension_number > 0)
16228 break;
16230 /* Arrays come in three flavors: Unspecified bounds, fixed bounds,
16231 and (in GNU C only) variable bounds. Handle all three forms
16232 here. */
16233 subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, type_die, NULL);
16234 if (domain)
16236 /* We have an array type with specified bounds. */
16237 lower = TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain);
16238 upper = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain);
16240 /* Define the index type. */
16241 if (TREE_TYPE (domain))
16243 /* ??? This is probably an Ada unnamed subrange type. Ignore the
16244 TREE_TYPE field. We can't emit debug info for this
16245 because it is an unnamed integral type. */
16246 if (TREE_CODE (domain) == INTEGER_TYPE
16247 && TYPE_NAME (domain) == NULL_TREE
16248 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (domain)) == INTEGER_TYPE
16249 && TYPE_NAME (TREE_TYPE (domain)) == NULL_TREE)
16251 else
16252 add_type_attribute (subrange_die, TREE_TYPE (domain), 0, 0,
16253 type_die);
16256 /* ??? If upper is NULL, the array has unspecified length,
16257 but it does have a lower bound. This happens with Fortran
16258 dimension arr(N:*)
16259 Since the debugger is definitely going to need to know N
16260 to produce useful results, go ahead and output the lower
16261 bound solo, and hope the debugger can cope. */
16263 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound, lower);
16264 if (upper)
16265 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound, upper);
16268 /* Otherwise we have an array type with an unspecified length. The
16269 DWARF-2 spec does not say how to handle this; let's just leave out the
16270 bounds. */
16274 static void
16275 add_byte_size_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree tree_node)
16277 unsigned size;
16279 switch (TREE_CODE (tree_node))
16281 case ERROR_MARK:
16282 size = 0;
16283 break;
16284 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
16285 case RECORD_TYPE:
16286 case UNION_TYPE:
16287 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
16288 size = int_size_in_bytes (tree_node);
16289 break;
16290 case FIELD_DECL:
16291 /* For a data member of a struct or union, the DW_AT_byte_size is
16292 generally given as the number of bytes normally allocated for an
16293 object of the *declared* type of the member itself. This is true
16294 even for bit-fields. */
16295 size = simple_type_size_in_bits (field_type (tree_node)) / BITS_PER_UNIT;
16296 break;
16297 default:
16298 gcc_unreachable ();
16301 /* Note that `size' might be -1 when we get to this point. If it is, that
16302 indicates that the byte size of the entity in question is variable. We
16303 have no good way of expressing this fact in Dwarf at the present time,
16304 so just let the -1 pass on through. */
16305 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_byte_size, size);
16308 /* For a FIELD_DECL node which represents a bit-field, output an attribute
16309 which specifies the distance in bits from the highest order bit of the
16310 "containing object" for the bit-field to the highest order bit of the
16311 bit-field itself.
16313 For any given bit-field, the "containing object" is a hypothetical object
16314 (of some integral or enum type) within which the given bit-field lives. The
16315 type of this hypothetical "containing object" is always the same as the
16316 declared type of the individual bit-field itself. The determination of the
16317 exact location of the "containing object" for a bit-field is rather
16318 complicated. It's handled by the `field_byte_offset' function (above).
16320 Note that it is the size (in bytes) of the hypothetical "containing object"
16321 which will be given in the DW_AT_byte_size attribute for this bit-field.
16322 (See `byte_size_attribute' above). */
16324 static inline void
16325 add_bit_offset_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
16327 HOST_WIDE_INT object_offset_in_bytes = field_byte_offset (decl);
16328 tree type = DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl);
16329 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos_int;
16330 HOST_WIDE_INT highest_order_object_bit_offset;
16331 HOST_WIDE_INT highest_order_field_bit_offset;
16332 HOST_WIDE_INT unsigned bit_offset;
16334 /* Must be a field and a bit field. */
16335 gcc_assert (type && TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL);
16337 /* We can't yet handle bit-fields whose offsets are variable, so if we
16338 encounter such things, just return without generating any attribute
16339 whatsoever. Likewise for variable or too large size. */
16340 if (! host_integerp (bit_position (decl), 0)
16341 || ! host_integerp (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1))
16342 return;
16344 bitpos_int = int_bit_position (decl);
16346 /* Note that the bit offset is always the distance (in bits) from the
16347 highest-order bit of the "containing object" to the highest-order bit of
16348 the bit-field itself. Since the "high-order end" of any object or field
16349 is different on big-endian and little-endian machines, the computation
16350 below must take account of these differences. */
16351 highest_order_object_bit_offset = object_offset_in_bytes * BITS_PER_UNIT;
16352 highest_order_field_bit_offset = bitpos_int;
16354 if (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
16356 highest_order_field_bit_offset += tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE (decl), 0);
16357 highest_order_object_bit_offset += simple_type_size_in_bits (type);
16360 bit_offset
16361 = (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
16362 ? highest_order_object_bit_offset - highest_order_field_bit_offset
16363 : highest_order_field_bit_offset - highest_order_object_bit_offset);
16365 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_bit_offset, bit_offset);
16368 /* For a FIELD_DECL node which represents a bit field, output an attribute
16369 which specifies the length in bits of the given field. */
16371 static inline void
16372 add_bit_size_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
16374 /* Must be a field and a bit field. */
16375 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL
16376 && DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl));
16378 if (host_integerp (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1))
16379 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_bit_size, tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1));
16382 /* If the compiled language is ANSI C, then add a 'prototyped'
16383 attribute, if arg types are given for the parameters of a function. */
16385 static inline void
16386 add_prototyped_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree func_type)
16388 if (get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language) == DW_LANG_C89
16389 && TYPE_ARG_TYPES (func_type) != NULL)
16390 add_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_prototyped, 1);
16393 /* Add an 'abstract_origin' attribute below a given DIE. The DIE is found
16394 by looking in either the type declaration or object declaration
16395 equate table. */
16397 static inline dw_die_ref
16398 add_abstract_origin_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree origin)
16400 dw_die_ref origin_die = NULL;
16402 if (TREE_CODE (origin) != FUNCTION_DECL)
16404 /* We may have gotten separated from the block for the inlined
16405 function, if we're in an exception handler or some such; make
16406 sure that the abstract function has been written out.
16408 Doing this for nested functions is wrong, however; functions are
16409 distinct units, and our context might not even be inline. */
16410 tree fn = origin;
16412 if (TYPE_P (fn))
16413 fn = TYPE_STUB_DECL (fn);
16415 fn = decl_function_context (fn);
16416 if (fn)
16417 dwarf2out_abstract_function (fn);
16420 if (DECL_P (origin))
16421 origin_die = lookup_decl_die (origin);
16422 else if (TYPE_P (origin))
16423 origin_die = lookup_type_die (origin);
16425 /* XXX: Functions that are never lowered don't always have correct block
16426 trees (in the case of java, they simply have no block tree, in some other
16427 languages). For these functions, there is nothing we can really do to
16428 output correct debug info for inlined functions in all cases. Rather
16429 than die, we'll just produce deficient debug info now, in that we will
16430 have variables without a proper abstract origin. In the future, when all
16431 functions are lowered, we should re-add a gcc_assert (origin_die)
16432 here. */
16434 if (origin_die)
16435 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin, origin_die);
16436 return origin_die;
16439 /* We do not currently support the pure_virtual attribute. */
16441 static inline void
16442 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree func_decl)
16444 if (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl))
16446 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_virtuality, DW_VIRTUALITY_virtual);
16448 if (host_integerp (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl), 0))
16449 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_vtable_elem_location,
16450 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_constu,
16451 tree_low_cst (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl), 0),
16452 0));
16454 /* GNU extension: Record what type this method came from originally. */
16455 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
16456 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_containing_type,
16457 lookup_type_die (DECL_CONTEXT (func_decl)));
16461 /* Add source coordinate attributes for the given decl. */
16463 static void
16464 add_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
16466 expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
16468 add_AT_file (die, DW_AT_decl_file, lookup_filename (s.file));
16469 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
16472 /* Add a DW_AT_name attribute and source coordinate attribute for the
16473 given decl, but only if it actually has a name. */
16475 static void
16476 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
16478 tree decl_name;
16480 decl_name = DECL_NAME (decl);
16481 if (decl_name != NULL && IDENTIFIER_POINTER (decl_name) != NULL)
16483 const char *name = dwarf2_name (decl, 0);
16484 if (name)
16485 add_name_attribute (die, name);
16486 if (! DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
16487 add_src_coords_attributes (die, decl);
16489 if ((TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL)
16490 && TREE_PUBLIC (decl)
16491 && !DECL_ABSTRACT (decl)
16492 && !(TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL && DECL_REGISTER (decl))
16493 && !is_fortran ())
16495 /* Defer until we have an assembler name set. */
16496 if (!DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME_SET_P (decl))
16498 limbo_die_node *asm_name;
16500 asm_name = GGC_CNEW (limbo_die_node);
16501 asm_name->die = die;
16502 asm_name->created_for = decl;
16503 asm_name->next = deferred_asm_name;
16504 deferred_asm_name = asm_name;
16506 else if (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl) != DECL_NAME (decl))
16507 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name,
16508 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl)));
16512 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
16513 /* Get the function's name, as described by its RTL. This may be different
16514 from the DECL_NAME name used in the source file. */
16515 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL && TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
16517 add_AT_addr (die, DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address,
16518 XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0));
16519 VEC_safe_push (rtx, gc, used_rtx_array, XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0));
16521 #endif
16524 /* Push a new declaration scope. */
16526 static void
16527 push_decl_scope (tree scope)
16529 VEC_safe_push (tree, gc, decl_scope_table, scope);
16532 /* Pop a declaration scope. */
16534 static inline void
16535 pop_decl_scope (void)
16537 VEC_pop (tree, decl_scope_table);
16540 /* Return the DIE for the scope that immediately contains this type.
16541 Non-named types get global scope. Named types nested in other
16542 types get their containing scope if it's open, or global scope
16543 otherwise. All other types (i.e. function-local named types) get
16544 the current active scope. */
16546 static dw_die_ref
16547 scope_die_for (tree t, dw_die_ref context_die)
16549 dw_die_ref scope_die = NULL;
16550 tree containing_scope;
16551 int i;
16553 /* Non-types always go in the current scope. */
16554 gcc_assert (TYPE_P (t));
16556 containing_scope = TYPE_CONTEXT (t);
16558 /* Use the containing namespace if it was passed in (for a declaration). */
16559 if (containing_scope && TREE_CODE (containing_scope) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
16561 if (context_die == lookup_decl_die (containing_scope))
16562 /* OK */;
16563 else
16564 containing_scope = NULL_TREE;
16567 /* Ignore function type "scopes" from the C frontend. They mean that
16568 a tagged type is local to a parmlist of a function declarator, but
16569 that isn't useful to DWARF. */
16570 if (containing_scope && TREE_CODE (containing_scope) == FUNCTION_TYPE)
16571 containing_scope = NULL_TREE;
16573 if (containing_scope == NULL_TREE)
16574 scope_die = comp_unit_die;
16575 else if (TYPE_P (containing_scope))
16577 /* For types, we can just look up the appropriate DIE. But
16578 first we check to see if we're in the middle of emitting it
16579 so we know where the new DIE should go. */
16580 for (i = VEC_length (tree, decl_scope_table) - 1; i >= 0; --i)
16581 if (VEC_index (tree, decl_scope_table, i) == containing_scope)
16582 break;
16584 if (i < 0)
16586 gcc_assert (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
16587 || TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (containing_scope));
16589 /* If none of the current dies are suitable, we get file scope. */
16590 scope_die = comp_unit_die;
16592 else
16593 scope_die = lookup_type_die (containing_scope);
16595 else
16596 scope_die = context_die;
16598 return scope_die;
16601 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is internal to a function. */
16603 static inline int
16604 local_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
16606 for (; context_die; context_die = context_die->die_parent)
16607 if (context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine
16608 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
16609 return 1;
16611 return 0;
16614 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is a class. */
16616 static inline int
16617 class_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
16619 return (context_die
16620 && (context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_structure_type
16621 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type
16622 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_interface_type
16623 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_union_type));
16626 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is a class or namespace, for deciding
16627 whether or not to treat a DIE in this context as a declaration. */
16629 static inline int
16630 class_or_namespace_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
16632 return (class_scope_p (context_die)
16633 || (context_die && context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace));
16636 /* Many forms of DIEs require a "type description" attribute. This
16637 routine locates the proper "type descriptor" die for the type given
16638 by 'type', and adds a DW_AT_type attribute below the given die. */
16640 static void
16641 add_type_attribute (dw_die_ref object_die, tree type, int decl_const,
16642 int decl_volatile, dw_die_ref context_die)
16644 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
16645 dw_die_ref type_die = NULL;
16647 /* ??? If this type is an unnamed subrange type of an integral, floating-point
16648 or fixed-point type, use the inner type. This is because we have no
16649 support for unnamed types in base_type_die. This can happen if this is
16650 an Ada subrange type. Correct solution is emit a subrange type die. */
16651 if ((code == INTEGER_TYPE || code == REAL_TYPE || code == FIXED_POINT_TYPE)
16652 && TREE_TYPE (type) != 0 && TYPE_NAME (type) == 0)
16653 type = TREE_TYPE (type), code = TREE_CODE (type);
16655 if (code == ERROR_MARK
16656 /* Handle a special case. For functions whose return type is void, we
16657 generate *no* type attribute. (Note that no object may have type
16658 `void', so this only applies to function return types). */
16659 || code == VOID_TYPE)
16660 return;
16662 type_die = modified_type_die (type,
16663 decl_const || TYPE_READONLY (type),
16664 decl_volatile || TYPE_VOLATILE (type),
16665 context_die);
16667 if (type_die != NULL)
16668 add_AT_die_ref (object_die, DW_AT_type, type_die);
16671 /* Given an object die, add the calling convention attribute for the
16672 function call type. */
16673 static void
16674 add_calling_convention_attribute (dw_die_ref subr_die, tree decl)
16676 enum dwarf_calling_convention value = DW_CC_normal;
16678 value = ((enum dwarf_calling_convention)
16679 targetm.dwarf_calling_convention (TREE_TYPE (decl)));
16681 /* DWARF doesn't provide a way to identify a program's source-level
16682 entry point. DW_AT_calling_convention attributes are only meant
16683 to describe functions' calling conventions. However, lacking a
16684 better way to signal the Fortran main program, we use this for the
16685 time being, following existing custom. */
16686 if (is_fortran ()
16687 && !strcmp (IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl)), "MAIN__"))
16688 value = DW_CC_program;
16690 /* Only add the attribute if the backend requests it, and
16691 is not DW_CC_normal. */
16692 if (value && (value != DW_CC_normal))
16693 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_calling_convention, value);
16696 /* Given a tree pointer to a struct, class, union, or enum type node, return
16697 a pointer to the (string) tag name for the given type, or zero if the type
16698 was declared without a tag. */
16700 static const char *
16701 type_tag (const_tree type)
16703 const char *name = 0;
16705 if (TYPE_NAME (type) != 0)
16707 tree t = 0;
16709 /* Find the IDENTIFIER_NODE for the type name. */
16710 if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == IDENTIFIER_NODE)
16711 t = TYPE_NAME (type);
16713 /* The g++ front end makes the TYPE_NAME of *each* tagged type point to
16714 a TYPE_DECL node, regardless of whether or not a `typedef' was
16715 involved. */
16716 else if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
16717 && ! DECL_IGNORED_P (TYPE_NAME (type)))
16719 /* We want to be extra verbose. Don't call dwarf_name if
16720 DECL_NAME isn't set. The default hook for decl_printable_name
16721 doesn't like that, and in this context it's correct to return
16722 0, instead of "<anonymous>" or the like. */
16723 if (DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (type)))
16724 name = lang_hooks.dwarf_name (TYPE_NAME (type), 2);
16727 /* Now get the name as a string, or invent one. */
16728 if (!name && t != 0)
16729 name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (t);
16732 return (name == 0 || *name == '\0') ? 0 : name;
16735 /* Return the type associated with a data member, make a special check
16736 for bit field types. */
16738 static inline tree
16739 member_declared_type (const_tree member)
16741 return (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (member)
16742 ? DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (member) : TREE_TYPE (member));
16745 /* Get the decl's label, as described by its RTL. This may be different
16746 from the DECL_NAME name used in the source file. */
16748 #if 0
16749 static const char *
16750 decl_start_label (tree decl)
16752 rtx x;
16753 const char *fnname;
16755 x = DECL_RTL (decl);
16756 gcc_assert (MEM_P (x));
16758 x = XEXP (x, 0);
16759 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF);
16761 fnname = XSTR (x, 0);
16762 return fnname;
16764 #endif
16766 /* These routines generate the internal representation of the DIE's for
16767 the compilation unit. Debugging information is collected by walking
16768 the declaration trees passed in from dwarf2out_decl(). */
16770 static void
16771 gen_array_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
16773 dw_die_ref scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
16774 dw_die_ref array_die;
16776 /* GNU compilers represent multidimensional array types as sequences of one
16777 dimensional array types whose element types are themselves array types.
16778 We sometimes squish that down to a single array_type DIE with multiple
16779 subscripts in the Dwarf debugging info. The draft Dwarf specification
16780 say that we are allowed to do this kind of compression in C, because
16781 there is no difference between an array of arrays and a multidimensional
16782 array. We don't do this for Ada to remain as close as possible to the
16783 actual representation, which is especially important against the language
16784 flexibilty wrt arrays of variable size. */
16786 bool collapse_nested_arrays = !is_ada ();
16787 tree element_type;
16789 /* Emit DW_TAG_string_type for Fortran character types (with kind 1 only, as
16790 DW_TAG_string_type doesn't have DW_AT_type attribute). */
16791 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (type)
16792 && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
16793 && is_fortran ()
16794 && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == TYPE_MODE (char_type_node))
16796 HOST_WIDE_INT size;
16798 array_die = new_die (DW_TAG_string_type, scope_die, type);
16799 add_name_attribute (array_die, type_tag (type));
16800 equate_type_number_to_die (type, array_die);
16801 size = int_size_in_bytes (type);
16802 if (size >= 0)
16803 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_byte_size, size);
16804 else if (TYPE_DOMAIN (type) != NULL_TREE
16805 && TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type)) != NULL_TREE
16806 && DECL_P (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type))))
16808 tree szdecl = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type));
16809 dw_loc_list_ref loc = loc_list_from_tree (szdecl, 2);
16811 size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (szdecl));
16812 if (loc && size > 0)
16814 add_AT_location_description (array_die, DW_AT_string_length, loc);
16815 if (size != DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
16816 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_byte_size, size);
16819 return;
16822 /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader fails for array of array of enum types
16823 (e.g. const enum machine_mode insn_operand_mode[2][10]) unless the inner
16824 array type comes before the outer array type. We thus call gen_type_die
16825 before we new_die and must prevent nested array types collapsing for this
16826 target. */
16828 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
16829 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
16830 collapse_nested_arrays = false;
16831 #endif
16833 array_die = new_die (DW_TAG_array_type, scope_die, type);
16834 add_name_attribute (array_die, type_tag (type));
16835 equate_type_number_to_die (type, array_die);
16837 if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
16839 /* The frontend feeds us a representation for the vector as a struct
16840 containing an array. Pull out the array type. */
16841 type = TREE_TYPE (TYPE_FIELDS (TYPE_DEBUG_REPRESENTATION_TYPE (type)));
16842 add_AT_flag (array_die, DW_AT_GNU_vector, 1);
16845 /* For Fortran multidimensional arrays use DW_ORD_col_major ordering. */
16846 if (is_fortran ()
16847 && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
16848 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == ARRAY_TYPE
16849 && !TYPE_STRING_FLAG (TREE_TYPE (type)))
16850 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_col_major);
16852 #if 0
16853 /* We default the array ordering. SDB will probably do
16854 the right things even if DW_AT_ordering is not present. It's not even
16855 an issue until we start to get into multidimensional arrays anyway. If
16856 SDB is ever caught doing the Wrong Thing for multi-dimensional arrays,
16857 then we'll have to put the DW_AT_ordering attribute back in. (But if
16858 and when we find out that we need to put these in, we will only do so
16859 for multidimensional arrays. */
16860 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_row_major);
16861 #endif
16863 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
16864 /* The SGI compilers handle arrays of unknown bound by setting
16865 AT_declaration and not emitting any subrange DIEs. */
16866 if (! TYPE_DOMAIN (type))
16867 add_AT_flag (array_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
16868 else
16869 #endif
16870 add_subscript_info (array_die, type, collapse_nested_arrays);
16872 /* Add representation of the type of the elements of this array type and
16873 emit the corresponding DIE if we haven't done it already. */
16874 element_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
16875 if (collapse_nested_arrays)
16876 while (TREE_CODE (element_type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
16878 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (element_type) && is_fortran ())
16879 break;
16880 element_type = TREE_TYPE (element_type);
16883 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
16884 gen_type_die (element_type, context_die);
16885 #endif
16887 add_type_attribute (array_die, element_type, 0, 0, context_die);
16889 if (get_AT (array_die, DW_AT_name))
16890 add_pubtype (type, array_die);
16893 static dw_loc_descr_ref
16894 descr_info_loc (tree val, tree base_decl)
16896 HOST_WIDE_INT size;
16897 dw_loc_descr_ref loc, loc2;
16898 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
16900 if (val == base_decl)
16901 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_push_object_address, 0, 0);
16903 switch (TREE_CODE (val))
16905 CASE_CONVERT:
16906 return descr_info_loc (TREE_OPERAND (val, 0), base_decl);
16907 case VAR_DECL:
16908 return loc_descriptor_from_tree (val, 0);
16909 case INTEGER_CST:
16910 if (host_integerp (val, 0))
16911 return int_loc_descriptor (tree_low_cst (val, 0));
16912 break;
16913 case INDIRECT_REF:
16914 size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (val));
16915 if (size < 0)
16916 break;
16917 loc = descr_info_loc (TREE_OPERAND (val, 0), base_decl);
16918 if (!loc)
16919 break;
16920 if (size == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
16921 add_loc_descr (&loc, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0));
16922 else
16923 add_loc_descr (&loc, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref_size, size, 0));
16924 return loc;
16925 case POINTER_PLUS_EXPR:
16926 case PLUS_EXPR:
16927 if (host_integerp (TREE_OPERAND (val, 1), 1)
16928 && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (val, 1), 1)
16929 < 16384)
16931 loc = descr_info_loc (TREE_OPERAND (val, 0), base_decl);
16932 if (!loc)
16933 break;
16934 loc_descr_plus_const (&loc, tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (val, 1), 0));
16936 else
16938 op = DW_OP_plus;
16939 do_binop:
16940 loc = descr_info_loc (TREE_OPERAND (val, 0), base_decl);
16941 if (!loc)
16942 break;
16943 loc2 = descr_info_loc (TREE_OPERAND (val, 1), base_decl);
16944 if (!loc2)
16945 break;
16946 add_loc_descr (&loc, loc2);
16947 add_loc_descr (&loc2, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
16949 return loc;
16950 case MINUS_EXPR:
16951 op = DW_OP_minus;
16952 goto do_binop;
16953 case MULT_EXPR:
16954 op = DW_OP_mul;
16955 goto do_binop;
16956 case EQ_EXPR:
16957 op = DW_OP_eq;
16958 goto do_binop;
16959 case NE_EXPR:
16960 op = DW_OP_ne;
16961 goto do_binop;
16962 default:
16963 break;
16965 return NULL;
16968 static void
16969 add_descr_info_field (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr,
16970 tree val, tree base_decl)
16972 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
16974 if (host_integerp (val, 0))
16976 add_AT_unsigned (die, attr, tree_low_cst (val, 0));
16977 return;
16980 loc = descr_info_loc (val, base_decl);
16981 if (!loc)
16982 return;
16984 add_AT_loc (die, attr, loc);
16987 /* This routine generates DIE for array with hidden descriptor, details
16988 are filled into *info by a langhook. */
16990 static void
16991 gen_descr_array_type_die (tree type, struct array_descr_info *info,
16992 dw_die_ref context_die)
16994 dw_die_ref scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
16995 dw_die_ref array_die;
16996 int dim;
16998 array_die = new_die (DW_TAG_array_type, scope_die, type);
16999 add_name_attribute (array_die, type_tag (type));
17000 equate_type_number_to_die (type, array_die);
17002 /* For Fortran multidimensional arrays use DW_ORD_col_major ordering. */
17003 if (is_fortran ()
17004 && info->ndimensions >= 2)
17005 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_col_major);
17007 if (info->data_location)
17008 add_descr_info_field (array_die, DW_AT_data_location, info->data_location,
17009 info->base_decl);
17010 if (info->associated)
17011 add_descr_info_field (array_die, DW_AT_associated, info->associated,
17012 info->base_decl);
17013 if (info->allocated)
17014 add_descr_info_field (array_die, DW_AT_allocated, info->allocated,
17015 info->base_decl);
17017 for (dim = 0; dim < info->ndimensions; dim++)
17019 dw_die_ref subrange_die
17020 = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, array_die, NULL);
17022 if (info->dimen[dim].lower_bound)
17024 /* If it is the default value, omit it. */
17025 if ((is_c_family () || is_java ())
17026 && integer_zerop (info->dimen[dim].lower_bound))
17028 else if (is_fortran ()
17029 && integer_onep (info->dimen[dim].lower_bound))
17031 else
17032 add_descr_info_field (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound,
17033 info->dimen[dim].lower_bound,
17034 info->base_decl);
17036 if (info->dimen[dim].upper_bound)
17037 add_descr_info_field (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound,
17038 info->dimen[dim].upper_bound,
17039 info->base_decl);
17040 if (info->dimen[dim].stride)
17041 add_descr_info_field (subrange_die, DW_AT_byte_stride,
17042 info->dimen[dim].stride,
17043 info->base_decl);
17046 gen_type_die (info->element_type, context_die);
17047 add_type_attribute (array_die, info->element_type, 0, 0, context_die);
17049 if (get_AT (array_die, DW_AT_name))
17050 add_pubtype (type, array_die);
17053 #if 0
17054 static void
17055 gen_entry_point_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
17057 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
17058 dw_die_ref decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_entry_point, context_die, decl);
17060 if (origin != NULL)
17061 add_abstract_origin_attribute (decl_die, origin);
17062 else
17064 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (decl_die, decl);
17065 add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
17066 0, 0, context_die);
17069 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
17070 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, decl_die);
17071 else
17072 add_AT_lbl_id (decl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, decl_start_label (decl));
17074 #endif
17076 /* Walk through the list of incomplete types again, trying once more to
17077 emit full debugging info for them. */
17079 static void
17080 retry_incomplete_types (void)
17082 int i;
17084 for (i = VEC_length (tree, incomplete_types) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
17085 gen_type_die (VEC_index (tree, incomplete_types, i), comp_unit_die);
17088 /* Determine what tag to use for a record type. */
17090 static enum dwarf_tag
17091 record_type_tag (tree type)
17093 if (! lang_hooks.types.classify_record)
17094 return DW_TAG_structure_type;
17096 switch (lang_hooks.types.classify_record (type))
17098 case RECORD_IS_STRUCT:
17099 return DW_TAG_structure_type;
17101 case RECORD_IS_CLASS:
17102 return DW_TAG_class_type;
17104 case RECORD_IS_INTERFACE:
17105 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
17106 return DW_TAG_interface_type;
17107 return DW_TAG_structure_type;
17109 default:
17110 gcc_unreachable ();
17114 /* Generate a DIE to represent an enumeration type. Note that these DIEs
17115 include all of the information about the enumeration values also. Each
17116 enumerated type name/value is listed as a child of the enumerated type
17117 DIE. */
17119 static dw_die_ref
17120 gen_enumeration_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
17122 dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
17124 if (type_die == NULL)
17126 type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumeration_type,
17127 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
17128 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
17129 add_name_attribute (type_die, type_tag (type));
17131 else if (! TYPE_SIZE (type))
17132 return type_die;
17133 else
17134 remove_AT (type_die, DW_AT_declaration);
17136 /* Handle a GNU C/C++ extension, i.e. incomplete enum types. If the
17137 given enum type is incomplete, do not generate the DW_AT_byte_size
17138 attribute or the DW_AT_element_list attribute. */
17139 if (TYPE_SIZE (type))
17141 tree link;
17143 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
17144 add_byte_size_attribute (type_die, type);
17145 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type) != NULL_TREE)
17146 add_src_coords_attributes (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
17148 /* If the first reference to this type was as the return type of an
17149 inline function, then it may not have a parent. Fix this now. */
17150 if (type_die->die_parent == NULL)
17151 add_child_die (scope_die_for (type, context_die), type_die);
17153 for (link = TYPE_VALUES (type);
17154 link != NULL; link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
17156 dw_die_ref enum_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumerator, type_die, link);
17157 tree value = TREE_VALUE (link);
17159 add_name_attribute (enum_die,
17160 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (TREE_PURPOSE (link)));
17162 if (TREE_CODE (value) == CONST_DECL)
17163 value = DECL_INITIAL (value);
17165 if (host_integerp (value, TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (value))))
17166 /* DWARF2 does not provide a way of indicating whether or
17167 not enumeration constants are signed or unsigned. GDB
17168 always assumes the values are signed, so we output all
17169 values as if they were signed. That means that
17170 enumeration constants with very large unsigned values
17171 will appear to have negative values in the debugger. */
17172 add_AT_int (enum_die, DW_AT_const_value,
17173 tree_low_cst (value, tree_int_cst_sgn (value) > 0));
17176 else
17177 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
17179 if (get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_name))
17180 add_pubtype (type, type_die);
17182 return type_die;
17185 /* Generate a DIE to represent either a real live formal parameter decl or to
17186 represent just the type of some formal parameter position in some function
17187 type.
17189 Note that this routine is a bit unusual because its argument may be a
17190 ..._DECL node (i.e. either a PARM_DECL or perhaps a VAR_DECL which
17191 represents an inlining of some PARM_DECL) or else some sort of a ..._TYPE
17192 node. If it's the former then this function is being called to output a
17193 DIE to represent a formal parameter object (or some inlining thereof). If
17194 it's the latter, then this function is only being called to output a
17195 DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE to stand as a placeholder for some formal
17196 argument type of some subprogram type.
17197 If EMIT_NAME_P is true, name and source coordinate attributes
17198 are emitted. */
17200 static dw_die_ref
17201 gen_formal_parameter_die (tree node, tree origin, bool emit_name_p,
17202 dw_die_ref context_die)
17204 tree node_or_origin = node ? node : origin;
17205 dw_die_ref parm_die
17206 = new_die (DW_TAG_formal_parameter, context_die, node);
17208 switch (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (node_or_origin)))
17210 case tcc_declaration:
17211 if (!origin)
17212 origin = decl_ultimate_origin (node);
17213 if (origin != NULL)
17214 add_abstract_origin_attribute (parm_die, origin);
17215 else
17217 tree type = TREE_TYPE (node);
17218 if (emit_name_p)
17219 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (parm_die, node);
17220 if (decl_by_reference_p (node))
17221 add_type_attribute (parm_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0,
17222 context_die);
17223 else
17224 add_type_attribute (parm_die, type,
17225 TREE_READONLY (node),
17226 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (node),
17227 context_die);
17228 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (node))
17229 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
17232 if (node && node != origin)
17233 equate_decl_number_to_die (node, parm_die);
17234 if (! DECL_ABSTRACT (node_or_origin))
17235 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (parm_die, node_or_origin,
17236 DW_AT_location);
17238 break;
17240 case tcc_type:
17241 /* We were called with some kind of a ..._TYPE node. */
17242 add_type_attribute (parm_die, node_or_origin, 0, 0, context_die);
17243 break;
17245 default:
17246 gcc_unreachable ();
17249 return parm_die;
17252 /* Generate and return a DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack. Also generate
17253 children DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIEs representing the arguments of the
17254 parameter pack.
17256 PARM_PACK must be a function parameter pack.
17257 PACK_ARG is the first argument of the parameter pack. Its TREE_CHAIN
17258 must point to the subsequent arguments of the function PACK_ARG belongs to.
17259 SUBR_DIE is the DIE of the function PACK_ARG belongs to.
17260 If NEXT_ARG is non NULL, *NEXT_ARG is set to the function argument
17261 following the last one for which a DIE was generated. */
17263 static dw_die_ref
17264 gen_formal_parameter_pack_die (tree parm_pack,
17265 tree pack_arg,
17266 dw_die_ref subr_die,
17267 tree *next_arg)
17269 tree arg;
17270 dw_die_ref parm_pack_die;
17272 gcc_assert (parm_pack
17273 && lang_hooks.function_parameter_pack_p (parm_pack)
17274 && subr_die);
17276 parm_pack_die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack, subr_die, parm_pack);
17277 add_src_coords_attributes (parm_pack_die, parm_pack);
17279 for (arg = pack_arg; arg; arg = TREE_CHAIN (arg))
17281 if (! lang_hooks.decls.function_parm_expanded_from_pack_p (arg,
17282 parm_pack))
17283 break;
17284 gen_formal_parameter_die (arg, NULL,
17285 false /* Don't emit name attribute. */,
17286 parm_pack_die);
17288 if (next_arg)
17289 *next_arg = arg;
17290 return parm_pack_die;
17293 /* Generate a special type of DIE used as a stand-in for a trailing ellipsis
17294 at the end of an (ANSI prototyped) formal parameters list. */
17296 static void
17297 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (tree decl_or_type, dw_die_ref context_die)
17299 new_die (DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters, context_die, decl_or_type);
17302 /* Generate a list of nameless DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIEs (and perhaps a
17303 DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters DIE) to represent the types of the formal
17304 parameters as specified in some function type specification (except for
17305 those which appear as part of a function *definition*). */
17307 static void
17308 gen_formal_types_die (tree function_or_method_type, dw_die_ref context_die)
17310 tree link;
17311 tree formal_type = NULL;
17312 tree first_parm_type;
17313 tree arg;
17315 if (TREE_CODE (function_or_method_type) == FUNCTION_DECL)
17317 arg = DECL_ARGUMENTS (function_or_method_type);
17318 function_or_method_type = TREE_TYPE (function_or_method_type);
17320 else
17321 arg = NULL_TREE;
17323 first_parm_type = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (function_or_method_type);
17325 /* Make our first pass over the list of formal parameter types and output a
17326 DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE for each one. */
17327 for (link = first_parm_type; link; )
17329 dw_die_ref parm_die;
17331 formal_type = TREE_VALUE (link);
17332 if (formal_type == void_type_node)
17333 break;
17335 /* Output a (nameless) DIE to represent the formal parameter itself. */
17336 parm_die = gen_formal_parameter_die (formal_type, NULL,
17337 true /* Emit name attribute. */,
17338 context_die);
17339 if ((TREE_CODE (function_or_method_type) == METHOD_TYPE
17340 && link == first_parm_type)
17341 || (arg && DECL_ARTIFICIAL (arg)))
17342 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
17344 link = TREE_CHAIN (link);
17345 if (arg)
17346 arg = TREE_CHAIN (arg);
17349 /* If this function type has an ellipsis, add a
17350 DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters DIE to the end of the parameter list. */
17351 if (formal_type != void_type_node)
17352 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (function_or_method_type, context_die);
17354 /* Make our second (and final) pass over the list of formal parameter types
17355 and output DIEs to represent those types (as necessary). */
17356 for (link = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (function_or_method_type);
17357 link && TREE_VALUE (link);
17358 link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
17359 gen_type_die (TREE_VALUE (link), context_die);
17362 /* We want to generate the DIE for TYPE so that we can generate the
17363 die for MEMBER, which has been defined; we will need to refer back
17364 to the member declaration nested within TYPE. If we're trying to
17365 generate minimal debug info for TYPE, processing TYPE won't do the
17366 trick; we need to attach the member declaration by hand. */
17368 static void
17369 gen_type_die_for_member (tree type, tree member, dw_die_ref context_die)
17371 gen_type_die (type, context_die);
17373 /* If we're trying to avoid duplicate debug info, we may not have
17374 emitted the member decl for this function. Emit it now. */
17375 if (TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type))
17376 && ! lookup_decl_die (member))
17378 dw_die_ref type_die;
17379 gcc_assert (!decl_ultimate_origin (member));
17381 push_decl_scope (type);
17382 type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
17383 if (TREE_CODE (member) == FUNCTION_DECL)
17384 gen_subprogram_die (member, type_die);
17385 else if (TREE_CODE (member) == FIELD_DECL)
17387 /* Ignore the nameless fields that are used to skip bits but handle
17388 C++ anonymous unions and structs. */
17389 if (DECL_NAME (member) != NULL_TREE
17390 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (member)) == UNION_TYPE
17391 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (member)) == RECORD_TYPE)
17393 gen_type_die (member_declared_type (member), type_die);
17394 gen_field_die (member, type_die);
17397 else
17398 gen_variable_die (member, NULL_TREE, type_die);
17400 pop_decl_scope ();
17404 /* Generate the DWARF2 info for the "abstract" instance of a function which we
17405 may later generate inlined and/or out-of-line instances of. */
17407 static void
17408 dwarf2out_abstract_function (tree decl)
17410 dw_die_ref old_die;
17411 tree save_fn;
17412 tree context;
17413 int was_abstract = DECL_ABSTRACT (decl);
17414 htab_t old_decl_loc_table;
17416 /* Make sure we have the actual abstract inline, not a clone. */
17417 decl = DECL_ORIGIN (decl);
17419 old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
17420 if (old_die && get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
17421 /* We've already generated the abstract instance. */
17422 return;
17424 /* We can be called while recursively when seeing block defining inlined subroutine
17425 DIE. Be sure to not clobber the outer location table nor use it or we would
17426 get locations in abstract instantces. */
17427 old_decl_loc_table = decl_loc_table;
17428 decl_loc_table = NULL;
17430 /* Be sure we've emitted the in-class declaration DIE (if any) first, so
17431 we don't get confused by DECL_ABSTRACT. */
17432 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
17434 context = decl_class_context (decl);
17435 if (context)
17436 gen_type_die_for_member
17437 (context, decl, decl_function_context (decl) ? NULL : comp_unit_die);
17440 /* Pretend we've just finished compiling this function. */
17441 save_fn = current_function_decl;
17442 current_function_decl = decl;
17443 push_cfun (DECL_STRUCT_FUNCTION (decl));
17445 set_decl_abstract_flags (decl, 1);
17446 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
17447 if (! was_abstract)
17448 set_decl_abstract_flags (decl, 0);
17450 current_function_decl = save_fn;
17451 decl_loc_table = old_decl_loc_table;
17452 pop_cfun ();
17455 /* Helper function of premark_used_types() which gets called through
17456 htab_traverse.
17458 Marks the DIE of a given type in *SLOT as perennial, so it never gets
17459 marked as unused by prune_unused_types. */
17461 static int
17462 premark_used_types_helper (void **slot, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
17464 tree type;
17465 dw_die_ref die;
17467 type = (tree) *slot;
17468 die = lookup_type_die (type);
17469 if (die != NULL)
17470 die->die_perennial_p = 1;
17471 return 1;
17474 /* Helper function of premark_types_used_by_global_vars which gets called
17475 through htab_traverse.
17477 Marks the DIE of a given type in *SLOT as perennial, so it never gets
17478 marked as unused by prune_unused_types. The DIE of the type is marked
17479 only if the global variable using the type will actually be emitted. */
17481 static int
17482 premark_types_used_by_global_vars_helper (void **slot,
17483 void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
17485 struct types_used_by_vars_entry *entry;
17486 dw_die_ref die;
17488 entry = (struct types_used_by_vars_entry *) *slot;
17489 gcc_assert (entry->type != NULL
17490 && entry->var_decl != NULL);
17491 die = lookup_type_die (entry->type);
17492 if (die)
17494 /* Ask cgraph if the global variable really is to be emitted.
17495 If yes, then we'll keep the DIE of ENTRY->TYPE. */
17496 struct varpool_node *node = varpool_node (entry->var_decl);
17497 if (node->needed)
17499 die->die_perennial_p = 1;
17500 /* Keep the parent DIEs as well. */
17501 while ((die = die->die_parent) && die->die_perennial_p == 0)
17502 die->die_perennial_p = 1;
17505 return 1;
17508 /* Mark all members of used_types_hash as perennial. */
17510 static void
17511 premark_used_types (void)
17513 if (cfun && cfun->used_types_hash)
17514 htab_traverse (cfun->used_types_hash, premark_used_types_helper, NULL);
17517 /* Mark all members of types_used_by_vars_entry as perennial. */
17519 static void
17520 premark_types_used_by_global_vars (void)
17522 if (types_used_by_vars_hash)
17523 htab_traverse (types_used_by_vars_hash,
17524 premark_types_used_by_global_vars_helper, NULL);
17527 /* Generate a DIE to represent a declared function (either file-scope or
17528 block-local). */
17530 static void
17531 gen_subprogram_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
17533 char label_id[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
17534 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
17535 dw_die_ref subr_die;
17536 tree fn_arg_types;
17537 tree outer_scope;
17538 dw_die_ref old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
17539 int declaration = (current_function_decl != decl
17540 || class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die));
17542 premark_used_types ();
17544 /* It is possible to have both DECL_ABSTRACT and DECLARATION be true if we
17545 started to generate the abstract instance of an inline, decided to output
17546 its containing class, and proceeded to emit the declaration of the inline
17547 from the member list for the class. If so, DECLARATION takes priority;
17548 we'll get back to the abstract instance when done with the class. */
17550 /* The class-scope declaration DIE must be the primary DIE. */
17551 if (origin && declaration && class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die))
17553 origin = NULL;
17554 gcc_assert (!old_die);
17557 /* Now that the C++ front end lazily declares artificial member fns, we
17558 might need to retrofit the declaration into its class. */
17559 if (!declaration && !origin && !old_die
17560 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl) && TYPE_P (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))
17561 && !class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die)
17562 && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
17563 old_die = force_decl_die (decl);
17565 if (origin != NULL)
17567 gcc_assert (!declaration || local_scope_p (context_die));
17569 /* Fixup die_parent for the abstract instance of a nested
17570 inline function. */
17571 if (old_die && old_die->die_parent == NULL)
17572 add_child_die (context_die, old_die);
17574 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
17575 add_abstract_origin_attribute (subr_die, origin);
17577 else if (old_die)
17579 expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
17580 struct dwarf_file_data * file_index = lookup_filename (s.file);
17582 if (!get_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_declaration)
17583 /* We can have a normal definition following an inline one in the
17584 case of redefinition of GNU C extern inlines.
17585 It seems reasonable to use AT_specification in this case. */
17586 && !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
17588 /* Detect and ignore this case, where we are trying to output
17589 something we have already output. */
17590 return;
17593 /* If the definition comes from the same place as the declaration,
17594 maybe use the old DIE. We always want the DIE for this function
17595 that has the *_pc attributes to be under comp_unit_die so the
17596 debugger can find it. We also need to do this for abstract
17597 instances of inlines, since the spec requires the out-of-line copy
17598 to have the same parent. For local class methods, this doesn't
17599 apply; we just use the old DIE. */
17600 if ((old_die->die_parent == comp_unit_die || context_die == NULL)
17601 && (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)
17602 || (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) == file_index
17603 && (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line)
17604 == (unsigned) s.line))))
17606 subr_die = old_die;
17608 /* Clear out the declaration attribute and the formal parameters.
17609 Do not remove all children, because it is possible that this
17610 declaration die was forced using force_decl_die(). In such
17611 cases die that forced declaration die (e.g. TAG_imported_module)
17612 is one of the children that we do not want to remove. */
17613 remove_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_declaration);
17614 remove_child_TAG (subr_die, DW_TAG_formal_parameter);
17616 else
17618 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
17619 add_AT_specification (subr_die, old_die);
17620 if (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) != file_index)
17621 add_AT_file (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
17622 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line) != (unsigned) s.line)
17623 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
17626 else
17628 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
17630 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
17631 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
17633 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (subr_die, decl);
17634 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
17636 add_prototyped_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (decl));
17637 add_type_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
17638 0, 0, context_die);
17641 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (subr_die, decl);
17642 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
17643 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
17645 if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
17646 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
17647 else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
17648 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
17651 if (declaration)
17653 if (!old_die || !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
17655 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
17657 /* If this is an explicit function declaration then generate
17658 a DW_AT_explicit attribute. */
17659 if (lang_hooks.decls.function_decl_explicit_p (decl)
17660 && (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
17661 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_explicit, 1);
17663 /* The first time we see a member function, it is in the context of
17664 the class to which it belongs. We make sure of this by emitting
17665 the class first. The next time is the definition, which is
17666 handled above. The two may come from the same source text.
17668 Note that force_decl_die() forces function declaration die. It is
17669 later reused to represent definition. */
17670 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
17673 else if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
17675 if (DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (decl))
17677 if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl))
17678 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_declared_inlined);
17679 else
17680 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_declared_not_inlined);
17682 else
17684 if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl))
17685 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_inlined);
17686 else
17687 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_not_inlined);
17690 if (DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (decl)
17691 && lookup_attribute ("artificial", DECL_ATTRIBUTES (decl)))
17692 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
17694 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
17696 else if (!DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
17698 HOST_WIDE_INT cfa_fb_offset;
17700 if (!old_die || !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
17701 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
17703 if (!flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
17705 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
17706 current_function_funcdef_no);
17707 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label_id);
17708 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_END_LABEL,
17709 current_function_funcdef_no);
17710 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_high_pc, label_id);
17712 add_pubname (decl, subr_die);
17713 add_arange (decl, subr_die);
17715 else
17716 { /* Do nothing for now; maybe need to duplicate die, one for
17717 hot section and one for cold section, then use the hot/cold
17718 section begin/end labels to generate the aranges... */
17720 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_low_pc, hot_section_label);
17721 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_high_pc, hot_section_end_label);
17722 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_lo_user, unlikely_section_label);
17723 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_hi_user, cold_section_end_label);
17725 add_pubname (decl, subr_die);
17726 add_arange (decl, subr_die);
17727 add_arange (decl, subr_die);
17731 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
17732 /* Add a reference to the FDE for this routine. */
17733 add_AT_fde_ref (subr_die, DW_AT_MIPS_fde, current_funcdef_fde);
17734 #endif
17736 cfa_fb_offset = CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (decl);
17738 /* We define the "frame base" as the function's CFA. This is more
17739 convenient for several reasons: (1) It's stable across the prologue
17740 and epilogue, which makes it better than just a frame pointer,
17741 (2) With dwarf3, there exists a one-byte encoding that allows us
17742 to reference the .debug_frame data by proxy, but failing that,
17743 (3) We can at least reuse the code inspection and interpretation
17744 code that determines the CFA position at various points in the
17745 function. */
17746 if (dwarf_version >= 3)
17748 dw_loc_descr_ref op = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_call_frame_cfa, 0, 0);
17749 add_AT_loc (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, op);
17751 else
17753 dw_loc_list_ref list = convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list (cfa_fb_offset);
17754 if (list->dw_loc_next)
17755 add_AT_loc_list (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, list);
17756 else
17757 add_AT_loc (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, list->expr);
17760 /* Compute a displacement from the "steady-state frame pointer" to
17761 the CFA. The former is what all stack slots and argument slots
17762 will reference in the rtl; the later is what we've told the
17763 debugger about. We'll need to adjust all frame_base references
17764 by this displacement. */
17765 compute_frame_pointer_to_fb_displacement (cfa_fb_offset);
17767 if (cfun->static_chain_decl)
17768 add_AT_location_description (subr_die, DW_AT_static_link,
17769 loc_list_from_tree (cfun->static_chain_decl, 2));
17772 /* Generate child dies for template paramaters. */
17773 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
17774 gen_generic_params_dies (decl);
17776 /* Now output descriptions of the arguments for this function. This gets
17777 (unnecessarily?) complex because of the fact that the DECL_ARGUMENT list
17778 for a FUNCTION_DECL doesn't indicate cases where there was a trailing
17779 `...' at the end of the formal parameter list. In order to find out if
17780 there was a trailing ellipsis or not, we must instead look at the type
17781 associated with the FUNCTION_DECL. This will be a node of type
17782 FUNCTION_TYPE. If the chain of type nodes hanging off of this
17783 FUNCTION_TYPE node ends with a void_type_node then there should *not* be
17784 an ellipsis at the end. */
17786 /* In the case where we are describing a mere function declaration, all we
17787 need to do here (and all we *can* do here) is to describe the *types* of
17788 its formal parameters. */
17789 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
17791 else if (declaration)
17792 gen_formal_types_die (decl, subr_die);
17793 else
17795 /* Generate DIEs to represent all known formal parameters. */
17796 tree parm = DECL_ARGUMENTS (decl);
17797 tree generic_decl = lang_hooks.decls.get_generic_function_decl (decl);
17798 tree generic_decl_parm = generic_decl
17799 ? DECL_ARGUMENTS (generic_decl)
17800 : NULL;
17802 /* Now we want to walk the list of parameters of the function and
17803 emit their relevant DIEs.
17805 We consider the case of DECL being an instance of a generic function
17806 as well as it being a normal function.
17808 If DECL is an instance of a generic function we walk the
17809 parameters of the generic function declaration _and_ the parameters of
17810 DECL itself. This is useful because we want to emit specific DIEs for
17811 function parameter packs and those are declared as part of the
17812 generic function declaration. In that particular case,
17813 the parameter pack yields a DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack DIE.
17814 That DIE has children DIEs representing the set of arguments
17815 of the pack. Note that the set of pack arguments can be empty.
17816 In that case, the DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack DIE will not have any
17817 children DIE.
17819 Otherwise, we just consider the parameters of DECL. */
17820 while (generic_decl_parm || parm)
17822 if (generic_decl_parm
17823 && lang_hooks.function_parameter_pack_p (generic_decl_parm))
17824 gen_formal_parameter_pack_die (generic_decl_parm,
17825 parm, subr_die,
17826 &parm);
17827 else if (parm)
17829 gen_decl_die (parm, NULL, subr_die);
17830 parm = TREE_CHAIN (parm);
17833 if (generic_decl_parm)
17834 generic_decl_parm = TREE_CHAIN (generic_decl_parm);
17837 /* Decide whether we need an unspecified_parameters DIE at the end.
17838 There are 2 more cases to do this for: 1) the ansi ... declaration -
17839 this is detectable when the end of the arg list is not a
17840 void_type_node 2) an unprototyped function declaration (not a
17841 definition). This just means that we have no info about the
17842 parameters at all. */
17843 fn_arg_types = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (decl));
17844 if (fn_arg_types != NULL)
17846 /* This is the prototyped case, check for.... */
17847 if (TREE_VALUE (tree_last (fn_arg_types)) != void_type_node)
17848 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl, subr_die);
17850 else if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE)
17851 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl, subr_die);
17854 /* Output Dwarf info for all of the stuff within the body of the function
17855 (if it has one - it may be just a declaration). */
17856 outer_scope = DECL_INITIAL (decl);
17858 /* OUTER_SCOPE is a pointer to the outermost BLOCK node created to represent
17859 a function. This BLOCK actually represents the outermost binding contour
17860 for the function, i.e. the contour in which the function's formal
17861 parameters and labels get declared. Curiously, it appears that the front
17862 end doesn't actually put the PARM_DECL nodes for the current function onto
17863 the BLOCK_VARS list for this outer scope, but are strung off of the
17864 DECL_ARGUMENTS list for the function instead.
17866 The BLOCK_VARS list for the `outer_scope' does provide us with a list of
17867 the LABEL_DECL nodes for the function however, and we output DWARF info
17868 for those in decls_for_scope. Just within the `outer_scope' there will be
17869 a BLOCK node representing the function's outermost pair of curly braces,
17870 and any blocks used for the base and member initializers of a C++
17871 constructor function. */
17872 if (! declaration && TREE_CODE (outer_scope) != ERROR_MARK)
17874 /* Emit a DW_TAG_variable DIE for a named return value. */
17875 if (DECL_NAME (DECL_RESULT (decl)))
17876 gen_decl_die (DECL_RESULT (decl), NULL, subr_die);
17878 current_function_has_inlines = 0;
17879 decls_for_scope (outer_scope, subr_die, 0);
17881 #if 0 && defined (MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO)
17882 if (current_function_has_inlines)
17884 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines, 1);
17885 if (! comp_unit_has_inlines)
17887 add_AT_flag (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines, 1);
17888 comp_unit_has_inlines = 1;
17891 #endif
17893 /* Add the calling convention attribute if requested. */
17894 add_calling_convention_attribute (subr_die, decl);
17898 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a die_struct). */
17900 static hashval_t
17901 common_block_die_table_hash (const void *x)
17903 const_dw_die_ref d = (const_dw_die_ref) x;
17904 return (hashval_t) d->decl_id ^ htab_hash_pointer (d->die_parent);
17907 /* Return nonzero if decl_id and die_parent of die_struct X is the same
17908 as decl_id and die_parent of die_struct Y. */
17910 static int
17911 common_block_die_table_eq (const void *x, const void *y)
17913 const_dw_die_ref d = (const_dw_die_ref) x;
17914 const_dw_die_ref e = (const_dw_die_ref) y;
17915 return d->decl_id == e->decl_id && d->die_parent == e->die_parent;
17918 /* Generate a DIE to represent a declared data object.
17919 Either DECL or ORIGIN must be non-null. */
17921 static void
17922 gen_variable_die (tree decl, tree origin, dw_die_ref context_die)
17924 HOST_WIDE_INT off;
17925 tree com_decl;
17926 tree decl_or_origin = decl ? decl : origin;
17927 dw_die_ref var_die;
17928 dw_die_ref old_die = decl ? lookup_decl_die (decl) : NULL;
17929 dw_die_ref origin_die;
17930 int declaration = (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl_or_origin)
17931 /* If DECL is COMDAT and has not actually been
17932 emitted, we cannot take its address; there
17933 might end up being no definition anywhere in
17934 the program. For example, consider the C++
17935 test case:
17937 template <class T>
17938 struct S { static const int i = 7; };
17940 template <class T>
17941 const int S<T>::i;
17943 int f() { return S<int>::i; }
17945 Here, S<int>::i is not DECL_EXTERNAL, but no
17946 definition is required, so the compiler will
17947 not emit a definition. */
17948 || (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == VAR_DECL
17949 && DECL_COMDAT (decl_or_origin)
17950 && !TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl_or_origin))
17951 || class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die));
17953 if (!origin)
17954 origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
17956 com_decl = fortran_common (decl_or_origin, &off);
17958 /* Symbol in common gets emitted as a child of the common block, in the form
17959 of a data member. */
17960 if (com_decl)
17962 tree field;
17963 dw_die_ref com_die;
17964 dw_loc_list_ref loc;
17965 die_node com_die_arg;
17967 var_die = lookup_decl_die (decl_or_origin);
17968 if (var_die)
17970 if (get_AT (var_die, DW_AT_location) == NULL)
17972 loc = loc_list_from_tree (com_decl, off ? 1 : 2);
17973 if (loc)
17975 if (off)
17977 /* Optimize the common case. */
17978 if (single_element_loc_list_p (loc)
17979 && loc->expr->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_addr
17980 && loc->expr->dw_loc_next == NULL
17981 && GET_CODE (loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr)
17982 == SYMBOL_REF)
17983 loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr
17984 = plus_constant (loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr, off);
17985 else
17986 loc_list_plus_const (loc, off);
17988 add_AT_location_description (var_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
17989 remove_AT (var_die, DW_AT_declaration);
17992 return;
17995 if (common_block_die_table == NULL)
17996 common_block_die_table
17997 = htab_create_ggc (10, common_block_die_table_hash,
17998 common_block_die_table_eq, NULL);
18000 field = TREE_OPERAND (DECL_VALUE_EXPR (decl), 0);
18001 com_die_arg.decl_id = DECL_UID (com_decl);
18002 com_die_arg.die_parent = context_die;
18003 com_die = (dw_die_ref) htab_find (common_block_die_table, &com_die_arg);
18004 loc = loc_list_from_tree (com_decl, 2);
18005 if (com_die == NULL)
18007 const char *cnam
18008 = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (com_decl));
18009 void **slot;
18011 com_die = new_die (DW_TAG_common_block, context_die, decl);
18012 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (com_die, com_decl);
18013 if (loc)
18015 add_AT_location_description (com_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
18016 /* Avoid sharing the same loc descriptor between
18017 DW_TAG_common_block and DW_TAG_variable. */
18018 loc = loc_list_from_tree (com_decl, 2);
18020 else if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
18021 add_AT_flag (com_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
18022 add_pubname_string (cnam, com_die); /* ??? needed? */
18023 com_die->decl_id = DECL_UID (com_decl);
18024 slot = htab_find_slot (common_block_die_table, com_die, INSERT);
18025 *slot = (void *) com_die;
18027 else if (get_AT (com_die, DW_AT_location) == NULL && loc)
18029 add_AT_location_description (com_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
18030 loc = loc_list_from_tree (com_decl, 2);
18031 remove_AT (com_die, DW_AT_declaration);
18033 var_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, com_die, decl);
18034 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (var_die, decl);
18035 add_type_attribute (var_die, TREE_TYPE (decl), TREE_READONLY (decl),
18036 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl), context_die);
18037 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
18038 if (loc)
18040 if (off)
18042 /* Optimize the common case. */
18043 if (single_element_loc_list_p (loc)
18044 && loc->expr->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_addr
18045 && loc->expr->dw_loc_next == NULL
18046 && GET_CODE (loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr) == SYMBOL_REF)
18047 loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr
18048 = plus_constant (loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr, off);
18049 else
18050 loc_list_plus_const (loc, off);
18052 add_AT_location_description (var_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
18054 else if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
18055 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
18056 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, var_die);
18057 return;
18060 /* If the compiler emitted a definition for the DECL declaration
18061 and if we already emitted a DIE for it, don't emit a second
18062 DIE for it again. */
18063 if (old_die
18064 && declaration
18065 && old_die->die_parent == context_die)
18066 return;
18068 /* For static data members, the declaration in the class is supposed
18069 to have DW_TAG_member tag; the specification should still be
18070 DW_TAG_variable referencing the DW_TAG_member DIE. */
18071 if (declaration && class_scope_p (context_die))
18072 var_die = new_die (DW_TAG_member, context_die, decl);
18073 else
18074 var_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, context_die, decl);
18076 origin_die = NULL;
18077 if (origin != NULL)
18078 origin_die = add_abstract_origin_attribute (var_die, origin);
18080 /* Loop unrolling can create multiple blocks that refer to the same
18081 static variable, so we must test for the DW_AT_declaration flag.
18083 ??? Loop unrolling/reorder_blocks should perhaps be rewritten to
18084 copy decls and set the DECL_ABSTRACT flag on them instead of
18085 sharing them.
18087 ??? Duplicated blocks have been rewritten to use .debug_ranges.
18089 ??? The declare_in_namespace support causes us to get two DIEs for one
18090 variable, both of which are declarations. We want to avoid considering
18091 one to be a specification, so we must test that this DIE is not a
18092 declaration. */
18093 else if (old_die && TREE_STATIC (decl) && ! declaration
18094 && get_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_declaration) == 1)
18096 /* This is a definition of a C++ class level static. */
18097 add_AT_specification (var_die, old_die);
18098 if (DECL_NAME (decl))
18100 expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
18101 struct dwarf_file_data * file_index = lookup_filename (s.file);
18103 if (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) != file_index)
18104 add_AT_file (var_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
18106 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line) != (unsigned) s.line)
18107 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
18110 else
18112 tree type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
18114 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (var_die, decl);
18115 if (decl_by_reference_p (decl))
18116 add_type_attribute (var_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
18117 else
18118 add_type_attribute (var_die, type, TREE_READONLY (decl),
18119 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl), context_die);
18121 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
18122 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
18124 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
18125 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
18127 if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
18128 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
18129 else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
18130 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
18133 if (declaration)
18134 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
18136 if (decl && (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl) || declaration))
18137 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, var_die);
18139 if (! declaration
18140 && (! DECL_ABSTRACT (decl_or_origin)
18141 /* Local static vars are shared between all clones/inlines,
18142 so emit DW_AT_location on the abstract DIE if DECL_RTL is
18143 already set. */
18144 || (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == VAR_DECL
18145 && TREE_STATIC (decl_or_origin)
18146 && DECL_RTL_SET_P (decl_or_origin)))
18147 /* When abstract origin already has DW_AT_location attribute, no need
18148 to add it again. */
18149 && (origin_die == NULL || get_AT (origin_die, DW_AT_location) == NULL))
18151 if (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == VAR_DECL && TREE_STATIC (decl_or_origin)
18152 && !TREE_SYMBOL_REFERENCED (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl_or_origin)))
18153 defer_location (decl_or_origin, var_die);
18154 else
18155 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (var_die,
18156 decl_or_origin,
18157 DW_AT_location);
18158 add_pubname (decl_or_origin, var_die);
18160 else
18161 tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (var_die, decl_or_origin);
18164 /* Generate a DIE to represent a named constant. */
18166 static void
18167 gen_const_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
18169 dw_die_ref const_die;
18170 tree type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
18172 const_die = new_die (DW_TAG_constant, context_die, decl);
18173 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (const_die, decl);
18174 add_type_attribute (const_die, type, 1, 0, context_die);
18175 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
18176 add_AT_flag (const_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
18177 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
18178 add_AT_flag (const_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
18179 tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (const_die, decl);
18182 /* Generate a DIE to represent a label identifier. */
18184 static void
18185 gen_label_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
18187 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
18188 dw_die_ref lbl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_label, context_die, decl);
18189 rtx insn;
18190 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
18192 if (origin != NULL)
18193 add_abstract_origin_attribute (lbl_die, origin);
18194 else
18195 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (lbl_die, decl);
18197 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
18198 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, lbl_die);
18199 else
18201 insn = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (decl);
18203 /* Deleted labels are programmer specified labels which have been
18204 eliminated because of various optimizations. We still emit them
18205 here so that it is possible to put breakpoints on them. */
18206 if (insn
18207 && (LABEL_P (insn)
18208 || ((NOTE_P (insn)
18209 && NOTE_KIND (insn) == NOTE_INSN_DELETED_LABEL))))
18211 /* When optimization is enabled (via -O) some parts of the compiler
18212 (e.g. jump.c and cse.c) may try to delete CODE_LABEL insns which
18213 represent source-level labels which were explicitly declared by
18214 the user. This really shouldn't be happening though, so catch
18215 it if it ever does happen. */
18216 gcc_assert (!INSN_DELETED_P (insn));
18218 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "L", CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn));
18219 add_AT_lbl_id (lbl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
18224 /* A helper function for gen_inlined_subroutine_die. Add source coordinate
18225 attributes to the DIE for a block STMT, to describe where the inlined
18226 function was called from. This is similar to add_src_coords_attributes. */
18228 static inline void
18229 add_call_src_coords_attributes (tree stmt, dw_die_ref die)
18231 expanded_location s = expand_location (BLOCK_SOURCE_LOCATION (stmt));
18233 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
18235 add_AT_file (die, DW_AT_call_file, lookup_filename (s.file));
18236 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_call_line, s.line);
18241 /* A helper function for gen_lexical_block_die and gen_inlined_subroutine_die.
18242 Add low_pc and high_pc attributes to the DIE for a block STMT. */
18244 static inline void
18245 add_high_low_attributes (tree stmt, dw_die_ref die)
18247 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
18249 if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt)
18250 && (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
18252 tree chain;
18254 if (inlined_function_outer_scope_p (stmt))
18256 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL,
18257 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
18258 add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_entry_pc, label);
18261 add_AT_range_list (die, DW_AT_ranges, add_ranges (stmt));
18263 chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt);
18266 add_ranges (chain);
18267 chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (chain);
18269 while (chain);
18270 add_ranges (NULL);
18272 else
18274 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL,
18275 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
18276 add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
18277 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_END_LABEL,
18278 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
18279 add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_high_pc, label);
18283 /* Generate a DIE for a lexical block. */
18285 static void
18286 gen_lexical_block_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
18288 dw_die_ref stmt_die = new_die (DW_TAG_lexical_block, context_die, stmt);
18290 if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt) && TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt))
18291 add_high_low_attributes (stmt, stmt_die);
18293 decls_for_scope (stmt, stmt_die, depth);
18296 /* Generate a DIE for an inlined subprogram. */
18298 static void
18299 gen_inlined_subroutine_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
18301 tree decl;
18303 /* The instance of function that is effectively being inlined shall not
18304 be abstract. */
18305 gcc_assert (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt));
18307 decl = block_ultimate_origin (stmt);
18309 /* Emit info for the abstract instance first, if we haven't yet. We
18310 must emit this even if the block is abstract, otherwise when we
18311 emit the block below (or elsewhere), we may end up trying to emit
18312 a die whose origin die hasn't been emitted, and crashing. */
18313 dwarf2out_abstract_function (decl);
18315 if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
18317 dw_die_ref subr_die
18318 = new_die (DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine, context_die, stmt);
18320 add_abstract_origin_attribute (subr_die, decl);
18321 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt))
18322 add_high_low_attributes (stmt, subr_die);
18323 add_call_src_coords_attributes (stmt, subr_die);
18325 decls_for_scope (stmt, subr_die, depth);
18326 current_function_has_inlines = 1;
18330 /* Generate a DIE for a field in a record, or structure. */
18332 static void
18333 gen_field_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
18335 dw_die_ref decl_die;
18337 if (TREE_TYPE (decl) == error_mark_node)
18338 return;
18340 decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_member, context_die, decl);
18341 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (decl_die, decl);
18342 add_type_attribute (decl_die, member_declared_type (decl),
18343 TREE_READONLY (decl), TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl),
18344 context_die);
18346 if (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl))
18348 add_byte_size_attribute (decl_die, decl);
18349 add_bit_size_attribute (decl_die, decl);
18350 add_bit_offset_attribute (decl_die, decl);
18353 if (TREE_CODE (DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (decl)) != UNION_TYPE)
18354 add_data_member_location_attribute (decl_die, decl);
18356 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
18357 add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
18359 if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
18360 add_AT_unsigned (decl_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
18361 else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
18362 add_AT_unsigned (decl_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
18364 /* Equate decl number to die, so that we can look up this decl later on. */
18365 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, decl_die);
18368 #if 0
18369 /* Don't generate either pointer_type DIEs or reference_type DIEs here.
18370 Use modified_type_die instead.
18371 We keep this code here just in case these types of DIEs may be needed to
18372 represent certain things in other languages (e.g. Pascal) someday. */
18374 static void
18375 gen_pointer_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
18377 dw_die_ref ptr_die
18378 = new_die (DW_TAG_pointer_type, scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
18380 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ptr_die);
18381 add_type_attribute (ptr_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
18382 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size, PTR_SIZE);
18385 /* Don't generate either pointer_type DIEs or reference_type DIEs here.
18386 Use modified_type_die instead.
18387 We keep this code here just in case these types of DIEs may be needed to
18388 represent certain things in other languages (e.g. Pascal) someday. */
18390 static void
18391 gen_reference_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
18393 dw_die_ref ref_die
18394 = new_die (DW_TAG_reference_type, scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
18396 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ref_die);
18397 add_type_attribute (ref_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
18398 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size, PTR_SIZE);
18400 #endif
18402 /* Generate a DIE for a pointer to a member type. */
18404 static void
18405 gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
18407 dw_die_ref ptr_die
18408 = new_die (DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type,
18409 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
18411 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ptr_die);
18412 add_AT_die_ref (ptr_die, DW_AT_containing_type,
18413 lookup_type_die (TYPE_OFFSET_BASETYPE (type)));
18414 add_type_attribute (ptr_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
18417 /* Generate the DIE for the compilation unit. */
18419 static dw_die_ref
18420 gen_compile_unit_die (const char *filename)
18422 dw_die_ref die;
18423 char producer[250];
18424 const char *language_string = lang_hooks.name;
18425 int language;
18427 die = new_die (DW_TAG_compile_unit, NULL, NULL);
18429 if (filename)
18431 add_name_attribute (die, filename);
18432 /* Don't add cwd for <built-in>. */
18433 if (!IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH (filename) && filename[0] != '<')
18434 add_comp_dir_attribute (die);
18437 sprintf (producer, "%s %s", language_string, version_string);
18439 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
18440 /* The MIPS/SGI compilers place the 'cc' command line options in the producer
18441 string. The SGI debugger looks for -g, -g1, -g2, or -g3; if they do
18442 not appear in the producer string, the debugger reaches the conclusion
18443 that the object file is stripped and has no debugging information.
18444 To get the MIPS/SGI debugger to believe that there is debugging
18445 information in the object file, we add a -g to the producer string. */
18446 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
18447 strcat (producer, " -g");
18448 #endif
18450 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_producer, producer);
18452 language = DW_LANG_C89;
18453 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU C++") == 0)
18454 language = DW_LANG_C_plus_plus;
18455 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU F77") == 0)
18456 language = DW_LANG_Fortran77;
18457 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Pascal") == 0)
18458 language = DW_LANG_Pascal83;
18459 else if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
18461 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Ada") == 0)
18462 language = DW_LANG_Ada95;
18463 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Fortran") == 0)
18464 language = DW_LANG_Fortran95;
18465 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Java") == 0)
18466 language = DW_LANG_Java;
18467 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Objective-C") == 0)
18468 language = DW_LANG_ObjC;
18469 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Objective-C++") == 0)
18470 language = DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus;
18473 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_language, language);
18474 return die;
18477 /* Generate the DIE for a base class. */
18479 static void
18480 gen_inheritance_die (tree binfo, tree access, dw_die_ref context_die)
18482 dw_die_ref die = new_die (DW_TAG_inheritance, context_die, binfo);
18484 add_type_attribute (die, BINFO_TYPE (binfo), 0, 0, context_die);
18485 add_data_member_location_attribute (die, binfo);
18487 if (BINFO_VIRTUAL_P (binfo))
18488 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_virtuality, DW_VIRTUALITY_virtual);
18490 if (access == access_public_node)
18491 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_public);
18492 else if (access == access_protected_node)
18493 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
18496 /* Generate a DIE for a class member. */
18498 static void
18499 gen_member_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
18501 tree member;
18502 tree binfo = TYPE_BINFO (type);
18503 dw_die_ref child;
18505 /* If this is not an incomplete type, output descriptions of each of its
18506 members. Note that as we output the DIEs necessary to represent the
18507 members of this record or union type, we will also be trying to output
18508 DIEs to represent the *types* of those members. However the `type'
18509 function (above) will specifically avoid generating type DIEs for member
18510 types *within* the list of member DIEs for this (containing) type except
18511 for those types (of members) which are explicitly marked as also being
18512 members of this (containing) type themselves. The g++ front- end can
18513 force any given type to be treated as a member of some other (containing)
18514 type by setting the TYPE_CONTEXT of the given (member) type to point to
18515 the TREE node representing the appropriate (containing) type. */
18517 /* First output info about the base classes. */
18518 if (binfo)
18520 VEC(tree,gc) *accesses = BINFO_BASE_ACCESSES (binfo);
18521 int i;
18522 tree base;
18524 for (i = 0; BINFO_BASE_ITERATE (binfo, i, base); i++)
18525 gen_inheritance_die (base,
18526 (accesses ? VEC_index (tree, accesses, i)
18527 : access_public_node), context_die);
18530 /* Now output info about the data members and type members. */
18531 for (member = TYPE_FIELDS (type); member; member = TREE_CHAIN (member))
18533 /* If we thought we were generating minimal debug info for TYPE
18534 and then changed our minds, some of the member declarations
18535 may have already been defined. Don't define them again, but
18536 do put them in the right order. */
18538 child = lookup_decl_die (member);
18539 if (child)
18540 splice_child_die (context_die, child);
18541 else
18542 gen_decl_die (member, NULL, context_die);
18545 /* Now output info about the function members (if any). */
18546 for (member = TYPE_METHODS (type); member; member = TREE_CHAIN (member))
18548 /* Don't include clones in the member list. */
18549 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (member))
18550 continue;
18552 child = lookup_decl_die (member);
18553 if (child)
18554 splice_child_die (context_die, child);
18555 else
18556 gen_decl_die (member, NULL, context_die);
18560 /* Generate a DIE for a structure or union type. If TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG
18561 is set, we pretend that the type was never defined, so we only get the
18562 member DIEs needed by later specification DIEs. */
18564 static void
18565 gen_struct_or_union_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die,
18566 enum debug_info_usage usage)
18568 dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
18569 dw_die_ref scope_die = 0;
18570 int nested = 0;
18571 int complete = (TYPE_SIZE (type)
18572 && (! TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
18573 || ! TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type))));
18574 int ns_decl = (context_die && context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace);
18575 complete = complete && should_emit_struct_debug (type, usage);
18577 if (type_die && ! complete)
18578 return;
18580 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type) != NULL_TREE
18581 && (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
18582 || TREE_CODE (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)) == NAMESPACE_DECL))
18583 nested = 1;
18585 scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
18587 if (! type_die || (nested && scope_die == comp_unit_die))
18588 /* First occurrence of type or toplevel definition of nested class. */
18590 dw_die_ref old_die = type_die;
18592 type_die = new_die (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE
18593 ? record_type_tag (type) : DW_TAG_union_type,
18594 scope_die, type);
18595 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
18596 if (old_die)
18597 add_AT_specification (type_die, old_die);
18598 else
18599 add_name_attribute (type_die, type_tag (type));
18601 else
18602 remove_AT (type_die, DW_AT_declaration);
18604 /* Generate child dies for template paramaters. */
18605 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
18606 && COMPLETE_TYPE_P (type))
18607 gen_generic_params_dies (type);
18609 /* If this type has been completed, then give it a byte_size attribute and
18610 then give a list of members. */
18611 if (complete && !ns_decl)
18613 /* Prevent infinite recursion in cases where the type of some member of
18614 this type is expressed in terms of this type itself. */
18615 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
18616 add_byte_size_attribute (type_die, type);
18617 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type) != NULL_TREE)
18618 add_src_coords_attributes (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
18620 /* If the first reference to this type was as the return type of an
18621 inline function, then it may not have a parent. Fix this now. */
18622 if (type_die->die_parent == NULL)
18623 add_child_die (scope_die, type_die);
18625 push_decl_scope (type);
18626 gen_member_die (type, type_die);
18627 pop_decl_scope ();
18629 /* GNU extension: Record what type our vtable lives in. */
18630 if (TYPE_VFIELD (type))
18632 tree vtype = DECL_FCONTEXT (TYPE_VFIELD (type));
18634 gen_type_die (vtype, context_die);
18635 add_AT_die_ref (type_die, DW_AT_containing_type,
18636 lookup_type_die (vtype));
18639 else
18641 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
18643 /* We don't need to do this for function-local types. */
18644 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
18645 && ! decl_function_context (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)))
18646 VEC_safe_push (tree, gc, incomplete_types, type);
18649 if (get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_name))
18650 add_pubtype (type, type_die);
18653 /* Generate a DIE for a subroutine _type_. */
18655 static void
18656 gen_subroutine_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
18658 tree return_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
18659 dw_die_ref subr_die
18660 = new_die (DW_TAG_subroutine_type,
18661 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
18663 equate_type_number_to_die (type, subr_die);
18664 add_prototyped_attribute (subr_die, type);
18665 add_type_attribute (subr_die, return_type, 0, 0, context_die);
18666 gen_formal_types_die (type, subr_die);
18668 if (get_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_name))
18669 add_pubtype (type, subr_die);
18672 /* Generate a DIE for a type definition. */
18674 static void
18675 gen_typedef_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
18677 dw_die_ref type_die;
18678 tree origin;
18680 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
18681 return;
18683 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl) = 1;
18684 type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_typedef, context_die, decl);
18685 origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
18686 if (origin != NULL)
18687 add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, origin);
18688 else
18690 tree type;
18692 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (type_die, decl);
18693 if (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl))
18695 type = DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl);
18697 gcc_assert (type != TREE_TYPE (decl));
18698 equate_type_number_to_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), type_die);
18700 else
18701 type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
18703 add_type_attribute (type_die, type, TREE_READONLY (decl),
18704 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl), context_die);
18707 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
18708 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, type_die);
18710 if (get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_name))
18711 add_pubtype (decl, type_die);
18714 /* Generate a type description DIE. */
18716 static void
18717 gen_type_die_with_usage (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die,
18718 enum debug_info_usage usage)
18720 int need_pop;
18721 struct array_descr_info info;
18723 if (type == NULL_TREE || type == error_mark_node)
18724 return;
18726 /* If TYPE is a typedef type variant, let's generate debug info
18727 for the parent typedef which TYPE is a type of. */
18728 if (TYPE_NAME (type) && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
18729 && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type)))
18731 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
18732 return;
18734 /* Prevent broken recursion; we can't hand off to the same type. */
18735 gcc_assert (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type)) != type);
18737 /* Use the DIE of the containing namespace as the parent DIE of
18738 the type description DIE we want to generate. */
18739 if (DECL_CONTEXT (TYPE_NAME (type))
18740 && TREE_CODE (DECL_CONTEXT (TYPE_NAME (type))) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
18741 context_die = get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (TYPE_NAME (type)));
18743 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
18744 gen_decl_die (TYPE_NAME (type), NULL, context_die);
18745 return;
18748 /* If this is an array type with hidden descriptor, handle it first. */
18749 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type)
18750 && lang_hooks.types.get_array_descr_info
18751 && lang_hooks.types.get_array_descr_info (type, &info)
18752 && (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
18754 gen_descr_array_type_die (type, &info, context_die);
18755 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
18756 return;
18759 /* We are going to output a DIE to represent the unqualified version
18760 of this type (i.e. without any const or volatile qualifiers) so
18761 get the main variant (i.e. the unqualified version) of this type
18762 now. (Vectors are special because the debugging info is in the
18763 cloned type itself). */
18764 if (TREE_CODE (type) != VECTOR_TYPE)
18765 type = type_main_variant (type);
18767 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
18768 return;
18770 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
18772 case ERROR_MARK:
18773 break;
18775 case POINTER_TYPE:
18776 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
18777 /* We must set TREE_ASM_WRITTEN in case this is a recursive type. This
18778 ensures that the gen_type_die recursion will terminate even if the
18779 type is recursive. Recursive types are possible in Ada. */
18780 /* ??? We could perhaps do this for all types before the switch
18781 statement. */
18782 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
18784 /* For these types, all that is required is that we output a DIE (or a
18785 set of DIEs) to represent the "basis" type. */
18786 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
18787 DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE);
18788 break;
18790 case OFFSET_TYPE:
18791 /* This code is used for C++ pointer-to-data-member types.
18792 Output a description of the relevant class type. */
18793 gen_type_die_with_usage (TYPE_OFFSET_BASETYPE (type), context_die,
18794 DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE);
18796 /* Output a description of the type of the object pointed to. */
18797 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
18798 DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE);
18800 /* Now output a DIE to represent this pointer-to-data-member type
18801 itself. */
18802 gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (type, context_die);
18803 break;
18805 case FUNCTION_TYPE:
18806 /* Force out return type (in case it wasn't forced out already). */
18807 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
18808 DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
18809 gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die);
18810 break;
18812 case METHOD_TYPE:
18813 /* Force out return type (in case it wasn't forced out already). */
18814 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
18815 DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
18816 gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die);
18817 break;
18819 case ARRAY_TYPE:
18820 gen_array_type_die (type, context_die);
18821 break;
18823 case VECTOR_TYPE:
18824 gen_array_type_die (type, context_die);
18825 break;
18827 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
18828 case RECORD_TYPE:
18829 case UNION_TYPE:
18830 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
18831 /* If this is a nested type whose containing class hasn't been written
18832 out yet, writing it out will cover this one, too. This does not apply
18833 to instantiations of member class templates; they need to be added to
18834 the containing class as they are generated. FIXME: This hurts the
18835 idea of combining type decls from multiple TUs, since we can't predict
18836 what set of template instantiations we'll get. */
18837 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)
18838 && AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
18839 && ! TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)))
18841 gen_type_die_with_usage (TYPE_CONTEXT (type), context_die, usage);
18843 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
18844 return;
18846 /* If that failed, attach ourselves to the stub. */
18847 push_decl_scope (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
18848 context_die = lookup_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
18849 need_pop = 1;
18851 else if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type) != NULL_TREE
18852 && (TREE_CODE (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)) == FUNCTION_DECL))
18854 /* If this type is local to a function that hasn't been written
18855 out yet, use a NULL context for now; it will be fixed up in
18856 decls_for_scope. */
18857 context_die = lookup_decl_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
18858 need_pop = 0;
18860 else
18862 context_die = declare_in_namespace (type, context_die);
18863 need_pop = 0;
18866 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ENUMERAL_TYPE)
18868 /* This might have been written out by the call to
18869 declare_in_namespace. */
18870 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
18871 gen_enumeration_type_die (type, context_die);
18873 else
18874 gen_struct_or_union_type_die (type, context_die, usage);
18876 if (need_pop)
18877 pop_decl_scope ();
18879 /* Don't set TREE_ASM_WRITTEN on an incomplete struct; we want to fix
18880 it up if it is ever completed. gen_*_type_die will set it for us
18881 when appropriate. */
18882 return;
18884 case VOID_TYPE:
18885 case INTEGER_TYPE:
18886 case REAL_TYPE:
18887 case FIXED_POINT_TYPE:
18888 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
18889 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
18890 /* No DIEs needed for fundamental types. */
18891 break;
18893 case LANG_TYPE:
18894 /* No Dwarf representation currently defined. */
18895 break;
18897 default:
18898 gcc_unreachable ();
18901 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
18904 static void
18905 gen_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
18907 gen_type_die_with_usage (type, context_die, DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
18910 /* Generate a DW_TAG_lexical_block DIE followed by DIEs to represent all of the
18911 things which are local to the given block. */
18913 static void
18914 gen_block_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
18916 int must_output_die = 0;
18917 bool inlined_func;
18919 /* Ignore blocks that are NULL. */
18920 if (stmt == NULL_TREE)
18921 return;
18923 inlined_func = inlined_function_outer_scope_p (stmt);
18925 /* If the block is one fragment of a non-contiguous block, do not
18926 process the variables, since they will have been done by the
18927 origin block. Do process subblocks. */
18928 if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_ORIGIN (stmt))
18930 tree sub;
18932 for (sub = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt); sub; sub = BLOCK_CHAIN (sub))
18933 gen_block_die (sub, context_die, depth + 1);
18935 return;
18938 /* Determine if we need to output any Dwarf DIEs at all to represent this
18939 block. */
18940 if (inlined_func)
18941 /* The outer scopes for inlinings *must* always be represented. We
18942 generate DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine DIEs for them. (See below.) */
18943 must_output_die = 1;
18944 else
18946 /* Determine if this block directly contains any "significant"
18947 local declarations which we will need to output DIEs for. */
18948 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
18949 /* We are not in terse mode so *any* local declaration counts
18950 as being a "significant" one. */
18951 must_output_die = ((BLOCK_VARS (stmt) != NULL
18952 || BLOCK_NUM_NONLOCALIZED_VARS (stmt))
18953 && (TREE_USED (stmt)
18954 || TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt)
18955 || BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt)));
18956 else if ((TREE_USED (stmt)
18957 || TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt)
18958 || BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
18959 && !dwarf2out_ignore_block (stmt))
18960 must_output_die = 1;
18963 /* It would be a waste of space to generate a Dwarf DW_TAG_lexical_block
18964 DIE for any block which contains no significant local declarations at
18965 all. Rather, in such cases we just call `decls_for_scope' so that any
18966 needed Dwarf info for any sub-blocks will get properly generated. Note
18967 that in terse mode, our definition of what constitutes a "significant"
18968 local declaration gets restricted to include only inlined function
18969 instances and local (nested) function definitions. */
18970 if (must_output_die)
18972 if (inlined_func)
18974 /* If STMT block is abstract, that means we have been called
18975 indirectly from dwarf2out_abstract_function.
18976 That function rightfully marks the descendent blocks (of
18977 the abstract function it is dealing with) as being abstract,
18978 precisely to prevent us from emitting any
18979 DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine DIE as a descendent
18980 of an abstract function instance. So in that case, we should
18981 not call gen_inlined_subroutine_die.
18983 Later though, when cgraph asks dwarf2out to emit info
18984 for the concrete instance of the function decl into which
18985 the concrete instance of STMT got inlined, the later will lead
18986 to the generation of a DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine DIE. */
18987 if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
18988 gen_inlined_subroutine_die (stmt, context_die, depth);
18990 else
18991 gen_lexical_block_die (stmt, context_die, depth);
18993 else
18994 decls_for_scope (stmt, context_die, depth);
18997 /* Process variable DECL (or variable with origin ORIGIN) within
18998 block STMT and add it to CONTEXT_DIE. */
18999 static void
19000 process_scope_var (tree stmt, tree decl, tree origin, dw_die_ref context_die)
19002 dw_die_ref die;
19003 tree decl_or_origin = decl ? decl : origin;
19004 tree ultimate_origin = origin ? decl_ultimate_origin (origin) : NULL;
19006 if (ultimate_origin)
19007 origin = ultimate_origin;
19009 if (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == FUNCTION_DECL)
19010 die = lookup_decl_die (decl_or_origin);
19011 else if (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == TYPE_DECL
19012 && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl_or_origin))
19013 die = lookup_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin));
19014 else
19015 die = NULL;
19017 if (die != NULL && die->die_parent == NULL)
19018 add_child_die (context_die, die);
19019 else if (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == IMPORTED_DECL)
19020 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (decl_or_origin, DECL_NAME (decl_or_origin),
19021 stmt, context_die);
19022 else
19023 gen_decl_die (decl, origin, context_die);
19026 /* Generate all of the decls declared within a given scope and (recursively)
19027 all of its sub-blocks. */
19029 static void
19030 decls_for_scope (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
19032 tree decl;
19033 unsigned int i;
19034 tree subblocks;
19036 /* Ignore NULL blocks. */
19037 if (stmt == NULL_TREE)
19038 return;
19040 /* Output the DIEs to represent all of the data objects and typedefs
19041 declared directly within this block but not within any nested
19042 sub-blocks. Also, nested function and tag DIEs have been
19043 generated with a parent of NULL; fix that up now. */
19044 for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (stmt); decl != NULL; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
19045 process_scope_var (stmt, decl, NULL_TREE, context_die);
19046 for (i = 0; i < BLOCK_NUM_NONLOCALIZED_VARS (stmt); i++)
19047 process_scope_var (stmt, NULL, BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VAR (stmt, i),
19048 context_die);
19050 /* If we're at -g1, we're not interested in subblocks. */
19051 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
19052 return;
19054 /* Output the DIEs to represent all sub-blocks (and the items declared
19055 therein) of this block. */
19056 for (subblocks = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt);
19057 subblocks != NULL;
19058 subblocks = BLOCK_CHAIN (subblocks))
19059 gen_block_die (subblocks, context_die, depth + 1);
19062 /* Is this a typedef we can avoid emitting? */
19064 static inline int
19065 is_redundant_typedef (const_tree decl)
19067 if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl))
19068 return 1;
19070 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)
19071 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl)
19072 && is_tagged_type (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))
19073 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))) == TYPE_DECL
19074 && DECL_NAME (decl) == DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))))
19075 /* Also ignore the artificial member typedef for the class name. */
19076 return 1;
19078 return 0;
19081 /* Returns the DIE for a context. */
19083 static inline dw_die_ref
19084 get_context_die (tree context)
19086 if (context)
19088 /* Find die that represents this context. */
19089 if (TYPE_P (context))
19090 return force_type_die (context);
19091 else
19092 return force_decl_die (context);
19094 return comp_unit_die;
19097 /* Returns the DIE for decl. A DIE will always be returned. */
19099 static dw_die_ref
19100 force_decl_die (tree decl)
19102 dw_die_ref decl_die;
19103 unsigned saved_external_flag;
19104 tree save_fn = NULL_TREE;
19105 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
19106 if (!decl_die)
19108 dw_die_ref context_die = get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
19110 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
19111 if (decl_die)
19112 return decl_die;
19114 switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
19116 case FUNCTION_DECL:
19117 /* Clear current_function_decl, so that gen_subprogram_die thinks
19118 that this is a declaration. At this point, we just want to force
19119 declaration die. */
19120 save_fn = current_function_decl;
19121 current_function_decl = NULL_TREE;
19122 gen_subprogram_die (decl, context_die);
19123 current_function_decl = save_fn;
19124 break;
19126 case VAR_DECL:
19127 /* Set external flag to force declaration die. Restore it after
19128 gen_decl_die() call. */
19129 saved_external_flag = DECL_EXTERNAL (decl);
19130 DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) = 1;
19131 gen_decl_die (decl, NULL, context_die);
19132 DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) = saved_external_flag;
19133 break;
19135 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
19136 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
19137 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
19138 else
19139 /* DWARF2 has neither DW_TAG_module, nor DW_TAG_namespace. */
19140 decl_die = comp_unit_die;
19141 break;
19143 default:
19144 gcc_unreachable ();
19147 /* We should be able to find the DIE now. */
19148 if (!decl_die)
19149 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
19150 gcc_assert (decl_die);
19153 return decl_die;
19156 /* Returns the DIE for TYPE, that must not be a base type. A DIE is
19157 always returned. */
19159 static dw_die_ref
19160 force_type_die (tree type)
19162 dw_die_ref type_die;
19164 type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
19165 if (!type_die)
19167 dw_die_ref context_die = get_context_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
19169 type_die = modified_type_die (type, TYPE_READONLY (type),
19170 TYPE_VOLATILE (type), context_die);
19171 gcc_assert (type_die);
19173 return type_die;
19176 /* Force out any required namespaces to be able to output DECL,
19177 and return the new context_die for it, if it's changed. */
19179 static dw_die_ref
19180 setup_namespace_context (tree thing, dw_die_ref context_die)
19182 tree context = (DECL_P (thing)
19183 ? DECL_CONTEXT (thing) : TYPE_CONTEXT (thing));
19184 if (context && TREE_CODE (context) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
19185 /* Force out the namespace. */
19186 context_die = force_decl_die (context);
19188 return context_die;
19191 /* Emit a declaration DIE for THING (which is either a DECL or a tagged
19192 type) within its namespace, if appropriate.
19194 For compatibility with older debuggers, namespace DIEs only contain
19195 declarations; all definitions are emitted at CU scope. */
19197 static dw_die_ref
19198 declare_in_namespace (tree thing, dw_die_ref context_die)
19200 dw_die_ref ns_context;
19202 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
19203 return context_die;
19205 /* If this decl is from an inlined function, then don't try to emit it in its
19206 namespace, as we will get confused. It would have already been emitted
19207 when the abstract instance of the inline function was emitted anyways. */
19208 if (DECL_P (thing) && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (thing))
19209 return context_die;
19211 ns_context = setup_namespace_context (thing, context_die);
19213 if (ns_context != context_die)
19215 if (is_fortran ())
19216 return ns_context;
19217 if (DECL_P (thing))
19218 gen_decl_die (thing, NULL, ns_context);
19219 else
19220 gen_type_die (thing, ns_context);
19222 return context_die;
19225 /* Generate a DIE for a namespace or namespace alias. */
19227 static void
19228 gen_namespace_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
19230 dw_die_ref namespace_die;
19232 /* Namespace aliases have a DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN of the namespace
19233 they are an alias of. */
19234 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == NULL)
19236 /* Output a real namespace or module. */
19237 context_die = setup_namespace_context (decl, comp_unit_die);
19238 namespace_die = new_die (is_fortran ()
19239 ? DW_TAG_module : DW_TAG_namespace,
19240 context_die, decl);
19241 /* For Fortran modules defined in different CU don't add src coords. */
19242 if (namespace_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_module && DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
19244 const char *name = dwarf2_name (decl, 0);
19245 if (name)
19246 add_name_attribute (namespace_die, name);
19248 else
19249 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (namespace_die, decl);
19250 if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
19251 add_AT_flag (namespace_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
19252 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, namespace_die);
19254 else
19256 /* Output a namespace alias. */
19258 /* Force out the namespace we are an alias of, if necessary. */
19259 dw_die_ref origin_die
19260 = force_decl_die (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl));
19262 if (DECL_CONTEXT (decl) == NULL_TREE
19263 || TREE_CODE (DECL_CONTEXT (decl)) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
19264 context_die = setup_namespace_context (decl, comp_unit_die);
19265 /* Now create the namespace alias DIE. */
19266 namespace_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_declaration, context_die, decl);
19267 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (namespace_die, decl);
19268 add_AT_die_ref (namespace_die, DW_AT_import, origin_die);
19269 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, namespace_die);
19273 /* Generate Dwarf debug information for a decl described by DECL. */
19275 static void
19276 gen_decl_die (tree decl, tree origin, dw_die_ref context_die)
19278 tree decl_or_origin = decl ? decl : origin;
19279 tree class_origin = NULL;
19281 if (DECL_P (decl_or_origin) && DECL_IGNORED_P (decl_or_origin))
19282 return;
19284 switch (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin))
19286 case ERROR_MARK:
19287 break;
19289 case CONST_DECL:
19290 if (!is_fortran ())
19292 /* The individual enumerators of an enum type get output when we output
19293 the Dwarf representation of the relevant enum type itself. */
19294 break;
19297 /* Emit its type. */
19298 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
19300 /* And its containing namespace. */
19301 context_die = declare_in_namespace (decl, context_die);
19303 gen_const_die (decl, context_die);
19304 break;
19306 case FUNCTION_DECL:
19307 /* Don't output any DIEs to represent mere function declarations,
19308 unless they are class members or explicit block externs. */
19309 if (DECL_INITIAL (decl_or_origin) == NULL_TREE
19310 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl_or_origin) == NULL_TREE
19311 && (current_function_decl == NULL_TREE
19312 || DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl_or_origin)))
19313 break;
19315 #if 0
19316 /* FIXME */
19317 /* This doesn't work because the C frontend sets DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN
19318 on local redeclarations of global functions. That seems broken. */
19319 if (current_function_decl != decl)
19320 /* This is only a declaration. */;
19321 #endif
19323 /* If we're emitting a clone, emit info for the abstract instance. */
19324 if (origin || DECL_ORIGIN (decl) != decl)
19325 dwarf2out_abstract_function (origin ? origin : DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl));
19327 /* If we're emitting an out-of-line copy of an inline function,
19328 emit info for the abstract instance and set up to refer to it. */
19329 else if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl)
19330 && ! DECL_ABSTRACT (decl)
19331 && ! class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die)
19332 /* dwarf2out_abstract_function won't emit a die if this is just
19333 a declaration. We must avoid setting DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN in
19334 that case, because that works only if we have a die. */
19335 && DECL_INITIAL (decl) != NULL_TREE)
19337 dwarf2out_abstract_function (decl);
19338 set_decl_origin_self (decl);
19341 /* Otherwise we're emitting the primary DIE for this decl. */
19342 else if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
19344 /* Before we describe the FUNCTION_DECL itself, make sure that we
19345 have described its return type. */
19346 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)), context_die);
19348 /* And its virtual context. */
19349 if (DECL_VINDEX (decl) != NULL_TREE)
19350 gen_type_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl), context_die);
19352 /* And its containing type. */
19353 if (!origin)
19354 origin = decl_class_context (decl);
19355 if (origin != NULL_TREE)
19356 gen_type_die_for_member (origin, decl, context_die);
19358 /* And its containing namespace. */
19359 context_die = declare_in_namespace (decl, context_die);
19362 /* Now output a DIE to represent the function itself. */
19363 if (decl)
19364 gen_subprogram_die (decl, context_die);
19365 break;
19367 case TYPE_DECL:
19368 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
19369 actual typedefs. */
19370 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
19371 break;
19373 /* In the special case of a TYPE_DECL node representing the declaration
19374 of some type tag, if the given TYPE_DECL is marked as having been
19375 instantiated from some other (original) TYPE_DECL node (e.g. one which
19376 was generated within the original definition of an inline function) we
19377 used to generate a special (abbreviated) DW_TAG_structure_type,
19378 DW_TAG_union_type, or DW_TAG_enumeration_type DIE here. But nothing
19379 should be actually referencing those DIEs, as variable DIEs with that
19380 type would be emitted already in the abstract origin, so it was always
19381 removed during unused type prunning. Don't add anything in this
19382 case. */
19383 if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl) && decl_ultimate_origin (decl) != NULL_TREE)
19384 break;
19386 if (is_redundant_typedef (decl))
19387 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
19388 else
19389 /* Output a DIE to represent the typedef itself. */
19390 gen_typedef_die (decl, context_die);
19391 break;
19393 case LABEL_DECL:
19394 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL)
19395 gen_label_die (decl, context_die);
19396 break;
19398 case VAR_DECL:
19399 case RESULT_DECL:
19400 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
19401 variable declarations or definitions. */
19402 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
19403 break;
19405 /* Output any DIEs that are needed to specify the type of this data
19406 object. */
19407 if (decl_by_reference_p (decl_or_origin))
19408 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin)), context_die);
19409 else
19410 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin), context_die);
19412 /* And its containing type. */
19413 class_origin = decl_class_context (decl_or_origin);
19414 if (class_origin != NULL_TREE)
19415 gen_type_die_for_member (class_origin, decl_or_origin, context_die);
19417 /* And its containing namespace. */
19418 context_die = declare_in_namespace (decl_or_origin, context_die);
19420 /* Now output the DIE to represent the data object itself. This gets
19421 complicated because of the possibility that the VAR_DECL really
19422 represents an inlined instance of a formal parameter for an inline
19423 function. */
19424 if (!origin)
19425 origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
19426 if (origin != NULL_TREE && TREE_CODE (origin) == PARM_DECL)
19427 gen_formal_parameter_die (decl, origin,
19428 true /* Emit name attribute. */,
19429 context_die);
19430 else
19431 gen_variable_die (decl, origin, context_die);
19432 break;
19434 case FIELD_DECL:
19435 /* Ignore the nameless fields that are used to skip bits but handle C++
19436 anonymous unions and structs. */
19437 if (DECL_NAME (decl) != NULL_TREE
19438 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == UNION_TYPE
19439 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == RECORD_TYPE)
19441 gen_type_die (member_declared_type (decl), context_die);
19442 gen_field_die (decl, context_die);
19444 break;
19446 case PARM_DECL:
19447 if (DECL_BY_REFERENCE (decl_or_origin))
19448 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin)), context_die);
19449 else
19450 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin), context_die);
19451 gen_formal_parameter_die (decl, origin,
19452 true /* Emit name attribute. */,
19453 context_die);
19454 break;
19456 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
19457 case IMPORTED_DECL:
19458 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
19459 gen_namespace_die (decl, context_die);
19460 break;
19462 default:
19463 /* Probably some frontend-internal decl. Assume we don't care. */
19464 gcc_assert ((int)TREE_CODE (decl) > NUM_TREE_CODES);
19465 break;
19469 /* Output debug information for global decl DECL. Called from toplev.c after
19470 compilation proper has finished. */
19472 static void
19473 dwarf2out_global_decl (tree decl)
19475 /* Output DWARF2 information for file-scope tentative data object
19476 declarations, file-scope (extern) function declarations (which
19477 had no corresponding body) and file-scope tagged type declarations
19478 and definitions which have not yet been forced out. */
19479 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != FUNCTION_DECL || !DECL_INITIAL (decl))
19480 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
19483 /* Output debug information for type decl DECL. Called from toplev.c
19484 and from language front ends (to record built-in types). */
19485 static void
19486 dwarf2out_type_decl (tree decl, int local)
19488 if (!local)
19489 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
19492 /* Output debug information for imported module or decl DECL.
19493 NAME is non-NULL name in the lexical block if the decl has been renamed.
19494 LEXICAL_BLOCK is the lexical block (which TREE_CODE is a BLOCK)
19495 that DECL belongs to.
19496 LEXICAL_BLOCK_DIE is the DIE of LEXICAL_BLOCK. */
19497 static void
19498 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (tree decl,
19499 tree name,
19500 tree lexical_block,
19501 dw_die_ref lexical_block_die)
19503 expanded_location xloc;
19504 dw_die_ref imported_die = NULL;
19505 dw_die_ref at_import_die;
19507 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == IMPORTED_DECL)
19509 xloc = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
19510 decl = IMPORTED_DECL_ASSOCIATED_DECL (decl);
19511 gcc_assert (decl);
19513 else
19514 xloc = expand_location (input_location);
19516 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == CONST_DECL)
19518 if (is_base_type (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
19519 at_import_die = base_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
19520 else
19521 at_import_die = force_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
19522 /* For namespace N { typedef void T; } using N::T; base_type_die
19523 returns NULL, but DW_TAG_imported_declaration requires
19524 the DW_AT_import tag. Force creation of DW_TAG_typedef. */
19525 if (!at_import_die)
19527 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL);
19528 gen_typedef_die (decl, get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl)));
19529 at_import_die = lookup_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
19530 gcc_assert (at_import_die);
19533 else
19535 at_import_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
19536 if (!at_import_die)
19538 /* If we're trying to avoid duplicate debug info, we may not have
19539 emitted the member decl for this field. Emit it now. */
19540 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL)
19542 tree type = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
19544 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)
19545 && TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
19546 && !should_emit_struct_debug (TYPE_CONTEXT (type),
19547 DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE))
19548 return;
19549 gen_type_die_for_member (type, decl,
19550 get_context_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)));
19552 at_import_die = force_decl_die (decl);
19556 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
19558 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
19559 imported_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_module,
19560 lexical_block_die,
19561 lexical_block);
19562 else
19563 return;
19565 else
19566 imported_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_declaration,
19567 lexical_block_die,
19568 lexical_block);
19570 add_AT_file (imported_die, DW_AT_decl_file, lookup_filename (xloc.file));
19571 add_AT_unsigned (imported_die, DW_AT_decl_line, xloc.line);
19572 if (name)
19573 add_AT_string (imported_die, DW_AT_name,
19574 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
19575 add_AT_die_ref (imported_die, DW_AT_import, at_import_die);
19578 /* Output debug information for imported module or decl DECL.
19579 NAME is non-NULL name in context if the decl has been renamed.
19580 CHILD is true if decl is one of the renamed decls as part of
19581 importing whole module. */
19583 static void
19584 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl (tree decl, tree name, tree context,
19585 bool child)
19587 /* dw_die_ref at_import_die; */
19588 dw_die_ref scope_die;
19590 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
19591 return;
19593 gcc_assert (decl);
19595 /* To emit DW_TAG_imported_module or DW_TAG_imported_decl, we need two DIEs.
19596 We need decl DIE for reference and scope die. First, get DIE for the decl
19597 itself. */
19599 /* Get the scope die for decl context. Use comp_unit_die for global module
19600 or decl. If die is not found for non globals, force new die. */
19601 if (context
19602 && TYPE_P (context)
19603 && !should_emit_struct_debug (context, DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE))
19604 return;
19606 if (!(dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
19607 return;
19609 scope_die = get_context_die (context);
19611 if (child)
19613 gcc_assert (scope_die->die_child);
19614 gcc_assert (scope_die->die_child->die_tag == DW_TAG_imported_module);
19615 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) != NAMESPACE_DECL);
19616 scope_die = scope_die->die_child;
19619 /* OK, now we have DIEs for decl as well as scope. Emit imported die. */
19620 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (decl, name, context, scope_die);
19624 /* Write the debugging output for DECL. */
19626 void
19627 dwarf2out_decl (tree decl)
19629 dw_die_ref context_die = comp_unit_die;
19631 switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
19633 case ERROR_MARK:
19634 return;
19636 case FUNCTION_DECL:
19637 /* What we would really like to do here is to filter out all mere
19638 file-scope declarations of file-scope functions which are never
19639 referenced later within this translation unit (and keep all of ones
19640 that *are* referenced later on) but we aren't clairvoyant, so we have
19641 no idea which functions will be referenced in the future (i.e. later
19642 on within the current translation unit). So here we just ignore all
19643 file-scope function declarations which are not also definitions. If
19644 and when the debugger needs to know something about these functions,
19645 it will have to hunt around and find the DWARF information associated
19646 with the definition of the function.
19648 We can't just check DECL_EXTERNAL to find out which FUNCTION_DECL
19649 nodes represent definitions and which ones represent mere
19650 declarations. We have to check DECL_INITIAL instead. That's because
19651 the C front-end supports some weird semantics for "extern inline"
19652 function definitions. These can get inlined within the current
19653 translation unit (and thus, we need to generate Dwarf info for their
19654 abstract instances so that the Dwarf info for the concrete inlined
19655 instances can have something to refer to) but the compiler never
19656 generates any out-of-lines instances of such things (despite the fact
19657 that they *are* definitions).
19659 The important point is that the C front-end marks these "extern
19660 inline" functions as DECL_EXTERNAL, but we need to generate DWARF for
19661 them anyway. Note that the C++ front-end also plays some similar games
19662 for inline function definitions appearing within include files which
19663 also contain `#pragma interface' pragmas. */
19664 if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE)
19665 return;
19667 /* If we're a nested function, initially use a parent of NULL; if we're
19668 a plain function, this will be fixed up in decls_for_scope. If
19669 we're a method, it will be ignored, since we already have a DIE. */
19670 if (decl_function_context (decl)
19671 /* But if we're in terse mode, we don't care about scope. */
19672 && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
19673 context_die = NULL;
19674 break;
19676 case VAR_DECL:
19677 /* Ignore this VAR_DECL if it refers to a file-scope extern data object
19678 declaration and if the declaration was never even referenced from
19679 within this entire compilation unit. We suppress these DIEs in
19680 order to save space in the .debug section (by eliminating entries
19681 which are probably useless). Note that we must not suppress
19682 block-local extern declarations (whether used or not) because that
19683 would screw-up the debugger's name lookup mechanism and cause it to
19684 miss things which really ought to be in scope at a given point. */
19685 if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) && !TREE_USED (decl))
19686 return;
19688 /* For local statics lookup proper context die. */
19689 if (TREE_STATIC (decl) && decl_function_context (decl))
19690 context_die = lookup_decl_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
19692 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
19693 variable declarations or definitions. */
19694 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
19695 return;
19696 break;
19698 case CONST_DECL:
19699 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
19700 return;
19701 if (!is_fortran ())
19702 return;
19703 if (TREE_STATIC (decl) && decl_function_context (decl))
19704 context_die = lookup_decl_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
19705 break;
19707 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
19708 case IMPORTED_DECL:
19709 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
19710 return;
19711 if (lookup_decl_die (decl) != NULL)
19712 return;
19713 break;
19715 case TYPE_DECL:
19716 /* Don't emit stubs for types unless they are needed by other DIEs. */
19717 if (TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (decl))
19718 return;
19720 /* Don't bother trying to generate any DIEs to represent any of the
19721 normal built-in types for the language we are compiling. */
19722 if (DECL_IS_BUILTIN (decl))
19724 /* OK, we need to generate one for `bool' so GDB knows what type
19725 comparisons have. */
19726 if (is_cxx ()
19727 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == BOOLEAN_TYPE
19728 && ! DECL_IGNORED_P (decl))
19729 modified_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), 0, 0, NULL);
19731 return;
19734 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs for types. */
19735 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
19736 return;
19738 /* If we're a function-scope tag, initially use a parent of NULL;
19739 this will be fixed up in decls_for_scope. */
19740 if (decl_function_context (decl))
19741 context_die = NULL;
19743 break;
19745 default:
19746 return;
19749 gen_decl_die (decl, NULL, context_die);
19752 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of the generated code for
19753 a lexical block. */
19755 static void
19756 dwarf2out_begin_block (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
19757 unsigned int blocknum)
19759 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
19760 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, blocknum);
19763 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the end of the generated code for a
19764 lexical block. */
19766 static void
19767 dwarf2out_end_block (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, unsigned int blocknum)
19769 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
19770 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, BLOCK_END_LABEL, blocknum);
19773 /* Returns nonzero if it is appropriate not to emit any debugging
19774 information for BLOCK, because it doesn't contain any instructions.
19776 Don't allow this for blocks with nested functions or local classes
19777 as we would end up with orphans, and in the presence of scheduling
19778 we may end up calling them anyway. */
19780 static bool
19781 dwarf2out_ignore_block (const_tree block)
19783 tree decl;
19784 unsigned int i;
19786 for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (block); decl; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
19787 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL
19788 || (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl)))
19789 return 0;
19790 for (i = 0; i < BLOCK_NUM_NONLOCALIZED_VARS (block); i++)
19792 decl = BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VAR (block, i);
19793 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL
19794 || (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl)))
19795 return 0;
19798 return 1;
19801 /* Hash table routines for file_hash. */
19803 static int
19804 file_table_eq (const void *p1_p, const void *p2_p)
19806 const struct dwarf_file_data *const p1 =
19807 (const struct dwarf_file_data *) p1_p;
19808 const char *const p2 = (const char *) p2_p;
19809 return strcmp (p1->filename, p2) == 0;
19812 static hashval_t
19813 file_table_hash (const void *p_p)
19815 const struct dwarf_file_data *const p = (const struct dwarf_file_data *) p_p;
19816 return htab_hash_string (p->filename);
19819 /* Lookup FILE_NAME (in the list of filenames that we know about here in
19820 dwarf2out.c) and return its "index". The index of each (known) filename is
19821 just a unique number which is associated with only that one filename. We
19822 need such numbers for the sake of generating labels (in the .debug_sfnames
19823 section) and references to those files numbers (in the .debug_srcinfo
19824 and.debug_macinfo sections). If the filename given as an argument is not
19825 found in our current list, add it to the list and assign it the next
19826 available unique index number. In order to speed up searches, we remember
19827 the index of the filename was looked up last. This handles the majority of
19828 all searches. */
19830 static struct dwarf_file_data *
19831 lookup_filename (const char *file_name)
19833 void ** slot;
19834 struct dwarf_file_data * created;
19836 /* Check to see if the file name that was searched on the previous
19837 call matches this file name. If so, return the index. */
19838 if (file_table_last_lookup
19839 && (file_name == file_table_last_lookup->filename
19840 || strcmp (file_table_last_lookup->filename, file_name) == 0))
19841 return file_table_last_lookup;
19843 /* Didn't match the previous lookup, search the table. */
19844 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (file_table, file_name,
19845 htab_hash_string (file_name), INSERT);
19846 if (*slot)
19847 return (struct dwarf_file_data *) *slot;
19849 created = GGC_NEW (struct dwarf_file_data);
19850 created->filename = file_name;
19851 created->emitted_number = 0;
19852 *slot = created;
19853 return created;
19856 /* If the assembler will construct the file table, then translate the compiler
19857 internal file table number into the assembler file table number, and emit
19858 a .file directive if we haven't already emitted one yet. The file table
19859 numbers are different because we prune debug info for unused variables and
19860 types, which may include filenames. */
19862 static int
19863 maybe_emit_file (struct dwarf_file_data * fd)
19865 if (! fd->emitted_number)
19867 if (last_emitted_file)
19868 fd->emitted_number = last_emitted_file->emitted_number + 1;
19869 else
19870 fd->emitted_number = 1;
19871 last_emitted_file = fd;
19873 if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
19875 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.file %u ", fd->emitted_number);
19876 output_quoted_string (asm_out_file,
19877 remap_debug_filename (fd->filename));
19878 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
19882 return fd->emitted_number;
19885 /* Schedule generation of a DW_AT_const_value attribute to DIE.
19886 That generation should happen after function debug info has been
19887 generated. The value of the attribute is the constant value of ARG. */
19889 static void
19890 append_entry_to_tmpl_value_parm_die_table (dw_die_ref die, tree arg)
19892 die_arg_entry entry;
19894 if (!die || !arg)
19895 return;
19897 if (!tmpl_value_parm_die_table)
19898 tmpl_value_parm_die_table
19899 = VEC_alloc (die_arg_entry, gc, 32);
19901 entry.die = die;
19902 entry.arg = arg;
19903 VEC_safe_push (die_arg_entry, gc,
19904 tmpl_value_parm_die_table,
19905 &entry);
19908 /* Add a DW_AT_const_value attribute to DIEs that were scheduled
19909 by append_entry_to_tmpl_value_parm_die_table. This function must
19910 be called after function DIEs have been generated. */
19912 static void
19913 gen_remaining_tmpl_value_param_die_attribute (void)
19915 if (tmpl_value_parm_die_table)
19917 unsigned i;
19918 die_arg_entry *e;
19920 for (i = 0;
19921 VEC_iterate (die_arg_entry, tmpl_value_parm_die_table, i, e);
19922 i++)
19923 tree_add_const_value_attribute (e->die, e->arg);
19928 /* Replace DW_AT_name for the decl with name. */
19930 static void
19931 dwarf2out_set_name (tree decl, tree name)
19933 dw_die_ref die;
19934 dw_attr_ref attr;
19935 const char *dname;
19937 die = TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (decl);
19938 if (!die)
19939 return;
19941 dname = dwarf2_name (name, 0);
19942 if (!dname)
19943 return;
19945 attr = get_AT (die, DW_AT_name);
19946 if (attr)
19948 struct indirect_string_node *node;
19950 node = find_AT_string (dname);
19951 /* replace the string. */
19952 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_str = node;
19955 else
19956 add_name_attribute (die, dname);
19959 /* Called by the final INSN scan whenever we see a direct function call.
19960 Make an entry into the direct call table, recording the point of call
19961 and a reference to the target function's debug entry. */
19963 static void
19964 dwarf2out_direct_call (tree targ)
19966 dcall_entry e;
19967 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (targ);
19969 /* If this is a clone, use the abstract origin as the target. */
19970 if (origin)
19971 targ = origin;
19973 e.poc_label_num = poc_label_num++;
19974 e.poc_decl = current_function_decl;
19975 e.targ_die = force_decl_die (targ);
19976 VEC_safe_push (dcall_entry, gc, dcall_table, &e);
19978 /* Drop a label at the return point to mark the point of call. */
19979 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, "LPOC", e.poc_label_num);
19982 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a struct vcall_insn). */
19984 static hashval_t
19985 vcall_insn_table_hash (const void *x)
19987 return (hashval_t) ((const struct vcall_insn *) x)->insn_uid;
19990 /* Return nonzero if insn_uid of struct vcall_insn *X is the same as
19991 insnd_uid of *Y. */
19993 static int
19994 vcall_insn_table_eq (const void *x, const void *y)
19996 return (((const struct vcall_insn *) x)->insn_uid
19997 == ((const struct vcall_insn *) y)->insn_uid);
20000 /* Associate VTABLE_SLOT with INSN_UID in the VCALL_INSN_TABLE. */
20002 static void
20003 store_vcall_insn (unsigned int vtable_slot, int insn_uid)
20005 struct vcall_insn *item = GGC_NEW (struct vcall_insn);
20006 struct vcall_insn **slot;
20008 gcc_assert (item);
20009 item->insn_uid = insn_uid;
20010 item->vtable_slot = vtable_slot;
20011 slot = (struct vcall_insn **)
20012 htab_find_slot_with_hash (vcall_insn_table, &item,
20013 (hashval_t) insn_uid, INSERT);
20014 *slot = item;
20017 /* Return the VTABLE_SLOT associated with INSN_UID. */
20019 static unsigned int
20020 lookup_vcall_insn (unsigned int insn_uid)
20022 struct vcall_insn item;
20023 struct vcall_insn *p;
20025 item.insn_uid = insn_uid;
20026 item.vtable_slot = 0;
20027 p = (struct vcall_insn *) htab_find_with_hash (vcall_insn_table,
20028 (void *) &item,
20029 (hashval_t) insn_uid);
20030 if (p == NULL)
20031 return (unsigned int) -1;
20032 return p->vtable_slot;
20036 /* Called when lowering indirect calls to RTL. We make a note of INSN_UID
20037 and the OBJ_TYPE_REF_TOKEN from ADDR. For C++ virtual calls, the token
20038 is the vtable slot index that we will need to put in the virtual call
20039 table later. */
20041 static void
20042 dwarf2out_virtual_call_token (tree addr, int insn_uid)
20044 if (is_cxx() && TREE_CODE (addr) == OBJ_TYPE_REF)
20046 tree token = OBJ_TYPE_REF_TOKEN (addr);
20047 if (TREE_CODE (token) == INTEGER_CST)
20048 store_vcall_insn (TREE_INT_CST_LOW (token), insn_uid);
20052 /* Called when scheduling RTL, when a CALL_INSN is split. Copies the
20053 OBJ_TYPE_REF_TOKEN previously associated with OLD_INSN and associates it
20054 with NEW_INSN. */
20056 static void
20057 dwarf2out_copy_call_info (rtx old_insn, rtx new_insn)
20059 unsigned int vtable_slot = lookup_vcall_insn (INSN_UID (old_insn));
20061 if (vtable_slot != (unsigned int) -1)
20062 store_vcall_insn (vtable_slot, INSN_UID (new_insn));
20065 /* Called by the final INSN scan whenever we see a virtual function call.
20066 Make an entry into the virtual call table, recording the point of call
20067 and the slot index of the vtable entry used to call the virtual member
20068 function. The slot index was associated with the INSN_UID during the
20069 lowering to RTL. */
20071 static void
20072 dwarf2out_virtual_call (int insn_uid)
20074 unsigned int vtable_slot = lookup_vcall_insn (insn_uid);
20075 vcall_entry e;
20077 if (vtable_slot == (unsigned int) -1)
20078 return;
20080 e.poc_label_num = poc_label_num++;
20081 e.vtable_slot = vtable_slot;
20082 VEC_safe_push (vcall_entry, gc, vcall_table, &e);
20084 /* Drop a label at the return point to mark the point of call. */
20085 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, "LPOC", e.poc_label_num);
20088 /* Called by the final INSN scan whenever we see a var location. We
20089 use it to drop labels in the right places, and throw the location in
20090 our lookup table. */
20092 static void
20093 dwarf2out_var_location (rtx loc_note)
20095 char loclabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES + 2];
20096 struct var_loc_node *newloc;
20097 rtx next_real;
20098 static const char *last_label;
20099 static const char *last_postcall_label;
20100 static bool last_in_cold_section_p;
20101 tree decl;
20103 if (!DECL_P (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (loc_note)))
20104 return;
20106 next_real = next_real_insn (loc_note);
20107 /* If there are no instructions which would be affected by this note,
20108 don't do anything. */
20109 if (next_real == NULL_RTX)
20110 return;
20112 newloc = GGC_CNEW (struct var_loc_node);
20113 /* If there were no real insns between note we processed last time
20114 and this note, use the label we emitted last time. */
20115 if (last_var_location_insn == NULL_RTX
20116 || last_var_location_insn != next_real
20117 || last_in_cold_section_p != in_cold_section_p)
20119 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loclabel, "LVL", loclabel_num);
20120 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, "LVL", loclabel_num);
20121 loclabel_num++;
20122 last_label = ggc_strdup (loclabel);
20123 last_postcall_label = NULL;
20125 newloc->var_loc_note = loc_note;
20126 newloc->next = NULL;
20128 if (!NOTE_DURING_CALL_P (loc_note))
20129 newloc->label = last_label;
20130 else
20132 if (!last_postcall_label)
20134 sprintf (loclabel, "%s-1", last_label);
20135 last_postcall_label = ggc_strdup (loclabel);
20137 newloc->label = last_postcall_label;
20140 if (cfun && in_cold_section_p)
20141 newloc->section_label = crtl->subsections.cold_section_label;
20142 else
20143 newloc->section_label = text_section_label;
20145 last_var_location_insn = next_real;
20146 last_in_cold_section_p = in_cold_section_p;
20147 decl = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (loc_note);
20148 add_var_loc_to_decl (decl, newloc);
20151 /* We need to reset the locations at the beginning of each
20152 function. We can't do this in the end_function hook, because the
20153 declarations that use the locations won't have been output when
20154 that hook is called. Also compute have_multiple_function_sections here. */
20156 static void
20157 dwarf2out_begin_function (tree fun)
20159 htab_empty (decl_loc_table);
20161 if (function_section (fun) != text_section)
20162 have_multiple_function_sections = true;
20164 dwarf2out_note_section_used ();
20167 /* Output a label to mark the beginning of a source code line entry
20168 and record information relating to this source line, in
20169 'line_info_table' for later output of the .debug_line section. */
20171 static void
20172 dwarf2out_source_line (unsigned int line, const char *filename,
20173 int discriminator, bool is_stmt)
20175 static bool last_is_stmt = true;
20177 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL
20178 && line != 0)
20180 int file_num = maybe_emit_file (lookup_filename (filename));
20182 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
20184 /* If requested, emit something human-readable. */
20185 if (flag_debug_asm)
20186 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t%s %s:%d\n", ASM_COMMENT_START,
20187 filename, line);
20189 if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
20191 /* Emit the .loc directive understood by GNU as. */
20192 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.loc %d %d 0", file_num, line);
20193 if (is_stmt != last_is_stmt)
20195 fprintf (asm_out_file, " is_stmt %d", is_stmt ? 1 : 0);
20196 last_is_stmt = is_stmt;
20198 if (SUPPORTS_DISCRIMINATOR && discriminator != 0)
20199 fprintf (asm_out_file, " discriminator %d", discriminator);
20200 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
20202 /* Indicate that line number info exists. */
20203 line_info_table_in_use++;
20205 else if (function_section (current_function_decl) != text_section)
20207 dw_separate_line_info_ref line_info;
20208 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file,
20209 SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL,
20210 separate_line_info_table_in_use);
20212 /* Expand the line info table if necessary. */
20213 if (separate_line_info_table_in_use
20214 == separate_line_info_table_allocated)
20216 separate_line_info_table_allocated += LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT;
20217 separate_line_info_table
20218 = GGC_RESIZEVEC (dw_separate_line_info_entry,
20219 separate_line_info_table,
20220 separate_line_info_table_allocated);
20221 memset (separate_line_info_table
20222 + separate_line_info_table_in_use,
20224 (LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT
20225 * sizeof (dw_separate_line_info_entry)));
20228 /* Add the new entry at the end of the line_info_table. */
20229 line_info
20230 = &separate_line_info_table[separate_line_info_table_in_use++];
20231 line_info->dw_file_num = file_num;
20232 line_info->dw_line_num = line;
20233 line_info->function = current_function_funcdef_no;
20235 else
20237 dw_line_info_ref line_info;
20239 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, LINE_CODE_LABEL,
20240 line_info_table_in_use);
20242 /* Expand the line info table if necessary. */
20243 if (line_info_table_in_use == line_info_table_allocated)
20245 line_info_table_allocated += LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT;
20246 line_info_table
20247 = GGC_RESIZEVEC (dw_line_info_entry, line_info_table,
20248 line_info_table_allocated);
20249 memset (line_info_table + line_info_table_in_use, 0,
20250 LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_line_info_entry));
20253 /* Add the new entry at the end of the line_info_table. */
20254 line_info = &line_info_table[line_info_table_in_use++];
20255 line_info->dw_file_num = file_num;
20256 line_info->dw_line_num = line;
20261 /* Record the beginning of a new source file. */
20263 static void
20264 dwarf2out_start_source_file (unsigned int lineno, const char *filename)
20266 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups && dwarf_version < 4)
20268 /* Record the beginning of the file for break_out_includes. */
20269 dw_die_ref bincl_die;
20271 bincl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL, comp_unit_die, NULL);
20272 add_AT_string (bincl_die, DW_AT_name, remap_debug_filename (filename));
20275 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
20277 int file_num = maybe_emit_file (lookup_filename (filename));
20279 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
20280 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_start_file, "Start new file");
20281 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lineno, "Included from line number %d",
20282 lineno);
20284 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (file_num, "file %s", filename);
20288 /* Record the end of a source file. */
20290 static void
20291 dwarf2out_end_source_file (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
20293 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups && dwarf_version < 4)
20294 /* Record the end of the file for break_out_includes. */
20295 new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL, comp_unit_die, NULL);
20297 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
20299 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
20300 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_end_file, "End file");
20304 /* Called from debug_define in toplev.c. The `buffer' parameter contains
20305 the tail part of the directive line, i.e. the part which is past the
20306 initial whitespace, #, whitespace, directive-name, whitespace part. */
20308 static void
20309 dwarf2out_define (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
20310 const char *buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
20312 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
20314 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
20315 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_define, "Define macro");
20316 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lineno, "At line number %d", lineno);
20317 dw2_asm_output_nstring (buffer, -1, "The macro");
20321 /* Called from debug_undef in toplev.c. The `buffer' parameter contains
20322 the tail part of the directive line, i.e. the part which is past the
20323 initial whitespace, #, whitespace, directive-name, whitespace part. */
20325 static void
20326 dwarf2out_undef (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
20327 const char *buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
20329 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
20331 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
20332 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_undef, "Undefine macro");
20333 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lineno, "At line number %d", lineno);
20334 dw2_asm_output_nstring (buffer, -1, "The macro");
20338 /* Set up for Dwarf output at the start of compilation. */
20340 static void
20341 dwarf2out_init (const char *filename ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
20343 /* Allocate the file_table. */
20344 file_table = htab_create_ggc (50, file_table_hash,
20345 file_table_eq, NULL);
20347 /* Allocate the decl_die_table. */
20348 decl_die_table = htab_create_ggc (10, decl_die_table_hash,
20349 decl_die_table_eq, NULL);
20351 /* Allocate the decl_loc_table. */
20352 decl_loc_table = htab_create_ggc (10, decl_loc_table_hash,
20353 decl_loc_table_eq, NULL);
20355 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the decl_scope_table. */
20356 decl_scope_table = VEC_alloc (tree, gc, 256);
20358 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the abbrev_die_table. */
20359 abbrev_die_table = GGC_CNEWVEC (dw_die_ref, ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT);
20360 abbrev_die_table_allocated = ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
20361 /* Zero-th entry is allocated, but unused. */
20362 abbrev_die_table_in_use = 1;
20364 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the line_info_table. */
20365 line_info_table = GGC_CNEWVEC (dw_line_info_entry, LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT);
20366 line_info_table_allocated = LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT;
20368 /* Zero-th entry is allocated, but unused. */
20369 line_info_table_in_use = 1;
20371 /* Allocate the pubtypes and pubnames vectors. */
20372 pubname_table = VEC_alloc (pubname_entry, gc, 32);
20373 pubtype_table = VEC_alloc (pubname_entry, gc, 32);
20375 /* Allocate the table that maps insn UIDs to vtable slot indexes. */
20376 vcall_insn_table = htab_create_ggc (10, vcall_insn_table_hash,
20377 vcall_insn_table_eq, NULL);
20379 /* Generate the initial DIE for the .debug section. Note that the (string)
20380 value given in the DW_AT_name attribute of the DW_TAG_compile_unit DIE
20381 will (typically) be a relative pathname and that this pathname should be
20382 taken as being relative to the directory from which the compiler was
20383 invoked when the given (base) source file was compiled. We will fill
20384 in this value in dwarf2out_finish. */
20385 comp_unit_die = gen_compile_unit_die (NULL);
20387 incomplete_types = VEC_alloc (tree, gc, 64);
20389 used_rtx_array = VEC_alloc (rtx, gc, 32);
20391 debug_info_section = get_section (DEBUG_INFO_SECTION,
20392 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
20393 debug_abbrev_section = get_section (DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION,
20394 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
20395 debug_aranges_section = get_section (DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION,
20396 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
20397 debug_macinfo_section = get_section (DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION,
20398 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
20399 debug_line_section = get_section (DEBUG_LINE_SECTION,
20400 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
20401 debug_loc_section = get_section (DEBUG_LOC_SECTION,
20402 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
20403 debug_pubnames_section = get_section (DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION,
20404 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
20405 debug_pubtypes_section = get_section (DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION,
20406 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
20407 debug_dcall_section = get_section (DEBUG_DCALL_SECTION,
20408 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
20409 debug_vcall_section = get_section (DEBUG_VCALL_SECTION,
20410 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
20411 debug_str_section = get_section (DEBUG_STR_SECTION,
20412 DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS, NULL);
20413 debug_ranges_section = get_section (DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION,
20414 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
20415 debug_frame_section = get_section (DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION,
20416 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
20418 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (text_end_label, TEXT_END_LABEL, 0);
20419 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (abbrev_section_label,
20420 DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
20421 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (text_section_label, TEXT_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
20422 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (cold_text_section_label,
20423 COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
20424 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (cold_end_label, COLD_END_LABEL, 0);
20426 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_info_section_label,
20427 DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
20428 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_line_section_label,
20429 DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
20430 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (ranges_section_label,
20431 DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
20432 switch_to_section (debug_abbrev_section);
20433 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, abbrev_section_label);
20434 switch_to_section (debug_info_section);
20435 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_info_section_label);
20436 switch_to_section (debug_line_section);
20437 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_line_section_label);
20439 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
20441 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
20442 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (macinfo_section_label,
20443 DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
20444 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, macinfo_section_label);
20447 switch_to_section (text_section);
20448 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, text_section_label);
20449 if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
20451 cold_text_section = unlikely_text_section ();
20452 switch_to_section (cold_text_section);
20453 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, cold_text_section_label);
20458 /* Called before cgraph_optimize starts outputtting functions, variables
20459 and toplevel asms into assembly. */
20461 static void
20462 dwarf2out_assembly_start (void)
20464 if (HAVE_GAS_CFI_SECTIONS_DIRECTIVE && dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
20466 #ifndef TARGET_UNWIND_INFO
20467 if (USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS || (!flag_unwind_tables && !flag_exceptions))
20468 #endif
20469 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_sections\t.debug_frame\n");
20473 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish called through
20474 htab_traverse. Emit one queued .debug_str string. */
20476 static int
20477 output_indirect_string (void **h, void *v ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
20479 struct indirect_string_node *node = (struct indirect_string_node *) *h;
20481 if (node->label && node->refcount)
20483 switch_to_section (debug_str_section);
20484 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, node->label);
20485 assemble_string (node->str, strlen (node->str) + 1);
20488 return 1;
20491 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
20492 /* Verify that all marks are clear. */
20494 static void
20495 verify_marks_clear (dw_die_ref die)
20497 dw_die_ref c;
20499 gcc_assert (! die->die_mark);
20500 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, verify_marks_clear (c));
20502 #endif /* ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING */
20504 /* Clear the marks for a die and its children.
20505 Be cool if the mark isn't set. */
20507 static void
20508 prune_unmark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
20510 dw_die_ref c;
20512 if (die->die_mark)
20513 die->die_mark = 0;
20514 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unmark_dies (c));
20517 /* Given DIE that we're marking as used, find any other dies
20518 it references as attributes and mark them as used. */
20520 static void
20521 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (dw_die_ref die)
20523 dw_attr_ref a;
20524 unsigned ix;
20526 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
20528 if (a->dw_attr_val.val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref)
20530 /* A reference to another DIE.
20531 Make sure that it will get emitted.
20532 If it was broken out into a comdat group, don't follow it. */
20533 if (dwarf_version < 4
20534 || a->dw_attr == DW_AT_specification
20535 || a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die->die_id.die_type_node == NULL)
20536 prune_unused_types_mark (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die, 1);
20538 /* Set the string's refcount to 0 so that prune_unused_types_mark
20539 accounts properly for it. */
20540 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
20541 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount = 0;
20546 /* Mark DIE as being used. If DOKIDS is true, then walk down
20547 to DIE's children. */
20549 static void
20550 prune_unused_types_mark (dw_die_ref die, int dokids)
20552 dw_die_ref c;
20554 if (die->die_mark == 0)
20556 /* We haven't done this node yet. Mark it as used. */
20557 die->die_mark = 1;
20559 /* We also have to mark its parents as used.
20560 (But we don't want to mark our parents' kids due to this.) */
20561 if (die->die_parent)
20562 prune_unused_types_mark (die->die_parent, 0);
20564 /* Mark any referenced nodes. */
20565 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (die);
20567 /* If this node is a specification,
20568 also mark the definition, if it exists. */
20569 if (get_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_declaration) && die->die_definition)
20570 prune_unused_types_mark (die->die_definition, 1);
20573 if (dokids && die->die_mark != 2)
20575 /* We need to walk the children, but haven't done so yet.
20576 Remember that we've walked the kids. */
20577 die->die_mark = 2;
20579 /* If this is an array type, we need to make sure our
20580 kids get marked, even if they're types. If we're
20581 breaking out types into comdat sections, do this
20582 for all type definitions. */
20583 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_array_type
20584 || (dwarf_version >= 4
20585 && is_type_die (die) && ! is_declaration_die (die)))
20586 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_mark (c, 1));
20587 else
20588 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_walk (c));
20592 /* For local classes, look if any static member functions were emitted
20593 and if so, mark them. */
20595 static void
20596 prune_unused_types_walk_local_classes (dw_die_ref die)
20598 dw_die_ref c;
20600 if (die->die_mark == 2)
20601 return;
20603 switch (die->die_tag)
20605 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
20606 case DW_TAG_union_type:
20607 case DW_TAG_class_type:
20608 break;
20610 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
20611 if (!get_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_declaration)
20612 || die->die_definition != NULL)
20613 prune_unused_types_mark (die, 1);
20614 return;
20616 default:
20617 return;
20620 /* Mark children. */
20621 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_walk_local_classes (c));
20624 /* Walk the tree DIE and mark types that we actually use. */
20626 static void
20627 prune_unused_types_walk (dw_die_ref die)
20629 dw_die_ref c;
20631 /* Don't do anything if this node is already marked and
20632 children have been marked as well. */
20633 if (die->die_mark == 2)
20634 return;
20636 switch (die->die_tag)
20638 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
20639 case DW_TAG_union_type:
20640 case DW_TAG_class_type:
20641 if (die->die_perennial_p)
20642 break;
20644 for (c = die->die_parent; c; c = c->die_parent)
20645 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
20646 break;
20648 /* Finding used static member functions inside of classes
20649 is needed just for local classes, because for other classes
20650 static member function DIEs with DW_AT_specification
20651 are emitted outside of the DW_TAG_*_type. If we ever change
20652 it, we'd need to call this even for non-local classes. */
20653 if (c)
20654 prune_unused_types_walk_local_classes (die);
20656 /* It's a type node --- don't mark it. */
20657 return;
20659 case DW_TAG_const_type:
20660 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
20661 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
20662 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
20663 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
20664 case DW_TAG_typedef:
20665 case DW_TAG_array_type:
20666 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
20667 case DW_TAG_friend:
20668 case DW_TAG_variant_part:
20669 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
20670 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
20671 case DW_TAG_string_type:
20672 case DW_TAG_set_type:
20673 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
20674 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
20675 case DW_TAG_file_type:
20676 if (die->die_perennial_p)
20677 break;
20679 /* It's a type node --- don't mark it. */
20680 return;
20682 default:
20683 /* Mark everything else. */
20684 break;
20687 if (die->die_mark == 0)
20689 die->die_mark = 1;
20691 /* Now, mark any dies referenced from here. */
20692 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (die);
20695 die->die_mark = 2;
20697 /* Mark children. */
20698 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_walk (c));
20701 /* Increment the string counts on strings referred to from DIE's
20702 attributes. */
20704 static void
20705 prune_unused_types_update_strings (dw_die_ref die)
20707 dw_attr_ref a;
20708 unsigned ix;
20710 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
20711 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
20713 struct indirect_string_node *s = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str;
20714 s->refcount++;
20715 /* Avoid unnecessarily putting strings that are used less than
20716 twice in the hash table. */
20717 if (s->refcount
20718 == ((DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS & SECTION_MERGE) ? 1 : 2))
20720 void ** slot;
20721 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (debug_str_hash, s->str,
20722 htab_hash_string (s->str),
20723 INSERT);
20724 gcc_assert (*slot == NULL);
20725 *slot = s;
20730 /* Remove from the tree DIE any dies that aren't marked. */
20732 static void
20733 prune_unused_types_prune (dw_die_ref die)
20735 dw_die_ref c;
20737 gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
20738 prune_unused_types_update_strings (die);
20740 if (! die->die_child)
20741 return;
20743 c = die->die_child;
20744 do {
20745 dw_die_ref prev = c;
20746 for (c = c->die_sib; ! c->die_mark; c = c->die_sib)
20747 if (c == die->die_child)
20749 /* No marked children between 'prev' and the end of the list. */
20750 if (prev == c)
20751 /* No marked children at all. */
20752 die->die_child = NULL;
20753 else
20755 prev->die_sib = c->die_sib;
20756 die->die_child = prev;
20758 return;
20761 if (c != prev->die_sib)
20762 prev->die_sib = c;
20763 prune_unused_types_prune (c);
20764 } while (c != die->die_child);
20767 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish called through
20768 htab_traverse. Clear .debug_str strings that we haven't already
20769 decided to emit. */
20771 static int
20772 prune_indirect_string (void **h, void *v ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
20774 struct indirect_string_node *node = (struct indirect_string_node *) *h;
20776 if (!node->label || !node->refcount)
20777 htab_clear_slot (debug_str_hash, h);
20779 return 1;
20782 /* Remove dies representing declarations that we never use. */
20784 static void
20785 prune_unused_types (void)
20787 unsigned int i;
20788 limbo_die_node *node;
20789 comdat_type_node *ctnode;
20790 pubname_ref pub;
20791 dcall_entry *dcall;
20793 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
20794 /* All the marks should already be clear. */
20795 verify_marks_clear (comp_unit_die);
20796 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
20797 verify_marks_clear (node->die);
20798 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode; ctnode = ctnode->next)
20799 verify_marks_clear (ctnode->root_die);
20800 #endif /* ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING */
20802 /* Mark types that are used in global variables. */
20803 premark_types_used_by_global_vars ();
20805 /* Set the mark on nodes that are actually used. */
20806 prune_unused_types_walk (comp_unit_die);
20807 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
20808 prune_unused_types_walk (node->die);
20809 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode; ctnode = ctnode->next)
20811 prune_unused_types_walk (ctnode->root_die);
20812 prune_unused_types_mark (ctnode->type_die, 1);
20815 /* Also set the mark on nodes referenced from the
20816 pubname_table or arange_table. */
20817 for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (pubname_entry, pubname_table, i, pub); i++)
20818 prune_unused_types_mark (pub->die, 1);
20819 for (i = 0; i < arange_table_in_use; i++)
20820 prune_unused_types_mark (arange_table[i], 1);
20822 /* Mark nodes referenced from the direct call table. */
20823 for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (dcall_entry, dcall_table, i, dcall); i++)
20824 prune_unused_types_mark (dcall->targ_die, 1);
20826 /* Get rid of nodes that aren't marked; and update the string counts. */
20827 if (debug_str_hash && debug_str_hash_forced)
20828 htab_traverse (debug_str_hash, prune_indirect_string, NULL);
20829 else if (debug_str_hash)
20830 htab_empty (debug_str_hash);
20831 prune_unused_types_prune (comp_unit_die);
20832 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
20833 prune_unused_types_prune (node->die);
20834 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode; ctnode = ctnode->next)
20835 prune_unused_types_prune (ctnode->root_die);
20837 /* Leave the marks clear. */
20838 prune_unmark_dies (comp_unit_die);
20839 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
20840 prune_unmark_dies (node->die);
20841 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode; ctnode = ctnode->next)
20842 prune_unmark_dies (ctnode->root_die);
20845 /* Set the parameter to true if there are any relative pathnames in
20846 the file table. */
20847 static int
20848 file_table_relative_p (void ** slot, void *param)
20850 bool *p = (bool *) param;
20851 struct dwarf_file_data *d = (struct dwarf_file_data *) *slot;
20852 if (!IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH (d->filename))
20854 *p = true;
20855 return 0;
20857 return 1;
20860 /* Routines to manipulate hash table of comdat type units. */
20862 static hashval_t
20863 htab_ct_hash (const void *of)
20865 hashval_t h;
20866 const comdat_type_node *const type_node = (const comdat_type_node *) of;
20868 memcpy (&h, type_node->signature, sizeof (h));
20869 return h;
20872 static int
20873 htab_ct_eq (const void *of1, const void *of2)
20875 const comdat_type_node *const type_node_1 = (const comdat_type_node *) of1;
20876 const comdat_type_node *const type_node_2 = (const comdat_type_node *) of2;
20878 return (! memcmp (type_node_1->signature, type_node_2->signature,
20879 DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE));
20882 /* Move a DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name attribute just added to dw_die_ref
20883 to the location it would have been added, should we know its
20884 DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME when we added other attributes. This will
20885 probably improve compactness of debug info, removing equivalent
20886 abbrevs, and hide any differences caused by deferring the
20887 computation of the assembler name, triggered by e.g. PCH. */
20889 static inline void
20890 move_linkage_attr (dw_die_ref die)
20892 unsigned ix = VEC_length (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr);
20893 dw_attr_node linkage = *VEC_index (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix - 1);
20895 gcc_assert (linkage.dw_attr == DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name);
20897 while (--ix > 0)
20899 dw_attr_node *prev = VEC_index (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix - 1);
20901 if (prev->dw_attr == DW_AT_decl_line || prev->dw_attr == DW_AT_name)
20902 break;
20905 if (ix != VEC_length (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr) - 1)
20907 VEC_pop (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr);
20908 VEC_quick_insert (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, &linkage);
20912 /* Helper function for resolve_addr, attempt to resolve
20913 one CONST_STRING, return non-zero if not successful. Similarly verify that
20914 SYMBOL_REFs refer to variables emitted in the current CU. */
20916 static int
20917 resolve_one_addr (rtx *addr, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
20919 rtx rtl = *addr;
20921 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
20923 size_t len = strlen (XSTR (rtl, 0)) + 1;
20924 tree t = build_string (len, XSTR (rtl, 0));
20925 tree tlen = build_int_cst (NULL_TREE, len - 1);
20926 TREE_TYPE (t)
20927 = build_array_type (char_type_node, build_index_type (tlen));
20928 rtl = lookup_constant_def (t);
20929 if (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl))
20930 return 1;
20931 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
20932 VEC_safe_push (rtx, gc, used_rtx_array, rtl);
20933 *addr = rtl;
20934 return 0;
20937 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF
20938 && SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl)
20939 && TREE_CODE (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl)) == VAR_DECL
20940 && !TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl)))
20941 return 1;
20943 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST
20944 && for_each_rtx (&XEXP (rtl, 0), resolve_one_addr, NULL))
20945 return 1;
20947 return 0;
20950 /* Helper function for resolve_addr, handle one location
20951 expression, return false if at least one CONST_STRING or SYMBOL_REF in
20952 the location list couldn't be resolved. */
20954 static bool
20955 resolve_addr_in_expr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
20957 for (; loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
20958 if ((loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_addr
20959 && resolve_one_addr (&loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr, NULL))
20960 || (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_implicit_value
20961 && loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class == dw_val_class_addr
20962 && resolve_one_addr (&loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_addr, NULL)))
20963 return false;
20964 return true;
20967 /* Resolve DW_OP_addr and DW_AT_const_value CONST_STRING arguments to
20968 an address in .rodata section if the string literal is emitted there,
20969 or remove the containing location list or replace DW_AT_const_value
20970 with DW_AT_location and empty location expression, if it isn't found
20971 in .rodata. Similarly for SYMBOL_REFs, keep only those that refer
20972 to something that has been emitted in the current CU. */
20974 static void
20975 resolve_addr (dw_die_ref die)
20977 dw_die_ref c;
20978 dw_attr_ref a;
20979 dw_loc_list_ref curr;
20980 unsigned ix;
20982 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
20983 switch (AT_class (a))
20985 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
20986 for (curr = AT_loc_list (a); curr != NULL; curr = curr->dw_loc_next)
20987 if (!resolve_addr_in_expr (curr->expr))
20988 curr->expr = NULL;
20989 break;
20990 case dw_val_class_loc:
20991 if (!resolve_addr_in_expr (AT_loc (a)))
20992 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc = NULL;
20993 break;
20994 case dw_val_class_addr:
20995 if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_const_value
20996 && resolve_one_addr (&a->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr, NULL))
20998 a->dw_attr = DW_AT_location;
20999 a->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
21000 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc = NULL;
21002 break;
21003 default:
21004 break;
21007 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, resolve_addr (c));
21010 /* Output stuff that dwarf requires at the end of every file,
21011 and generate the DWARF-2 debugging info. */
21013 static void
21014 dwarf2out_finish (const char *filename)
21016 limbo_die_node *node, *next_node;
21017 comdat_type_node *ctnode;
21018 htab_t comdat_type_table;
21019 dw_die_ref die = 0;
21020 unsigned int i;
21022 gen_remaining_tmpl_value_param_die_attribute ();
21024 /* Add the name for the main input file now. We delayed this from
21025 dwarf2out_init to avoid complications with PCH. */
21026 add_name_attribute (comp_unit_die, remap_debug_filename (filename));
21027 if (!IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH (filename))
21028 add_comp_dir_attribute (comp_unit_die);
21029 else if (get_AT (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_comp_dir) == NULL)
21031 bool p = false;
21032 htab_traverse (file_table, file_table_relative_p, &p);
21033 if (p)
21034 add_comp_dir_attribute (comp_unit_die);
21037 for (i = 0; i < VEC_length (deferred_locations, deferred_locations_list); i++)
21039 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (
21040 VEC_index (deferred_locations, deferred_locations_list, i)->die,
21041 VEC_index (deferred_locations, deferred_locations_list, i)->variable,
21042 DW_AT_location);
21045 /* Traverse the limbo die list, and add parent/child links. The only
21046 dies without parents that should be here are concrete instances of
21047 inline functions, and the comp_unit_die. We can ignore the comp_unit_die.
21048 For concrete instances, we can get the parent die from the abstract
21049 instance. */
21050 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = next_node)
21052 next_node = node->next;
21053 die = node->die;
21055 if (die->die_parent == NULL)
21057 dw_die_ref origin = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin);
21059 if (origin)
21060 add_child_die (origin->die_parent, die);
21061 else if (die == comp_unit_die)
21063 else if (errorcount > 0 || sorrycount > 0)
21064 /* It's OK to be confused by errors in the input. */
21065 add_child_die (comp_unit_die, die);
21066 else
21068 /* In certain situations, the lexical block containing a
21069 nested function can be optimized away, which results
21070 in the nested function die being orphaned. Likewise
21071 with the return type of that nested function. Force
21072 this to be a child of the containing function.
21074 It may happen that even the containing function got fully
21075 inlined and optimized out. In that case we are lost and
21076 assign the empty child. This should not be big issue as
21077 the function is likely unreachable too. */
21078 tree context = NULL_TREE;
21080 gcc_assert (node->created_for);
21082 if (DECL_P (node->created_for))
21083 context = DECL_CONTEXT (node->created_for);
21084 else if (TYPE_P (node->created_for))
21085 context = TYPE_CONTEXT (node->created_for);
21087 gcc_assert (context
21088 && (TREE_CODE (context) == FUNCTION_DECL
21089 || TREE_CODE (context) == NAMESPACE_DECL));
21091 origin = lookup_decl_die (context);
21092 if (origin)
21093 add_child_die (origin, die);
21094 else
21095 add_child_die (comp_unit_die, die);
21100 limbo_die_list = NULL;
21102 resolve_addr (comp_unit_die);
21104 for (node = deferred_asm_name; node; node = node->next)
21106 tree decl = node->created_for;
21107 if (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl) != DECL_NAME (decl))
21109 add_AT_string (node->die, DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name,
21110 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl)));
21111 move_linkage_attr (node->die);
21115 deferred_asm_name = NULL;
21117 /* Walk through the list of incomplete types again, trying once more to
21118 emit full debugging info for them. */
21119 retry_incomplete_types ();
21121 if (flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types)
21122 prune_unused_types ();
21124 /* Generate separate CUs for each of the include files we've seen.
21125 They will go into limbo_die_list. */
21126 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups && dwarf_version < 4)
21127 break_out_includes (comp_unit_die);
21129 /* Generate separate COMDAT sections for type DIEs. */
21130 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
21132 break_out_comdat_types (comp_unit_die);
21134 /* Each new type_unit DIE was added to the limbo die list when created.
21135 Since these have all been added to comdat_type_list, clear the
21136 limbo die list. */
21137 limbo_die_list = NULL;
21139 /* For each new comdat type unit, copy declarations for incomplete
21140 types to make the new unit self-contained (i.e., no direct
21141 references to the main compile unit). */
21142 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode != NULL; ctnode = ctnode->next)
21143 copy_decls_for_unworthy_types (ctnode->root_die);
21144 copy_decls_for_unworthy_types (comp_unit_die);
21146 /* In the process of copying declarations from one unit to another,
21147 we may have left some declarations behind that are no longer
21148 referenced. Prune them. */
21149 prune_unused_types ();
21152 /* Traverse the DIE's and add add sibling attributes to those DIE's
21153 that have children. */
21154 add_sibling_attributes (comp_unit_die);
21155 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
21156 add_sibling_attributes (node->die);
21157 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode != NULL; ctnode = ctnode->next)
21158 add_sibling_attributes (ctnode->root_die);
21160 /* Output a terminator label for the .text section. */
21161 switch_to_section (text_section);
21162 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, TEXT_END_LABEL, 0);
21163 if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
21165 switch_to_section (unlikely_text_section ());
21166 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, COLD_END_LABEL, 0);
21169 /* We can only use the low/high_pc attributes if all of the code was
21170 in .text. */
21171 if (!have_multiple_function_sections
21172 || !(dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
21174 add_AT_lbl_id (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_low_pc, text_section_label);
21175 add_AT_lbl_id (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_high_pc, text_end_label);
21178 else
21180 unsigned fde_idx = 0;
21182 /* We need to give .debug_loc and .debug_ranges an appropriate
21183 "base address". Use zero so that these addresses become
21184 absolute. Historically, we've emitted the unexpected
21185 DW_AT_entry_pc instead of DW_AT_low_pc for this purpose.
21186 Emit both to give time for other tools to adapt. */
21187 add_AT_addr (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_low_pc, const0_rtx);
21188 add_AT_addr (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_entry_pc, const0_rtx);
21190 add_AT_range_list (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_ranges,
21191 add_ranges_by_labels (text_section_label,
21192 text_end_label));
21193 if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
21194 add_ranges_by_labels (cold_text_section_label,
21195 cold_end_label);
21197 for (fde_idx = 0; fde_idx < fde_table_in_use; fde_idx++)
21199 dw_fde_ref fde = &fde_table[fde_idx];
21201 if (fde->dw_fde_switched_sections)
21203 if (!fde->in_std_section)
21204 add_ranges_by_labels (fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label,
21205 fde->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label);
21206 if (!fde->cold_in_std_section)
21207 add_ranges_by_labels (fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label,
21208 fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label);
21210 else if (!fde->in_std_section)
21211 add_ranges_by_labels (fde->dw_fde_begin,
21212 fde->dw_fde_end);
21215 add_ranges (NULL);
21218 /* Output location list section if necessary. */
21219 if (have_location_lists)
21221 /* Output the location lists info. */
21222 switch_to_section (debug_loc_section);
21223 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loc_section_label,
21224 DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
21225 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, loc_section_label);
21226 output_location_lists (die);
21229 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL)
21230 add_AT_lineptr (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_stmt_list,
21231 debug_line_section_label);
21233 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
21234 add_AT_macptr (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_macro_info, macinfo_section_label);
21236 /* Output all of the compilation units. We put the main one last so that
21237 the offsets are available to output_pubnames. */
21238 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
21239 output_comp_unit (node->die, 0);
21241 comdat_type_table = htab_create (100, htab_ct_hash, htab_ct_eq, NULL);
21242 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode != NULL; ctnode = ctnode->next)
21244 void **slot = htab_find_slot (comdat_type_table, ctnode, INSERT);
21246 /* Don't output duplicate types. */
21247 if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
21248 continue;
21250 /* Add a pointer to the line table for the main compilation unit
21251 so that the debugger can make sense of DW_AT_decl_file
21252 attributes. */
21253 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL)
21254 add_AT_lineptr (ctnode->root_die, DW_AT_stmt_list,
21255 debug_line_section_label);
21257 output_comdat_type_unit (ctnode);
21258 *slot = ctnode;
21260 htab_delete (comdat_type_table);
21262 /* Output the main compilation unit if non-empty or if .debug_macinfo
21263 has been emitted. */
21264 output_comp_unit (comp_unit_die, debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE);
21266 /* Output the abbreviation table. */
21267 switch_to_section (debug_abbrev_section);
21268 output_abbrev_section ();
21270 /* Output public names table if necessary. */
21271 if (!VEC_empty (pubname_entry, pubname_table))
21273 switch_to_section (debug_pubnames_section);
21274 output_pubnames (pubname_table);
21277 /* Output public types table if necessary. */
21278 /* ??? Only defined by DWARF3, but emitted by Darwin for DWARF2.
21279 It shouldn't hurt to emit it always, since pure DWARF2 consumers
21280 simply won't look for the section. */
21281 if (!VEC_empty (pubname_entry, pubtype_table))
21283 switch_to_section (debug_pubtypes_section);
21284 output_pubnames (pubtype_table);
21287 /* Output direct and virtual call tables if necessary. */
21288 if (!VEC_empty (dcall_entry, dcall_table))
21290 switch_to_section (debug_dcall_section);
21291 output_dcall_table ();
21293 if (!VEC_empty (vcall_entry, vcall_table))
21295 switch_to_section (debug_vcall_section);
21296 output_vcall_table ();
21299 /* Output the address range information. We only put functions in the arange
21300 table, so don't write it out if we don't have any. */
21301 if (fde_table_in_use)
21303 switch_to_section (debug_aranges_section);
21304 output_aranges ();
21307 /* Output ranges section if necessary. */
21308 if (ranges_table_in_use)
21310 switch_to_section (debug_ranges_section);
21311 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, ranges_section_label);
21312 output_ranges ();
21315 /* Output the source line correspondence table. We must do this
21316 even if there is no line information. Otherwise, on an empty
21317 translation unit, we will generate a present, but empty,
21318 .debug_info section. IRIX 6.5 `nm' will then complain when
21319 examining the file. This is done late so that any filenames
21320 used by the debug_info section are marked as 'used'. */
21321 if (! DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
21323 switch_to_section (debug_line_section);
21324 output_line_info ();
21327 /* Have to end the macro section. */
21328 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
21330 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
21331 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End compilation unit");
21334 /* If we emitted any DW_FORM_strp form attribute, output the string
21335 table too. */
21336 if (debug_str_hash)
21337 htab_traverse (debug_str_hash, output_indirect_string, NULL);
21339 #else
21341 /* This should never be used, but its address is needed for comparisons. */
21342 const struct gcc_debug_hooks dwarf2_debug_hooks =
21344 0, /* init */
21345 0, /* finish */
21346 0, /* assembly_start */
21347 0, /* define */
21348 0, /* undef */
21349 0, /* start_source_file */
21350 0, /* end_source_file */
21351 0, /* begin_block */
21352 0, /* end_block */
21353 0, /* ignore_block */
21354 0, /* source_line */
21355 0, /* begin_prologue */
21356 0, /* end_prologue */
21357 0, /* end_epilogue */
21358 0, /* begin_function */
21359 0, /* end_function */
21360 0, /* function_decl */
21361 0, /* global_decl */
21362 0, /* type_decl */
21363 0, /* imported_module_or_decl */
21364 0, /* deferred_inline_function */
21365 0, /* outlining_inline_function */
21366 0, /* label */
21367 0, /* handle_pch */
21368 0, /* var_location */
21369 0, /* switch_text_section */
21370 0, /* direct_call */
21371 0, /* virtual_call_token */
21372 0, /* copy_call_info */
21373 0, /* virtual_call */
21374 0, /* set_name */
21375 0 /* start_end_main_source_file */
21378 #endif /* DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO */
21380 #include "gt-dwarf2out.h"